clang 22.0.0git
Sema.h
Go to the documentation of this file.
1//===--- Sema.h - Semantic Analysis & AST Building --------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4// See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5// SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6//
7//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8//
9// This file defines the Sema class, which performs semantic analysis and
10// builds ASTs.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#ifndef LLVM_CLANG_SEMA_SEMA_H
15#define LLVM_CLANG_SEMA_SEMA_H
16
18#include "clang/AST/ASTFwd.h"
19#include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
20#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
22#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
23#include "clang/AST/DeclBase.h"
24#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
27#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
28#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
33#include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h"
34#include "clang/AST/Type.h"
35#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
39#include "clang/Basic/Cuda.h"
43#include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h"
44#include "clang/Basic/Lambda.h"
46#include "clang/Basic/Module.h"
58#include "clang/Sema/Attr.h"
60#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
66#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
67#include "clang/Sema/SemaBase.h"
71#include "clang/Sema/Weak.h"
72#include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
73#include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
74#include "llvm/ADT/BitmaskEnum.h"
75#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
76#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
77#include "llvm/ADT/FloatingPointMode.h"
78#include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h"
79#include "llvm/ADT/MapVector.h"
80#include "llvm/ADT/PointerIntPair.h"
81#include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h"
82#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
83#include "llvm/ADT/STLForwardCompat.h"
84#include "llvm/ADT/STLFunctionalExtras.h"
85#include "llvm/ADT/SetVector.h"
86#include "llvm/ADT/SmallBitVector.h"
87#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
88#include "llvm/ADT/SmallSet.h"
89#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
90#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
91#include "llvm/ADT/StringMap.h"
92#include "llvm/ADT/TinyPtrVector.h"
93#include "llvm/Support/Allocator.h"
94#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
95#include "llvm/Support/Error.h"
96#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
97#include <cassert>
98#include <climits>
99#include <cstddef>
100#include <cstdint>
101#include <deque>
102#include <functional>
103#include <iterator>
104#include <memory>
105#include <optional>
106#include <string>
107#include <tuple>
108#include <type_traits>
109#include <utility>
110#include <vector>
111
112namespace llvm {
113struct InlineAsmIdentifierInfo;
114} // namespace llvm
115
116namespace clang {
117class ADLResult;
118class APValue;
120class ASTConsumer;
121class ASTContext;
122class ASTDeclReader;
124class ASTReader;
125class ASTWriter;
126class CXXBasePath;
127class CXXBasePaths;
130enum class ComparisonCategoryType : unsigned char;
132class DarwinSDKInfo;
133class DeclGroupRef;
137class Designation;
138class IdentifierInfo;
144enum class LangAS : unsigned int;
146class LookupResult;
149class ModuleLoader;
153class ObjCMethodDecl;
154struct OverloadCandidate;
155enum class OverloadCandidateParamOrder : char;
156enum OverloadCandidateRewriteKind : unsigned;
158class Preprocessor;
159class SemaAMDGPU;
160class SemaARM;
161class SemaAVR;
162class SemaBPF;
164class SemaCUDA;
165class SemaDirectX;
166class SemaHLSL;
167class SemaHexagon;
168class SemaLoongArch;
169class SemaM68k;
170class SemaMIPS;
171class SemaMSP430;
172class SemaNVPTX;
173class SemaObjC;
174class SemaOpenACC;
175class SemaOpenCL;
176class SemaOpenMP;
177class SemaPPC;
178class SemaPseudoObject;
179class SemaRISCV;
180class SemaSPIRV;
181class SemaSYCL;
182class SemaSwift;
183class SemaSystemZ;
184class SemaWasm;
185class SemaX86;
187class TemplateArgument;
192class Token;
193class TypeConstraint;
198
199namespace sema {
200class BlockScopeInfo;
201class Capture;
208class LambdaScopeInfo;
209class SemaPPCallbacks;
211} // namespace sema
212
213// AssignmentAction - This is used by all the assignment diagnostic functions
214// to represent what is actually causing the operation
225
226namespace threadSafety {
227class BeforeSet;
228void threadSafetyCleanup(BeforeSet *Cache);
229} // namespace threadSafety
230
231// FIXME: No way to easily map from TemplateTypeParmTypes to
232// TemplateTypeParmDecls, so we have this horrible PointerUnion.
233typedef std::pair<llvm::PointerUnion<const TemplateTypeParmType *, NamedDecl *,
234 const TemplateSpecializationType *,
235 const SubstBuiltinTemplatePackType *>,
238
239/// Describes whether we've seen any nullability information for the given
240/// file.
242 /// The first pointer declarator (of any pointer kind) in the file that does
243 /// not have a corresponding nullability annotation.
245
246 /// The end location for the first pointer declarator in the file. Used for
247 /// placing fix-its.
249
250 /// Which kind of pointer declarator we saw.
251 uint8_t PointerKind;
252
253 /// Whether we saw any type nullability annotations in the given file.
254 bool SawTypeNullability = false;
255};
256
257/// A mapping from file IDs to a record of whether we've seen nullability
258/// information in that file.
260 /// A mapping from file IDs to the nullability information for each file ID.
261 llvm::DenseMap<FileID, FileNullability> Map;
262
263 /// A single-element cache based on the file ID.
264 struct {
267 } Cache;
268
269public:
271 // Check the single-element cache.
272 if (file == Cache.File)
273 return Cache.Nullability;
274
275 // It's not in the single-element cache; flush the cache if we have one.
276 if (!Cache.File.isInvalid()) {
277 Map[Cache.File] = Cache.Nullability;
278 }
279
280 // Pull this entry into the cache.
281 Cache.File = file;
282 Cache.Nullability = Map[file];
283 return Cache.Nullability;
284 }
285};
286
287/// Tracks expected type during expression parsing, for use in code completion.
288/// The type is tied to a particular token, all functions that update or consume
289/// the type take a start location of the token they are looking at as a
290/// parameter. This avoids updating the type on hot paths in the parser.
292public:
294 : Ctx(Ctx), Enabled(Enabled) {}
295
299 /// Handles e.g. BaseType{ .D = Tok...
301 const Designation &D);
302 /// Computing a type for the function argument may require running
303 /// overloading, so we postpone its computation until it is actually needed.
304 ///
305 /// Clients should be very careful when using this function, as it stores a
306 /// function_ref, clients should make sure all calls to get() with the same
307 /// location happen while function_ref is alive.
308 ///
309 /// The callback should also emit signature help as a side-effect, but only
310 /// if the completion point has been reached.
312 llvm::function_ref<QualType()> ComputeType);
313
316 SourceLocation OpLoc);
319 void enterSubscript(Sema &S, SourceLocation Tok, Expr *LHS);
320 /// Handles all type casts, including C-style cast, C++ casts, etc.
322
323 /// Get the expected type associated with this location, if any.
324 ///
325 /// If the location is a function argument, determining the expected type
326 /// involves considering all function overloads and the arguments so far.
327 /// In this case, signature help for these function overloads will be reported
328 /// as a side-effect (only if the completion point has been reached).
330 if (!Enabled || Tok != ExpectedLoc)
331 return QualType();
332 if (!Type.isNull())
333 return Type;
334 if (ComputeType)
335 return ComputeType();
336 return QualType();
337 }
338
339private:
340 ASTContext *Ctx;
341 bool Enabled;
342 /// Start position of a token for which we store expected type.
343 SourceLocation ExpectedLoc;
344 /// Expected type for a token starting at ExpectedLoc.
346 /// A function to compute expected type at ExpectedLoc. It is only considered
347 /// if Type is null.
348 llvm::function_ref<QualType()> ComputeType;
349};
350
352 SkipBodyInfo() = default;
353 bool ShouldSkip = false;
355 NamedDecl *Previous = nullptr;
356 NamedDecl *New = nullptr;
357};
358
359/// Describes the result of template argument deduction.
360///
361/// The TemplateDeductionResult enumeration describes the result of
362/// template argument deduction, as returned from
363/// DeduceTemplateArguments(). The separate TemplateDeductionInfo
364/// structure provides additional information about the results of
365/// template argument deduction, e.g., the deduced template argument
366/// list (if successful) or the specific template parameters or
367/// deduced arguments that were involved in the failure.
369 /// Template argument deduction was successful.
371 /// The declaration was invalid; do nothing.
373 /// Template argument deduction exceeded the maximum template
374 /// instantiation depth (which has already been diagnosed).
376 /// Template argument deduction did not deduce a value
377 /// for every template parameter.
379 /// Template argument deduction did not deduce a value for every
380 /// expansion of an expanded template parameter pack.
382 /// Template argument deduction produced inconsistent
383 /// deduced values for the given template parameter.
385 /// Template argument deduction failed due to inconsistent
386 /// cv-qualifiers on a template parameter type that would
387 /// otherwise be deduced, e.g., we tried to deduce T in "const T"
388 /// but were given a non-const "X".
390 /// Substitution of the deduced template argument values
391 /// resulted in an error.
393 /// After substituting deduced template arguments, a dependent
394 /// parameter type did not match the corresponding argument.
396 /// After substituting deduced template arguments, an element of
397 /// a dependent parameter type did not match the corresponding element
398 /// of the corresponding argument (when deducing from an initializer list).
400 /// A non-depnedent component of the parameter did not match the
401 /// corresponding component of the argument.
403 /// When performing template argument deduction for a function
404 /// template, there were too many call arguments.
406 /// When performing template argument deduction for a function
407 /// template, there were too few call arguments.
409 /// The explicitly-specified template arguments were not valid
410 /// template arguments for the given template.
412 /// Checking non-dependent argument conversions failed.
414 /// The deduced arguments did not satisfy the constraints associated
415 /// with the template.
417 /// Deduction failed; that's all we know.
419 /// CUDA Target attributes do not match.
421 /// Some error which was already diagnosed.
423};
424
425/// Kinds of C++ special members.
435
436/// The kind of conversion being performed.
438 /// An implicit conversion.
440 /// A C-style cast.
442 /// A functional-style cast.
444 /// A cast other than a C-style cast.
446 /// A conversion for an operand of a builtin overloaded operator.
448};
449
450enum class TagUseKind {
451 Reference, // Reference to a tag: 'struct foo *X;'
452 Declaration, // Fwd decl of a tag: 'struct foo;'
453 Definition, // Definition of a tag: 'struct foo { int X; } Y;'
454 Friend // Friend declaration: 'friend struct foo;'
455};
456
457/// Used with attributes/effects with a boolean condition, e.g. `nonblocking`.
458enum class FunctionEffectMode : uint8_t {
459 None, // effect is not present.
460 False, // effect(false).
461 True, // effect(true).
462 Dependent // effect(expr) where expr is dependent.
463};
464
465/// pragma clang section kind
468 BSS = 1,
469 Data = 2,
471 Text = 4,
473};
474
475enum class PragmaClangSectionAction { Set = 0, Clear = 1 };
476
478 Native, // #pragma options align=native
479 Natural, // #pragma options align=natural
480 Packed, // #pragma options align=packed
481 Power, // #pragma options align=power
482 Mac68k, // #pragma options align=mac68k
483 Reset // #pragma options align=reset
484};
485
486enum class TUFragmentKind {
487 /// The global module fragment, between 'module;' and a module-declaration.
489 /// A normal translation unit fragment. For a non-module unit, this is the
490 /// entire translation unit. Otherwise, it runs from the module-declaration
491 /// to the private-module-fragment (if any) or the end of the TU (if not).
493 /// The private module fragment, between 'module :private;' and the end of
494 /// the translation unit.
496};
497
510
511// Used for emitting the right warning by DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion
519
528
529// Contexts where using non-trivial C union types can be disallowed. This is
530// passed to err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context.
532 // Function parameter.
534 // Function return.
536 // Default-initialized object.
538 // Variable with automatic storage duration.
540 // Initializer expression that might copy from another object.
542 // Assignment.
544 // Compound literal.
546 // Block capture.
548 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion of volatile type.
550};
551
552/// Describes the result of the name lookup and resolution performed
553/// by \c Sema::ClassifyName().
555 /// This name is not a type or template in this context, but might be
556 /// something else.
558 /// Classification failed; an error has been produced.
560 /// The name has been typo-corrected to a keyword.
562 /// The name was classified as a type.
564 /// The name was classified as a specific non-type, non-template
565 /// declaration. ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType should be called to
566 /// convert the declaration to an expression.
568 /// The name was classified as an ADL-only function name.
569 /// ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType should be called to convert the
570 /// result to an expression.
572 /// The name denotes a member of a dependent type that could not be
573 /// resolved. ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType should be called to
574 /// convert the result to an expression.
576 /// The name was classified as an overload set, and an expression
577 /// representing that overload set has been formed.
578 /// ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet should be called to form a suitable
579 /// expression referencing the overload set.
581 /// The name was classified as a template whose specializations are types.
583 /// The name was classified as a variable template name.
585 /// The name was classified as a function template name.
587 /// The name was classified as an ADL-only function template name.
589 /// The name was classified as a concept name.
591};
592
594 // Address discrimination argument of __ptrauth.
596
597 // Extra discriminator argument of __ptrauth.
599};
600
601/// Common ways to introduce type names without a tag for use in diagnostics.
602/// Keep in sync with err_tag_reference_non_tag.
614
615enum class OffsetOfKind {
616 // Not parsing a type within __builtin_offsetof.
618 // Parsing a type within __builtin_offsetof.
620 // Parsing a type within macro "offsetof", defined in __buitin_offsetof
621 // To improve our diagnostic message.
623};
624
625/// Describes the kind of merge to perform for availability
626/// attributes (including "deprecated", "unavailable", and "availability").
628 /// Don't merge availability attributes at all.
630 /// Merge availability attributes for a redeclaration, which requires
631 /// an exact match.
633 /// Merge availability attributes for an override, which requires
634 /// an exact match or a weakening of constraints.
636 /// Merge availability attributes for an implementation of
637 /// a protocol requirement.
639 /// Merge availability attributes for an implementation of
640 /// an optional protocol requirement.
642};
643
645 /// The triviality of a method unaffected by "trivial_abi".
647
648 /// The triviality of a method affected by "trivial_abi".
650};
651
653
654enum class AllowFoldKind {
657};
658
659/// Context in which we're performing a usual arithmetic conversion.
660enum class ArithConvKind {
661 /// An arithmetic operation.
663 /// A bitwise operation.
665 /// A comparison.
667 /// A conditional (?:) operator.
669 /// A compound assignment expression.
671};
672
673// Used for determining in which context a type is allowed to be passed to a
674// vararg function.
682
683/// AssignConvertType - All of the 'assignment' semantic checks return this
684/// enum to indicate whether the assignment was allowed. These checks are
685/// done for simple assignments, as well as initialization, return from
686/// function, argument passing, etc. The query is phrased in terms of a
687/// source and destination type.
689 /// Compatible - the types are compatible according to the standard.
691
692 /// CompatibleVoidPtrToNonVoidPtr - The types are compatible in C because
693 /// a void * can implicitly convert to another pointer type, which we
694 /// differentiate for better diagnostic behavior.
696
697 /// PointerToInt - The assignment converts a pointer to an int, which we
698 /// accept as an extension.
700
701 /// IntToPointer - The assignment converts an int to a pointer, which we
702 /// accept as an extension.
704
705 /// FunctionVoidPointer - The assignment is between a function pointer and
706 /// void*, which the standard doesn't allow, but we accept as an extension.
708
709 /// IncompatiblePointer - The assignment is between two pointers types that
710 /// are not compatible, but we accept them as an extension.
712
713 /// IncompatibleFunctionPointer - The assignment is between two function
714 /// pointers types that are not compatible, but we accept them as an
715 /// extension.
717
718 /// IncompatibleFunctionPointerStrict - The assignment is between two
719 /// function pointer types that are not identical, but are compatible,
720 /// unless compiled with -fsanitize=cfi, in which case the type mismatch
721 /// may trip an indirect call runtime check.
723
724 /// IncompatiblePointerSign - The assignment is between two pointers types
725 /// which point to integers which have a different sign, but are otherwise
726 /// identical. This is a subset of the above, but broken out because it's by
727 /// far the most common case of incompatible pointers.
729
730 /// CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers - The assignment discards
731 /// c/v/r qualifiers, which we accept as an extension.
733
734 /// IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers - The assignment
735 /// discards qualifiers that we don't permit to be discarded,
736 /// like address spaces.
738
739 /// IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch - The assignment
740 /// changes address spaces in nested pointer types which is not allowed.
741 /// For instance, converting __private int ** to __generic int ** is
742 /// illegal even though __private could be converted to __generic.
744
745 /// IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers - The assignment is between two
746 /// nested pointer types, and the qualifiers other than the first two
747 /// levels differ e.g. char ** -> const char **, but we accept them as an
748 /// extension.
750
751 /// IncompatibleVectors - The assignment is between two vector types that
752 /// have the same size, which we accept as an extension.
754
755 /// IntToBlockPointer - The assignment converts an int to a block
756 /// pointer. We disallow this.
758
759 /// IncompatibleBlockPointer - The assignment is between two block
760 /// pointers types that are not compatible.
762
763 /// IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId - The assignment is between a qualified
764 /// id type and something else (that is incompatible with it). For example,
765 /// "id <XXX>" = "Foo *", where "Foo *" doesn't implement the XXX protocol.
767
768 /// IncompatibleObjCWeakRef - Assigning a weak-unavailable object to an
769 /// object with __weak qualifier.
771
772 /// Incompatible - We reject this conversion outright, it is invalid to
773 /// represent it in the AST.
775};
776
777/// The scope in which to find allocation functions.
779 /// Only look for allocation functions in the global scope.
781 /// Only look for allocation functions in the scope of the
782 /// allocated class.
784 /// Look for allocation functions in both the global scope
785 /// and in the scope of the allocated class.
787};
788
789/// Describes the result of an "if-exists" condition check.
790enum class IfExistsResult {
791 /// The symbol exists.
793
794 /// The symbol does not exist.
796
797 /// The name is a dependent name, so the results will differ
798 /// from one instantiation to the next.
800
801 /// An error occurred.
803};
804
805enum class CorrectTypoKind {
806 NonError, // CorrectTypo used in a non error recovery situation.
807 ErrorRecovery // CorrectTypo used in normal error recovery.
808};
809
810enum class OverloadKind {
811 /// This is a legitimate overload: the existing declarations are
812 /// functions or function templates with different signatures.
814
815 /// This is not an overload because the signature exactly matches
816 /// an existing declaration.
818
819 /// This is not an overload because the lookup results contain a
820 /// non-function.
822};
823
824/// Contexts in which a converted constant expression is required.
825enum class CCEKind {
826 CaseValue, ///< Expression in a case label.
827 Enumerator, ///< Enumerator value with fixed underlying type.
828 TemplateArg, ///< Value of a non-type template parameter.
829 TempArgStrict, ///< As above, but applies strict template checking
830 ///< rules.
831 ArrayBound, ///< Array bound in array declarator or new-expression.
832 ExplicitBool, ///< Condition in an explicit(bool) specifier.
833 Noexcept, ///< Condition in a noexcept(bool) specifier.
834 StaticAssertMessageSize, ///< Call to size() in a static assert
835 ///< message.
836 StaticAssertMessageData, ///< Call to data() in a static assert
837 ///< message.
838};
839
840/// Enums for the diagnostics of target, target_version and target_clones.
841namespace DiagAttrParams {
845} // end namespace DiagAttrParams
846
847void inferNoReturnAttr(Sema &S, Decl *D);
848
849#ifdef __GNUC__
850#pragma GCC diagnostic push
851#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wattributes"
852#endif
853/// Sema - This implements semantic analysis and AST building for C.
854/// \nosubgrouping
855class Sema final : public SemaBase {
856#ifdef __GNUC__
857#pragma GCC diagnostic pop
858#endif
859 // Table of Contents
860 // -----------------
861 // 1. Semantic Analysis (Sema.cpp)
862 // 2. API Notes (SemaAPINotes.cpp)
863 // 3. C++ Access Control (SemaAccess.cpp)
864 // 4. Attributes (SemaAttr.cpp)
865 // 5. Availability Attribute Handling (SemaAvailability.cpp)
866 // 6. Bounds Safety (SemaBoundsSafety.cpp)
867 // 7. Casts (SemaCast.cpp)
868 // 8. Extra Semantic Checking (SemaChecking.cpp)
869 // 9. C++ Coroutines (SemaCoroutine.cpp)
870 // 10. C++ Scope Specifiers (SemaCXXScopeSpec.cpp)
871 // 11. Declarations (SemaDecl.cpp)
872 // 12. Declaration Attribute Handling (SemaDeclAttr.cpp)
873 // 13. C++ Declarations (SemaDeclCXX.cpp)
874 // 14. C++ Exception Specifications (SemaExceptionSpec.cpp)
875 // 15. Expressions (SemaExpr.cpp)
876 // 16. C++ Expressions (SemaExprCXX.cpp)
877 // 17. Member Access Expressions (SemaExprMember.cpp)
878 // 18. Initializers (SemaInit.cpp)
879 // 19. C++ Lambda Expressions (SemaLambda.cpp)
880 // 20. Name Lookup (SemaLookup.cpp)
881 // 21. Modules (SemaModule.cpp)
882 // 22. C++ Overloading (SemaOverload.cpp)
883 // 23. Statements (SemaStmt.cpp)
884 // 24. `inline asm` Statement (SemaStmtAsm.cpp)
885 // 25. Statement Attribute Handling (SemaStmtAttr.cpp)
886 // 26. C++ Templates (SemaTemplate.cpp)
887 // 27. C++ Template Argument Deduction (SemaTemplateDeduction.cpp)
888 // 28. C++ Template Deduction Guide (SemaTemplateDeductionGuide.cpp)
889 // 29. C++ Template Instantiation (SemaTemplateInstantiate.cpp)
890 // 30. C++ Template Declaration Instantiation
891 // (SemaTemplateInstantiateDecl.cpp)
892 // 31. C++ Variadic Templates (SemaTemplateVariadic.cpp)
893 // 32. Constraints and Concepts (SemaConcept.cpp)
894 // 33. Types (SemaType.cpp)
895 // 34. FixIt Helpers (SemaFixItUtils.cpp)
896 // 35. Function Effects (SemaFunctionEffects.cpp)
897
898 /// \name Semantic Analysis
899 /// Implementations are in Sema.cpp
900 ///@{
901
902public:
903 Sema(Preprocessor &pp, ASTContext &ctxt, ASTConsumer &consumer,
905 CodeCompleteConsumer *CompletionConsumer = nullptr);
906 ~Sema();
907
908 /// Perform initialization that occurs after the parser has been
909 /// initialized but before it parses anything.
910 void Initialize();
911
912 /// This virtual key function only exists to limit the emission of debug info
913 /// describing the Sema class. GCC and Clang only emit debug info for a class
914 /// with a vtable when the vtable is emitted. Sema is final and not
915 /// polymorphic, but the debug info size savings are so significant that it is
916 /// worth adding a vtable just to take advantage of this optimization.
918
919 const LangOptions &getLangOpts() const { return LangOpts; }
922
925 Preprocessor &getPreprocessor() const { return PP; }
926 ASTContext &getASTContext() const { return Context; }
930
932 StringRef Platform);
934
935 /// Registers an external source. If an external source already exists,
936 /// creates a multiplex external source and appends to it.
937 ///
938 ///\param[in] E - A non-null external sema source.
939 ///
941
942 /// Print out statistics about the semantic analysis.
943 void PrintStats() const;
944
945 /// Run some code with "sufficient" stack space. (Currently, at least 256K is
946 /// guaranteed). Produces a warning if we're low on stack space and allocates
947 /// more in that case. Use this in code that may recurse deeply (for example,
948 /// in template instantiation) to avoid stack overflow.
950 llvm::function_ref<void()> Fn);
951
952 /// Returns default addr space for method qualifiers.
954
955 /// Load weak undeclared identifiers from the external source.
957
958 /// Determine if VD, which must be a variable or function, is an external
959 /// symbol that nonetheless can't be referenced from outside this translation
960 /// unit because its type has no linkage and it's not extern "C".
961 bool isExternalWithNoLinkageType(const ValueDecl *VD) const;
962
963 /// Obtain a sorted list of functions that are undefined but ODR-used.
965 SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<NamedDecl *, SourceLocation>> &Undefined);
966
967 typedef std::pair<SourceLocation, bool> DeleteExprLoc;
969 /// Retrieves list of suspicious delete-expressions that will be checked at
970 /// the end of translation unit.
971 const llvm::MapVector<FieldDecl *, DeleteLocs> &
973
974 /// Cause the built diagnostic to be emitted on the DiagosticsEngine.
975 /// This is closely coupled to the SemaDiagnosticBuilder class and
976 /// should not be used elsewhere.
977 void EmitDiagnostic(unsigned DiagID, const DiagnosticBuilder &DB);
978
979 void addImplicitTypedef(StringRef Name, QualType T);
980
981 /// Whether uncompilable error has occurred. This includes error happens
982 /// in deferred diagnostics.
983 bool hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() const;
984
985 /// Looks through the macro-expansion chain for the given
986 /// location, looking for a macro expansion with the given name.
987 /// If one is found, returns true and sets the location to that
988 /// expansion loc.
989 bool findMacroSpelling(SourceLocation &loc, StringRef name);
990
991 /// Calls \c Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken()
992 SourceLocation getLocForEndOfToken(SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Offset = 0);
993
994 /// Calls \c Lexer::findNextToken() to find the next token, and if the
995 /// locations of both ends of the token can be resolved it return that
996 /// range; Otherwise it returns an invalid SourceRange.
998 SourceLocation Loc, bool IncludeMacros, bool IncludeComments,
999 std::optional<tok::TokenKind> ExpectedToken = std::nullopt);
1000
1001 /// Retrieve the module loader associated with the preprocessor.
1003
1004 /// Invent a new identifier for parameters of abbreviated templates.
1007 unsigned Index);
1008
1010
1011 // Emit all deferred diagnostics.
1012 void emitDeferredDiags();
1013
1014 /// This is called before the very first declaration in the translation unit
1015 /// is parsed. Note that the ASTContext may have already injected some
1016 /// declarations.
1018 /// ActOnEndOfTranslationUnit - This is called at the very end of the
1019 /// translation unit when EOF is reached and all but the top-level scope is
1020 /// popped.
1023
1024 /// Determines the active Scope associated with the given declaration
1025 /// context.
1026 ///
1027 /// This routine maps a declaration context to the active Scope object that
1028 /// represents that declaration context in the parser. It is typically used
1029 /// from "scope-less" code (e.g., template instantiation, lazy creation of
1030 /// declarations) that injects a name for name-lookup purposes and, therefore,
1031 /// must update the Scope.
1032 ///
1033 /// \returns The scope corresponding to the given declaraion context, or NULL
1034 /// if no such scope is open.
1036
1037 void PushFunctionScope();
1038 void PushBlockScope(Scope *BlockScope, BlockDecl *Block);
1040
1041 /// This is used to inform Sema what the current TemplateParameterDepth
1042 /// is during Parsing. Currently it is used to pass on the depth
1043 /// when parsing generic lambda 'auto' parameters.
1044 void RecordParsingTemplateParameterDepth(unsigned Depth);
1045
1046 void PushCapturedRegionScope(Scope *RegionScope, CapturedDecl *CD,
1048 unsigned OpenMPCaptureLevel = 0);
1049
1050 /// Custom deleter to allow FunctionScopeInfos to be kept alive for a short
1051 /// time after they've been popped.
1053 Sema *Self;
1054
1055 public:
1056 explicit PoppedFunctionScopeDeleter(Sema *Self) : Self(Self) {}
1058 };
1059
1061 std::unique_ptr<sema::FunctionScopeInfo, PoppedFunctionScopeDeleter>;
1062
1063 /// Pop a function (or block or lambda or captured region) scope from the
1064 /// stack.
1065 ///
1066 /// \param WP The warning policy to use for CFG-based warnings, or null if
1067 /// such warnings should not be produced.
1068 /// \param D The declaration corresponding to this function scope, if
1069 /// producing CFG-based warnings.
1070 /// \param BlockType The type of the block expression, if D is a BlockDecl.
1073 Decl *D = nullptr, QualType BlockType = QualType());
1074
1076
1081
1082 void PushCompoundScope(bool IsStmtExpr);
1083 void PopCompoundScope();
1084
1085 /// Determine whether any errors occurred within this function/method/
1086 /// block.
1088
1089 /// Retrieve the current block, if any.
1091
1092 /// Get the innermost lambda or block enclosing the current location, if any.
1093 /// This looks through intervening non-lambda, non-block scopes such as local
1094 /// functions.
1096
1097 /// Retrieve the current lambda scope info, if any.
1098 /// \param IgnoreNonLambdaCapturingScope true if should find the top-most
1099 /// lambda scope info ignoring all inner capturing scopes that are not
1100 /// lambda scopes.
1102 getCurLambda(bool IgnoreNonLambdaCapturingScope = false);
1103
1104 /// Retrieve the current generic lambda info, if any.
1106
1107 /// Retrieve the current captured region, if any.
1109
1110 void ActOnComment(SourceRange Comment);
1111
1112 /// Retrieve the parser's current scope.
1113 ///
1114 /// This routine must only be used when it is certain that semantic analysis
1115 /// and the parser are in precisely the same context, which is not the case
1116 /// when, e.g., we are performing any kind of template instantiation.
1117 /// Therefore, the only safe places to use this scope are in the parser
1118 /// itself and in routines directly invoked from the parser and *never* from
1119 /// template substitution or instantiation.
1120 Scope *getCurScope() const { return CurScope; }
1121
1123
1127
1128 SemaDiagnosticBuilder targetDiag(SourceLocation Loc, unsigned DiagID,
1129 const FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr);
1131 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
1132 const FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr) {
1133 return targetDiag(Loc, PD.getDiagID(), FD) << PD;
1134 }
1135
1136 /// Check if the type is allowed to be used for the current target.
1138 ValueDecl *D = nullptr);
1139
1140 /// ImpCastExprToType - If Expr is not of type 'Type', insert an implicit
1141 /// cast. If there is already an implicit cast, merge into the existing one.
1142 /// If isLvalue, the result of the cast is an lvalue.
1145 const CXXCastPath *BasePath = nullptr,
1147
1148 /// ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind - Returns the cast kind corresponding
1149 /// to the conversion from scalar type ScalarTy to the Boolean type.
1151
1152 /// If \p AllowLambda is true, treat lambda as function.
1153 DeclContext *getFunctionLevelDeclContext(bool AllowLambda = false) const;
1154
1155 /// Returns a pointer to the innermost enclosing function, or nullptr if the
1156 /// current context is not inside a function. If \p AllowLambda is true,
1157 /// this can return the call operator of an enclosing lambda, otherwise
1158 /// lambdas are skipped when looking for an enclosing function.
1159 FunctionDecl *getCurFunctionDecl(bool AllowLambda = false) const;
1160
1161 /// getCurMethodDecl - If inside of a method body, this returns a pointer to
1162 /// the method decl for the method being parsed. If we're currently
1163 /// in a 'block', this returns the containing context.
1165
1166 /// getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl - Return the Decl for the current ObjC method
1167 /// or C function we're in, otherwise return null. If we're currently
1168 /// in a 'block', this returns the containing context.
1170
1171 /// Warn if we're implicitly casting from a _Nullable pointer type to a
1172 /// _Nonnull one.
1174 SourceLocation Loc);
1175
1176 /// Warn when implicitly casting 0 to nullptr.
1177 void diagnoseZeroToNullptrConversion(CastKind Kind, const Expr *E);
1178
1179 /// Warn when implicitly changing function effects.
1181 SourceLocation Loc);
1182
1183 /// makeUnavailableInSystemHeader - There is an error in the current
1184 /// context. If we're still in a system header, and we can plausibly
1185 /// make the relevant declaration unavailable instead of erroring, do
1186 /// so and return true.
1188 UnavailableAttr::ImplicitReason reason);
1189
1190 /// Retrieve a suitable printing policy for diagnostics.
1194
1195 /// Retrieve a suitable printing policy for diagnostics.
1197 const Preprocessor &PP);
1198
1199 /// Scope actions.
1201
1202 /// Determine whether \param D is function like (function or function
1203 /// template) for parsing.
1205
1206 /// The maximum alignment, same as in llvm::Value. We duplicate them here
1207 /// because that allows us not to duplicate the constants in clang code,
1208 /// which we must to since we can't directly use the llvm constants.
1209 /// The value is verified against llvm here: lib/CodeGen/CGDecl.cpp
1210 ///
1211 /// This is the greatest alignment value supported by load, store, and alloca
1212 /// instructions, and global values.
1213 static const unsigned MaxAlignmentExponent = 32;
1214 static const uint64_t MaximumAlignment = 1ull << MaxAlignmentExponent;
1215
1216 /// Flag indicating whether or not to collect detailed statistics.
1218
1219 std::unique_ptr<sema::FunctionScopeInfo> CachedFunctionScope;
1220
1221 /// Stack containing information about each of the nested
1222 /// function, block, and method scopes that are currently active.
1224
1225 /// The index of the first FunctionScope that corresponds to the current
1226 /// context.
1228
1229 /// Track the number of currently active capturing scopes.
1231
1232 llvm::BumpPtrAllocator BumpAlloc;
1233
1234 /// The kind of translation unit we are processing.
1235 ///
1236 /// When we're processing a complete translation unit, Sema will perform
1237 /// end-of-translation-unit semantic tasks (such as creating
1238 /// initializers for tentative definitions in C) once parsing has
1239 /// completed. Modules and precompiled headers perform different kinds of
1240 /// checks.
1242
1243 /// Translation Unit Scope - useful to Objective-C actions that need
1244 /// to lookup file scope declarations in the "ordinary" C decl namespace.
1245 /// For example, user-defined classes, built-in "id" type, etc.
1247
1249 return CurScope->incrementMSManglingNumber();
1250 }
1251
1252 /// Try to recover by turning the given expression into a
1253 /// call. Returns true if recovery was attempted or an error was
1254 /// emitted; this may also leave the ExprResult invalid.
1256 bool ForceComplain = false,
1257 bool (*IsPlausibleResult)(QualType) = nullptr);
1258
1259 /// Figure out if an expression could be turned into a call.
1260 ///
1261 /// Use this when trying to recover from an error where the programmer may
1262 /// have written just the name of a function instead of actually calling it.
1263 ///
1264 /// \param E - The expression to examine.
1265 /// \param ZeroArgCallReturnTy - If the expression can be turned into a call
1266 /// with no arguments, this parameter is set to the type returned by such a
1267 /// call; otherwise, it is set to an empty QualType.
1268 /// \param OverloadSet - If the expression is an overloaded function
1269 /// name, this parameter is populated with the decls of the various
1270 /// overloads.
1271 bool tryExprAsCall(Expr &E, QualType &ZeroArgCallReturnTy,
1272 UnresolvedSetImpl &NonTemplateOverloads);
1273
1277
1280
1288
1289 /// A RAII object to enter scope of a compound statement.
1291 public:
1292 CompoundScopeRAII(Sema &S, bool IsStmtExpr = false) : S(S) {
1293 S.ActOnStartOfCompoundStmt(IsStmtExpr);
1294 }
1295
1296 ~CompoundScopeRAII() { S.ActOnFinishOfCompoundStmt(); }
1297
1298 private:
1299 Sema &S;
1300 };
1301
1302 /// An RAII helper that pops function a function scope on exit.
1308 if (Active)
1309 S.PopFunctionScopeInfo();
1310 }
1311 void disable() { Active = false; }
1312 };
1313
1315 return FunctionScopes.empty() ? nullptr : FunctionScopes.back();
1316 }
1317
1318 /// Worker object for performing CFG-based warnings.
1321
1322 /// Callback to the parser to parse templated functions when needed.
1323 typedef void LateTemplateParserCB(void *P, LateParsedTemplate &LPT);
1326
1328 LateTemplateParser = LTP;
1329 OpaqueParser = P;
1330 }
1331
1332 /// Callback to the parser to parse a type expressed as a string.
1333 std::function<TypeResult(StringRef, StringRef, SourceLocation)>
1335
1336 /// VAListTagName - The declaration name corresponding to __va_list_tag.
1337 /// This is used as part of a hack to omit that class from ADL results.
1339
1340 /// Is the last error level diagnostic immediate. This is used to determined
1341 /// whether the next info diagnostic should be immediate.
1343
1344 class DelayedDiagnostics;
1345
1347 sema::DelayedDiagnosticPool *SavedPool = nullptr;
1349 };
1352
1353 /// A class which encapsulates the logic for delaying diagnostics
1354 /// during parsing and other processing.
1356 /// The current pool of diagnostics into which delayed
1357 /// diagnostics should go.
1358 sema::DelayedDiagnosticPool *CurPool = nullptr;
1359
1360 public:
1362
1363 /// Adds a delayed diagnostic.
1364 void add(const sema::DelayedDiagnostic &diag); // in DelayedDiagnostic.h
1365
1366 /// Determines whether diagnostics should be delayed.
1367 bool shouldDelayDiagnostics() { return CurPool != nullptr; }
1368
1369 /// Returns the current delayed-diagnostics pool.
1370 sema::DelayedDiagnosticPool *getCurrentPool() const { return CurPool; }
1371
1372 /// Enter a new scope. Access and deprecation diagnostics will be
1373 /// collected in this pool.
1376 state.SavedPool = CurPool;
1377 CurPool = &pool;
1378 return state;
1379 }
1380
1381 /// Leave a delayed-diagnostic state that was previously pushed.
1382 /// Do not emit any of the diagnostics. This is performed as part
1383 /// of the bookkeeping of popping a pool "properly".
1385 CurPool = state.SavedPool;
1386 }
1387
1388 /// Enter a new scope where access and deprecation diagnostics are
1389 /// not delayed.
1392 state.SavedPool = CurPool;
1393 CurPool = nullptr;
1394 return state;
1395 }
1396
1397 /// Undo a previous pushUndelayed().
1399 assert(CurPool == nullptr);
1400 CurPool = state.SavedPool;
1401 }
1403
1407
1408 /// Diagnostics that are emitted only if we discover that the given function
1409 /// must be codegen'ed. Because handling these correctly adds overhead to
1410 /// compilation, this is currently only enabled for CUDA compilations.
1411 SemaDiagnosticBuilder::DeferredDiagnosticsType DeviceDeferredDiags;
1412
1413 /// CurContext - This is the current declaration context of parsing.
1415
1417 assert(AMDGPUPtr);
1418 return *AMDGPUPtr;
1419 }
1420
1422 assert(ARMPtr);
1423 return *ARMPtr;
1424 }
1425
1427 assert(AVRPtr);
1428 return *AVRPtr;
1429 }
1430
1432 assert(BPFPtr);
1433 return *BPFPtr;
1434 }
1435
1437 assert(CodeCompletionPtr);
1438 return *CodeCompletionPtr;
1439 }
1440
1442 assert(CUDAPtr);
1443 return *CUDAPtr;
1444 }
1445
1447 assert(DirectXPtr);
1448 return *DirectXPtr;
1449 }
1450
1452 assert(HLSLPtr);
1453 return *HLSLPtr;
1454 }
1455
1457 assert(HexagonPtr);
1458 return *HexagonPtr;
1459 }
1460
1462 assert(LoongArchPtr);
1463 return *LoongArchPtr;
1464 }
1465
1467 assert(M68kPtr);
1468 return *M68kPtr;
1469 }
1470
1472 assert(MIPSPtr);
1473 return *MIPSPtr;
1474 }
1475
1477 assert(MSP430Ptr);
1478 return *MSP430Ptr;
1479 }
1480
1482 assert(NVPTXPtr);
1483 return *NVPTXPtr;
1484 }
1485
1487 assert(ObjCPtr);
1488 return *ObjCPtr;
1489 }
1490
1492 assert(OpenACCPtr);
1493 return *OpenACCPtr;
1494 }
1495
1497 assert(OpenCLPtr);
1498 return *OpenCLPtr;
1499 }
1500
1502 assert(OpenMPPtr && "SemaOpenMP is dead");
1503 return *OpenMPPtr;
1504 }
1505
1507 assert(PPCPtr);
1508 return *PPCPtr;
1509 }
1510
1512 assert(PseudoObjectPtr);
1513 return *PseudoObjectPtr;
1514 }
1515
1517 assert(RISCVPtr);
1518 return *RISCVPtr;
1519 }
1520
1522 assert(SPIRVPtr);
1523 return *SPIRVPtr;
1524 }
1525
1527 assert(SYCLPtr);
1528 return *SYCLPtr;
1529 }
1530
1532 assert(SwiftPtr);
1533 return *SwiftPtr;
1534 }
1535
1537 assert(SystemZPtr);
1538 return *SystemZPtr;
1539 }
1540
1542 assert(WasmPtr);
1543 return *WasmPtr;
1544 }
1545
1547 assert(X86Ptr);
1548 return *X86Ptr;
1549 }
1550
1551 /// Source of additional semantic information.
1553
1554protected:
1555 friend class Parser;
1557 friend class ASTReader;
1558 friend class ASTDeclReader;
1559 friend class ASTWriter;
1560
1561private:
1562 std::optional<std::unique_ptr<DarwinSDKInfo>> CachedDarwinSDKInfo;
1563 bool WarnedDarwinSDKInfoMissing = false;
1564
1565 StackExhaustionHandler StackHandler;
1566
1567 Sema(const Sema &) = delete;
1568 void operator=(const Sema &) = delete;
1569
1570 /// The handler for the FileChanged preprocessor events.
1571 ///
1572 /// Used for diagnostics that implement custom semantic analysis for #include
1573 /// directives, like -Wpragma-pack.
1574 sema::SemaPPCallbacks *SemaPPCallbackHandler;
1575
1576 /// The parser's current scope.
1577 ///
1578 /// The parser maintains this state here.
1579 Scope *CurScope;
1580
1581 mutable IdentifierInfo *Ident_super;
1582
1583 std::unique_ptr<SemaAMDGPU> AMDGPUPtr;
1584 std::unique_ptr<SemaARM> ARMPtr;
1585 std::unique_ptr<SemaAVR> AVRPtr;
1586 std::unique_ptr<SemaBPF> BPFPtr;
1587 std::unique_ptr<SemaCodeCompletion> CodeCompletionPtr;
1588 std::unique_ptr<SemaCUDA> CUDAPtr;
1589 std::unique_ptr<SemaDirectX> DirectXPtr;
1590 std::unique_ptr<SemaHLSL> HLSLPtr;
1591 std::unique_ptr<SemaHexagon> HexagonPtr;
1592 std::unique_ptr<SemaLoongArch> LoongArchPtr;
1593 std::unique_ptr<SemaM68k> M68kPtr;
1594 std::unique_ptr<SemaMIPS> MIPSPtr;
1595 std::unique_ptr<SemaMSP430> MSP430Ptr;
1596 std::unique_ptr<SemaNVPTX> NVPTXPtr;
1597 std::unique_ptr<SemaObjC> ObjCPtr;
1598 std::unique_ptr<SemaOpenACC> OpenACCPtr;
1599 std::unique_ptr<SemaOpenCL> OpenCLPtr;
1600 std::unique_ptr<SemaOpenMP> OpenMPPtr;
1601 std::unique_ptr<SemaPPC> PPCPtr;
1602 std::unique_ptr<SemaPseudoObject> PseudoObjectPtr;
1603 std::unique_ptr<SemaRISCV> RISCVPtr;
1604 std::unique_ptr<SemaSPIRV> SPIRVPtr;
1605 std::unique_ptr<SemaSYCL> SYCLPtr;
1606 std::unique_ptr<SemaSwift> SwiftPtr;
1607 std::unique_ptr<SemaSystemZ> SystemZPtr;
1608 std::unique_ptr<SemaWasm> WasmPtr;
1609 std::unique_ptr<SemaX86> X86Ptr;
1610
1611 ///@}
1612
1613 //
1614 //
1615 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
1616 //
1617 //
1618
1619 /// \name API Notes
1620 /// Implementations are in SemaAPINotes.cpp
1621 ///@{
1622
1623public:
1624 /// Map any API notes provided for this declaration to attributes on the
1625 /// declaration.
1626 ///
1627 /// Triggered by declaration-attribute processing.
1628 void ProcessAPINotes(Decl *D);
1629 /// Apply the 'Nullability:' annotation to the specified declaration
1630 void ApplyNullability(Decl *D, NullabilityKind Nullability);
1631 /// Apply the 'Type:' annotation to the specified declaration
1632 void ApplyAPINotesType(Decl *D, StringRef TypeString);
1633
1634 /// Whether APINotes should be gathered for all applicable Swift language
1635 /// versions, without being applied. Leaving clients of the current module
1636 /// to select and apply the correct version.
1638 return APINotes.captureVersionIndependentSwift();
1639 }
1640 ///@}
1641
1642 //
1643 //
1644 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
1645 //
1646 //
1647
1648 /// \name C++ Access Control
1649 /// Implementations are in SemaAccess.cpp
1650 ///@{
1651
1652public:
1659
1660 /// SetMemberAccessSpecifier - Set the access specifier of a member.
1661 /// Returns true on error (when the previous member decl access specifier
1662 /// is different from the new member decl access specifier).
1663 bool SetMemberAccessSpecifier(NamedDecl *MemberDecl,
1664 NamedDecl *PrevMemberDecl,
1665 AccessSpecifier LexicalAS);
1666
1667 /// Perform access-control checking on a previously-unresolved member
1668 /// access which has now been resolved to a member.
1670 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl);
1672 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl);
1673
1674 /// Checks access to an overloaded operator new or delete.
1676 SourceRange PlacementRange,
1677 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
1678 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1679 bool Diagnose = true);
1680
1681 /// Checks access to a constructor.
1683 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1684 const InitializedEntity &Entity,
1685 bool IsCopyBindingRefToTemp = false);
1686
1687 /// Checks access to a constructor.
1689 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1690 const InitializedEntity &Entity,
1691 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag);
1693 CXXDestructorDecl *Dtor,
1694 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
1695 QualType objectType = QualType());
1696
1697 /// Checks access to the target of a friend declaration.
1699
1700 /// Checks access to a member.
1702 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
1704
1705 /// Checks implicit access to a member in a structured binding.
1708 CXXRecordDecl *DecomposedClass,
1709 DeclAccessPair Field);
1711 const SourceRange &,
1712 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl);
1713
1714 /// Checks access to an overloaded member operator, including
1715 /// conversion operators.
1717 Expr *ArgExpr,
1718 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl);
1720 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs,
1721 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl);
1723 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl);
1724
1725 /// Checks access for a hierarchy conversion.
1726 ///
1727 /// \param ForceCheck true if this check should be performed even if access
1728 /// control is disabled; some things rely on this for semantics
1729 /// \param ForceUnprivileged true if this check should proceed as if the
1730 /// context had no special privileges
1732 QualType Derived, const CXXBasePath &Path,
1733 unsigned DiagID, bool ForceCheck = false,
1734 bool ForceUnprivileged = false);
1735
1737 SourceLocation AccessLoc, CXXRecordDecl *Base, CXXRecordDecl *Derived,
1738 const CXXBasePath &Path, unsigned DiagID,
1739 llvm::function_ref<void(PartialDiagnostic &PD)> SetupPDiag,
1740 bool ForceCheck = false, bool ForceUnprivileged = false);
1741
1742 /// Checks access to all the declarations in the given result set.
1743 void CheckLookupAccess(const LookupResult &R);
1744
1745 /// Checks access to Target from the given class. The check will take access
1746 /// specifiers into account, but no member access expressions and such.
1747 ///
1748 /// \param Target the declaration to check if it can be accessed
1749 /// \param NamingClass the class in which the lookup was started.
1750 /// \param BaseType type of the left side of member access expression.
1751 /// \p BaseType and \p NamingClass are used for C++ access control.
1752 /// Depending on the lookup case, they should be set to the following:
1753 /// - lhs.target (member access without a qualifier):
1754 /// \p BaseType and \p NamingClass are both the type of 'lhs'.
1755 /// - lhs.X::target (member access with a qualifier):
1756 /// BaseType is the type of 'lhs', NamingClass is 'X'
1757 /// - X::target (qualified lookup without member access):
1758 /// BaseType is null, NamingClass is 'X'.
1759 /// - target (unqualified lookup).
1760 /// BaseType is null, NamingClass is the parent class of 'target'.
1761 /// \return true if the Target is accessible from the Class, false otherwise.
1762 bool IsSimplyAccessible(NamedDecl *Decl, CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
1763 QualType BaseType);
1764
1765 /// Is the given member accessible for the purposes of deciding whether to
1766 /// define a special member function as deleted?
1768 DeclAccessPair Found, QualType ObjectType,
1769 SourceLocation Loc,
1770 const PartialDiagnostic &Diag);
1773 QualType ObjectType) {
1774 return isMemberAccessibleForDeletion(NamingClass, Found, ObjectType,
1775 SourceLocation(), PDiag());
1776 }
1777
1779 const DependentDiagnostic &DD,
1780 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
1782
1783 ///@}
1784
1785 //
1786 //
1787 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
1788 //
1789 //
1790
1791 /// \name Attributes
1792 /// Implementations are in SemaAttr.cpp
1793 ///@{
1794
1795public:
1796 /// Controls member pointer representation format under the MS ABI.
1799
1800 bool MSStructPragmaOn; // True when \#pragma ms_struct on
1801
1802 /// Source location for newly created implicit MSInheritanceAttrs
1804
1810
1816
1818 PSK_Reset = 0x0, // #pragma ()
1819 PSK_Set = 0x1, // #pragma (value)
1820 PSK_Push = 0x2, // #pragma (push[, id])
1821 PSK_Pop = 0x4, // #pragma (pop[, id])
1822 PSK_Show = 0x8, // #pragma (show) -- only for "pack"!
1823 PSK_Push_Set = PSK_Push | PSK_Set, // #pragma (push[, id], value)
1824 PSK_Pop_Set = PSK_Pop | PSK_Set, // #pragma (pop[, id], value)
1825 };
1826
1832
1833 // #pragma pack and align.
1835 public:
1836 // `Native` represents default align mode, which may vary based on the
1837 // platform.
1838 enum Mode : unsigned char { Native, Natural, Packed, Mac68k };
1839
1840 // #pragma pack info constructor
1841 AlignPackInfo(AlignPackInfo::Mode M, unsigned Num, bool IsXL)
1842 : PackAttr(true), AlignMode(M), PackNumber(Num), XLStack(IsXL) {
1843 assert(Num == PackNumber && "The pack number has been truncated.");
1844 }
1845
1846 // #pragma align info constructor
1848 : PackAttr(false), AlignMode(M),
1849 PackNumber(M == Packed ? 1 : UninitPackVal), XLStack(IsXL) {}
1850
1851 explicit AlignPackInfo(bool IsXL) : AlignPackInfo(Native, IsXL) {}
1852
1854
1855 // When a AlignPackInfo itself cannot be used, this returns an 32-bit
1856 // integer encoding for it. This should only be passed to
1857 // AlignPackInfo::getFromRawEncoding, it should not be inspected directly.
1858 static uint32_t getRawEncoding(const AlignPackInfo &Info) {
1859 std::uint32_t Encoding{};
1860 if (Info.IsXLStack())
1861 Encoding |= IsXLMask;
1862
1863 Encoding |= static_cast<uint32_t>(Info.getAlignMode()) << 1;
1864
1865 if (Info.IsPackAttr())
1866 Encoding |= PackAttrMask;
1867
1868 Encoding |= static_cast<uint32_t>(Info.getPackNumber()) << 4;
1869
1870 return Encoding;
1871 }
1872
1873 static AlignPackInfo getFromRawEncoding(unsigned Encoding) {
1874 bool IsXL = static_cast<bool>(Encoding & IsXLMask);
1876 static_cast<AlignPackInfo::Mode>((Encoding & AlignModeMask) >> 1);
1877 int PackNumber = (Encoding & PackNumMask) >> 4;
1878
1879 if (Encoding & PackAttrMask)
1880 return AlignPackInfo(M, PackNumber, IsXL);
1881
1882 return AlignPackInfo(M, IsXL);
1883 }
1884
1885 bool IsPackAttr() const { return PackAttr; }
1886
1887 bool IsAlignAttr() const { return !PackAttr; }
1888
1889 Mode getAlignMode() const { return AlignMode; }
1890
1891 unsigned getPackNumber() const { return PackNumber; }
1892
1893 bool IsPackSet() const {
1894 // #pragma align, #pragma pack(), and #pragma pack(0) do not set the pack
1895 // attriute on a decl.
1896 return PackNumber != UninitPackVal && PackNumber != 0;
1897 }
1898
1899 bool IsXLStack() const { return XLStack; }
1900
1901 bool operator==(const AlignPackInfo &Info) const {
1902 return std::tie(AlignMode, PackNumber, PackAttr, XLStack) ==
1903 std::tie(Info.AlignMode, Info.PackNumber, Info.PackAttr,
1904 Info.XLStack);
1905 }
1906
1907 bool operator!=(const AlignPackInfo &Info) const {
1908 return !(*this == Info);
1909 }
1910
1911 private:
1912 /// \brief True if this is a pragma pack attribute,
1913 /// not a pragma align attribute.
1914 bool PackAttr;
1915
1916 /// \brief The alignment mode that is in effect.
1917 Mode AlignMode;
1918
1919 /// \brief The pack number of the stack.
1920 unsigned char PackNumber;
1921
1922 /// \brief True if it is a XL #pragma align/pack stack.
1923 bool XLStack;
1924
1925 /// \brief Uninitialized pack value.
1926 static constexpr unsigned char UninitPackVal = -1;
1927
1928 // Masks to encode and decode an AlignPackInfo.
1929 static constexpr uint32_t IsXLMask{0x0000'0001};
1930 static constexpr uint32_t AlignModeMask{0x0000'0006};
1931 static constexpr uint32_t PackAttrMask{0x00000'0008};
1932 static constexpr uint32_t PackNumMask{0x0000'01F0};
1933 };
1934
1935 template <typename ValueType> struct PragmaStack {
1947
1948 void Act(SourceLocation PragmaLocation, PragmaMsStackAction Action,
1949 llvm::StringRef StackSlotLabel, ValueType Value) {
1950 if (Action == PSK_Reset) {
1952 CurrentPragmaLocation = PragmaLocation;
1953 return;
1954 }
1955 if (Action & PSK_Push)
1956 Stack.emplace_back(StackSlotLabel, CurrentValue, CurrentPragmaLocation,
1957 PragmaLocation);
1958 else if (Action & PSK_Pop) {
1959 if (!StackSlotLabel.empty()) {
1960 // If we've got a label, try to find it and jump there.
1961 auto I = llvm::find_if(llvm::reverse(Stack), [&](const Slot &x) {
1962 return x.StackSlotLabel == StackSlotLabel;
1963 });
1964 // If we found the label so pop from there.
1965 if (I != Stack.rend()) {
1966 CurrentValue = I->Value;
1967 CurrentPragmaLocation = I->PragmaLocation;
1968 Stack.erase(std::prev(I.base()), Stack.end());
1969 }
1970 } else if (!Stack.empty()) {
1971 // We do not have a label, just pop the last entry.
1972 CurrentValue = Stack.back().Value;
1973 CurrentPragmaLocation = Stack.back().PragmaLocation;
1974 Stack.pop_back();
1975 }
1976 }
1977 if (Action & PSK_Set) {
1979 CurrentPragmaLocation = PragmaLocation;
1980 }
1981 }
1982
1983 // MSVC seems to add artificial slots to #pragma stacks on entering a C++
1984 // method body to restore the stacks on exit, so it works like this:
1985 //
1986 // struct S {
1987 // #pragma <name>(push, InternalPragmaSlot, <current_pragma_value>)
1988 // void Method {}
1989 // #pragma <name>(pop, InternalPragmaSlot)
1990 // };
1991 //
1992 // It works even with #pragma vtordisp, although MSVC doesn't support
1993 // #pragma vtordisp(push [, id], n)
1994 // syntax.
1995 //
1996 // Push / pop a named sentinel slot.
1997 void SentinelAction(PragmaMsStackAction Action, StringRef Label) {
1998 assert((Action == PSK_Push || Action == PSK_Pop) &&
1999 "Can only push / pop #pragma stack sentinels!");
2000 Act(CurrentPragmaLocation, Action, Label, CurrentValue);
2001 }
2002
2003 // Constructors.
2004 explicit PragmaStack(const ValueType &Default)
2006
2007 bool hasValue() const { return CurrentValue != DefaultValue; }
2008
2010 ValueType DefaultValue; // Value used for PSK_Reset action.
2011 ValueType CurrentValue;
2013 };
2014 // FIXME: We should serialize / deserialize these if they occur in a PCH (but
2015 // we shouldn't do so if they're in a module).
2016
2017 /// Whether to insert vtordisps prior to virtual bases in the Microsoft
2018 /// C++ ABI. Possible values are 0, 1, and 2, which mean:
2019 ///
2020 /// 0: Suppress all vtordisps
2021 /// 1: Insert vtordisps in the presence of vbase overrides and non-trivial
2022 /// structors
2023 /// 2: Always insert vtordisps to support RTTI on partially constructed
2024 /// objects
2027 // The current #pragma align/pack values and locations at each #include.
2034 // Segment #pragmas.
2039
2040 // #pragma strict_gs_check.
2042
2043 // This stack tracks the current state of Sema.CurFPFeatures.
2046 FPOptionsOverride result;
2047 if (!FpPragmaStack.hasValue()) {
2048 result = FPOptionsOverride();
2049 } else {
2050 result = FpPragmaStack.CurrentValue;
2051 }
2052 return result;
2053 }
2054
2061
2062 // RAII object to push / pop sentinel slots for all MS #pragma stacks.
2063 // Actions should be performed only if we enter / exit a C++ method body.
2065 public:
2066 PragmaStackSentinelRAII(Sema &S, StringRef SlotLabel, bool ShouldAct);
2068
2069 private:
2070 Sema &S;
2071 StringRef SlotLabel;
2072 bool ShouldAct;
2073 };
2074
2075 /// Last section used with #pragma init_seg.
2078
2079 /// Sections used with #pragma alloc_text.
2080 llvm::StringMap<std::tuple<StringRef, SourceLocation>> FunctionToSectionMap;
2081
2082 /// VisContext - Manages the stack for \#pragma GCC visibility.
2083 void *VisContext; // Really a "PragmaVisStack*"
2084
2085 /// This an attribute introduced by \#pragma clang attribute.
2092
2093 /// A push'd group of PragmaAttributeEntries.
2095 /// The location of the push attribute.
2097 /// The namespace of this push group.
2100 };
2101
2103
2104 /// The declaration that is currently receiving an attribute from the
2105 /// #pragma attribute stack.
2107
2108 /// This represents the last location of a "#pragma clang optimize off"
2109 /// directive if such a directive has not been closed by an "on" yet. If
2110 /// optimizations are currently "on", this is set to an invalid location.
2112
2113 /// Get the location for the currently active "\#pragma clang optimize
2114 /// off". If this location is invalid, then the state of the pragma is "on".
2118
2119 /// The "on" or "off" argument passed by \#pragma optimize, that denotes
2120 /// whether the optimizations in the list passed to the pragma should be
2121 /// turned off or on. This boolean is true by default because command line
2122 /// options are honored when `#pragma optimize("", on)`.
2123 /// (i.e. `ModifyFnAttributeMSPragmaOptimze()` does nothing)
2125
2126 /// Set of no-builtin functions listed by \#pragma function.
2128
2129 /// AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord - Adds any needed alignment attributes to
2130 /// a the record decl, to handle '\#pragma pack' and '\#pragma options align'.
2132
2133 /// AddMsStructLayoutForRecord - Adds ms_struct layout attribute to record.
2135
2136 /// Add gsl::Pointer attribute to std::container::iterator
2137 /// \param ND The declaration that introduces the name
2138 /// std::container::iterator. \param UnderlyingRecord The record named by ND.
2139 void inferGslPointerAttribute(NamedDecl *ND, CXXRecordDecl *UnderlyingRecord);
2140
2141 /// Add [[gsl::Owner]] and [[gsl::Pointer]] attributes for std:: types.
2143
2144 /// Add [[clang:::lifetimebound]] attr for std:: functions and methods.
2146
2147 /// Add [[clang:::lifetime_capture_by(this)]] to STL container methods.
2149
2150 /// Add [[gsl::Pointer]] attributes for std:: types.
2152
2153 LifetimeCaptureByAttr *ParseLifetimeCaptureByAttr(const ParsedAttr &AL,
2154 StringRef ParamName);
2155 // Processes the argument 'X' in [[clang::lifetime_capture_by(X)]]. Since 'X'
2156 // can be the name of a function parameter, we need to parse the function
2157 // declaration and rest of the parameters before processesing 'X'. Therefore
2158 // do this lazily instead of processing while parsing the annotation itself.
2160
2161 /// Add _Nullable attributes for std:: types.
2163
2164 /// ActOnPragmaClangSection - Called on well formed \#pragma clang section
2167 PragmaClangSectionKind SecKind,
2168 StringRef SecName);
2169
2170 /// ActOnPragmaOptionsAlign - Called on well formed \#pragma options align.
2172 SourceLocation PragmaLoc);
2173
2174 /// ActOnPragmaPack - Called on well formed \#pragma pack(...).
2175 void ActOnPragmaPack(SourceLocation PragmaLoc, PragmaMsStackAction Action,
2176 StringRef SlotLabel, Expr *Alignment);
2177
2178 /// ConstantFoldAttrArgs - Folds attribute arguments into ConstantExprs
2179 /// (unless they are value dependent or type dependent). Returns false
2180 /// and emits a diagnostic if one or more of the arguments could not be
2181 /// folded into a constant.
2184
2189
2191 SourceLocation IncludeLoc);
2193
2194 /// ActOnPragmaMSStruct - Called on well formed \#pragma ms_struct [on|off].
2196
2197 /// ActOnPragmaMSComment - Called on well formed
2198 /// \#pragma comment(kind, "arg").
2200 StringRef Arg);
2201
2202 /// ActOnPragmaDetectMismatch - Call on well-formed \#pragma detect_mismatch
2203 void ActOnPragmaDetectMismatch(SourceLocation Loc, StringRef Name,
2204 StringRef Value);
2205
2206 /// Are precise floating point semantics currently enabled?
2208 return !CurFPFeatures.getAllowFPReassociate() &&
2209 !CurFPFeatures.getNoSignedZero() &&
2210 !CurFPFeatures.getAllowReciprocal() &&
2211 !CurFPFeatures.getAllowApproxFunc();
2212 }
2213
2216
2217 /// ActOnPragmaFloatControl - Call on well-formed \#pragma float_control
2218 void ActOnPragmaFloatControl(SourceLocation Loc, PragmaMsStackAction Action,
2220
2221 /// ActOnPragmaMSPointersToMembers - called on well formed \#pragma
2222 /// pointers_to_members(representation method[, general purpose
2223 /// representation]).
2226 SourceLocation PragmaLoc);
2227
2228 /// Called on well formed \#pragma vtordisp().
2229 void ActOnPragmaMSVtorDisp(PragmaMsStackAction Action,
2231
2232 bool UnifySection(StringRef SectionName, int SectionFlags,
2233 NamedDecl *TheDecl);
2234 bool UnifySection(StringRef SectionName, int SectionFlags,
2235 SourceLocation PragmaSectionLocation);
2236
2237 /// Called on well formed \#pragma bss_seg/data_seg/const_seg/code_seg.
2238 void ActOnPragmaMSSeg(SourceLocation PragmaLocation,
2239 PragmaMsStackAction Action,
2240 llvm::StringRef StackSlotLabel,
2241 StringLiteral *SegmentName, llvm::StringRef PragmaName);
2242
2243 /// Called on well formed \#pragma section().
2244 void ActOnPragmaMSSection(SourceLocation PragmaLocation, int SectionFlags,
2245 StringLiteral *SegmentName);
2246
2247 /// Called on well-formed \#pragma init_seg().
2248 void ActOnPragmaMSInitSeg(SourceLocation PragmaLocation,
2249 StringLiteral *SegmentName);
2250
2251 /// Called on well-formed \#pragma alloc_text().
2253 SourceLocation PragmaLocation, StringRef Section,
2254 const SmallVector<std::tuple<IdentifierInfo *, SourceLocation>>
2255 &Functions);
2256
2257 /// ActOnPragmaMSStrictGuardStackCheck - Called on well formed \#pragma
2258 /// strict_gs_check.
2260 PragmaMsStackAction Action,
2261 bool Value);
2262
2263 /// ActOnPragmaUnused - Called on well-formed '\#pragma unused'.
2264 void ActOnPragmaUnused(const Token &Identifier, Scope *curScope,
2265 SourceLocation PragmaLoc);
2266
2268 SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
2271 const IdentifierInfo *Namespace);
2272
2273 /// Called on well-formed '\#pragma clang attribute pop'.
2275 const IdentifierInfo *Namespace);
2276
2277 /// Adds the attributes that have been specified using the
2278 /// '\#pragma clang attribute push' directives to the given declaration.
2279 void AddPragmaAttributes(Scope *S, Decl *D);
2280
2282 llvm::function_ref<void(SourceLocation, PartialDiagnostic)>;
2284 return [this](SourceLocation Loc, PartialDiagnostic PD) {
2285 // This bypasses a lot of the filters in the diag engine, as it's
2286 // to be used to attach notes to diagnostics which have already
2287 // been filtered through.
2288 DiagnosticBuilder Builder(Diags.Report(Loc, PD.getDiagID()));
2289 PD.Emit(Builder);
2290 };
2291 }
2292
2298
2300
2301 /// Called on well formed \#pragma clang optimize.
2302 void ActOnPragmaOptimize(bool On, SourceLocation PragmaLoc);
2303
2304 /// #pragma optimize("[optimization-list]", on | off).
2305 void ActOnPragmaMSOptimize(SourceLocation Loc, bool IsOn);
2306
2307 /// Call on well formed \#pragma function.
2308 void
2310 const llvm::SmallVectorImpl<StringRef> &NoBuiltins);
2311
2312 /// Only called on function definitions; if there is a pragma in scope
2313 /// with the effect of a range-based optnone, consider marking the function
2314 /// with attribute optnone.
2316
2317 /// Only called on function definitions; if there is a `#pragma alloc_text`
2318 /// that decides which code section the function should be in, add
2319 /// attribute section to the function.
2321
2322 /// Adds the 'optnone' attribute to the function declaration if there
2323 /// are no conflicts; Loc represents the location causing the 'optnone'
2324 /// attribute to be added (usually because of a pragma).
2326
2327 /// Only called on function definitions; if there is a MSVC #pragma optimize
2328 /// in scope, consider changing the function's attributes based on the
2329 /// optimization list passed to the pragma.
2331
2332 /// Only called on function definitions; if there is a pragma in scope
2333 /// with the effect of a range-based no_builtin, consider marking the function
2334 /// with attribute no_builtin.
2336
2337 /// AddPushedVisibilityAttribute - If '\#pragma GCC visibility' was used,
2338 /// add an appropriate visibility attribute.
2340
2341 /// FreeVisContext - Deallocate and null out VisContext.
2342 void FreeVisContext();
2343
2344 /// ActOnPragmaVisibility - Called on well formed \#pragma GCC visibility... .
2345 void ActOnPragmaVisibility(const IdentifierInfo *VisType,
2346 SourceLocation PragmaLoc);
2347
2348 /// ActOnPragmaFPContract - Called on well formed
2349 /// \#pragma {STDC,OPENCL} FP_CONTRACT and
2350 /// \#pragma clang fp contract
2352
2353 /// Called on well formed
2354 /// \#pragma clang fp reassociate
2355 /// or
2356 /// \#pragma clang fp reciprocal
2358 bool IsEnabled);
2359
2360 /// ActOnPragmaFenvAccess - Called on well formed
2361 /// \#pragma STDC FENV_ACCESS
2362 void ActOnPragmaFEnvAccess(SourceLocation Loc, bool IsEnabled);
2363
2364 /// ActOnPragmaCXLimitedRange - Called on well formed
2365 /// \#pragma STDC CX_LIMITED_RANGE
2368
2369 /// Called on well formed '\#pragma clang fp' that has option 'exceptions'.
2372
2373 /// Called to set constant rounding mode for floating point operations.
2374 void ActOnPragmaFEnvRound(SourceLocation Loc, llvm::RoundingMode);
2375
2376 /// Called to set exception behavior for floating point operations.
2378
2379 /// PushNamespaceVisibilityAttr - Note that we've entered a
2380 /// namespace with a visibility attribute.
2381 void PushNamespaceVisibilityAttr(const VisibilityAttr *Attr,
2382 SourceLocation Loc);
2383
2384 /// PopPragmaVisibility - Pop the top element of the visibility stack; used
2385 /// for '\#pragma GCC visibility' and visibility attributes on namespaces.
2386 void PopPragmaVisibility(bool IsNamespaceEnd, SourceLocation EndLoc);
2387
2388 /// Handles semantic checking for features that are common to all attributes,
2389 /// such as checking whether a parameter was properly specified, or the
2390 /// correct number of arguments were passed, etc. Returns true if the
2391 /// attribute has been diagnosed.
2392 bool checkCommonAttributeFeatures(const Decl *D, const ParsedAttr &A,
2393 bool SkipArgCountCheck = false);
2394 bool checkCommonAttributeFeatures(const Stmt *S, const ParsedAttr &A,
2395 bool SkipArgCountCheck = false);
2396
2397 ///@}
2398
2399 //
2400 //
2401 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
2402 //
2403 //
2404
2405 /// \name Availability Attribute Handling
2406 /// Implementations are in SemaAvailability.cpp
2407 ///@{
2408
2409public:
2410 /// Issue any -Wunguarded-availability warnings in \c FD
2412
2414
2415 /// Retrieve the current function, if any, that should be analyzed for
2416 /// potential availability violations.
2418
2420 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
2421 bool ObjCPropertyAccess,
2422 bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks,
2423 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReceiver);
2424
2426
2427 std::pair<AvailabilityResult, const NamedDecl *>
2428 ShouldDiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(const NamedDecl *D, std::string *Message,
2429 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReceiver);
2430 ///@}
2431
2432 //
2433 //
2434 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
2435 //
2436 //
2437
2438 /// \name Bounds Safety
2439 /// Implementations are in SemaBoundsSafety.cpp
2440 ///@{
2441public:
2442 /// Check if applying the specified attribute variant from the "counted by"
2443 /// family of attributes to FieldDecl \p FD is semantically valid. If
2444 /// semantically invalid diagnostics will be emitted explaining the problems.
2445 ///
2446 /// \param FD The FieldDecl to apply the attribute to
2447 /// \param E The count expression on the attribute
2448 /// \param CountInBytes If true the attribute is from the "sized_by" family of
2449 /// attributes. If the false the attribute is from
2450 /// "counted_by" family of attributes.
2451 /// \param OrNull If true the attribute is from the "_or_null" suffixed family
2452 /// of attributes. If false the attribute does not have the
2453 /// suffix.
2454 ///
2455 /// Together \p CountInBytes and \p OrNull decide the attribute variant. E.g.
2456 /// \p CountInBytes and \p OrNull both being true indicates the
2457 /// `counted_by_or_null` attribute.
2458 ///
2459 /// \returns false iff semantically valid.
2460 bool CheckCountedByAttrOnField(FieldDecl *FD, Expr *E, bool CountInBytes,
2461 bool OrNull);
2462
2463 /// Perform Bounds Safety Semantic checks for assigning to a `__counted_by` or
2464 /// `__counted_by_or_null` pointer type \param LHSTy.
2465 ///
2466 /// \param LHSTy The type being assigned to. Checks will only be performed if
2467 /// the type is a `counted_by` or `counted_by_or_null ` pointer.
2468 /// \param RHSExpr The expression being assigned from.
2469 /// \param Action The type assignment being performed
2470 /// \param Loc The SourceLocation to use for error diagnostics
2471 /// \param Assignee The ValueDecl being assigned. This is used to compute
2472 /// the name of the assignee. If the assignee isn't known this can
2473 /// be set to nullptr.
2474 /// \param ShowFullyQualifiedAssigneeName If set to true when using \p
2475 /// Assignee to compute the name of the assignee use the fully
2476 /// qualified name, otherwise use the unqualified name.
2477 ///
2478 /// \returns True iff no diagnostic where emitted, false otherwise.
2480 QualType LHSTy, Expr *RHSExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
2481 SourceLocation Loc, const ValueDecl *Assignee,
2482 bool ShowFullyQualifiedAssigneeName);
2483
2484 /// Perform Bounds Safety Semantic checks for initializing a Bounds Safety
2485 /// pointer.
2486 ///
2487 /// \param Entity The entity being initialized
2488 /// \param Kind The kind of initialization being performed
2489 /// \param Action The type assignment being performed
2490 /// \param LHSTy The type being assigned to. Checks will only be performed if
2491 /// the type is a `counted_by` or `counted_by_or_null ` pointer.
2492 /// \param RHSExpr The expression being used for initialization.
2493 ///
2494 /// \returns True iff no diagnostic where emitted, false otherwise.
2496 const InitializationKind &Kind,
2497 AssignmentAction Action,
2498 QualType LHSType, Expr *RHSExpr);
2499
2500 /// Perform Bounds Safety semantic checks for uses of invalid uses counted_by
2501 /// or counted_by_or_null pointers in \param E.
2502 ///
2503 /// \param E the expression to check
2504 ///
2505 /// \returns True iff no diagnostic where emitted, false otherwise.
2507 ///@}
2508
2509 //
2510 //
2511 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
2512 //
2513 //
2514
2515 /// \name Casts
2516 /// Implementations are in SemaCast.cpp
2517 ///@{
2518
2519public:
2525
2526 /// ActOnCXXNamedCast - Parse
2527 /// {dynamic,static,reinterpret,const,addrspace}_cast's.
2529 SourceLocation LAngleBracketLoc, Declarator &D,
2530 SourceLocation RAngleBracketLoc,
2531 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr *E,
2532 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
2533
2535 TypeSourceInfo *Ty, Expr *E,
2536 SourceRange AngleBrackets, SourceRange Parens);
2537
2539 ExprResult Operand,
2540 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
2541
2543 Expr *Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc);
2544
2545 // Checks that reinterpret casts don't have undefined behavior.
2546 void CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(QualType SrcType, QualType DestType,
2547 bool IsDereference, SourceRange Range);
2548
2549 // Checks that the vector type should be initialized from a scalar
2550 // by splatting the value rather than populating a single element.
2551 // This is the case for AltiVecVector types as well as with
2552 // AltiVecPixel and AltiVecBool when -faltivec-src-compat=xl is specified.
2553 bool ShouldSplatAltivecScalarInCast(const VectorType *VecTy);
2554
2555 // Checks if the -faltivec-src-compat=gcc option is specified.
2556 // If so, AltiVecVector, AltiVecBool and AltiVecPixel types are
2557 // treated the same way as they are when trying to initialize
2558 // these vectors on gcc (an error is emitted).
2560 QualType SrcTy);
2561
2563 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op);
2564
2566 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
2567 Expr *CastExpr,
2568 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
2569
2570 ///@}
2571
2572 //
2573 //
2574 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
2575 //
2576 //
2577
2578 /// \name Extra Semantic Checking
2579 /// Implementations are in SemaChecking.cpp
2580 ///@{
2581
2582public:
2583 /// Used to change context to isConstantEvaluated without pushing a heavy
2584 /// ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord object.
2586
2591
2593 unsigned ByteNo) const;
2594
2596 FAPK_Fixed, // values to format are fixed (no C-style variadic arguments)
2597 FAPK_Variadic, // values to format are passed as variadic arguments
2598 FAPK_VAList, // values to format are passed in a va_list
2599 FAPK_Elsewhere, // values to format are not passed to this function
2600 };
2601
2602 // Used to grab the relevant information from a FormatAttr and a
2603 // FunctionDeclaration.
2609
2610 /// Given a function and its FormatAttr or FormatMatchesAttr info, attempts to
2611 /// populate the FormatStringInfo parameter with the attribute's correct
2612 /// format_idx and firstDataArg. Returns true when the format fits the
2613 /// function and the FormatStringInfo has been populated.
2614 static bool getFormatStringInfo(const Decl *Function, unsigned FormatIdx,
2615 unsigned FirstArg, FormatStringInfo *FSI);
2616 static bool getFormatStringInfo(unsigned FormatIdx, unsigned FirstArg,
2617 bool HasImplicitThisParam, bool IsVariadic,
2618 FormatStringInfo *FSI);
2619
2620 // Used by C++ template instantiation.
2622
2623 /// ConvertVectorExpr - Handle __builtin_convertvector
2625 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
2626 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
2627
2628 static StringRef GetFormatStringTypeName(FormatStringType FST);
2629 static FormatStringType GetFormatStringType(StringRef FormatFlavor);
2630 static FormatStringType GetFormatStringType(const FormatAttr *Format);
2631 static FormatStringType GetFormatStringType(const FormatMatchesAttr *Format);
2632
2633 bool FormatStringHasSArg(const StringLiteral *FExpr);
2634
2635 /// Check for comparisons of floating-point values using == and !=. Issue a
2636 /// warning if the comparison is not likely to do what the programmer
2637 /// intended.
2638 void CheckFloatComparison(SourceLocation Loc, const Expr *LHS,
2639 const Expr *RHS, BinaryOperatorKind Opcode);
2640
2641 /// Register a magic integral constant to be used as a type tag.
2642 void RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(const IdentifierInfo *ArgumentKind,
2643 uint64_t MagicValue, QualType Type,
2644 bool LayoutCompatible, bool MustBeNull);
2645
2648
2652
2654
2655 /// If true, \c Type should be compared with other expression's types for
2656 /// layout-compatibility.
2657 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2659 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(bool)
2660 unsigned MustBeNull : 1;
2661 };
2662
2663 /// A pair of ArgumentKind identifier and magic value. This uniquely
2664 /// identifies the magic value.
2665 typedef std::pair<const IdentifierInfo *, uint64_t> TypeTagMagicValue;
2666
2667 /// Diagnoses the current set of gathered accesses. This happens at the end of
2668 /// each expression evaluation context. Diagnostics are emitted only for
2669 /// accesses gathered in the current evaluation context.
2671
2672 /// This function checks if the expression is in the sef of potentially
2673 /// misaligned members and it is converted to some pointer type T with lower
2674 /// or equal alignment requirements. If so it removes it. This is used when
2675 /// we do not want to diagnose such misaligned access (e.g. in conversions to
2676 /// void*).
2677 void DiscardMisalignedMemberAddress(const Type *T, Expr *E);
2678
2679 /// Returns true if `From` is a function or pointer to a function with the
2680 /// `cfi_unchecked_callee` attribute but `To` is a function or pointer to
2681 /// function without this attribute.
2682 bool DiscardingCFIUncheckedCallee(QualType From, QualType To) const;
2683
2684 /// This function calls Action when it determines that E designates a
2685 /// misaligned member due to the packed attribute. This is used to emit
2686 /// local diagnostics like in reference binding.
2688 Expr *E,
2689 llvm::function_ref<void(Expr *, RecordDecl *, FieldDecl *, CharUnits)>
2690 Action);
2691
2692 enum class AtomicArgumentOrder { API, AST };
2694 BuildAtomicExpr(SourceRange CallRange, SourceRange ExprRange,
2695 SourceLocation RParenLoc, MultiExprArg Args,
2698
2699 /// Check to see if a given expression could have '.c_str()' called on it.
2700 bool hasCStrMethod(const Expr *E);
2701
2702 /// Diagnose pointers that are always non-null.
2703 /// \param E the expression containing the pointer
2704 /// \param NullKind NPCK_NotNull if E is a cast to bool, otherwise, E is
2705 /// compared to a null pointer
2706 /// \param IsEqual True when the comparison is equal to a null pointer
2707 /// \param Range Extra SourceRange to highlight in the diagnostic
2710 bool IsEqual, SourceRange Range);
2711
2712 /// CheckParmsForFunctionDef - Check that the parameters of the given
2713 /// function are appropriate for the definition of a function. This
2714 /// takes care of any checks that cannot be performed on the
2715 /// declaration itself, e.g., that the types of each of the function
2716 /// parameters are complete.
2718 bool CheckParameterNames);
2719
2720 /// CheckCastAlign - Implements -Wcast-align, which warns when a
2721 /// pointer cast increases the alignment requirements.
2722 void CheckCastAlign(Expr *Op, QualType T, SourceRange TRange);
2723
2724 /// checkUnsafeAssigns - Check whether +1 expr is being assigned
2725 /// to weak/__unsafe_unretained type.
2726 bool checkUnsafeAssigns(SourceLocation Loc, QualType LHS, Expr *RHS);
2727
2728 /// checkUnsafeExprAssigns - Check whether +1 expr is being assigned
2729 /// to weak/__unsafe_unretained expression.
2730 void checkUnsafeExprAssigns(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS);
2731
2732 /// Emit \p DiagID if statement located on \p StmtLoc has a suspicious null
2733 /// statement as a \p Body, and it is located on the same line.
2734 ///
2735 /// This helps prevent bugs due to typos, such as:
2736 /// if (condition);
2737 /// do_stuff();
2738 void DiagnoseEmptyStmtBody(SourceLocation StmtLoc, const Stmt *Body,
2739 unsigned DiagID);
2740
2741 /// Warn if a for/while loop statement \p S, which is followed by
2742 /// \p PossibleBody, has a suspicious null statement as a body.
2743 void DiagnoseEmptyLoopBody(const Stmt *S, const Stmt *PossibleBody);
2744
2745 /// DiagnoseSelfMove - Emits a warning if a value is moved to itself.
2746 void DiagnoseSelfMove(const Expr *LHSExpr, const Expr *RHSExpr,
2747 SourceLocation OpLoc);
2748
2749 bool IsLayoutCompatible(QualType T1, QualType T2) const;
2751 const TypeSourceInfo *Derived);
2752
2753 /// CheckFunctionCall - Check a direct function call for various correctness
2754 /// and safety properties not strictly enforced by the C type system.
2755 bool CheckFunctionCall(FunctionDecl *FDecl, CallExpr *TheCall,
2756 const FunctionProtoType *Proto);
2757
2764
2765 /// \param FPOnly restricts the arguments to floating-point types.
2766 std::optional<QualType>
2767 BuiltinVectorMath(CallExpr *TheCall,
2770 bool BuiltinVectorToScalarMath(CallExpr *TheCall);
2771
2772 void checkLifetimeCaptureBy(FunctionDecl *FDecl, bool IsMemberFunction,
2773 const Expr *ThisArg, ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args);
2774
2775 /// Handles the checks for format strings, non-POD arguments to vararg
2776 /// functions, NULL arguments passed to non-NULL parameters, diagnose_if
2777 /// attributes and AArch64 SME attributes.
2778 void checkCall(NamedDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
2779 const Expr *ThisArg, ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args,
2780 bool IsMemberFunction, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range,
2781 VariadicCallType CallType);
2782
2783 /// Verify that two format strings (as understood by attribute(format) and
2784 /// attribute(format_matches) are compatible. If they are incompatible,
2785 /// diagnostics are emitted with the assumption that \c
2786 /// AuthoritativeFormatString is correct and
2787 /// \c TestedFormatString is wrong. If \c FunctionCallArg is provided,
2788 /// diagnostics will point to it and a note will refer to \c
2789 /// TestedFormatString or \c AuthoritativeFormatString as appropriate.
2790 bool
2792 const StringLiteral *AuthoritativeFormatString,
2793 const StringLiteral *TestedFormatString,
2794 const Expr *FunctionCallArg = nullptr);
2795
2796 /// Verify that one format string (as understood by attribute(format)) is
2797 /// self-consistent; for instance, that it doesn't have multiple positional
2798 /// arguments referring to the same argument in incompatible ways. Diagnose
2799 /// if it isn't.
2801
2802 /// \brief Enforce the bounds of a TCB
2803 /// CheckTCBEnforcement - Enforces that every function in a named TCB only
2804 /// directly calls other functions in the same TCB as marked by the
2805 /// enforce_tcb and enforce_tcb_leaf attributes.
2806 void CheckTCBEnforcement(const SourceLocation CallExprLoc,
2807 const NamedDecl *Callee);
2808
2809 void CheckConstrainedAuto(const AutoType *AutoT, SourceLocation Loc);
2810
2811 /// BuiltinConstantArg - Handle a check if argument ArgNum of CallExpr
2812 /// TheCall is a constant expression.
2813 bool BuiltinConstantArg(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum,
2814 llvm::APSInt &Result);
2815
2816 /// BuiltinConstantArgRange - Handle a check if argument ArgNum of CallExpr
2817 /// TheCall is a constant expression in the range [Low, High].
2818 bool BuiltinConstantArgRange(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum, int Low,
2819 int High, bool RangeIsError = true);
2820
2821 /// BuiltinConstantArgMultiple - Handle a check if argument ArgNum of CallExpr
2822 /// TheCall is a constant expression is a multiple of Num..
2823 bool BuiltinConstantArgMultiple(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum,
2824 unsigned Multiple);
2825
2826 /// BuiltinConstantArgPower2 - Check if argument ArgNum of TheCall is a
2827 /// constant expression representing a power of 2.
2828 bool BuiltinConstantArgPower2(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum);
2829
2830 /// BuiltinConstantArgShiftedByte - Check if argument ArgNum of TheCall is
2831 /// a constant expression representing an arbitrary byte value shifted left by
2832 /// a multiple of 8 bits.
2833 bool BuiltinConstantArgShiftedByte(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum,
2834 unsigned ArgBits);
2835
2836 /// BuiltinConstantArgShiftedByteOr0xFF - Check if argument ArgNum of
2837 /// TheCall is a constant expression representing either a shifted byte value,
2838 /// or a value of the form 0x??FF (i.e. a member of the arithmetic progression
2839 /// 0x00FF, 0x01FF, ..., 0xFFFF). This strange range check is needed for some
2840 /// Arm MVE intrinsics.
2841 bool BuiltinConstantArgShiftedByteOrXXFF(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum,
2842 unsigned ArgBits);
2843
2844 /// Checks that a call expression's argument count is at least the desired
2845 /// number. This is useful when doing custom type-checking on a variadic
2846 /// function. Returns true on error.
2847 bool checkArgCountAtLeast(CallExpr *Call, unsigned MinArgCount);
2848
2849 /// Checks that a call expression's argument count is at most the desired
2850 /// number. This is useful when doing custom type-checking on a variadic
2851 /// function. Returns true on error.
2852 bool checkArgCountAtMost(CallExpr *Call, unsigned MaxArgCount);
2853
2854 /// Checks that a call expression's argument count is in the desired range.
2855 /// This is useful when doing custom type-checking on a variadic function.
2856 /// Returns true on error.
2857 bool checkArgCountRange(CallExpr *Call, unsigned MinArgCount,
2858 unsigned MaxArgCount);
2859
2860 /// Checks that a call expression's argument count is the desired number.
2861 /// This is useful when doing custom type-checking. Returns true on error.
2862 bool checkArgCount(CallExpr *Call, unsigned DesiredArgCount);
2863
2864 /// Returns true if the argument consists of one contiguous run of 1s with any
2865 /// number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to MSB,
2866 /// so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, 0xFF0000FF, 0x0 are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is not,
2867 /// since all 1s are not contiguous.
2868 bool ValueIsRunOfOnes(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum);
2869
2871 bool *ICContext = nullptr,
2872 bool IsListInit = false);
2873
2874 bool
2879 CallExpr *TheCall, EltwiseBuiltinArgTyRestriction ArgTyRestr =
2881
2882private:
2883 void CheckArrayAccess(const Expr *BaseExpr, const Expr *IndexExpr,
2884 const ArraySubscriptExpr *ASE = nullptr,
2885 bool AllowOnePastEnd = true, bool IndexNegated = false);
2886 void CheckArrayAccess(const Expr *E);
2887
2888 bool CheckPointerCall(NamedDecl *NDecl, CallExpr *TheCall,
2889 const FunctionProtoType *Proto);
2890
2891 /// Checks function calls when a FunctionDecl or a NamedDecl is not available,
2892 /// such as function pointers returned from functions.
2893 bool CheckOtherCall(CallExpr *TheCall, const FunctionProtoType *Proto);
2894
2895 /// CheckConstructorCall - Check a constructor call for correctness and safety
2896 /// properties not enforced by the C type system.
2897 void CheckConstructorCall(FunctionDecl *FDecl, QualType ThisType,
2899 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, SourceLocation Loc);
2900
2901 /// Warn if a pointer or reference argument passed to a function points to an
2902 /// object that is less aligned than the parameter. This can happen when
2903 /// creating a typedef with a lower alignment than the original type and then
2904 /// calling functions defined in terms of the original type.
2905 void CheckArgAlignment(SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *FDecl,
2906 StringRef ParamName, QualType ArgTy, QualType ParamTy);
2907
2908 ExprResult CheckOSLogFormatStringArg(Expr *Arg);
2909
2910 ExprResult CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FunctionDecl *FDecl, unsigned BuiltinID,
2911 CallExpr *TheCall);
2912
2913 bool CheckTSBuiltinFunctionCall(const TargetInfo &TI, unsigned BuiltinID,
2914 CallExpr *TheCall);
2915
2916 void checkFortifiedBuiltinMemoryFunction(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *TheCall);
2917
2918 /// Check the arguments to '__builtin_va_start', '__builtin_ms_va_start',
2919 /// or '__builtin_c23_va_start' for validity. Emit an error and return true
2920 /// on failure; return false on success.
2921 bool BuiltinVAStart(unsigned BuiltinID, CallExpr *TheCall);
2922 bool BuiltinVAStartARMMicrosoft(CallExpr *Call);
2923
2924 /// BuiltinUnorderedCompare - Handle functions like __builtin_isgreater and
2925 /// friends. This is declared to take (...), so we have to check everything.
2926 bool BuiltinUnorderedCompare(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned BuiltinID);
2927
2928 /// BuiltinSemaBuiltinFPClassification - Handle functions like
2929 /// __builtin_isnan and friends. This is declared to take (...), so we have
2930 /// to check everything.
2931 bool BuiltinFPClassification(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned NumArgs,
2932 unsigned BuiltinID);
2933
2934 /// Perform semantic analysis for a call to __builtin_complex.
2935 bool BuiltinComplex(CallExpr *TheCall);
2936 bool BuiltinOSLogFormat(CallExpr *TheCall);
2937
2938 /// BuiltinPrefetch - Handle __builtin_prefetch.
2939 /// This is declared to take (const void*, ...) and can take two
2940 /// optional constant int args.
2941 bool BuiltinPrefetch(CallExpr *TheCall);
2942
2943 /// Handle __builtin_alloca_with_align. This is declared
2944 /// as (size_t, size_t) where the second size_t must be a power of 2 greater
2945 /// than 8.
2946 bool BuiltinAllocaWithAlign(CallExpr *TheCall);
2947
2948 /// BuiltinArithmeticFence - Handle __arithmetic_fence.
2949 bool BuiltinArithmeticFence(CallExpr *TheCall);
2950
2951 /// BuiltinAssume - Handle __assume (MS Extension).
2952 /// __assume does not evaluate its arguments, and should warn if its argument
2953 /// has side effects.
2954 bool BuiltinAssume(CallExpr *TheCall);
2955
2956 /// Handle __builtin_assume_aligned. This is declared
2957 /// as (const void*, size_t, ...) and can take one optional constant int arg.
2958 bool BuiltinAssumeAligned(CallExpr *TheCall);
2959
2960 /// BuiltinLongjmp - Handle __builtin_longjmp(void *env[5], int val).
2961 /// This checks that the target supports __builtin_longjmp and
2962 /// that val is a constant 1.
2963 bool BuiltinLongjmp(CallExpr *TheCall);
2964
2965 /// BuiltinSetjmp - Handle __builtin_setjmp(void *env[5]).
2966 /// This checks that the target supports __builtin_setjmp.
2967 bool BuiltinSetjmp(CallExpr *TheCall);
2968
2969 /// We have a call to a function like __sync_fetch_and_add, which is an
2970 /// overloaded function based on the pointer type of its first argument.
2971 /// The main BuildCallExpr routines have already promoted the types of
2972 /// arguments because all of these calls are prototyped as void(...).
2973 ///
2974 /// This function goes through and does final semantic checking for these
2975 /// builtins, as well as generating any warnings.
2976 ExprResult BuiltinAtomicOverloaded(ExprResult TheCallResult);
2977
2978 /// BuiltinNontemporalOverloaded - We have a call to
2979 /// __builtin_nontemporal_store or __builtin_nontemporal_load, which is an
2980 /// overloaded function based on the pointer type of its last argument.
2981 ///
2982 /// This function goes through and does final semantic checking for these
2983 /// builtins.
2984 ExprResult BuiltinNontemporalOverloaded(ExprResult TheCallResult);
2985 ExprResult AtomicOpsOverloaded(ExprResult TheCallResult,
2987
2988 /// \param FPOnly restricts the arguments to floating-point types.
2989 bool BuiltinElementwiseMath(CallExpr *TheCall,
2992 bool PrepareBuiltinReduceMathOneArgCall(CallExpr *TheCall);
2993
2994 bool BuiltinNonDeterministicValue(CallExpr *TheCall);
2995
2996 bool CheckInvalidBuiltinCountedByRef(const Expr *E,
2998 bool BuiltinCountedByRef(CallExpr *TheCall);
2999
3000 // Matrix builtin handling.
3001 ExprResult BuiltinMatrixTranspose(CallExpr *TheCall, ExprResult CallResult);
3002 ExprResult BuiltinMatrixColumnMajorLoad(CallExpr *TheCall,
3003 ExprResult CallResult);
3004 ExprResult BuiltinMatrixColumnMajorStore(CallExpr *TheCall,
3005 ExprResult CallResult);
3006
3007 /// CheckFormatArguments - Check calls to printf and scanf (and similar
3008 /// functions) for correct use of format strings.
3009 /// Returns true if a format string has been fully checked.
3010 bool CheckFormatArguments(const FormatAttr *Format,
3011 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, bool IsCXXMember,
3012 VariadicCallType CallType, SourceLocation Loc,
3013 SourceRange Range,
3014 llvm::SmallBitVector &CheckedVarArgs);
3015 bool CheckFormatString(const FormatMatchesAttr *Format,
3016 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, bool IsCXXMember,
3017 VariadicCallType CallType, SourceLocation Loc,
3018 SourceRange Range,
3019 llvm::SmallBitVector &CheckedVarArgs);
3020 bool CheckFormatArguments(ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args,
3021 FormatArgumentPassingKind FAPK,
3022 StringLiteral *ReferenceFormatString,
3023 unsigned format_idx, unsigned firstDataArg,
3025 SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange range,
3026 llvm::SmallBitVector &CheckedVarArgs);
3027
3028 void CheckInfNaNFunction(const CallExpr *Call, const FunctionDecl *FDecl);
3029
3030 /// Warn when using the wrong abs() function.
3031 void CheckAbsoluteValueFunction(const CallExpr *Call,
3032 const FunctionDecl *FDecl);
3033
3034 void CheckMaxUnsignedZero(const CallExpr *Call, const FunctionDecl *FDecl);
3035
3036 /// Check for dangerous or invalid arguments to memset().
3037 ///
3038 /// This issues warnings on known problematic, dangerous or unspecified
3039 /// arguments to the standard 'memset', 'memcpy', 'memmove', and 'memcmp'
3040 /// function calls.
3041 ///
3042 /// \param Call The call expression to diagnose.
3043 void CheckMemaccessArguments(const CallExpr *Call, unsigned BId,
3044 IdentifierInfo *FnName);
3045
3046 // Warn if the user has made the 'size' argument to strlcpy or strlcat
3047 // be the size of the source, instead of the destination.
3048 void CheckStrlcpycatArguments(const CallExpr *Call, IdentifierInfo *FnName);
3049
3050 // Warn on anti-patterns as the 'size' argument to strncat.
3051 // The correct size argument should look like following:
3052 // strncat(dst, src, sizeof(dst) - strlen(dest) - 1);
3053 void CheckStrncatArguments(const CallExpr *Call,
3054 const IdentifierInfo *FnName);
3055
3056 /// Alerts the user that they are attempting to free a non-malloc'd object.
3057 void CheckFreeArguments(const CallExpr *E);
3058
3059 void CheckReturnValExpr(Expr *RetValExp, QualType lhsType,
3060 SourceLocation ReturnLoc, bool isObjCMethod = false,
3061 const AttrVec *Attrs = nullptr,
3062 const FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr);
3063
3064 /// Diagnoses "dangerous" implicit conversions within the given
3065 /// expression (which is a full expression). Implements -Wconversion
3066 /// and -Wsign-compare.
3067 ///
3068 /// \param CC the "context" location of the implicit conversion, i.e.
3069 /// the most location of the syntactic entity requiring the implicit
3070 /// conversion
3071 void CheckImplicitConversions(Expr *E, SourceLocation CC = SourceLocation());
3072
3073 /// CheckBoolLikeConversion - Check conversion of given expression to boolean.
3074 /// Input argument E is a logical expression.
3076
3077 /// Diagnose when expression is an integer constant expression and its
3078 /// evaluation results in integer overflow
3079 void CheckForIntOverflow(const Expr *E);
3080 void CheckUnsequencedOperations(const Expr *E);
3081
3082 /// Perform semantic checks on a completed expression. This will either
3083 /// be a full-expression or a default argument expression.
3084 void CheckCompletedExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation CheckLoc = SourceLocation(),
3085 bool IsConstexpr = false);
3086
3087 void CheckBitFieldInitialization(SourceLocation InitLoc, FieldDecl *Field,
3088 Expr *Init);
3089
3090 /// A map from magic value to type information.
3091 std::unique_ptr<llvm::DenseMap<TypeTagMagicValue, TypeTagData>>
3092 TypeTagForDatatypeMagicValues;
3093
3094 /// Peform checks on a call of a function with argument_with_type_tag
3095 /// or pointer_with_type_tag attributes.
3096 void CheckArgumentWithTypeTag(const ArgumentWithTypeTagAttr *Attr,
3097 const ArrayRef<const Expr *> ExprArgs,
3098 SourceLocation CallSiteLoc);
3099
3100 /// Check if we are taking the address of a packed field
3101 /// as this may be a problem if the pointer value is dereferenced.
3102 void CheckAddressOfPackedMember(Expr *rhs);
3103
3104 /// Helper class that collects misaligned member designations and
3105 /// their location info for delayed diagnostics.
3106 struct MisalignedMember {
3107 Expr *E;
3108 RecordDecl *RD;
3109 ValueDecl *MD;
3110 CharUnits Alignment;
3111
3112 MisalignedMember() : E(), RD(), MD() {}
3113 MisalignedMember(Expr *E, RecordDecl *RD, ValueDecl *MD,
3114 CharUnits Alignment)
3115 : E(E), RD(RD), MD(MD), Alignment(Alignment) {}
3116 explicit MisalignedMember(Expr *E)
3117 : MisalignedMember(E, nullptr, nullptr, CharUnits()) {}
3118
3119 bool operator==(const MisalignedMember &m) { return this->E == m.E; }
3120 };
3121
3122 /// Adds an expression to the set of gathered misaligned members.
3123 void AddPotentialMisalignedMembers(Expr *E, RecordDecl *RD, ValueDecl *MD,
3124 CharUnits Alignment);
3125 ///@}
3126
3127 //
3128 //
3129 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
3130 //
3131 //
3132
3133 /// \name C++ Coroutines
3134 /// Implementations are in SemaCoroutine.cpp
3135 ///@{
3136
3137public:
3138 /// The C++ "std::coroutine_traits" template, which is defined in
3139 /// <coroutine_traits>
3141
3143 StringRef Keyword);
3147
3150 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Lookup);
3152 Expr *Awaiter, bool IsImplicit = false);
3154 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Lookup);
3157 bool IsImplicit = false);
3162
3163 // As a clang extension, enforces that a non-coroutine function must be marked
3164 // with [[clang::coro_wrapper]] if it returns a type marked with
3165 // [[clang::coro_return_type]].
3166 // Expects that FD is not a coroutine.
3168 /// Lookup 'coroutine_traits' in std namespace and std::experimental
3169 /// namespace. The namespace found is recorded in Namespace.
3171 SourceLocation FuncLoc);
3172 /// Check that the expression co_await promise.final_suspend() shall not be
3173 /// potentially-throwing.
3174 bool checkFinalSuspendNoThrow(const Stmt *FinalSuspend);
3175
3176 ///@}
3177
3178 //
3179 //
3180 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
3181 //
3182 //
3183
3184 /// \name C++ Scope Specifiers
3185 /// Implementations are in SemaCXXScopeSpec.cpp
3186 ///@{
3187
3188public:
3189 // Marks SS invalid if it represents an incomplete type.
3191 // Complete an enum decl, maybe without a scope spec.
3193 CXXScopeSpec *SS = nullptr);
3194
3195 /// Compute the DeclContext that is associated with the given type.
3196 ///
3197 /// \param T the type for which we are attempting to find a DeclContext.
3198 ///
3199 /// \returns the declaration context represented by the type T,
3200 /// or NULL if the declaration context cannot be computed (e.g., because it is
3201 /// dependent and not the current instantiation).
3203
3204 /// Compute the DeclContext that is associated with the given
3205 /// scope specifier.
3206 ///
3207 /// \param SS the C++ scope specifier as it appears in the source
3208 ///
3209 /// \param EnteringContext when true, we will be entering the context of
3210 /// this scope specifier, so we can retrieve the declaration context of a
3211 /// class template or class template partial specialization even if it is
3212 /// not the current instantiation.
3213 ///
3214 /// \returns the declaration context represented by the scope specifier @p SS,
3215 /// or NULL if the declaration context cannot be computed (e.g., because it is
3216 /// dependent and not the current instantiation).
3218 bool EnteringContext = false);
3220
3221 /// If the given nested name specifier refers to the current
3222 /// instantiation, return the declaration that corresponds to that
3223 /// current instantiation (C++0x [temp.dep.type]p1).
3224 ///
3225 /// \param NNS a dependent nested name specifier.
3227
3228 /// The parser has parsed a global nested-name-specifier '::'.
3229 ///
3230 /// \param CCLoc The location of the '::'.
3231 ///
3232 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier, which will be updated in-place
3233 /// to reflect the parsed nested-name-specifier.
3234 ///
3235 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
3237
3238 /// The parser has parsed a '__super' nested-name-specifier.
3239 ///
3240 /// \param SuperLoc The location of the '__super' keyword.
3241 ///
3242 /// \param ColonColonLoc The location of the '::'.
3243 ///
3244 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier, which will be updated in-place
3245 /// to reflect the parsed nested-name-specifier.
3246 ///
3247 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
3249 SourceLocation ColonColonLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS);
3250
3251 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an valid acceptable
3252 /// result for name lookup of a nested-name-specifier.
3253 /// \param SD Declaration checked for nested-name-specifier.
3254 /// \param IsExtension If not null and the declaration is accepted as an
3255 /// extension, the pointed variable is assigned true.
3257 bool *CanCorrect = nullptr);
3258
3259 /// If the given nested-name-specifier begins with a bare identifier
3260 /// (e.g., Base::), perform name lookup for that identifier as a
3261 /// nested-name-specifier within the given scope, and return the result of
3262 /// that name lookup.
3264
3265 /// Keeps information about an identifier in a nested-name-spec.
3266 ///
3268 /// The type of the object, if we're parsing nested-name-specifier in
3269 /// a member access expression.
3271
3272 /// The identifier preceding the '::'.
3274
3275 /// The location of the identifier.
3277
3278 /// The location of the '::'.
3280
3281 /// Creates info object for the most typical case.
3283 SourceLocation ColonColonLoc,
3286 CCLoc(ColonColonLoc) {}
3287
3289 SourceLocation ColonColonLoc, QualType ObjectType)
3291 IdentifierLoc(IdLoc), CCLoc(ColonColonLoc) {}
3292 };
3293
3294 /// Build a new nested-name-specifier for "identifier::", as described
3295 /// by ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifier.
3296 ///
3297 /// \param S Scope in which the nested-name-specifier occurs.
3298 /// \param IdInfo Parser information about an identifier in the
3299 /// nested-name-spec.
3300 /// \param EnteringContext If true, enter the context specified by the
3301 /// nested-name-specifier.
3302 /// \param SS Optional nested name specifier preceding the identifier.
3303 /// \param ScopeLookupResult Provides the result of name lookup within the
3304 /// scope of the nested-name-specifier that was computed at template
3305 /// definition time.
3306 /// \param ErrorRecoveryLookup Specifies if the method is called to improve
3307 /// error recovery and what kind of recovery is performed.
3308 /// \param IsCorrectedToColon If not null, suggestion of replace '::' -> ':'
3309 /// are allowed. The bool value pointed by this parameter is set to
3310 /// 'true' if the identifier is treated as if it was followed by ':',
3311 /// not '::'.
3312 /// \param OnlyNamespace If true, only considers namespaces in lookup.
3313 ///
3314 /// This routine differs only slightly from ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifier, in
3315 /// that it contains an extra parameter \p ScopeLookupResult, which provides
3316 /// the result of name lookup within the scope of the nested-name-specifier
3317 /// that was computed at template definition time.
3318 ///
3319 /// If ErrorRecoveryLookup is true, then this call is used to improve error
3320 /// recovery. This means that it should not emit diagnostics, it should
3321 /// just return true on failure. It also means it should only return a valid
3322 /// scope if it *knows* that the result is correct. It should not return in a
3323 /// dependent context, for example. Nor will it extend \p SS with the scope
3324 /// specifier.
3325 bool BuildCXXNestedNameSpecifier(Scope *S, NestedNameSpecInfo &IdInfo,
3326 bool EnteringContext, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3327 NamedDecl *ScopeLookupResult,
3328 bool ErrorRecoveryLookup,
3329 bool *IsCorrectedToColon = nullptr,
3330 bool OnlyNamespace = false);
3331
3332 /// The parser has parsed a nested-name-specifier 'identifier::'.
3333 ///
3334 /// \param S The scope in which this nested-name-specifier occurs.
3335 ///
3336 /// \param IdInfo Parser information about an identifier in the
3337 /// nested-name-spec.
3338 ///
3339 /// \param EnteringContext Whether we're entering the context nominated by
3340 /// this nested-name-specifier.
3341 ///
3342 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier, which is both an input
3343 /// parameter (the nested-name-specifier before this type) and an
3344 /// output parameter (containing the full nested-name-specifier,
3345 /// including this new type).
3346 ///
3347 /// \param IsCorrectedToColon If not null, suggestions to replace '::' -> ':'
3348 /// are allowed. The bool value pointed by this parameter is set to 'true'
3349 /// if the identifier is treated as if it was followed by ':', not '::'.
3350 ///
3351 /// \param OnlyNamespace If true, only considers namespaces in lookup.
3352 ///
3353 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
3354 bool ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifier(Scope *S, NestedNameSpecInfo &IdInfo,
3355 bool EnteringContext, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3356 bool *IsCorrectedToColon = nullptr,
3357 bool OnlyNamespace = false);
3358
3359 /// The parser has parsed a nested-name-specifier
3360 /// 'template[opt] template-name < template-args >::'.
3361 ///
3362 /// \param S The scope in which this nested-name-specifier occurs.
3363 ///
3364 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier, which is both an input
3365 /// parameter (the nested-name-specifier before this type) and an
3366 /// output parameter (containing the full nested-name-specifier,
3367 /// including this new type).
3368 ///
3369 /// \param TemplateKWLoc the location of the 'template' keyword, if any.
3370 /// \param TemplateName the template name.
3371 /// \param TemplateNameLoc The location of the template name.
3372 /// \param LAngleLoc The location of the opening angle bracket ('<').
3373 /// \param TemplateArgs The template arguments.
3374 /// \param RAngleLoc The location of the closing angle bracket ('>').
3375 /// \param CCLoc The location of the '::'.
3376 ///
3377 /// \param EnteringContext Whether we're entering the context of the
3378 /// nested-name-specifier.
3379 ///
3380 ///
3381 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
3383 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
3384 TemplateTy TemplateName, SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc,
3385 SourceLocation LAngleLoc, ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgs,
3386 SourceLocation RAngleLoc, SourceLocation CCLoc, bool EnteringContext);
3387
3389 SourceLocation ColonColonLoc);
3390
3392 const DeclSpec &DS,
3393 SourceLocation ColonColonLoc,
3394 QualType Type);
3395
3396 /// IsInvalidUnlessNestedName - This method is used for error recovery
3397 /// purposes to determine whether the specified identifier is only valid as
3398 /// a nested name specifier, for example a namespace name. It is
3399 /// conservatively correct to always return false from this method.
3400 ///
3401 /// The arguments are the same as those passed to ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifier.
3403 NestedNameSpecInfo &IdInfo,
3404 bool EnteringContext);
3405
3406 /// Given a C++ nested-name-specifier, produce an annotation value
3407 /// that the parser can use later to reconstruct the given
3408 /// nested-name-specifier.
3409 ///
3410 /// \param SS A nested-name-specifier.
3411 ///
3412 /// \returns A pointer containing all of the information in the
3413 /// nested-name-specifier \p SS.
3415
3416 /// Given an annotation pointer for a nested-name-specifier, restore
3417 /// the nested-name-specifier structure.
3418 ///
3419 /// \param Annotation The annotation pointer, produced by
3420 /// \c SaveNestedNameSpecifierAnnotation().
3421 ///
3422 /// \param AnnotationRange The source range corresponding to the annotation.
3423 ///
3424 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier that will be updated with the contents
3425 /// of the annotation pointer.
3426 void RestoreNestedNameSpecifierAnnotation(void *Annotation,
3427 SourceRange AnnotationRange,
3428 CXXScopeSpec &SS);
3429
3430 bool ShouldEnterDeclaratorScope(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS);
3431
3432 /// ActOnCXXEnterDeclaratorScope - Called when a C++ scope specifier (global
3433 /// scope or nested-name-specifier) is parsed, part of a declarator-id.
3434 /// After this method is called, according to [C++ 3.4.3p3], names should be
3435 /// looked up in the declarator-id's scope, until the declarator is parsed and
3436 /// ActOnCXXExitDeclaratorScope is called.
3437 /// The 'SS' should be a non-empty valid CXXScopeSpec.
3439
3440 /// ActOnCXXExitDeclaratorScope - Called when a declarator that previously
3441 /// invoked ActOnCXXEnterDeclaratorScope(), is finished. 'SS' is the same
3442 /// CXXScopeSpec that was passed to ActOnCXXEnterDeclaratorScope as well.
3443 /// Used to indicate that names should revert to being looked up in the
3444 /// defining scope.
3446
3447 ///@}
3448
3449 //
3450 //
3451 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
3452 //
3453 //
3454
3455 /// \name Declarations
3456 /// Implementations are in SemaDecl.cpp
3457 ///@{
3458
3459public:
3461
3462 /// The index of the first InventedParameterInfo that refers to the current
3463 /// context.
3465
3466 /// A RAII object to temporarily push a declaration context.
3468 private:
3469 Sema &S;
3470 DeclContext *SavedContext;
3471 ProcessingContextState SavedContextState;
3472 QualType SavedCXXThisTypeOverride;
3473 unsigned SavedFunctionScopesStart;
3474 unsigned SavedInventedParameterInfosStart;
3475
3476 public:
3477 ContextRAII(Sema &S, DeclContext *ContextToPush, bool NewThisContext = true)
3478 : S(S), SavedContext(S.CurContext),
3479 SavedContextState(S.DelayedDiagnostics.pushUndelayed()),
3480 SavedCXXThisTypeOverride(S.CXXThisTypeOverride),
3481 SavedFunctionScopesStart(S.FunctionScopesStart),
3482 SavedInventedParameterInfosStart(S.InventedParameterInfosStart) {
3483 assert(ContextToPush && "pushing null context");
3484 S.CurContext = ContextToPush;
3485 if (NewThisContext)
3486 S.CXXThisTypeOverride = QualType();
3487 // Any saved FunctionScopes do not refer to this context.
3488 S.FunctionScopesStart = S.FunctionScopes.size();
3489 S.InventedParameterInfosStart = S.InventedParameterInfos.size();
3490 }
3491
3492 void pop() {
3493 if (!SavedContext)
3494 return;
3495 S.CurContext = SavedContext;
3496 S.DelayedDiagnostics.popUndelayed(SavedContextState);
3497 S.CXXThisTypeOverride = SavedCXXThisTypeOverride;
3498 S.FunctionScopesStart = SavedFunctionScopesStart;
3499 S.InventedParameterInfosStart = SavedInventedParameterInfosStart;
3500 SavedContext = nullptr;
3501 }
3502
3504 };
3505
3506 void DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Stmt *Body);
3507
3508 /// The function definitions which were renamed as part of typo-correction
3509 /// to match their respective declarations. We want to keep track of them
3510 /// to ensure that we don't emit a "redefinition" error if we encounter a
3511 /// correctly named definition after the renamed definition.
3513
3514 /// A cache of the flags available in enumerations with the flag_bits
3515 /// attribute.
3516 mutable llvm::DenseMap<const EnumDecl *, llvm::APInt> FlagBitsCache;
3517
3518 /// WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers - Identifiers contained in \#pragma weak before
3519 /// declared. Rare. May alias another identifier, declared or undeclared.
3520 ///
3521 /// For aliases, the target identifier is used as a key for eventual
3522 /// processing when the target is declared. For the single-identifier form,
3523 /// the sole identifier is used as the key. Each entry is a `SetVector`
3524 /// (ordered by parse order) of aliases (identified by the alias name) in case
3525 /// of multiple aliases to the same undeclared identifier.
3526 llvm::MapVector<
3528 llvm::SetVector<
3530 llvm::SmallDenseSet<WeakInfo, 2u, WeakInfo::DenseMapInfoByAliasOnly>>>
3532
3533 /// ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers - Identifiers contained in
3534 /// \#pragma redefine_extname before declared. Used in Solaris system headers
3535 /// to define functions that occur in multiple standards to call the version
3536 /// in the currently selected standard.
3537 llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo *, AsmLabelAttr *> ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers;
3538
3539 /// Set containing all typedefs that are likely unused.
3542
3546
3547 /// The set of file scoped decls seen so far that have not been used
3548 /// and must warn if not used. Only contains the first declaration.
3550
3554
3555 /// All the tentative definitions encountered in the TU.
3557
3558 /// All the external declarations encoutered and used in the TU.
3560
3561 /// Generally null except when we temporarily switch decl contexts,
3562 /// like in \see SemaObjC::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext.
3564
3565 /// Is the module scope we are in a C++ Header Unit?
3567 return ModuleScopes.empty() ? false
3568 : ModuleScopes.back().Module->isHeaderUnit();
3569 }
3570
3571 /// Get the module owning an entity.
3572 Module *getOwningModule(const Decl *Entity) {
3573 return Entity->getOwningModule();
3574 }
3575
3576 DeclGroupPtrTy ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType = nullptr);
3577
3579 /// Returns the TypeDeclType for the given type declaration,
3580 /// as ASTContext::getTypeDeclType would, but
3581 /// performs the required semantic checks for name lookup of said entity.
3582 void checkTypeDeclType(DeclContext *LookupCtx, DiagCtorKind DCK, TypeDecl *TD,
3583 SourceLocation NameLoc);
3584
3585 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope,
3586 /// return the declaration of that type.
3587 ///
3588 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II
3589 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to
3590 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an
3591 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that
3592 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL.
3594 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS = nullptr,
3595 bool isClassName = false, bool HasTrailingDot = false,
3596 ParsedType ObjectType = nullptr,
3597 bool IsCtorOrDtorName = false,
3598 bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo = false,
3599 bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext = true,
3600 ImplicitTypenameContext AllowImplicitTypename =
3602 IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII = nullptr);
3603
3604 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only*
3605 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo"). If
3606 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum,
3607 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class). This is used to
3608 /// diagnose cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag.
3610
3611 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope,
3612 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes
3613 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning.
3614 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example:
3615 /// @code
3616 /// template<class T> class A {
3617 /// public:
3618 /// typedef int TYPE;
3619 /// };
3620 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> {
3621 /// public:
3622 /// A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class.
3623 /// };
3624 /// @endcode
3625 bool isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S);
3627 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS,
3628 ParsedType &SuggestedType,
3629 bool IsTemplateName = false);
3630
3631 /// Attempt to behave like MSVC in situations where lookup of an unqualified
3632 /// type name has failed in a dependent context. In these situations, we
3633 /// automatically form a DependentTypeName that will retry lookup in a related
3634 /// scope during instantiation.
3636 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3637 bool IsTemplateTypeArg);
3638
3639 class NameClassification {
3641 union {
3646 };
3647
3648 explicit NameClassification(NameClassificationKind Kind) : Kind(Kind) {}
3649
3650 public:
3653
3656
3657 static NameClassification Error() {
3658 return NameClassification(NameClassificationKind::Error);
3659 }
3660
3661 static NameClassification Unknown() {
3662 return NameClassification(NameClassificationKind::Unknown);
3663 }
3664
3665 static NameClassification OverloadSet(ExprResult E) {
3666 NameClassification Result(NameClassificationKind::OverloadSet);
3667 Result.Expr = E;
3668 return Result;
3669 }
3670
3671 static NameClassification NonType(NamedDecl *D) {
3672 NameClassification Result(NameClassificationKind::NonType);
3673 Result.NonTypeDecl = D;
3674 return Result;
3675 }
3676
3677 static NameClassification UndeclaredNonType() {
3678 return NameClassification(NameClassificationKind::UndeclaredNonType);
3679 }
3680
3681 static NameClassification DependentNonType() {
3682 return NameClassification(NameClassificationKind::DependentNonType);
3683 }
3684
3685 static NameClassification TypeTemplate(TemplateName Name) {
3686 NameClassification Result(NameClassificationKind::TypeTemplate);
3687 Result.Template = Name;
3688 return Result;
3689 }
3690
3691 static NameClassification VarTemplate(TemplateName Name) {
3692 NameClassification Result(NameClassificationKind::VarTemplate);
3693 Result.Template = Name;
3694 return Result;
3695 }
3696
3697 static NameClassification FunctionTemplate(TemplateName Name) {
3699 Result.Template = Name;
3700 return Result;
3701 }
3702
3703 static NameClassification Concept(TemplateName Name) {
3704 NameClassification Result(NameClassificationKind::Concept);
3705 Result.Template = Name;
3706 return Result;
3707 }
3708
3709 static NameClassification UndeclaredTemplate(TemplateName Name) {
3711 Result.Template = Name;
3712 return Result;
3713 }
3714
3715 NameClassificationKind getKind() const { return Kind; }
3716
3719 return Expr;
3720 }
3721
3723 assert(Kind == NameClassificationKind::Type);
3724 return Type;
3725 }
3726
3728 assert(Kind == NameClassificationKind::NonType);
3729 return NonTypeDecl;
3730 }
3731
3740
3742 switch (Kind) {
3744 return TNK_Type_template;
3746 return TNK_Function_template;
3748 return TNK_Var_template;
3750 return TNK_Concept_template;
3753 default:
3754 llvm_unreachable("unsupported name classification.");
3755 }
3756 }
3757 };
3758
3759 /// Perform name lookup on the given name, classifying it based on
3760 /// the results of name lookup and the following token.
3761 ///
3762 /// This routine is used by the parser to resolve identifiers and help direct
3763 /// parsing. When the identifier cannot be found, this routine will attempt
3764 /// to correct the typo and classify based on the resulting name.
3765 ///
3766 /// \param S The scope in which we're performing name lookup.
3767 ///
3768 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier that precedes the name.
3769 ///
3770 /// \param Name The identifier. If typo correction finds an alternative name,
3771 /// this pointer parameter will be updated accordingly.
3772 ///
3773 /// \param NameLoc The location of the identifier.
3774 ///
3775 /// \param NextToken The token following the identifier. Used to help
3776 /// disambiguate the name.
3777 ///
3778 /// \param CCC The correction callback, if typo correction is desired.
3779 NameClassification ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3780 IdentifierInfo *&Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
3781 const Token &NextToken,
3782 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = nullptr);
3783
3784 /// Act on the result of classifying a name as an undeclared (ADL-only)
3785 /// non-type declaration.
3787 SourceLocation NameLoc);
3788 /// Act on the result of classifying a name as an undeclared member of a
3789 /// dependent base class.
3791 IdentifierInfo *Name,
3792 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3793 bool IsAddressOfOperand);
3794 /// Act on the result of classifying a name as a specific non-type
3795 /// declaration.
3798 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3799 const Token &NextToken);
3800 /// Act on the result of classifying a name as an overload set.
3802
3803 /// Describes the detailed kind of a template name. Used in diagnostics.
3815
3816 /// Determine whether it's plausible that E was intended to be a
3817 /// template-name.
3819 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E.isInvalid())
3820 return false;
3821 Dependent = false;
3822 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E.get()))
3823 return !DRE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs();
3824 if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E.get()))
3825 return !ME->hasExplicitTemplateArgs();
3826 Dependent = true;
3827 if (auto *DSDRE = dyn_cast<DependentScopeDeclRefExpr>(E.get()))
3828 return !DSDRE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs();
3829 if (auto *DSME = dyn_cast<CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr>(E.get()))
3830 return !DSME->hasExplicitTemplateArgs();
3831 // Any additional cases recognized here should also be handled by
3832 // diagnoseExprIntendedAsTemplateName.
3833 return false;
3834 }
3835
3836 void warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D);
3838
3840
3842 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists);
3843
3844 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning
3845 /// true if we were successful.
3847 SourceLocation Loc,
3848 unsigned FailedFoldDiagID);
3849
3850 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so
3851 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C"
3852 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just
3853 /// function-scope declarations.
3855
3856 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13:
3857 /// If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a
3858 /// name different from T:
3859 /// - every static data member of class T;
3860 /// - every member function of class T
3861 /// - every member of class T that is itself a type;
3862 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules.
3864
3865 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given
3866 /// nested-name-specifier.
3867 ///
3868 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id.
3869 ///
3870 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier
3871 /// resolves.
3872 ///
3873 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared.
3874 ///
3875 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared.
3876 ///
3877 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization Whether we are declaring a member
3878 /// specialization.
3879 ///
3880 /// \param TemplateId The template-id, if any.
3881 ///
3882 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false
3883 /// otherwise.
3886 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId,
3887 bool IsMemberSpecialization);
3888
3890
3891 bool checkConstantPointerAuthKey(Expr *keyExpr, unsigned &key);
3892
3894 unsigned &IntVal);
3895
3896 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that
3897 /// does not identify a function.
3898 void DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS);
3899
3900 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null
3901 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
3903 const LookupResult &R);
3904
3905 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null
3906 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
3908
3909 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null
3910 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
3912 const LookupResult &R);
3913 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing. Implements
3914 /// -Wshadow.
3915 ///
3916 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful"
3917 /// scope.
3918 ///
3919 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable
3920 /// \param R the lookup of the name
3921 void CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl,
3922 const LookupResult &R);
3923
3924 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup.
3925 void CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D);
3926
3927 /// Warn if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers
3928 /// to a shadowing declaration.
3930
3931 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD
3932 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda.
3934
3935 void handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope);
3936 void setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec,
3937 TypedefNameDecl *NewTD);
3940 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3942
3943 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which
3944 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via
3945 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'.
3949 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3951 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists,
3952 bool &AddToScope,
3954
3955private:
3956 // Perform a check on an AsmLabel to verify its consistency and emit
3957 // diagnostics in case of an error.
3958 void CheckAsmLabel(Scope *S, Expr *AsmLabelExpr, StorageClass SC,
3959 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, VarDecl *);
3960
3961public:
3962 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable
3963 /// declaration.
3964 ///
3965 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a
3966 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to
3967 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators
3968 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables
3969 /// that have been instantiated from a template.
3970 ///
3971 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered.
3972 ///
3973 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration.
3974 bool CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous);
3975 void CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD);
3976 void CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *VD);
3977
3978 NamedDecl *ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC,
3979 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3980 LookupResult &Previous,
3981 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists,
3982 bool &AddToScope);
3983
3984 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes,
3985 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it.
3986 bool AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD);
3987
3988 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration.
3989 ///
3990 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration
3991 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not
3992 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is
3993 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed
3994 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions
3995 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called
3996 /// via InstantiateDecl).
3997 ///
3998 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is
3999 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the
4000 /// previous declaration).
4001 ///
4002 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
4003 ///
4004 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration.
4005 bool CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
4006 LookupResult &Previous,
4007 bool IsMemberSpecialization, bool DeclIsDefn);
4008
4009 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be
4010 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration.
4011 ///
4012 /// \param D Declaration that is checked.
4013 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for
4014 /// the same declaration name.
4015 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl
4016 /// belongs to.
4017 bool shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *OldDecl);
4018
4019 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a
4020 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a
4021 /// best-effort check.
4022 ///
4023 /// \param NewD The new declaration.
4024 /// \param OldD The old declaration.
4025 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check.
4026 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check.
4027 bool canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD,
4028 QualType NewT, QualType OldT);
4029 void CheckMain(FunctionDecl *FD, const DeclSpec &D);
4030 void CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD);
4031
4032 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a
4033 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the
4034 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack
4035 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value).
4036 ///
4037 /// \param FD Function being declared.
4038 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declaration.
4039 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or
4040 /// nullptr if no attribute should be added.
4041 Attr *getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD,
4042 bool IsDefinition);
4043
4044 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both
4045 /// function parameters and non-type template parameters.
4046 void CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D);
4047
4048 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator()
4049 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope.
4050 Decl *ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D,
4051 SourceLocation ExplicitThisLoc = {});
4052
4053 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a
4054 /// typedef.
4055 ParmVarDecl *BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation Loc,
4056 QualType T);
4057 ParmVarDecl *CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc,
4058 SourceLocation NameLoc,
4059 const IdentifierInfo *Name, QualType T,
4060 TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, StorageClass SC);
4061
4062 /// Emit diagnostics if the initializer or any of its explicit or
4063 /// implicitly-generated subexpressions require copying or
4064 /// default-initializing a type that is or contains a C union type that is
4065 /// non-trivial to copy or default-initialize.
4066 void checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init, SourceLocation Loc);
4067
4068 // These flags are passed to checkNonTrivialCUnion.
4074
4075 /// Emit diagnostics if a non-trivial C union type or a struct that contains
4076 /// a non-trivial C union is used in an invalid context.
4078 NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext,
4079 unsigned NonTrivialKind);
4080
4081 /// Certain globally-unique variables might be accidentally duplicated if
4082 /// built into multiple shared libraries with hidden visibility. This can
4083 /// cause problems if the variable is mutable, its initialization is
4084 /// effectful, or its address is taken.
4087
4088 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the
4089 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct
4090 /// initialization rather than copy initialization.
4091 void AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *dcl, Expr *init, bool DirectInit);
4092 void ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *dcl);
4093
4094 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an
4095 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to at least re-establish
4096 /// invariants such as whether a variable's type is either dependent or
4097 /// complete.
4098 void ActOnInitializerError(Decl *Dcl);
4099
4100 void ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D);
4102 IdentifierInfo *Ident,
4103 ParsedAttributes &Attrs);
4104
4105 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a
4106 /// dllexport/import function.
4109
4110 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform
4111 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached.
4112 void FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *D);
4114 ArrayRef<Decl *> Group);
4115
4116 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration
4117 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking.
4119
4120 /// Should be called on all declarations that might have attached
4121 /// documentation comments.
4122 void ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D);
4124
4125 enum class FnBodyKind {
4126 /// C++26 [dcl.fct.def.general]p1
4127 /// function-body:
4128 /// ctor-initializer[opt] compound-statement
4129 /// function-try-block
4131 /// = default ;
4133 /// deleted-function-body
4134 ///
4135 /// deleted-function-body:
4136 /// = delete ;
4137 /// = delete ( unevaluated-string ) ;
4139 };
4140
4142 SourceLocation LocAfterDecls);
4144 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition = nullptr,
4145 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody = nullptr);
4147 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists,
4148 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody = nullptr,
4149 FnBodyKind BodyKind = FnBodyKind::Other);
4151 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody = nullptr,
4152 FnBodyKind BodyKind = FnBodyKind::Other);
4154
4155 /// Determine whether we can delay parsing the body of a function or
4156 /// function template until it is used, assuming we don't care about emitting
4157 /// code for that function.
4158 ///
4159 /// This will be \c false if we may need the body of the function in the
4160 /// middle of parsing an expression (where it's impractical to switch to
4161 /// parsing a different function), for instance, if it's constexpr in C++11
4162 /// or has an 'auto' return type in C++14. These cases are essentially bugs.
4163 bool canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D);
4164
4165 /// Determine whether we can skip parsing the body of a function
4166 /// definition, assuming we don't care about analyzing its body or emitting
4167 /// code for that function.
4168 ///
4169 /// This will be \c false only if we may need the body of the function in
4170 /// order to parse the rest of the program (for instance, if it is
4171 /// \c constexpr in C++11 or has an 'auto' return type in C++14).
4172 bool canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D);
4173
4174 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body,
4175 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value
4176 /// optimization.
4177 ///
4178 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value
4179 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any
4180 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can
4181 /// use the named return value optimization.
4182 ///
4183 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every
4184 /// return statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate,
4185 /// that candidate is an NRVO variable.
4187
4188 /// Performs semantic analysis at the end of a function body.
4189 ///
4190 /// \param RetainFunctionScopeInfo If \c true, the client is responsible for
4191 /// releasing the associated \p FunctionScopeInfo. This is useful when
4192 /// building e.g. LambdaExprs.
4194 bool IsInstantiation = false,
4195 bool RetainFunctionScopeInfo = false);
4198
4199 /// ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute - Invoked when we have finished parsing an
4200 /// attribute for which parsing is delayed.
4202
4203 /// Diagnose any unused parameters in the given sequence of
4204 /// ParmVarDecl pointers.
4206
4207 /// Diagnose whether the size of parameters or return value of a
4208 /// function or obj-c method definition is pass-by-value and larger than a
4209 /// specified threshold.
4210 void
4212 QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D);
4213
4215 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
4216
4219
4220 void ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S);
4221
4222 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with
4223 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed.
4225 const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs,
4226 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord);
4227
4228 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with
4229 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template
4230 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations.
4232 const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs,
4233 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams,
4234 bool IsExplicitInstantiation,
4235 RecordDecl *&AnonRecord,
4236 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc = {});
4237
4238 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an
4239 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature
4240 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures
4241 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension.
4242 Decl *BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, AccessSpecifier AS,
4243 RecordDecl *Record,
4244 const PrintingPolicy &Policy);
4245
4246 /// Called once it is known whether
4247 /// a tag declaration is an anonymous union or struct.
4249
4250 /// Emit diagnostic warnings for placeholder members.
4251 /// We can only do that after the class is fully constructed,
4252 /// as anonymous union/structs can insert placeholders
4253 /// in their parent scope (which might be a Record).
4255
4256 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an
4257 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure.
4258 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx
4259 /// Example:
4260 ///
4261 /// struct A { int a; };
4262 /// struct B { struct A; int b; };
4263 ///
4264 /// void foo() {
4265 /// B var;
4266 /// var.a = 3;
4267 /// }
4268 Decl *BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
4269 RecordDecl *Record);
4270
4271 /// Given a non-tag type declaration, returns an enum useful for indicating
4272 /// what kind of non-tag type this is.
4273 NonTagKind getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *D, TagTypeKind TTK);
4274
4275 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable
4276 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration.
4277 ///
4278 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise.
4280 bool isDefinition, SourceLocation NewTagLoc,
4281 const IdentifierInfo *Name);
4282
4283 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'. In the
4284 /// former case, Name will be non-null. In the later case, Name will be null.
4285 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is
4286 /// a reference/declaration/definition of a tag.
4287 ///
4288 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or
4289 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration.
4290 ///
4291 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should
4292 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration.
4293 DeclResult ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK,
4294 SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
4295 IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
4296 const ParsedAttributesView &Attr, AccessSpecifier AS,
4297 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc,
4298 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
4299 bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent,
4300 SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc,
4301 bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType,
4302 bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg,
4303 OffsetOfKind OOK, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody = nullptr);
4304
4305 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order
4306 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it.
4307 Decl *ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart,
4308 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth);
4309
4310 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member.
4311 FieldDecl *HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart,
4312 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth,
4313 InClassInitStyle InitStyle, AccessSpecifier AS);
4314
4315 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness.
4316 ///
4317 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type,
4318 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration
4319 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be
4320 /// created.
4321 ///
4322 /// \returns a new FieldDecl.
4323 ///
4324 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once
4325 FieldDecl *CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T,
4326 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, RecordDecl *Record,
4327 SourceLocation Loc, bool Mutable,
4328 Expr *BitfieldWidth, InClassInitStyle InitStyle,
4329 SourceLocation TSSL, AccessSpecifier AS,
4330 NamedDecl *PrevDecl, Declarator *D = nullptr);
4331
4333
4334 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for
4335 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class
4336 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type,
4337 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface.
4338 void ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclStart,
4339 SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls);
4340
4341 // This is used for both record definitions and ObjC interface declarations.
4342 void ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *TagDecl,
4343 ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac,
4344 SourceLocation RBrac, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList);
4345
4346 /// ActOnTagStartDefinition - Invoked when we have entered the
4347 /// scope of a tag's definition (e.g., for an enumeration, class,
4348 /// struct, or union).
4349 void ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagDecl);
4350
4351 /// Perform ODR-like check for C/ObjC when merging tag types from modules.
4352 /// Differently from C++, actually parse the body and reject / error out
4353 /// in case of a structural mismatch.
4354 bool ActOnDuplicateDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *Prev, SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody);
4355
4357
4358 /// Invoked when we enter a tag definition that we're skipping.
4360
4361 /// ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations - Invoked when we have parsed a
4362 /// C++ record definition's base-specifiers clause and are starting its
4363 /// member declarations.
4365 SourceLocation FinalLoc,
4366 bool IsFinalSpelledSealed,
4367 bool IsAbstract,
4368 SourceLocation TriviallyRelocatable,
4369 SourceLocation LBraceLoc);
4370
4371 /// ActOnTagFinishDefinition - Invoked once we have finished parsing
4372 /// the definition of a tag (enumeration, class, struct, or union).
4374 SourceRange BraceRange);
4375
4378
4380
4381 /// ActOnTagDefinitionError - Invoked when there was an unrecoverable
4382 /// error parsing the definition of a tag.
4384
4386 EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst,
4387 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id,
4388 Expr *val);
4389
4390 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration.
4392
4393 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration.
4394 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid.
4395 bool CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped,
4396 QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed,
4397 const EnumDecl *Prev);
4398
4399 /// Determine whether the body of an anonymous enumeration should be skipped.
4400 /// \param II The name of the first enumerator.
4402 SourceLocation IILoc);
4403
4404 Decl *ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *EnumDecl, Decl *LastEnumConstant,
4405 SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id,
4406 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs,
4407 SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val,
4408 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody = nullptr);
4409 void ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange,
4410 Decl *EnumDecl, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S,
4411 const ParsedAttributesView &Attr);
4412
4413 /// Set the current declaration context until it gets popped.
4414 void PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC);
4415 void PopDeclContext();
4416
4417 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context
4418 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier.
4421
4422 /// Enter a template parameter scope, after it's been associated with a
4423 /// particular DeclContext. Causes lookup within the scope to chain through
4424 /// enclosing contexts in the correct order.
4426
4427 /// Push the parameters of D, which must be a function, into scope.
4430
4431 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains.
4432 void PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext = true);
4433
4434 /// isDeclInScope - If 'Ctx' is a function/method, isDeclInScope returns true
4435 /// if 'D' is in Scope 'S', otherwise 'S' is ignored and isDeclInScope returns
4436 /// true if 'D' belongs to the given declaration context.
4437 ///
4438 /// \param AllowInlineNamespace If \c true, allow the declaration to be in the
4439 /// enclosing namespace set of the context, rather than contained
4440 /// directly within it.
4441 bool isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S = nullptr,
4442 bool AllowInlineNamespace = false) const;
4443
4444 /// Finds the scope corresponding to the given decl context, if it
4445 /// happens to be an enclosing scope. Otherwise return NULL.
4447
4448 /// Subroutines of ActOnDeclarator().
4450 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo);
4452
4453 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one.
4455 NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old,
4457
4458 /// CheckAttributesOnDeducedType - Calls Sema functions for attributes that
4459 /// requires the type to be deduced.
4461
4462 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the
4463 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out
4464 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting
4465 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid.
4467 LookupResult &OldDecls);
4468
4469 /// CleanupMergedEnum - We have just merged the decl 'New' by making another
4470 /// definition visible.
4471 /// This method performs any necessary cleanup on the parser state to discard
4472 /// child nodes from newly parsed decl we are retiring.
4473 void CleanupMergedEnum(Scope *S, Decl *New);
4474
4475 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from
4476 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous
4477 /// declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this situation,
4478 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
4479 ///
4480 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not
4481 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are
4482 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be
4483 /// merged with.
4484 ///
4485 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
4487 bool MergeTypeWithOld, bool NewDeclIsDefn);
4488
4489 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are
4490 /// known to be compatible.
4491 ///
4492 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other
4493 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to
4494 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a
4495 /// redeclaration of Old.
4496 ///
4497 /// \returns false
4499 Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld);
4501
4502 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name
4503 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to resolve this
4504 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
4505 ///
4506 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by
4507 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative
4508 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached.
4510
4511 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and
4512 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'. Figure out how to merge their
4513 /// types, emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
4514 ///
4515 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call
4516 /// back to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the
4517 /// initializer is attached.
4518 void MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, bool MergeTypeWithOld);
4519
4520 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions
4521 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem.
4522 bool checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *OldDefn, VarDecl *NewDefn);
4524
4525 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope
4526 /// as determined by isDeclInScope.
4528 bool ConsiderLinkage, bool AllowInlineNamespace);
4529
4530 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they
4531 /// have compatible owning modules.
4533
4534 /// [module.interface]p6:
4535 /// A redeclaration of an entity X is implicitly exported if X was introduced
4536 /// by an exported declaration; otherwise it shall not be exported.
4538
4539 /// A wrapper function for checking the semantic restrictions of
4540 /// a redeclaration within a module.
4542
4543 /// Check the redefinition in C++20 Modules.
4544 ///
4545 /// [basic.def.odr]p14:
4546 /// For any definable item D with definitions in multiple translation units,
4547 /// - if D is a non-inline non-templated function or variable, or
4548 /// - if the definitions in different translation units do not satisfy the
4549 /// following requirements,
4550 /// the program is ill-formed; a diagnostic is required only if the
4551 /// definable item is attached to a named module and a prior definition is
4552 /// reachable at the point where a later definition occurs.
4553 /// - Each such definition shall not be attached to a named module
4554 /// ([module.unit]).
4555 /// - Each such definition shall consist of the same sequence of tokens, ...
4556 /// ...
4557 ///
4558 /// Return true if the redefinition is not allowed. Return false otherwise.
4559 bool IsRedefinitionInModule(const NamedDecl *New, const NamedDecl *Old) const;
4560
4562
4563 /// If it's a file scoped decl that must warn if not used, keep track
4564 /// of it.
4566
4567 typedef llvm::function_ref<void(SourceLocation Loc, PartialDiagnostic PD)>
4569
4572 DiagReceiverTy DiagReceiver);
4573 void DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *ND);
4574
4575 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used
4576 /// unless they are marked attr(unused).
4577 void DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *ND, DiagReceiverTy DiagReceiver);
4578
4579 /// If VD is set but not otherwise used, diagnose, for a parameter or a
4580 /// variable.
4581 void DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD, DiagReceiverTy DiagReceiver);
4582
4583 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting
4584 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes
4585 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and
4586 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but
4587 /// ill-formed in C++:
4588 /// @code
4589 /// struct S6 {
4590 /// enum { BAR } e;
4591 /// };
4592 ///
4593 /// void test_S6() {
4594 /// struct S6 a;
4595 /// a.e = BAR;
4596 /// }
4597 /// @endcode
4598 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different
4599 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration
4600 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated
4601 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent
4602 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this
4603 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the
4604 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot
4605 /// contain non-field names.
4607
4609 SourceLocation Loc);
4610
4611 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at
4612 /// file scope. lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true
4613 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the
4614 /// built-in.
4615 NamedDecl *LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, Scope *S,
4616 bool ForRedeclaration, SourceLocation Loc);
4617
4618 /// Get the outermost AttributedType node that sets a calling convention.
4619 /// Valid types should not have multiple attributes with different CCs.
4620 const AttributedType *getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const;
4621
4622 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the
4623 /// given Declarator.
4625
4626 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id.
4628
4629 /// ParsingInitForAutoVars - a set of declarations with auto types for which
4630 /// we are currently parsing the initializer.
4632
4633 /// Look for a locally scoped extern "C" declaration by the given name.
4635
4638
4639 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a
4640 /// function-local external declaration.
4642
4644
4645 /// Checks if the variant/multiversion functions are compatible.
4647 const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD,
4648 const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID,
4649 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt,
4650 const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt,
4651 const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported,
4652 bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer);
4653
4654 /// type checking declaration initializers (C99 6.7.8)
4656 Expr *Init, unsigned DiagID = diag::err_init_element_not_constant);
4657
4660 SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit,
4661 Expr *Init);
4662
4664 Expr *Init);
4665
4667
4668 // Heuristically tells if the function is `get_return_object` member of a
4669 // coroutine promise_type by matching the function name.
4670 static bool CanBeGetReturnObject(const FunctionDecl *FD);
4671 static bool CanBeGetReturnTypeOnAllocFailure(const FunctionDecl *FD);
4672
4673 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function
4674 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2).
4676 Scope *S);
4677
4678 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function
4679 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]),
4680 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard.
4681 ///
4682 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written
4683 /// attributes are applied to declarations.
4685 FunctionDecl *FD);
4686
4687 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on
4688 /// the declaration of this function.
4689 ///
4690 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins
4691 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions
4692 /// like NSLog or printf.
4693 ///
4694 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written
4695 /// attributes are applied to declarations.
4697
4698 /// VerifyBitField - verifies that a bit field expression is an ICE and has
4699 /// the correct width, and that the field type is valid.
4700 /// Returns false on success.
4702 const IdentifierInfo *FieldName, QualType FieldTy,
4703 bool IsMsStruct, Expr *BitWidth);
4704
4705 /// IsValueInFlagEnum - Determine if a value is allowed as part of a flag
4706 /// enum. If AllowMask is true, then we also allow the complement of a valid
4707 /// value, to be used as a mask.
4708 bool IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val,
4709 bool AllowMask) const;
4710
4711 /// ActOnPragmaWeakID - Called on well formed \#pragma weak ident.
4712 void ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo *WeakName, SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
4713 SourceLocation WeakNameLoc);
4714
4715 /// ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname - Called on well formed
4716 /// \#pragma redefine_extname oldname newname.
4718 IdentifierInfo *AliasName,
4719 SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
4720 SourceLocation WeakNameLoc,
4721 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc);
4722
4723 /// ActOnPragmaWeakAlias - Called on well formed \#pragma weak ident = ident.
4724 void ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo *WeakName, IdentifierInfo *AliasName,
4725 SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
4726 SourceLocation WeakNameLoc,
4727 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc);
4728
4729 /// Status of the function emission on the CUDA/HIP/OpenMP host/device attrs.
4732 CUDADiscarded, // Discarded due to CUDA/HIP hostness
4733 OMPDiscarded, // Discarded due to OpenMP hostness
4734 TemplateDiscarded, // Discarded due to uninstantiated templates
4736 };
4737 FunctionEmissionStatus getEmissionStatus(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
4738 bool Final = false);
4739
4740 // Whether the callee should be ignored in CUDA/HIP/OpenMP host/device check.
4742
4743 /// Function or variable declarations to be checked for whether the deferred
4744 /// diagnostics should be emitted.
4746
4747private:
4748 /// Map of current shadowing declarations to shadowed declarations. Warn if
4749 /// it looks like the user is trying to modify the shadowing declaration.
4750 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, const NamedDecl *> ShadowingDecls;
4751
4752 // We need this to handle
4753 //
4754 // typedef struct {
4755 // void *foo() { return 0; }
4756 // } A;
4757 //
4758 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A'
4759 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A',
4760 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end
4761 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external
4762 // linkage. Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external
4763 // linkage or not.
4764 static bool mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *FD);
4765
4766#include "clang/Sema/AttrIsTypeDependent.inc"
4767
4768 ///@}
4769
4770 //
4771 //
4772 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
4773 //
4774 //
4775
4776 /// \name Declaration Attribute Handling
4777 /// Implementations are in SemaDeclAttr.cpp
4778 ///@{
4779
4780public:
4781 /// Describes the kind of priority given to an availability attribute.
4782 ///
4783 /// The sum of priorities deteremines the final priority of the attribute.
4784 /// The final priority determines how the attribute will be merged.
4785 /// An attribute with a lower priority will always remove higher priority
4786 /// attributes for the specified platform when it is being applied. An
4787 /// attribute with a higher priority will not be applied if the declaration
4788 /// already has an availability attribute with a lower priority for the
4789 /// specified platform. The final prirority values are not expected to match
4790 /// the values in this enumeration, but instead should be treated as a plain
4791 /// integer value. This enumeration just names the priority weights that are
4792 /// used to calculate that final vaue.
4794 /// The availability attribute was specified explicitly next to the
4795 /// declaration.
4797
4798 /// The availability attribute was applied using '#pragma clang attribute'.
4800
4801 /// The availability attribute for a specific platform was inferred from
4802 /// an availability attribute for another platform.
4804 };
4805
4806 /// Describes the reason a calling convention specification was ignored, used
4807 /// for diagnostics.
4814
4815 /// A helper function to provide Attribute Location for the Attr types
4816 /// AND the ParsedAttr.
4817 template <typename AttrInfo>
4818 static std::enable_if_t<std::is_base_of_v<Attr, AttrInfo>, SourceLocation>
4819 getAttrLoc(const AttrInfo &AL) {
4820 return AL.getLocation();
4821 }
4823
4824 /// If Expr is a valid integer constant, get the value of the integer
4825 /// expression and return success or failure. May output an error.
4826 ///
4827 /// Negative argument is implicitly converted to unsigned, unless
4828 /// \p StrictlyUnsigned is true.
4829 template <typename AttrInfo>
4830 bool checkUInt32Argument(const AttrInfo &AI, const Expr *Expr, uint32_t &Val,
4831 unsigned Idx = UINT_MAX,
4832 bool StrictlyUnsigned = false) {
4833 std::optional<llvm::APSInt> I = llvm::APSInt(32);
4834 if (Expr->isTypeDependent() ||
4836 if (Idx != UINT_MAX)
4837 Diag(getAttrLoc(AI), diag::err_attribute_argument_n_type)
4838 << &AI << Idx << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant
4839 << Expr->getSourceRange();
4840 else
4841 Diag(getAttrLoc(AI), diag::err_attribute_argument_type)
4843 return false;
4844 }
4845
4846 if (!I->isIntN(32)) {
4847 Diag(Expr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ice_too_large)
4848 << toString(*I, 10, false) << 32 << /* Unsigned */ 1;
4849 return false;
4850 }
4851
4852 if (StrictlyUnsigned && I->isSigned() && I->isNegative()) {
4853 Diag(getAttrLoc(AI), diag::err_attribute_requires_positive_integer)
4854 << &AI << /*non-negative*/ 1;
4855 return false;
4856 }
4857
4858 Val = (uint32_t)I->getZExtValue();
4859 return true;
4860 }
4861
4862 /// WeakTopLevelDecl - Translation-unit scoped declarations generated by
4863 /// \#pragma weak during processing of other Decls.
4864 /// I couldn't figure out a clean way to generate these in-line, so
4865 /// we store them here and handle separately -- which is a hack.
4866 /// It would be best to refactor this.
4868
4869 /// WeakTopLevelDeclDecls - access to \#pragma weak-generated Decls
4871
4875
4876 /// ExtVectorDecls - This is a list all the extended vector types. This allows
4877 /// us to associate a raw vector type with one of the ext_vector type names.
4878 /// This is only necessary for issuing pretty diagnostics.
4880
4881 /// Check if the argument \p E is a ASCII string literal. If not emit an error
4882 /// and return false, otherwise set \p Str to the value of the string literal
4883 /// and return true.
4885 const Expr *E, StringRef &Str,
4886 SourceLocation *ArgLocation = nullptr);
4887
4888 /// Check if the argument \p ArgNum of \p Attr is a ASCII string literal.
4889 /// If not emit an error and return false. If the argument is an identifier it
4890 /// will emit an error with a fixit hint and treat it as if it was a string
4891 /// literal.
4892 bool checkStringLiteralArgumentAttr(const ParsedAttr &Attr, unsigned ArgNum,
4893 StringRef &Str,
4894 SourceLocation *ArgLocation = nullptr);
4895
4896 /// Determine if type T is a valid subject for a nonnull and similar
4897 /// attributes. Dependent types are considered valid so they can be checked
4898 /// during instantiation time. By default, we look through references (the
4899 /// behavior used by nonnull), but if the second parameter is true, then we
4900 /// treat a reference type as valid.
4901 bool isValidPointerAttrType(QualType T, bool RefOkay = false);
4902
4903 /// AddAssumeAlignedAttr - Adds an assume_aligned attribute to a particular
4904 /// declaration.
4905 void AddAssumeAlignedAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *E,
4906 Expr *OE);
4907
4908 /// AddAllocAlignAttr - Adds an alloc_align attribute to a particular
4909 /// declaration.
4910 void AddAllocAlignAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4911 Expr *ParamExpr);
4912
4913 bool CheckAttrTarget(const ParsedAttr &CurrAttr);
4914 bool CheckAttrNoArgs(const ParsedAttr &CurrAttr);
4915
4916 AvailabilityAttr *mergeAvailabilityAttr(
4917 NamedDecl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, IdentifierInfo *Platform,
4918 bool Implicit, VersionTuple Introduced, VersionTuple Deprecated,
4919 VersionTuple Obsoleted, bool IsUnavailable, StringRef Message,
4920 bool IsStrict, StringRef Replacement, AvailabilityMergeKind AMK,
4921 int Priority, IdentifierInfo *IIEnvironment);
4922
4923 TypeVisibilityAttr *
4925 TypeVisibilityAttr::VisibilityType Vis);
4926 VisibilityAttr *mergeVisibilityAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4927 VisibilityAttr::VisibilityType Vis);
4928 SectionAttr *mergeSectionAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4929 StringRef Name);
4930
4931 /// Used to implement to perform semantic checking on
4932 /// attribute((section("foo"))) specifiers.
4933 ///
4934 /// In this case, "foo" is passed in to be checked. If the section
4935 /// specifier is invalid, return an Error that indicates the problem.
4936 ///
4937 /// This is a simple quality of implementation feature to catch errors
4938 /// and give good diagnostics in cases when the assembler or code generator
4939 /// would otherwise reject the section specifier.
4940 llvm::Error isValidSectionSpecifier(StringRef Str);
4941 bool checkSectionName(SourceLocation LiteralLoc, StringRef Str);
4942 CodeSegAttr *mergeCodeSegAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4943 StringRef Name);
4944
4945 // Check for things we'd like to warn about. Multiversioning issues are
4946 // handled later in the process, once we know how many exist.
4947 bool checkTargetAttr(SourceLocation LiteralLoc, StringRef Str);
4948
4949 ErrorAttr *mergeErrorAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4950 StringRef NewUserDiagnostic);
4951 FormatAttr *mergeFormatAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4952 IdentifierInfo *Format, int FormatIdx,
4953 int FirstArg);
4954 FormatMatchesAttr *mergeFormatMatchesAttr(Decl *D,
4955 const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4956 IdentifierInfo *Format,
4957 int FormatIdx,
4958 StringLiteral *FormatStr);
4959 ModularFormatAttr *mergeModularFormatAttr(Decl *D,
4960 const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4961 IdentifierInfo *ModularImplFn,
4962 StringRef ImplName,
4964
4965 /// AddAlignedAttr - Adds an aligned attribute to a particular declaration.
4966 void AddAlignedAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *E,
4967 bool IsPackExpansion);
4969 bool IsPackExpansion);
4970
4971 /// AddAlignValueAttr - Adds an align_value attribute to a particular
4972 /// declaration.
4973 void AddAlignValueAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *E);
4974
4975 /// CreateAnnotationAttr - Creates an annotation Annot with Args arguments.
4976 Attr *CreateAnnotationAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, StringRef Annot,
4979
4981 bool BestCase,
4982 MSInheritanceModel SemanticSpelling);
4983
4985
4986 /// AddModeAttr - Adds a mode attribute to a particular declaration.
4987 void AddModeAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, IdentifierInfo *Name,
4988 bool InInstantiation = false);
4989 AlwaysInlineAttr *mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(Decl *D,
4990 const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
4991 const IdentifierInfo *Ident);
4992 MinSizeAttr *mergeMinSizeAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI);
4993 OptimizeNoneAttr *mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(Decl *D,
4994 const AttributeCommonInfo &CI);
4995 InternalLinkageAttr *mergeInternalLinkageAttr(Decl *D, const ParsedAttr &AL);
4996 InternalLinkageAttr *mergeInternalLinkageAttr(Decl *D,
4997 const InternalLinkageAttr &AL);
4998
4999 /// Check validaty of calling convention attribute \p attr. If \p FD
5000 /// is not null pointer, use \p FD to determine the CUDA/HIP host/device
5001 /// target. Otherwise, it is specified by \p CFT.
5003 const ParsedAttr &attr, CallingConv &CC, const FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr,
5005
5006 /// Checks a regparm attribute, returning true if it is ill-formed and
5007 /// otherwise setting numParams to the appropriate value.
5008 bool CheckRegparmAttr(const ParsedAttr &attr, unsigned &value);
5009
5010 /// Create an CUDALaunchBoundsAttr attribute.
5011 CUDALaunchBoundsAttr *CreateLaunchBoundsAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
5012 Expr *MaxThreads,
5013 Expr *MinBlocks,
5014 Expr *MaxBlocks);
5015
5016 /// AddLaunchBoundsAttr - Adds a launch_bounds attribute to a particular
5017 /// declaration.
5018 void AddLaunchBoundsAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
5019 Expr *MaxThreads, Expr *MinBlocks, Expr *MaxBlocks);
5020
5021 /// Add a cluster_dims attribute to a particular declaration.
5022 CUDAClusterDimsAttr *createClusterDimsAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
5023 Expr *X, Expr *Y, Expr *Z);
5024 void addClusterDimsAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *X,
5025 Expr *Y, Expr *Z);
5026 /// Add a no_cluster attribute to a particular declaration.
5027 void addNoClusterAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI);
5028
5029 enum class RetainOwnershipKind { NS, CF, OS };
5030
5031 UuidAttr *mergeUuidAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
5032 StringRef UuidAsWritten, MSGuidDecl *GuidDecl);
5033
5034 BTFDeclTagAttr *mergeBTFDeclTagAttr(Decl *D, const BTFDeclTagAttr &AL);
5035
5036 DLLImportAttr *mergeDLLImportAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI);
5037 DLLExportAttr *mergeDLLExportAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI);
5038 MSInheritanceAttr *mergeMSInheritanceAttr(Decl *D,
5039 const AttributeCommonInfo &CI,
5040 bool BestCase,
5041 MSInheritanceModel Model);
5042
5043 EnforceTCBAttr *mergeEnforceTCBAttr(Decl *D, const EnforceTCBAttr &AL);
5044 EnforceTCBLeafAttr *mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(Decl *D,
5045 const EnforceTCBLeafAttr &AL);
5046
5047 /// Helper for delayed processing TransparentUnion or
5048 /// BPFPreserveAccessIndexAttr attribute.
5050 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList);
5051
5052 // Options for ProcessDeclAttributeList().
5056
5059 Result.IncludeCXX11Attributes = Val;
5060 return Result;
5061 }
5062
5065 Result.IgnoreTypeAttributes = Val;
5066 return Result;
5067 }
5068
5069 // Should C++11 attributes be processed?
5071
5072 // Should any type attributes encountered be ignored?
5073 // If this option is false, a diagnostic will be emitted for any type
5074 // attributes of a kind that does not "slide" from the declaration to
5075 // the decl-specifier-seq.
5077 };
5078
5079 /// ProcessDeclAttributeList - Apply all the decl attributes in the specified
5080 /// attribute list to the specified decl, ignoring any type attributes.
5082 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList,
5083 const ProcessDeclAttributeOptions &Options =
5085
5086 /// Annotation attributes are the only attributes allowed after an access
5087 /// specifier.
5089 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList);
5090
5091 /// checkUnusedDeclAttributes - Given a declarator which is not being
5092 /// used to build a declaration, complain about any decl attributes
5093 /// which might be lying around on it.
5095
5096 void DiagnoseUnknownAttribute(const ParsedAttr &AL);
5097
5098 /// DeclClonePragmaWeak - clone existing decl (maybe definition),
5099 /// \#pragma weak needs a non-definition decl and source may not have one.
5101 SourceLocation Loc);
5102
5103 /// DeclApplyPragmaWeak - A declaration (maybe definition) needs \#pragma weak
5104 /// applied to it, possibly with an alias.
5105 void DeclApplyPragmaWeak(Scope *S, NamedDecl *ND, const WeakInfo &W);
5106
5107 void ProcessPragmaWeak(Scope *S, Decl *D);
5108 // Decl attributes - this routine is the top level dispatcher.
5109 void ProcessDeclAttributes(Scope *S, Decl *D, const Declarator &PD);
5110
5112
5113 /// Given a set of delayed diagnostics, re-emit them as if they had
5114 /// been delayed in the current context instead of in the given pool.
5115 /// Essentially, this just moves them to the current pool.
5117
5118 /// Check that the type is a plain record with one field being a pointer
5119 /// type and the other field being an integer. This matches the common
5120 /// implementation of std::span or sized_allocation_t in P0901R11.
5121 bool CheckSpanLikeType(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, const QualType &Ty);
5122
5123 /// Check if IdxExpr is a valid parameter index for a function or
5124 /// instance method D. May output an error.
5125 ///
5126 /// \returns true if IdxExpr is a valid index.
5127 template <typename AttrInfo>
5129 const Decl *D, const AttrInfo &AI, unsigned AttrArgNum,
5130 const Expr *IdxExpr, ParamIdx &Idx, bool CanIndexImplicitThis = false,
5131 bool CanIndexVariadicArguments = false) {
5133
5134 // In C++ the implicit 'this' function parameter also counts.
5135 // Parameters are counted from one.
5136 bool HP = hasFunctionProto(D);
5137 bool HasImplicitThisParam = hasImplicitObjectParameter(D);
5138 bool IV = HP && isFunctionOrMethodVariadic(D);
5139 unsigned NumParams =
5140 (HP ? getFunctionOrMethodNumParams(D) : 0) + HasImplicitThisParam;
5141
5142 std::optional<llvm::APSInt> IdxInt;
5143 if (IdxExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
5144 !(IdxInt = IdxExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) {
5145 Diag(getAttrLoc(AI), diag::err_attribute_argument_n_type)
5146 << &AI << AttrArgNum << AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant
5147 << IdxExpr->getSourceRange();
5148 return false;
5149 }
5150
5151 unsigned IdxSource = IdxInt->getLimitedValue(UINT_MAX);
5152 if (IdxSource < 1 ||
5153 ((!IV || !CanIndexVariadicArguments) && IdxSource > NumParams)) {
5154 Diag(getAttrLoc(AI), diag::err_attribute_argument_out_of_bounds)
5155 << &AI << AttrArgNum << IdxExpr->getSourceRange();
5156 return false;
5157 }
5158 if (HasImplicitThisParam && !CanIndexImplicitThis) {
5159 if (IdxSource == 1) {
5160 Diag(getAttrLoc(AI), diag::err_attribute_invalid_implicit_this_argument)
5161 << &AI << IdxExpr->getSourceRange();
5162 return false;
5163 }
5164 }
5165
5166 Idx = ParamIdx(IdxSource, D);
5167 return true;
5168 }
5169
5170 ///@}
5171
5172 //
5173 //
5174 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
5175 //
5176 //
5177
5178 /// \name C++ Declarations
5179 /// Implementations are in SemaDeclCXX.cpp
5180 ///@{
5181
5182public:
5184
5185 /// Called before parsing a function declarator belonging to a function
5186 /// declaration.
5188 unsigned TemplateParameterDepth);
5189
5190 /// Called after parsing a function declarator belonging to a function
5191 /// declaration.
5193
5194 // Act on C++ namespaces
5196 SourceLocation NamespaceLoc,
5197 SourceLocation IdentLoc, IdentifierInfo *Ident,
5198 SourceLocation LBrace,
5199 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList,
5200 UsingDirectiveDecl *&UsingDecl, bool IsNested);
5201
5202 /// ActOnFinishNamespaceDef - This callback is called after a namespace is
5203 /// exited. Decl is the DeclTy returned by ActOnStartNamespaceDef.
5204 void ActOnFinishNamespaceDef(Decl *Dcl, SourceLocation RBrace);
5205
5207
5208 /// Retrieve the special "std" namespace, which may require us to
5209 /// implicitly define the namespace.
5211
5213 EnumDecl *getStdAlignValT() const;
5214
5217 QualType AllocType, SourceLocation);
5218
5220 const IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase);
5221
5223 /// The '<=>' operator was used in an expression and a builtin operator
5224 /// was selected.
5226 /// A defaulted 'operator<=>' needed the comparison category. This
5227 /// typically only applies to 'std::strong_ordering', due to the implicit
5228 /// fallback return value.
5230 };
5231
5232 /// Lookup the specified comparison category types in the standard
5233 /// library, an check the VarDecls possibly returned by the operator<=>
5234 /// builtins for that type.
5235 ///
5236 /// \return The type of the comparison category type corresponding to the
5237 /// specified Kind, or a null type if an error occurs
5239 SourceLocation Loc,
5241
5242 /// Tests whether Ty is an instance of std::initializer_list and, if
5243 /// it is and Element is not NULL, assigns the element type to Element.
5244 bool isStdInitializerList(QualType Ty, QualType *Element);
5245
5246 /// Tests whether Ty is an instance of std::type_identity and, if
5247 /// it is and TypeArgument is not NULL, assigns the element type to Element.
5248 /// If MalformedDecl is not null, and type_identity was ruled out due to being
5249 /// incorrectly structured despite having the correct name, the faulty Decl
5250 /// will be assigned to MalformedDecl.
5251 bool isStdTypeIdentity(QualType Ty, QualType *TypeArgument,
5252 const Decl **MalformedDecl = nullptr);
5253
5254 /// Looks for the std::initializer_list template and instantiates it
5255 /// with Element, or emits an error if it's not found.
5256 ///
5257 /// \returns The instantiated template, or null on error.
5259
5260 /// Looks for the std::type_identity template and instantiates it
5261 /// with Type, or returns a null type if type_identity has not been declared
5262 ///
5263 /// \returns The instantiated template, or null if std::type_identity is not
5264 /// declared
5266
5267 /// Determine whether Ctor is an initializer-list constructor, as
5268 /// defined in [dcl.init.list]p2.
5269 bool isInitListConstructor(const FunctionDecl *Ctor);
5270
5271 Decl *ActOnUsingDirective(Scope *CurScope, SourceLocation UsingLoc,
5272 SourceLocation NamespcLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
5273 SourceLocation IdentLoc,
5274 IdentifierInfo *NamespcName,
5275 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList);
5276
5278
5279 Decl *ActOnNamespaceAliasDef(Scope *CurScope, SourceLocation NamespaceLoc,
5280 SourceLocation AliasLoc, IdentifierInfo *Alias,
5281 CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation IdentLoc,
5282 IdentifierInfo *Ident);
5283
5284 /// Remove decls we can't actually see from a lookup being used to declare
5285 /// shadow using decls.
5286 ///
5287 /// \param S - The scope of the potential shadow decl
5288 /// \param Previous - The lookup of a potential shadow decl's name.
5289 void FilterUsingLookup(Scope *S, LookupResult &lookup);
5290
5291 /// Hides a using shadow declaration. This is required by the current
5292 /// using-decl implementation when a resolvable using declaration in a
5293 /// class is followed by a declaration which would hide or override
5294 /// one or more of the using decl's targets; for example:
5295 ///
5296 /// struct Base { void foo(int); };
5297 /// struct Derived : Base {
5298 /// using Base::foo;
5299 /// void foo(int);
5300 /// };
5301 ///
5302 /// The governing language is C++03 [namespace.udecl]p12:
5303 ///
5304 /// When a using-declaration brings names from a base class into a
5305 /// derived class scope, member functions in the derived class
5306 /// override and/or hide member functions with the same name and
5307 /// parameter types in a base class (rather than conflicting).
5308 ///
5309 /// There are two ways to implement this:
5310 /// (1) optimistically create shadow decls when they're not hidden
5311 /// by existing declarations, or
5312 /// (2) don't create any shadow decls (or at least don't make them
5313 /// visible) until we've fully parsed/instantiated the class.
5314 /// The problem with (1) is that we might have to retroactively remove
5315 /// a shadow decl, which requires several O(n) operations because the
5316 /// decl structures are (very reasonably) not designed for removal.
5317 /// (2) avoids this but is very fiddly and phase-dependent.
5318 void HideUsingShadowDecl(Scope *S, UsingShadowDecl *Shadow);
5319
5320 /// Determines whether to create a using shadow decl for a particular
5321 /// decl, given the set of decls existing prior to this using lookup.
5323 const LookupResult &PreviousDecls,
5324 UsingShadowDecl *&PrevShadow);
5325
5326 /// Builds a shadow declaration corresponding to a 'using' declaration.
5329 UsingShadowDecl *PrevDecl);
5330
5331 /// Checks that the given using declaration is not an invalid
5332 /// redeclaration. Note that this is checking only for the using decl
5333 /// itself, not for any ill-formedness among the UsingShadowDecls.
5335 bool HasTypenameKeyword,
5336 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
5337 SourceLocation NameLoc,
5338 const LookupResult &Previous);
5339
5340 /// Checks that the given nested-name qualifier used in a using decl
5341 /// in the current context is appropriately related to the current
5342 /// scope. If an error is found, diagnoses it and returns true.
5343 /// R is nullptr, if the caller has not (yet) done a lookup, otherwise it's
5344 /// the result of that lookup. UD is likewise nullptr, except when we have an
5345 /// already-populated UsingDecl whose shadow decls contain the same
5346 /// information (i.e. we're instantiating a UsingDecl with non-dependent
5347 /// scope).
5348 bool CheckUsingDeclQualifier(SourceLocation UsingLoc, bool HasTypename,
5349 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
5350 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
5351 SourceLocation NameLoc,
5352 const LookupResult *R = nullptr,
5353 const UsingDecl *UD = nullptr);
5354
5355 /// Builds a using declaration.
5356 ///
5357 /// \param IsInstantiation - Whether this call arises from an
5358 /// instantiation of an unresolved using declaration. We treat
5359 /// the lookup differently for these declarations.
5361 SourceLocation UsingLoc,
5362 bool HasTypenameKeyword,
5363 SourceLocation TypenameLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
5364 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo,
5365 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
5366 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList,
5367 bool IsInstantiation, bool IsUsingIfExists);
5369 SourceLocation UsingLoc,
5370 SourceLocation EnumLoc,
5371 SourceLocation NameLoc,
5372 TypeSourceInfo *EnumType, EnumDecl *ED);
5373 NamedDecl *BuildUsingPackDecl(NamedDecl *InstantiatedFrom,
5374 ArrayRef<NamedDecl *> Expansions);
5375
5376 /// Additional checks for a using declaration referring to a constructor name.
5378
5379 /// Given a derived-class using shadow declaration for a constructor and the
5380 /// correspnding base class constructor, find or create the implicit
5381 /// synthesized derived class constructor to use for this initialization.
5384 ConstructorUsingShadowDecl *DerivedShadow);
5385
5387 SourceLocation UsingLoc,
5388 SourceLocation TypenameLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
5389 UnqualifiedId &Name, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
5390 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList);
5392 SourceLocation UsingLoc,
5393 SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange TyLoc,
5394 const IdentifierInfo &II, ParsedType Ty,
5395 const CXXScopeSpec &SS);
5397 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams,
5398 SourceLocation UsingLoc, UnqualifiedId &Name,
5399 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList,
5400 TypeResult Type, Decl *DeclFromDeclSpec);
5401
5402 /// BuildCXXConstructExpr - Creates a complete call to a constructor,
5403 /// including handling of its default argument expressions.
5404 ///
5405 /// \param ConstructKind - a CXXConstructExpr::ConstructionKind
5407 SourceLocation ConstructLoc, QualType DeclInitType, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
5409 bool HadMultipleCandidates, bool IsListInitialization,
5410 bool IsStdInitListInitialization, bool RequiresZeroInit,
5411 CXXConstructionKind ConstructKind, SourceRange ParenRange);
5412
5413 /// Build a CXXConstructExpr whose constructor has already been resolved if
5414 /// it denotes an inherited constructor.
5416 SourceLocation ConstructLoc, QualType DeclInitType,
5417 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, bool Elidable, MultiExprArg Exprs,
5418 bool HadMultipleCandidates, bool IsListInitialization,
5419 bool IsStdInitListInitialization, bool RequiresZeroInit,
5420 CXXConstructionKind ConstructKind, SourceRange ParenRange);
5421
5422 // FIXME: Can we remove this and have the above BuildCXXConstructExpr check if
5423 // the constructor can be elidable?
5425 SourceLocation ConstructLoc, QualType DeclInitType, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
5426 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, bool Elidable, MultiExprArg Exprs,
5427 bool HadMultipleCandidates, bool IsListInitialization,
5428 bool IsStdInitListInitialization, bool RequiresZeroInit,
5429 CXXConstructionKind ConstructKind, SourceRange ParenRange);
5430
5432 SourceLocation InitLoc);
5433
5434 /// FinalizeVarWithDestructor - Prepare for calling destructor on the
5435 /// constructed variable.
5436 void FinalizeVarWithDestructor(VarDecl *VD, CXXRecordDecl *DeclInit);
5437
5438 /// Helper class that collects exception specifications for
5439 /// implicitly-declared special member functions.
5441 // Pointer to allow copying
5442 Sema *Self;
5443 // We order exception specifications thus:
5444 // noexcept is the most restrictive, but is only used in C++11.
5445 // throw() comes next.
5446 // Then a throw(collected exceptions)
5447 // Finally no specification, which is expressed as noexcept(false).
5448 // throw(...) is used instead if any called function uses it.
5449 ExceptionSpecificationType ComputedEST;
5450 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CanQualType, 4> ExceptionsSeen;
5451 SmallVector<QualType, 4> Exceptions;
5452
5453 void ClearExceptions() {
5454 ExceptionsSeen.clear();
5455 Exceptions.clear();
5456 }
5457
5458 public:
5460 : Self(&Self), ComputedEST(EST_BasicNoexcept) {
5461 if (!Self.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
5462 ComputedEST = EST_DynamicNone;
5463 }
5464
5465 /// Get the computed exception specification type.
5467 assert(!isComputedNoexcept(ComputedEST) &&
5468 "noexcept(expr) should not be a possible result");
5469 return ComputedEST;
5470 }
5471
5472 /// The number of exceptions in the exception specification.
5473 unsigned size() const { return Exceptions.size(); }
5474
5475 /// The set of exceptions in the exception specification.
5476 const QualType *data() const { return Exceptions.data(); }
5477
5478 /// Integrate another called method into the collected data.
5479 void CalledDecl(SourceLocation CallLoc, const CXXMethodDecl *Method);
5480
5481 /// Integrate an invoked expression into the collected data.
5482 void CalledExpr(Expr *E) { CalledStmt(E); }
5483
5484 /// Integrate an invoked statement into the collected data.
5485 void CalledStmt(Stmt *S);
5486
5487 /// Overwrite an EPI's exception specification with this
5488 /// computed exception specification.
5491 ESI.Type = getExceptionSpecType();
5492 if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
5493 ESI.Exceptions = Exceptions;
5494 } else if (ESI.Type == EST_None) {
5495 /// C++11 [except.spec]p14:
5496 /// The exception-specification is noexcept(false) if the set of
5497 /// potential exceptions of the special member function contains "any"
5498 ESI.Type = EST_NoexceptFalse;
5499 ESI.NoexceptExpr =
5500 Self->ActOnCXXBoolLiteral(SourceLocation(), tok::kw_false).get();
5501 }
5502 return ESI;
5503 }
5504 };
5505
5506 /// Evaluate the implicit exception specification for a defaulted
5507 /// special member function.
5509
5510 /// Check the given exception-specification and update the
5511 /// exception specification information with the results.
5512 void checkExceptionSpecification(bool IsTopLevel,
5514 ArrayRef<ParsedType> DynamicExceptions,
5515 ArrayRef<SourceRange> DynamicExceptionRanges,
5516 Expr *NoexceptExpr,
5517 SmallVectorImpl<QualType> &Exceptions,
5519
5520 /// Add an exception-specification to the given member or friend function
5521 /// (or function template). The exception-specification was parsed
5522 /// after the function itself was declared.
5524 Decl *D, ExceptionSpecificationType EST, SourceRange SpecificationRange,
5525 ArrayRef<ParsedType> DynamicExceptions,
5526 ArrayRef<SourceRange> DynamicExceptionRanges, Expr *NoexceptExpr);
5527
5528 class InheritedConstructorInfo;
5529
5530 /// Determine if a special member function should have a deleted
5531 /// definition when it is defaulted.
5533 InheritedConstructorInfo *ICI = nullptr,
5534 bool Diagnose = false);
5535
5536 /// Produce notes explaining why a defaulted function was defined as deleted.
5538
5539 /// Declare the implicit default constructor for the given class.
5540 ///
5541 /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
5542 /// default constructor will be added.
5543 ///
5544 /// \returns The implicitly-declared default constructor.
5547
5548 /// DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor - Checks for feasibility of
5549 /// defining this constructor as the default constructor.
5552
5553 /// Declare the implicit destructor for the given class.
5554 ///
5555 /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
5556 /// destructor will be added.
5557 ///
5558 /// \returns The implicitly-declared destructor.
5560
5561 /// DefineImplicitDestructor - Checks for feasibility of
5562 /// defining this destructor as the default destructor.
5563 void DefineImplicitDestructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
5565
5566 /// Build an exception spec for destructors that don't have one.
5567 ///
5568 /// C++11 says that user-defined destructors with no exception spec get one
5569 /// that looks as if the destructor was implicitly declared.
5571
5572 /// Define the specified inheriting constructor.
5575
5576 /// Declare the implicit copy constructor for the given class.
5577 ///
5578 /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
5579 /// copy constructor will be added.
5580 ///
5581 /// \returns The implicitly-declared copy constructor.
5583
5584 /// DefineImplicitCopyConstructor - Checks for feasibility of
5585 /// defining this constructor as the copy constructor.
5586 void DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
5588
5589 /// Declare the implicit move constructor for the given class.
5590 ///
5591 /// \param ClassDecl The Class declaration into which the implicit
5592 /// move constructor will be added.
5593 ///
5594 /// \returns The implicitly-declared move constructor, or NULL if it wasn't
5595 /// declared.
5597
5598 /// DefineImplicitMoveConstructor - Checks for feasibility of
5599 /// defining this constructor as the move constructor.
5600 void DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
5602
5603 /// Declare the implicit copy assignment operator for the given class.
5604 ///
5605 /// \param ClassDecl The class declaration into which the implicit
5606 /// copy assignment operator will be added.
5607 ///
5608 /// \returns The implicitly-declared copy assignment operator.
5610
5611 /// Defines an implicitly-declared copy assignment operator.
5612 void DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
5613 CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl);
5614
5615 /// Declare the implicit move assignment operator for the given class.
5616 ///
5617 /// \param ClassDecl The Class declaration into which the implicit
5618 /// move assignment operator will be added.
5619 ///
5620 /// \returns The implicitly-declared move assignment operator, or NULL if it
5621 /// wasn't declared.
5623
5624 /// Defines an implicitly-declared move assignment operator.
5625 void DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
5626 CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl);
5627
5628 /// Check a completed declaration of an implicit special member.
5630
5631 /// Determine whether the given function is an implicitly-deleted
5632 /// special member function.
5634
5635 /// Check whether 'this' shows up in the type of a static member
5636 /// function after the (naturally empty) cv-qualifier-seq would be.
5637 ///
5638 /// \returns true if an error occurred.
5640
5641 /// Whether this' shows up in the exception specification of a static
5642 /// member function.
5644
5645 /// Check whether 'this' shows up in the attributes of the given
5646 /// static member function.
5647 ///
5648 /// \returns true if an error occurred.
5650
5652 FunctionDecl *FD, const sema::FunctionScopeInfo *FSI);
5653
5655
5656 /// Given a constructor and the set of arguments provided for the
5657 /// constructor, convert the arguments and add any required default arguments
5658 /// to form a proper call to this constructor.
5659 ///
5660 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
5662 QualType DeclInitType, MultiExprArg ArgsPtr,
5663 SourceLocation Loc,
5664 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs,
5665 bool AllowExplicit = false,
5666 bool IsListInitialization = false);
5667
5668 /// ActOnCXXEnterDeclInitializer - Invoked when we are about to parse an
5669 /// initializer for the declaration 'Dcl'.
5670 /// After this method is called, according to [C++ 3.4.1p13], if 'Dcl' is a
5671 /// static data member of class X, names should be looked up in the scope of
5672 /// class X.
5674
5675 /// ActOnCXXExitDeclInitializer - Invoked after we are finished parsing an
5676 /// initializer for the declaration 'Dcl'.
5677 void ActOnCXXExitDeclInitializer(Scope *S, Decl *Dcl);
5678
5679 /// Define the "body" of the conversion from a lambda object to a
5680 /// function pointer.
5681 ///
5682 /// This routine doesn't actually define a sensible body; rather, it fills
5683 /// in the initialization expression needed to copy the lambda object into
5684 /// the block, and IR generation actually generates the real body of the
5685 /// block pointer conversion.
5686 void
5688 CXXConversionDecl *Conv);
5689
5690 /// Define the "body" of the conversion from a lambda object to a
5691 /// block pointer.
5692 ///
5693 /// This routine doesn't actually define a sensible body; rather, it fills
5694 /// in the initialization expression needed to copy the lambda object into
5695 /// the block, and IR generation actually generates the real body of the
5696 /// block pointer conversion.
5698 CXXConversionDecl *Conv);
5699
5700 /// ActOnStartLinkageSpecification - Parsed the beginning of a C++
5701 /// linkage specification, including the language and (if present)
5702 /// the '{'. ExternLoc is the location of the 'extern', Lang is the
5703 /// language string literal. LBraceLoc, if valid, provides the location of
5704 /// the '{' brace. Otherwise, this linkage specification does not
5705 /// have any braces.
5707 Expr *LangStr, SourceLocation LBraceLoc);
5708
5709 /// ActOnFinishLinkageSpecification - Complete the definition of
5710 /// the C++ linkage specification LinkageSpec. If RBraceLoc is
5711 /// valid, it's the position of the closing '}' brace in a linkage
5712 /// specification that uses braces.
5714 SourceLocation RBraceLoc);
5715
5716 //===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5717 // C++ Classes
5718 //
5719
5720 /// Get the class that is directly named by the current context. This is the
5721 /// class for which an unqualified-id in this scope could name a constructor
5722 /// or destructor.
5723 ///
5724 /// If the scope specifier denotes a class, this will be that class.
5725 /// If the scope specifier is empty, this will be the class whose
5726 /// member-specification we are currently within. Otherwise, there
5727 /// is no such class.
5729
5730 /// isCurrentClassName - Determine whether the identifier II is the
5731 /// name of the class type currently being defined. In the case of
5732 /// nested classes, this will only return true if II is the name of
5733 /// the innermost class.
5734 bool isCurrentClassName(const IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S,
5735 const CXXScopeSpec *SS = nullptr);
5736
5737 /// Determine whether the identifier II is a typo for the name of
5738 /// the class type currently being defined. If so, update it to the identifier
5739 /// that should have been used.
5741
5742 /// ActOnAccessSpecifier - Parsed an access specifier followed by a colon.
5744 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
5745 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs);
5746
5747 /// ActOnCXXMemberDeclarator - This is invoked when a C++ class member
5748 /// declarator is parsed. 'AS' is the access specifier, 'BW' specifies the
5749 /// bitfield width if there is one, 'InitExpr' specifies the initializer if
5750 /// one has been parsed, and 'InitStyle' is set if an in-class initializer is
5751 /// present (but parsing it has been deferred).
5752 NamedDecl *
5754 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
5755 Expr *BitfieldWidth, const VirtSpecifiers &VS,
5756 InClassInitStyle InitStyle);
5757
5758 /// Enter a new C++ default initializer scope. After calling this, the
5759 /// caller must call \ref ActOnFinishCXXInClassMemberInitializer, even if
5760 /// parsing or instantiating the initializer failed.
5762
5763 /// This is invoked after parsing an in-class initializer for a
5764 /// non-static C++ class member, and after instantiating an in-class
5765 /// initializer in a class template. Such actions are deferred until the class
5766 /// is complete.
5768 SourceLocation EqualLoc,
5770
5771 /// Handle a C++ member initializer using parentheses syntax.
5773 ActOnMemInitializer(Decl *ConstructorD, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
5774 IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase, ParsedType TemplateTypeTy,
5775 const DeclSpec &DS, SourceLocation IdLoc,
5776 SourceLocation LParenLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5777 SourceLocation RParenLoc, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
5778
5779 /// Handle a C++ member initializer using braced-init-list syntax.
5780 MemInitResult ActOnMemInitializer(Decl *ConstructorD, Scope *S,
5781 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
5782 IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase,
5783 ParsedType TemplateTypeTy,
5784 const DeclSpec &DS, SourceLocation IdLoc,
5785 Expr *InitList, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
5786
5787 /// Handle a C++ member initializer.
5788 MemInitResult BuildMemInitializer(Decl *ConstructorD, Scope *S,
5789 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
5790 IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase,
5791 ParsedType TemplateTypeTy,
5792 const DeclSpec &DS, SourceLocation IdLoc,
5793 Expr *Init, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
5794
5796 SourceLocation IdLoc);
5797
5799 TypeSourceInfo *BaseTInfo, Expr *Init,
5800 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl,
5801 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
5802
5804 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl);
5805
5808
5810 ArrayRef<CXXCtorInitializer *> Initializers = {});
5811
5812 /// MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced - Given a record decl,
5813 /// mark all the non-trivial destructors of its members and bases as
5814 /// referenced.
5815 void MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(SourceLocation Loc,
5816 CXXRecordDecl *Record);
5817
5818 /// Mark destructors of virtual bases of this class referenced. In the Itanium
5819 /// C++ ABI, this is done when emitting a destructor for any non-abstract
5820 /// class. In the Microsoft C++ ABI, this is done any time a class's
5821 /// destructor is referenced.
5823 SourceLocation Location, CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl,
5824 llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const CXXRecordDecl *> *DirectVirtualBases =
5825 nullptr);
5826
5827 /// Do semantic checks to allow the complete destructor variant to be emitted
5828 /// when the destructor is defined in another translation unit. In the Itanium
5829 /// C++ ABI, destructor variants are emitted together. In the MS C++ ABI, they
5830 /// can be emitted in separate TUs. To emit the complete variant, run a subset
5831 /// of the checks performed when emitting a regular destructor.
5832 void CheckCompleteDestructorVariant(SourceLocation CurrentLocation,
5833 CXXDestructorDecl *Dtor);
5834
5835 /// The list of classes whose vtables have been used within
5836 /// this translation unit, and the source locations at which the
5837 /// first use occurred.
5838 typedef std::pair<CXXRecordDecl *, SourceLocation> VTableUse;
5839
5840 /// The list of vtables that are required but have not yet been
5841 /// materialized.
5843
5844 /// The set of classes whose vtables have been used within
5845 /// this translation unit, and a bit that will be true if the vtable is
5846 /// required to be emitted (otherwise, it should be emitted only if needed
5847 /// by code generation).
5848 llvm::DenseMap<CXXRecordDecl *, bool> VTablesUsed;
5849
5850 /// Load any externally-stored vtable uses.
5852
5853 /// Note that the vtable for the given class was used at the
5854 /// given location.
5856 bool DefinitionRequired = false);
5857
5858 /// Mark the exception specifications of all virtual member functions
5859 /// in the given class as needed.
5861 const CXXRecordDecl *RD);
5862
5863 /// MarkVirtualMembersReferenced - Will mark all members of the given
5864 /// CXXRecordDecl referenced.
5866 bool ConstexprOnly = false);
5867
5868 /// Define all of the vtables that have been used in this
5869 /// translation unit and reference any virtual members used by those
5870 /// vtables.
5871 ///
5872 /// \returns true if any work was done, false otherwise.
5873 bool DefineUsedVTables();
5874
5875 /// AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass - Adds any implicitly-declared
5876 /// special functions, such as the default constructor, copy
5877 /// constructor, or destructor, to the given C++ class (C++
5878 /// [special]p1). This routine can only be executed just before the
5879 /// definition of the class is complete.
5881
5882 /// ActOnMemInitializers - Handle the member initializers for a constructor.
5883 void ActOnMemInitializers(Decl *ConstructorDecl, SourceLocation ColonLoc,
5885 bool AnyErrors);
5886
5887 /// Check class-level dllimport/dllexport attribute. The caller must
5888 /// ensure that referenceDLLExportedClassMethods is called some point later
5889 /// when all outer classes of Class are complete.
5892
5894
5895 /// Perform propagation of DLL attributes from a derived class to a
5896 /// templated base class for MS compatibility.
5898 CXXRecordDecl *Class, Attr *ClassAttr,
5899 ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *BaseTemplateSpec,
5900 SourceLocation BaseLoc);
5901
5902 /// Perform semantic checks on a class definition that has been
5903 /// completing, introducing implicitly-declared members, checking for
5904 /// abstract types, etc.
5905 ///
5906 /// \param S The scope in which the class was parsed. Null if we didn't just
5907 /// parse a class definition.
5908 /// \param Record The completed class.
5910
5911 /// Check that the C++ class annoated with "trivial_abi" satisfies all the
5912 /// conditions that are needed for the attribute to have an effect.
5914
5915 /// Check that VTable Pointer authentication is only being set on the first
5916 /// first instantiation of the vtable
5918
5920 Decl *TagDecl, SourceLocation LBrac,
5921 SourceLocation RBrac,
5922 const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList);
5923
5924 /// Perform any semantic analysis which needs to be delayed until all
5925 /// pending class member declarations have been parsed.
5928
5929 /// This is used to implement the constant expression evaluation part of the
5930 /// attribute enable_if extension. There is nothing in standard C++ which
5931 /// would require reentering parameters.
5934 llvm::function_ref<Scope *()> EnterScope);
5936
5937 /// ActOnStartDelayedCXXMethodDeclaration - We have completed
5938 /// parsing a top-level (non-nested) C++ class, and we are now
5939 /// parsing those parts of the given Method declaration that could
5940 /// not be parsed earlier (C++ [class.mem]p2), such as default
5941 /// arguments. This action should enter the scope of the given
5942 /// Method declaration as if we had just parsed the qualified method
5943 /// name. However, it should not bring the parameters into scope;
5944 /// that will be performed by ActOnDelayedCXXMethodParameter.
5946 void ActOnDelayedCXXMethodParameter(Scope *S, Decl *Param);
5948
5949 /// ActOnFinishDelayedCXXMethodDeclaration - We have finished
5950 /// processing the delayed method declaration for Method. The method
5951 /// declaration is now considered finished. There may be a separate
5952 /// ActOnStartOfFunctionDef action later (not necessarily
5953 /// immediately!) for this method, if it was also defined inside the
5954 /// class body.
5957
5959
5960 bool EvaluateAsString(Expr *Message, APValue &Result, ASTContext &Ctx,
5961 StringEvaluationContext EvalContext,
5962 bool ErrorOnInvalidMessage);
5963 bool EvaluateAsString(Expr *Message, std::string &Result, ASTContext &Ctx,
5964 StringEvaluationContext EvalContext,
5965 bool ErrorOnInvalidMessage);
5966
5968 Expr *AssertExpr, Expr *AssertMessageExpr,
5969 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
5971 Expr *AssertExpr, Expr *AssertMessageExpr,
5972 SourceLocation RParenLoc, bool Failed);
5973
5974 /// Try to print more useful information about a failed static_assert
5975 /// with expression \E
5976 void DiagnoseStaticAssertDetails(const Expr *E);
5977
5978 /// If E represents a built-in type trait, or a known standard type trait,
5979 /// try to print more information about why the type type-trait failed.
5980 /// This assumes we already evaluated the expression to a false boolean value.
5981 void DiagnoseTypeTraitDetails(const Expr *E);
5982
5983 /// Handle a friend type declaration. This works in tandem with
5984 /// ActOnTag.
5985 ///
5986 /// Notes on friend class templates:
5987 ///
5988 /// We generally treat friend class declarations as if they were
5989 /// declaring a class. So, for example, the elaborated type specifier
5990 /// in a friend declaration is required to obey the restrictions of a
5991 /// class-head (i.e. no typedefs in the scope chain), template
5992 /// parameters are required to match up with simple template-ids, &c.
5993 /// However, unlike when declaring a template specialization, it's
5994 /// okay to refer to a template specialization without an empty
5995 /// template parameter declaration, e.g.
5996 /// friend class A<T>::B<unsigned>;
5997 /// We permit this as a special case; if there are any template
5998 /// parameters present at all, require proper matching, i.e.
5999 /// template <> template <class T> friend class A<int>::B;
6000 Decl *ActOnFriendTypeDecl(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS,
6001 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams,
6002 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
6004 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams);
6005
6006 /// CheckConstructorDeclarator - Called by ActOnDeclarator to check
6007 /// the well-formedness of the constructor declarator @p D with type @p
6008 /// R. If there are any errors in the declarator, this routine will
6009 /// emit diagnostics and set the invalid bit to true. In any case, the type
6010 /// will be updated to reflect a well-formed type for the constructor and
6011 /// returned.
6013 StorageClass &SC);
6014
6015 /// CheckConstructor - Checks a fully-formed constructor for
6016 /// well-formedness, issuing any diagnostics required. Returns true if
6017 /// the constructor declarator is invalid.
6019
6020 /// CheckDestructorDeclarator - Called by ActOnDeclarator to check
6021 /// the well-formednes of the destructor declarator @p D with type @p
6022 /// R. If there are any errors in the declarator, this routine will
6023 /// emit diagnostics and set the declarator to invalid. Even if this happens,
6024 /// will be updated to reflect a well-formed type for the destructor and
6025 /// returned.
6027 StorageClass &SC);
6028
6029 /// CheckDestructor - Checks a fully-formed destructor definition for
6030 /// well-formedness, issuing any diagnostics required. Returns true
6031 /// on error.
6033
6034 /// CheckConversionDeclarator - Called by ActOnDeclarator to check the
6035 /// well-formednes of the conversion function declarator @p D with
6036 /// type @p R. If there are any errors in the declarator, this routine
6037 /// will emit diagnostics and return true. Otherwise, it will return
6038 /// false. Either way, the type @p R will be updated to reflect a
6039 /// well-formed type for the conversion operator.
6041
6042 /// ActOnConversionDeclarator - Called by ActOnDeclarator to complete
6043 /// the declaration of the given C++ conversion function. This routine
6044 /// is responsible for recording the conversion function in the C++
6045 /// class, if possible.
6047
6048 /// Check the validity of a declarator that we parsed for a deduction-guide.
6049 /// These aren't actually declarators in the grammar, so we need to check that
6050 /// the user didn't specify any pieces that are not part of the
6051 /// deduction-guide grammar. Return true on invalid deduction-guide.
6053 StorageClass &SC);
6054
6056
6059 SourceLocation DefaultLoc);
6061
6062 /// Kinds of defaulted comparison operator functions.
6063 enum class DefaultedComparisonKind : unsigned char {
6064 /// This is not a defaultable comparison operator.
6066 /// This is an operator== that should be implemented as a series of
6067 /// subobject comparisons.
6069 /// This is an operator<=> that should be implemented as a series of
6070 /// subobject comparisons.
6072 /// This is an operator!= that should be implemented as a rewrite in terms
6073 /// of a == comparison.
6075 /// This is an <, <=, >, or >= that should be implemented as a rewrite in
6076 /// terms of a <=> comparison.
6078 };
6079
6083 FunctionDecl *Spaceship);
6086
6088 QualType R, bool IsLambda,
6089 DeclContext *DC = nullptr);
6091 DeclarationName Name, QualType R);
6093
6094 //===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6095 // C++ Derived Classes
6096 //
6097
6098 /// Check the validity of a C++ base class specifier.
6099 ///
6100 /// \returns a new CXXBaseSpecifier if well-formed, emits diagnostics
6101 /// and returns NULL otherwise.
6103 SourceRange SpecifierRange, bool Virtual,
6104 AccessSpecifier Access,
6105 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
6106 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
6107
6108 /// ActOnBaseSpecifier - Parsed a base specifier. A base specifier is
6109 /// one entry in the base class list of a class specifier, for
6110 /// example:
6111 /// class foo : public bar, virtual private baz {
6112 /// 'public bar' and 'virtual private baz' are each base-specifiers.
6113 BaseResult ActOnBaseSpecifier(Decl *classdecl, SourceRange SpecifierRange,
6114 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, bool Virtual,
6115 AccessSpecifier Access, ParsedType basetype,
6116 SourceLocation BaseLoc,
6117 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
6118
6119 /// Performs the actual work of attaching the given base class
6120 /// specifiers to a C++ class.
6123
6124 /// ActOnBaseSpecifiers - Attach the given base specifiers to the
6125 /// class, after checking whether there are any duplicate base
6126 /// classes.
6127 void ActOnBaseSpecifiers(Decl *ClassDecl,
6129
6130 /// Determine whether the type \p Derived is a C++ class that is
6131 /// derived from the type \p Base.
6132 bool IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation Loc, CXXRecordDecl *Derived,
6134 bool IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation Loc, CXXRecordDecl *Derived,
6138 CXXBasePaths &Paths);
6139
6140 // FIXME: I don't like this name.
6141 void BuildBasePathArray(const CXXBasePaths &Paths, CXXCastPath &BasePath);
6142
6144 SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range,
6145 CXXCastPath *BasePath = nullptr,
6146 bool IgnoreAccess = false);
6147
6148 /// CheckDerivedToBaseConversion - Check whether the Derived-to-Base
6149 /// conversion (where Derived and Base are class types) is
6150 /// well-formed, meaning that the conversion is unambiguous (and
6151 /// that all of the base classes are accessible). Returns true
6152 /// and emits a diagnostic if the code is ill-formed, returns false
6153 /// otherwise. Loc is the location where this routine should point to
6154 /// if there is an error, and Range is the source range to highlight
6155 /// if there is an error.
6156 ///
6157 /// If either InaccessibleBaseID or AmbiguousBaseConvID are 0, then the
6158 /// diagnostic for the respective type of error will be suppressed, but the
6159 /// check for ill-formed code will still be performed.
6161 unsigned InaccessibleBaseID,
6162 unsigned AmbiguousBaseConvID,
6163 SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range,
6164 DeclarationName Name, CXXCastPath *BasePath,
6165 bool IgnoreAccess = false);
6166
6167 /// Builds a string representing ambiguous paths from a
6168 /// specific derived class to different subobjects of the same base
6169 /// class.
6170 ///
6171 /// This function builds a string that can be used in error messages
6172 /// to show the different paths that one can take through the
6173 /// inheritance hierarchy to go from the derived class to different
6174 /// subobjects of a base class. The result looks something like this:
6175 /// @code
6176 /// struct D -> struct B -> struct A
6177 /// struct D -> struct C -> struct A
6178 /// @endcode
6179 std::string getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(CXXBasePaths &Paths);
6180
6182 const CXXMethodDecl *Old);
6183
6184 /// CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType - Checks whether the return types are
6185 /// covariant, according to C++ [class.virtual]p5.
6187 const CXXMethodDecl *Old);
6188
6189 // Check that the overriding method has no explicit object parameter.
6191 const CXXMethodDecl *Old);
6192
6193 /// Mark the given method pure.
6194 ///
6195 /// \param Method the method to be marked pure.
6196 ///
6197 /// \param InitRange the source range that covers the "0" initializer.
6199
6200 /// CheckOverrideControl - Check C++11 override control semantics.
6202
6203 /// DiagnoseAbsenceOfOverrideControl - Diagnose if 'override' keyword was
6204 /// not used in the declaration of an overriding method.
6206
6207 /// CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal - Checks whether a virtual member
6208 /// function overrides a virtual member function marked 'final', according to
6209 /// C++11 [class.virtual]p4.
6211 const CXXMethodDecl *Old);
6212
6223
6224 struct TypeDiagnoser;
6225
6228 TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser);
6229 template <typename... Ts>
6231 const Ts &...Args) {
6232 BoundTypeDiagnoser<Ts...> Diagnoser(DiagID, Args...);
6233 return RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T, Diagnoser);
6234 }
6235
6236 void DiagnoseAbstractType(const CXXRecordDecl *RD);
6237
6238 //===--------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6239 // C++ Overloaded Operators [C++ 13.5]
6240 //
6241
6242 /// CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration - Check whether the declaration
6243 /// of this overloaded operator is well-formed. If so, returns false;
6244 /// otherwise, emits appropriate diagnostics and returns true.
6246
6247 /// CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration - Check whether the declaration
6248 /// of this literal operator function is well-formed. If so, returns
6249 /// false; otherwise, emits appropriate diagnostics and returns true.
6251
6252 /// ActOnExplicitBoolSpecifier - Build an ExplicitSpecifier from an expression
6253 /// found in an explicit(bool) specifier.
6255
6256 /// tryResolveExplicitSpecifier - Attempt to resolve the explict specifier.
6257 /// Returns true if the explicit specifier is now resolved.
6259
6260 /// ActOnCXXConditionDeclarationExpr - Parsed a condition declaration of a
6261 /// C++ if/switch/while/for statement.
6262 /// e.g: "if (int x = f()) {...}"
6264
6265 // Emitting members of dllexported classes is delayed until the class
6266 // (including field initializers) is fully parsed.
6269
6270 /// Merge the exception specifications of two variable declarations.
6271 ///
6272 /// This is called when there's a redeclaration of a VarDecl. The function
6273 /// checks if the redeclaration might have an exception specification and
6274 /// validates compatibility and merges the specs if necessary.
6276
6277 /// MergeCXXFunctionDecl - Merge two declarations of the same C++
6278 /// function, once we already know that they have the same
6279 /// type. Subroutine of MergeFunctionDecl. Returns true if there was an
6280 /// error, false otherwise.
6282
6283 /// Helpers for dealing with blocks and functions.
6285
6286 /// CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments - Check for any extra default
6287 /// arguments in the declarator, which is not a function declaration
6288 /// or definition and therefore is not permitted to have default
6289 /// arguments. This routine should be invoked for every declarator
6290 /// that is not a function declaration or definition.
6292
6296
6297 /// Perform semantic analysis for the variable declaration that
6298 /// occurs within a C++ catch clause, returning the newly-created
6299 /// variable.
6301 SourceLocation StartLoc,
6302 SourceLocation IdLoc,
6303 const IdentifierInfo *Id);
6304
6305 /// ActOnExceptionDeclarator - Parsed the exception-declarator in a C++ catch
6306 /// handler.
6308
6310
6311 /// Handle a friend tag declaration where the scope specifier was
6312 /// templated.
6314 unsigned TagSpec, SourceLocation TagLoc,
6315 CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *Name,
6316 SourceLocation NameLoc,
6317 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
6319 MultiTemplateParamsArg TempParamLists);
6320
6322 SourceLocation DeclStart, Declarator &D,
6323 Expr *BitfieldWidth,
6324 InClassInitStyle InitStyle,
6325 AccessSpecifier AS,
6326 const ParsedAttr &MSPropertyAttr);
6327
6328 /// Diagnose why the specified class does not have a trivial special member of
6329 /// the given kind.
6332
6333 /// Determine whether a defaulted or deleted special member function is
6334 /// trivial, as specified in C++11 [class.ctor]p5, C++11 [class.copy]p12,
6335 /// C++11 [class.copy]p25, and C++11 [class.dtor]p5.
6339 bool Diagnose = false);
6340
6341 /// For a defaulted function, the kind of defaulted function that it is.
6343 LLVM_PREFERRED_TYPE(CXXSpecialMemberKind)
6344 unsigned SpecialMember : 8;
6345 unsigned Comparison : 8;
6346
6347 public:
6349 : SpecialMember(llvm::to_underlying(CXXSpecialMemberKind::Invalid)),
6350 Comparison(llvm::to_underlying(DefaultedComparisonKind::None)) {}
6352 : SpecialMember(llvm::to_underlying(CSM)),
6353 Comparison(llvm::to_underlying(DefaultedComparisonKind::None)) {}
6355 : SpecialMember(llvm::to_underlying(CXXSpecialMemberKind::Invalid)),
6356 Comparison(llvm::to_underlying(Comp)) {}
6357
6358 bool isSpecialMember() const {
6359 return static_cast<CXXSpecialMemberKind>(SpecialMember) !=
6361 }
6362 bool isComparison() const {
6363 return static_cast<DefaultedComparisonKind>(Comparison) !=
6365 }
6366
6367 explicit operator bool() const {
6368 return isSpecialMember() || isComparison();
6369 }
6370
6372 return static_cast<CXXSpecialMemberKind>(SpecialMember);
6373 }
6375 return static_cast<DefaultedComparisonKind>(Comparison);
6376 }
6377
6378 /// Get the index of this function kind for use in diagnostics.
6379 unsigned getDiagnosticIndex() const {
6380 static_assert(llvm::to_underlying(CXXSpecialMemberKind::Invalid) >
6381 llvm::to_underlying(CXXSpecialMemberKind::Destructor),
6382 "invalid should have highest index");
6383 static_assert((unsigned)DefaultedComparisonKind::None == 0,
6384 "none should be equal to zero");
6385 return SpecialMember + Comparison;
6386 }
6387 };
6388
6389 /// Determine the kind of defaulting that would be done for a given function.
6390 ///
6391 /// If the function is both a default constructor and a copy / move
6392 /// constructor (due to having a default argument for the first parameter),
6393 /// this picks CXXSpecialMemberKind::DefaultConstructor.
6394 ///
6395 /// FIXME: Check that case is properly handled by all callers.
6396 DefaultedFunctionKind getDefaultedFunctionKind(const FunctionDecl *FD);
6397
6398 /// Handle a C++11 empty-declaration and attribute-declaration.
6400 SourceLocation SemiLoc);
6401
6403 /// Diagnose issues that are non-constant or that are extensions.
6405 /// Identify whether this function satisfies the formal rules for constexpr
6406 /// functions in the current lanugage mode (with no extensions).
6408 };
6409
6410 // Check whether a function declaration satisfies the requirements of a
6411 // constexpr function definition or a constexpr constructor definition. If so,
6412 // return true. If not, produce appropriate diagnostics (unless asked not to
6413 // by Kind) and return false.
6414 //
6415 // This implements C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3,4, as amended by DR1360.
6417 CheckConstexprKind Kind);
6418
6419 /// Diagnose methods which overload virtual methods in a base class
6420 /// without overriding any.
6422
6423 /// Check if a method overloads virtual methods in a base class without
6424 /// overriding any.
6425 void
6427 SmallVectorImpl<CXXMethodDecl *> &OverloadedMethods);
6428 void
6430 SmallVectorImpl<CXXMethodDecl *> &OverloadedMethods);
6431
6432 /// ActOnParamDefaultArgument - Check whether the default argument
6433 /// provided for a function parameter is well-formed. If so, attach it
6434 /// to the parameter declaration.
6435 void ActOnParamDefaultArgument(Decl *param, SourceLocation EqualLoc,
6436 Expr *defarg);
6437
6438 /// ActOnParamUnparsedDefaultArgument - We've seen a default
6439 /// argument for a function parameter, but we can't parse it yet
6440 /// because we're inside a class definition. Note that this default
6441 /// argument will be parsed later.
6443 SourceLocation ArgLoc);
6444
6445 /// ActOnParamDefaultArgumentError - Parsing or semantic analysis of
6446 /// the default argument for the parameter param failed.
6448 Expr *DefaultArg);
6450 SourceLocation EqualLoc);
6451 void SetParamDefaultArgument(ParmVarDecl *Param, Expr *DefaultArg,
6452 SourceLocation EqualLoc);
6453
6454 void ActOnPureSpecifier(Decl *D, SourceLocation PureSpecLoc);
6455 void SetDeclDeleted(Decl *dcl, SourceLocation DelLoc,
6456 StringLiteral *Message = nullptr);
6457 void SetDeclDefaulted(Decl *dcl, SourceLocation DefaultLoc);
6458
6459 void SetFunctionBodyKind(Decl *D, SourceLocation Loc, FnBodyKind BodyKind,
6460 StringLiteral *DeletedMessage = nullptr);
6464
6465 NamedDecl *
6467 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists);
6470 RecordDecl *ClassDecl,
6471 const IdentifierInfo *Name);
6472
6474 SourceLocation Loc);
6476
6477 /// Stack containing information needed when in C++2a an 'auto' is encountered
6478 /// in a function declaration parameter type specifier in order to invent a
6479 /// corresponding template parameter in the enclosing abbreviated function
6480 /// template. This information is also present in LambdaScopeInfo, stored in
6481 /// the FunctionScopes stack.
6483
6484 /// FieldCollector - Collects CXXFieldDecls during parsing of C++ classes.
6485 std::unique_ptr<CXXFieldCollector> FieldCollector;
6486
6488 /// Set containing all declared private fields that are not used.
6490
6492
6493 /// PureVirtualClassDiagSet - a set of class declarations which we have
6494 /// emitted a list of pure virtual functions. Used to prevent emitting the
6495 /// same list more than once.
6496 std::unique_ptr<RecordDeclSetTy> PureVirtualClassDiagSet;
6497
6501
6502 /// All the delegating constructors seen so far in the file, used for
6503 /// cycle detection at the end of the TU.
6505
6506 /// The C++ "std" namespace, where the standard library resides.
6508
6509 /// The C++ "std::initializer_list" template, which is defined in
6510 /// <initializer_list>.
6512
6513 /// The C++ "std::type_identity" template, which is defined in
6514 /// <type_traits>.
6516
6517 // Contains the locations of the beginning of unparsed default
6518 // argument locations.
6519 llvm::DenseMap<ParmVarDecl *, SourceLocation> UnparsedDefaultArgLocs;
6520
6521 /// UndefinedInternals - all the used, undefined objects which require a
6522 /// definition in this translation unit.
6523 llvm::MapVector<NamedDecl *, SourceLocation> UndefinedButUsed;
6524
6525 typedef llvm::PointerIntPair<CXXRecordDecl *, 3, CXXSpecialMemberKind>
6527
6528 /// The C++ special members which we are currently in the process of
6529 /// declaring. If this process recursively triggers the declaration of the
6530 /// same special member, we should act as if it is not yet declared.
6532
6534
6535 void ActOnDefaultCtorInitializers(Decl *CDtorDecl);
6536
6539 ParsingClassDepth++;
6541 }
6543 ParsingClassDepth--;
6545 }
6546
6548 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
6549 ParsedType TemplateTypeTy,
6550 IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase);
6551
6552private:
6553 void setupImplicitSpecialMemberType(CXXMethodDecl *SpecialMem,
6554 QualType ResultTy,
6555 ArrayRef<QualType> Args);
6556 // Helper for ActOnFields to check for all function pointer members.
6557 bool EntirelyFunctionPointers(const RecordDecl *Record);
6558
6559 // A cache representing if we've fully checked the various comparison category
6560 // types stored in ASTContext. The bit-index corresponds to the integer value
6561 // of a ComparisonCategoryType enumerator.
6562 llvm::SmallBitVector FullyCheckedComparisonCategories;
6563
6564 /// Check if there is a field shadowing.
6565 void CheckShadowInheritedFields(const SourceLocation &Loc,
6566 DeclarationName FieldName,
6567 const CXXRecordDecl *RD,
6568 bool DeclIsField = true);
6569
6570 ///@}
6571
6572 //
6573 //
6574 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
6575 //
6576 //
6577
6578 /// \name C++ Exception Specifications
6579 /// Implementations are in SemaExceptionSpec.cpp
6580 ///@{
6581
6582public:
6583 /// All the overriding functions seen during a class definition
6584 /// that had their exception spec checks delayed, plus the overridden
6585 /// function.
6588
6589 /// All the function redeclarations seen during a class definition that had
6590 /// their exception spec checks delayed, plus the prior declaration they
6591 /// should be checked against. Except during error recovery, the new decl
6592 /// should always be a friend declaration, as that's the only valid way to
6593 /// redeclare a special member before its class is complete.
6596
6597 /// Determine if we're in a case where we need to (incorrectly) eagerly
6598 /// parse an exception specification to work around a libstdc++ bug.
6600
6601 /// Check the given noexcept-specifier, convert its expression, and compute
6602 /// the appropriate ExceptionSpecificationType.
6603 ExprResult ActOnNoexceptSpec(Expr *NoexceptExpr,
6605
6606 CanThrowResult canThrow(const Stmt *E);
6607 /// Determine whether the callee of a particular function call can throw.
6608 /// E, D and Loc are all optional.
6609 static CanThrowResult canCalleeThrow(Sema &S, const Expr *E, const Decl *D,
6612 const FunctionProtoType *FPT);
6615
6616 /// CheckSpecifiedExceptionType - Check if the given type is valid in an
6617 /// exception specification. Incomplete types, or pointers to incomplete types
6618 /// other than void are not allowed.
6619 ///
6620 /// \param[in,out] T The exception type. This will be decayed to a pointer
6621 /// type
6622 /// when the input is an array or a function type.
6624
6625 /// CheckDistantExceptionSpec - Check if the given type is a pointer or
6626 /// pointer to member to a function with an exception specification. This
6627 /// means that it is invalid to add another level of indirection.
6630
6631 /// CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec - Check if the two types have equivalent
6632 /// exception specifications. Exception specifications are equivalent if
6633 /// they allow exactly the same set of exception types. It does not matter how
6634 /// that is achieved. See C++ [except.spec]p2.
6636 SourceLocation OldLoc,
6637 const FunctionProtoType *New,
6638 SourceLocation NewLoc);
6640 const PartialDiagnostic &NoteID,
6641 const FunctionProtoType *Old,
6642 SourceLocation OldLoc,
6643 const FunctionProtoType *New,
6644 SourceLocation NewLoc);
6645 bool handlerCanCatch(QualType HandlerType, QualType ExceptionType);
6646
6647 /// CheckExceptionSpecSubset - Check whether the second function type's
6648 /// exception specification is a subset (or equivalent) of the first function
6649 /// type. This is used by override and pointer assignment checks.
6651 const PartialDiagnostic &DiagID, const PartialDiagnostic &NestedDiagID,
6652 const PartialDiagnostic &NoteID, const PartialDiagnostic &NoThrowDiagID,
6653 const FunctionProtoType *Superset, bool SkipSupersetFirstParameter,
6654 SourceLocation SuperLoc, const FunctionProtoType *Subset,
6655 bool SkipSubsetFirstParameter, SourceLocation SubLoc);
6656
6657 /// CheckParamExceptionSpec - Check if the parameter and return types of the
6658 /// two functions have equivalent exception specs. This is part of the
6659 /// assignment and override compatibility check. We do not check the
6660 /// parameters of parameter function pointers recursively, as no sane
6661 /// programmer would even be able to write such a function type.
6663 const PartialDiagnostic &NestedDiagID, const PartialDiagnostic &NoteID,
6664 const FunctionProtoType *Target, bool SkipTargetFirstParameter,
6665 SourceLocation TargetLoc, const FunctionProtoType *Source,
6666 bool SkipSourceFirstParameter, SourceLocation SourceLoc);
6667
6668 bool CheckExceptionSpecCompatibility(Expr *From, QualType ToType);
6669
6670 /// CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec - Checks whether the exception
6671 /// spec is a subset of base spec.
6673 const CXXMethodDecl *Old);
6674
6675 ///@}
6676
6677 //
6678 //
6679 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
6680 //
6681 //
6682
6683 /// \name Expressions
6684 /// Implementations are in SemaExpr.cpp
6685 ///@{
6686
6687public:
6688 /// Describes how the expressions currently being parsed are
6689 /// evaluated at run-time, if at all.
6691 /// The current expression and its subexpressions occur within an
6692 /// unevaluated operand (C++11 [expr]p7), such as the subexpression of
6693 /// \c sizeof, where the type of the expression may be significant but
6694 /// no code will be generated to evaluate the value of the expression at
6695 /// run time.
6697
6698 /// The current expression occurs within a braced-init-list within
6699 /// an unevaluated operand. This is mostly like a regular unevaluated
6700 /// context, except that we still instantiate constexpr functions that are
6701 /// referenced here so that we can perform narrowing checks correctly.
6703
6704 /// The current expression occurs within a discarded statement.
6705 /// This behaves largely similarly to an unevaluated operand in preventing
6706 /// definitions from being required, but not in other ways.
6708
6709 /// The current expression occurs within an unevaluated
6710 /// operand that unconditionally permits abstract references to
6711 /// fields, such as a SIZE operator in MS-style inline assembly.
6713
6714 /// The current context is "potentially evaluated" in C++11 terms,
6715 /// but the expression is evaluated at compile-time (like the values of
6716 /// cases in a switch statement).
6718
6719 /// In addition of being constant evaluated, the current expression
6720 /// occurs in an immediate function context - either a consteval function
6721 /// or a consteval if statement.
6723
6724 /// The current expression is potentially evaluated at run time,
6725 /// which means that code may be generated to evaluate the value of the
6726 /// expression at run time.
6728
6729 /// The current expression is potentially evaluated, but any
6730 /// declarations referenced inside that expression are only used if
6731 /// in fact the current expression is used.
6732 ///
6733 /// This value is used when parsing default function arguments, for which
6734 /// we would like to provide diagnostics (e.g., passing non-POD arguments
6735 /// through varargs) but do not want to mark declarations as "referenced"
6736 /// until the default argument is used.
6738 };
6739
6740 /// Store a set of either DeclRefExprs or MemberExprs that contain a reference
6741 /// to a variable (constant) that may or may not be odr-used in this Expr, and
6742 /// we won't know until all lvalue-to-rvalue and discarded value conversions
6743 /// have been applied to all subexpressions of the enclosing full expression.
6744 /// This is cleared at the end of each full expression.
6747
6748 using ImmediateInvocationCandidate = llvm::PointerIntPair<ConstantExpr *, 1>;
6749
6750 /// Data structure used to record current or nested
6751 /// expression evaluation contexts.
6753 /// The expression evaluation context.
6755
6756 /// Whether the enclosing context needed a cleanup.
6758
6759 /// The number of active cleanup objects when we entered
6760 /// this expression evaluation context.
6762
6764
6765 /// The lambdas that are present within this context, if it
6766 /// is indeed an unevaluated context.
6768
6769 /// The declaration that provides context for lambda expressions
6770 /// and block literals if the normal declaration context does not
6771 /// suffice, e.g., in a default function argument.
6773
6774 /// Declaration for initializer if one is currently being
6775 /// parsed. Used when an expression has a possibly unreachable
6776 /// diagnostic to reference the declaration as a whole.
6778
6779 /// If we are processing a decltype type, a set of call expressions
6780 /// for which we have deferred checking the completeness of the return type.
6782
6783 /// If we are processing a decltype type, a set of temporary binding
6784 /// expressions for which we have deferred checking the destructor.
6786
6788
6789 /// Expressions appearing as the LHS of a volatile assignment in this
6790 /// context. We produce a warning for these when popping the context if
6791 /// they are not discarded-value expressions nor unevaluated operands.
6793
6794 /// Set of candidates for starting an immediate invocation.
6797
6798 /// Set of DeclRefExprs referencing a consteval function when used in a
6799 /// context not already known to be immediately invoked.
6801
6802 /// P2718R0 - Lifetime extension in range-based for loops.
6803 /// MaterializeTemporaryExprs in for-range-init expressions which need to
6804 /// extend lifetime. Add MaterializeTemporaryExpr* if the value of
6805 /// InLifetimeExtendingContext is true.
6807
6808 /// Small set of gathered accesses to potentially misaligned members
6809 /// due to the packed attribute.
6811
6812 /// \brief Describes whether we are in an expression constext which we have
6813 /// to handle differently.
6821
6822 // A context can be nested in both a discarded statement context and
6823 // an immediate function context, so they need to be tracked independently.
6827
6829
6830 // We are in a constant context, but we also allow
6831 // non constant expressions, for example for array bounds (which may be
6832 // VLAs).
6834
6835 /// Whether we are currently in a context in which all temporaries must be
6836 /// lifetime-extended, even if they're not bound to a reference (for
6837 /// example, in a for-range initializer).
6839
6840 /// Whether evaluating an expression for a switch case label.
6841 bool IsCaseExpr = false;
6842
6843 /// Whether we should rebuild CXXDefaultArgExpr and CXXDefaultInitExpr.
6845
6846 // When evaluating immediate functions in the initializer of a default
6847 // argument or default member initializer, this is the declaration whose
6848 // default initializer is being evaluated and the location of the call
6849 // or constructor definition.
6853 : Loc(Loc), Decl(Decl), Context(Context) {
6854 assert(Decl && Context && "invalid initialization context");
6855 }
6856
6858 ValueDecl *Decl = nullptr;
6860 };
6861 std::optional<InitializationContext> DelayedDefaultInitializationContext;
6862
6873
6879
6886
6891
6896 // C++23 [expr.const]p14:
6897 // An expression or conversion is in an immediate function
6898 // context if it is potentially evaluated and either:
6899 // * its innermost enclosing non-block scope is a function
6900 // parameter scope of an immediate function, or
6901 // * its enclosing statement is enclosed by the compound-
6902 // statement of a consteval if statement.
6905 }
6906
6914 };
6915
6917 assert(!ExprEvalContexts.empty() &&
6918 "Must be in an expression evaluation context");
6919 return ExprEvalContexts.back();
6920 }
6921
6923 assert(!ExprEvalContexts.empty() &&
6924 "Must be in an expression evaluation context");
6925 return ExprEvalContexts.back();
6926 }
6927
6929 assert(ExprEvalContexts.size() >= 2 &&
6930 "Must be in an expression evaluation context");
6931 return ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size() - 2];
6932 }
6933
6935 return const_cast<Sema *>(this)->parentEvaluationContext();
6936 }
6937
6942
6943 /// Increment when we find a reference; decrement when we find an ignored
6944 /// assignment. Ultimately the value is 0 if every reference is an ignored
6945 /// assignment.
6946 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, int> RefsMinusAssignments;
6947
6948 /// Used to control the generation of ExprWithCleanups.
6950
6951 /// ExprCleanupObjects - This is the stack of objects requiring
6952 /// cleanup that are created by the current full expression.
6954
6955 /// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without
6956 /// emitting diagnostics.
6957 bool CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D, bool TreatUnavailableAsInvalid);
6958 // A version of DiagnoseUseOfDecl that should be used if overload resolution
6959 // has been used to find this declaration, which means we don't have to bother
6960 // checking the trailing requires clause.
6962 return DiagnoseUseOfDecl(
6963 D, Loc, /*UnknownObjCClass=*/nullptr, /*ObjCPropertyAccess=*/false,
6964 /*AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks=*/false, /*ClassReceiver=*/nullptr,
6965 /*SkipTrailingRequiresClause=*/true);
6966 }
6967
6968 /// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
6969 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
6970 ///
6971 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
6972 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
6973 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
6974 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
6975 /// function is being used.
6976 ///
6977 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
6978 /// referenced), false otherwise.
6980 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass = nullptr,
6981 bool ObjCPropertyAccess = false,
6982 bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks = false,
6983 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReciever = nullptr,
6984 bool SkipTrailingRequiresClause = false);
6985
6986 /// Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted.
6988
6989 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or
6990 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and
6991 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are
6992 /// satisfied.
6994 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args);
6995
6997 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, Decl *LambdaContextDecl = nullptr,
7000
7002 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, FunctionDecl *FD);
7003
7006 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t,
7010
7012
7016
7017 /// Check whether E, which is either a discarded-value expression or an
7018 /// unevaluated operand, is a simple-assignment to a volatlie-qualified
7019 /// lvalue, and if so, remove it from the list of volatile-qualified
7020 /// assignments that we are going to warn are deprecated.
7022
7024
7025 // Functions for marking a declaration referenced. These functions also
7026 // contain the relevant logic for marking if a reference to a function or
7027 // variable is an odr-use (in the C++11 sense). There are separate variants
7028 // for expressions referring to a decl; these exist because odr-use marking
7029 // needs to be delayed for some constant variables when we build one of the
7030 // named expressions.
7031 //
7032 // MightBeOdrUse indicates whether the use could possibly be an odr-use, and
7033 // should usually be true. This only needs to be set to false if the lack of
7034 // odr-use cannot be determined from the current context (for instance,
7035 // because the name denotes a virtual function and was written without an
7036 // explicit nested-name-specifier).
7037 void MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, bool MightBeOdrUse);
7038
7039 /// Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
7040 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3)
7042 bool MightBeOdrUse = true);
7043
7044 /// Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
7045 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3). Note that this should not be
7046 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl.
7048
7049 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr.
7050 ///
7051 /// Note, this may change the dependence of the DeclRefExpr, and so needs to
7052 /// be handled with care if the DeclRefExpr is not newly-created.
7053 void MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E, const Expr *Base = nullptr);
7054
7055 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr.
7057
7058 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a FunctionParmPackExpr.
7061 unsigned CapturingScopeIndex);
7062
7064 void CleanupVarDeclMarking();
7065
7066 /// Try to capture the given variable.
7067 ///
7068 /// \param Var The variable to capture.
7069 ///
7070 /// \param Loc The location at which the capture occurs.
7071 ///
7072 /// \param Kind The kind of capture, which may be implicit (for either a
7073 /// block or a lambda), or explicit by-value or by-reference (for a lambda).
7074 ///
7075 /// \param EllipsisLoc The location of the ellipsis, if one is provided in
7076 /// an explicit lambda capture.
7077 ///
7078 /// \param BuildAndDiagnose Whether we are actually supposed to add the
7079 /// captures or diagnose errors. If false, this routine merely check whether
7080 /// the capture can occur without performing the capture itself or complaining
7081 /// if the variable cannot be captured.
7082 ///
7083 /// \param CaptureType Will be set to the type of the field used to capture
7084 /// this variable in the innermost block or lambda. Only valid when the
7085 /// variable can be captured.
7086 ///
7087 /// \param DeclRefType Will be set to the type of a reference to the capture
7088 /// from within the current scope. Only valid when the variable can be
7089 /// captured.
7090 ///
7091 /// \param FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt If non-null, it points to the index
7092 /// of the FunctionScopeInfo stack beyond which we do not attempt to capture.
7093 /// This is useful when enclosing lambdas must speculatively capture
7094 /// variables that may or may not be used in certain specializations of
7095 /// a nested generic lambda.
7096 ///
7097 /// \returns true if an error occurred (i.e., the variable cannot be
7098 /// captured) and false if the capture succeeded.
7100 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
7101 bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType,
7102 QualType &DeclRefType,
7103 const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt);
7104
7105 /// Try to capture the given variable.
7108 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc = SourceLocation());
7109
7110 /// Checks if the variable must be captured.
7112
7113 /// Given a variable, determine the type that a reference to that
7114 /// variable will have in the given scope.
7116
7117 /// Mark all of the declarations referenced within a particular AST node as
7118 /// referenced. Used when template instantiation instantiates a non-dependent
7119 /// type -- entities referenced by the type are now referenced.
7121
7122 /// Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
7123 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7124 ///
7125 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as
7126 /// 'referenced'.
7127 /// \param StopAt Subexpressions that we shouldn't recurse into.
7129 bool SkipLocalVariables = false,
7130 ArrayRef<const Expr *> StopAt = {});
7131
7132 /// Try to convert an expression \p E to type \p Ty. Returns the result of the
7133 /// conversion.
7134 ExprResult tryConvertExprToType(Expr *E, QualType Ty);
7135
7136 /// Conditionally issue a diagnostic based on the statements's reachability
7137 /// analysis.
7138 ///
7139 /// \param Stmts If Stmts is non-empty, delay reporting the diagnostic until
7140 /// the function body is parsed, and then do a basic reachability analysis to
7141 /// determine if the statement is reachable. If it is unreachable, the
7142 /// diagnostic will not be emitted.
7143 bool DiagIfReachable(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef<const Stmt *> Stmts,
7144 const PartialDiagnostic &PD);
7145
7146 /// Conditionally issue a diagnostic based on the current
7147 /// evaluation context.
7148 ///
7149 /// \param Statement If Statement is non-null, delay reporting the
7150 /// diagnostic until the function body is parsed, and then do a basic
7151 /// reachability analysis to determine if the statement is reachable.
7152 /// If it is unreachable, the diagnostic will not be emitted.
7153 bool DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement,
7154 const PartialDiagnostic &PD);
7155 /// Similar, but diagnostic is only produced if all the specified statements
7156 /// are reachable.
7157 bool DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef<const Stmt *> Stmts,
7158 const PartialDiagnostic &PD);
7159
7160 // Primary Expressions.
7161 SourceRange getExprRange(Expr *E) const;
7162
7163 ExprResult ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
7164 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id,
7165 bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand,
7166 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = nullptr,
7167 bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier = false,
7168 Token *KeywordReplacement = nullptr);
7169
7170 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
7171 /// possibly a list of template arguments.
7172 ///
7173 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
7174 /// DecomposeTemplateName.
7175 ///
7176 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
7177 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
7178 /// some way.
7179 void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id,
7180 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
7181 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
7182 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs);
7183
7184 /// Diagnose a lookup that found results in an enclosing class during error
7185 /// recovery. This usually indicates that the results were found in a
7186 /// dependent base class that could not be searched as part of a template
7187 /// definition. Always issues a diagnostic (though this may be only a warning
7188 /// in MS compatibility mode).
7189 ///
7190 /// Return \c true if the error is unrecoverable, or \c false if the caller
7191 /// should attempt to recover using these lookup results.
7192 bool DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(const LookupResult &R);
7193
7194 /// Diagnose an empty lookup.
7195 ///
7196 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
7197 bool
7198 DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
7199 CorrectionCandidateCallback &CCC,
7200 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr,
7201 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args = {},
7202 DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr);
7203
7204 /// If \p D cannot be odr-used in the current expression evaluation context,
7205 /// return a reason explaining why. Otherwise, return NOUR_None.
7207
7208 DeclRefExpr *BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
7209 SourceLocation Loc,
7210 const CXXScopeSpec *SS = nullptr);
7211 DeclRefExpr *
7212 BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
7213 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
7214 const CXXScopeSpec *SS = nullptr,
7215 NamedDecl *FoundD = nullptr,
7216 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = SourceLocation(),
7217 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = nullptr);
7218
7219 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a
7220 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture.
7221 DeclRefExpr *
7222 BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
7223 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
7224 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS, NamedDecl *FoundD = nullptr,
7225 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = SourceLocation(),
7226 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = nullptr);
7227
7228 bool UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const LookupResult &R,
7229 bool HasTrailingLParen);
7230
7231 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
7232 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
7233 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
7234 /// this path.
7236 CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
7237 bool IsAddressOfOperand, TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI = nullptr);
7238
7239 ExprResult BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
7240 bool NeedsADL,
7241 bool AcceptInvalidDecl = false);
7242
7243 /// Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
7245 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D,
7246 NamedDecl *FoundD = nullptr,
7247 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = nullptr,
7248 bool AcceptInvalidDecl = false);
7249
7250 // ExpandFunctionLocalPredefinedMacros - Returns a new vector of Tokens,
7251 // where Tokens representing function local predefined macros (such as
7252 // __FUNCTION__) are replaced (expanded) with string-literal Tokens.
7253 std::vector<Token> ExpandFunctionLocalPredefinedMacros(ArrayRef<Token> Toks);
7254
7255 ExprResult BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, PredefinedIdentKind IK);
7256 ExprResult ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind);
7257 ExprResult ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, int64_t Val);
7258
7259 bool CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, bool AllowZero);
7260
7261 ExprResult ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope = nullptr);
7263 Scope *UDLScope = nullptr);
7264 ExprResult ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E);
7265 ExprResult ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R,
7266 MultiExprArg Val);
7267 ExprResult ActOnCXXParenListInitExpr(ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, QualType T,
7268 unsigned NumUserSpecifiedExprs,
7269 SourceLocation InitLoc,
7270 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7271 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
7272
7273 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
7274 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle
7275 /// string concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come
7276 /// from multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points
7277 /// to one string.
7278 ExprResult ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks,
7279 Scope *UDLScope = nullptr);
7280
7281 ExprResult ActOnUnevaluatedStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks);
7282
7283 /// ControllingExprOrType is either an opaque pointer coming out of a
7284 /// ParsedType or an Expr *. FIXME: it'd be better to split this interface
7285 /// into two so we don't take a void *, but that's awkward because one of
7286 /// the operands is either a ParsedType or an Expr *, which doesn't lend
7287 /// itself to generic code very well.
7288 ExprResult ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
7289 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
7290 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7291 bool PredicateIsExpr,
7292 void *ControllingExprOrType,
7293 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes,
7294 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs);
7295 /// ControllingExprOrType is either a TypeSourceInfo * or an Expr *. FIXME:
7296 /// it'd be better to split this interface into two so we don't take a
7297 /// void *, but see the FIXME on ActOnGenericSelectionExpr as to why that
7298 /// isn't a trivial change.
7299 ExprResult CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
7300 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
7301 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7302 bool PredicateIsExpr,
7303 void *ControllingExprOrType,
7304 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types,
7305 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs);
7306
7307 // Binary/Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
7308 ExprResult CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7309 Expr *InputExpr, bool IsAfterAmp = false);
7310 ExprResult BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7311 Expr *Input, bool IsAfterAmp = false);
7312
7313 /// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
7314 ExprResult ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Op,
7315 Expr *Input, bool IsAfterAmp = false);
7316
7317 /// Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member
7318 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member
7319 /// with the address-of operator.
7320 bool isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E);
7321 bool CheckUseOfCXXMethodAsAddressOfOperand(SourceLocation OpLoc,
7322 const Expr *Op,
7323 const CXXMethodDecl *MD);
7324
7325 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
7326 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
7327 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
7328 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
7329 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
7330 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
7331 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
7332 QualType CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &Operand, SourceLocation OpLoc);
7333
7334 /// ActOnAlignasTypeArgument - Handle @c alignas(type-id) and @c
7335 /// _Alignas(type-name) .
7336 /// [dcl.align] An alignment-specifier of the form
7337 /// alignas(type-id) has the same effect as alignas(alignof(type-id)).
7338 ///
7339 /// [N1570 6.7.5] _Alignas(type-name) is equivalent to
7340 /// _Alignas(_Alignof(type-name)).
7341 bool ActOnAlignasTypeArgument(StringRef KWName, ParsedType Ty,
7342 SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceRange R);
7343 bool CheckAlignasTypeArgument(StringRef KWName, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7344 SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceRange R);
7345
7346 /// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
7347 ExprResult CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7348 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7349 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
7350 SourceRange R);
7351
7352 /// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
7353 /// operand.
7354 ExprResult CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7355 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind);
7356
7357 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c
7358 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
7359 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
7360 ExprResult ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,
7361 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
7362 bool IsType, void *TyOrEx,
7363 SourceRange ArgRange);
7364
7365 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
7366 /// Returns ExprError() if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
7368 bool CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E);
7369
7370 /// Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression
7371 /// and type traits.
7372 ///
7373 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand
7374 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may
7375 /// modify the expression as it completes the type for that expression through
7376 /// template instantiation, etc.
7378
7379 /// Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type
7380 /// traits.
7381 ///
7382 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various
7383 /// constraints on those operands.
7384 ///
7385 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
7386 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state:
7387 /// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ...
7388 ///
7389 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4
7390 /// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer
7391 /// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof.
7392 ///
7393 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions.
7394 bool CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7395 SourceRange ExprRange,
7396 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
7397 StringRef KWName);
7398
7399 ExprResult ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7400 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input);
7401
7402 ExprResult ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
7403 MultiExprArg ArgExprs,
7404 SourceLocation RLoc);
7405 ExprResult CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
7406 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc);
7407
7408 ExprResult CreateBuiltinMatrixSingleSubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, Expr *RowIdx,
7409 SourceLocation RBLoc);
7410
7411 ExprResult CreateBuiltinMatrixSubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, Expr *RowIdx,
7412 Expr *ColumnIdx,
7413 SourceLocation RBLoc);
7414
7415 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
7416 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
7417 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
7418 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
7419 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
7420 /// true if the call is ill-formed.
7421 bool ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn, FunctionDecl *FDecl,
7422 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
7423 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7424 bool ExecConfig = false);
7425
7426 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static
7427 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by
7428 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large.
7429 ///
7430 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of
7431 /// the array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value
7432 /// of the corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first
7433 /// element of an array with at least as many elements as specified by the
7434 /// size expression.
7435 void CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, ParmVarDecl *Param,
7436 const Expr *ArgExpr);
7437
7438 /// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
7439 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
7440 /// locations.
7441 ExprResult ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7442 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7443 Expr *ExecConfig = nullptr);
7444
7445 /// BuildCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
7446 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
7447 /// locations.
7448 ExprResult BuildCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7449 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7450 Expr *ExecConfig = nullptr,
7451 bool IsExecConfig = false,
7452 bool AllowRecovery = false);
7453
7454 /// BuildBuiltinCallExpr - Create a call to a builtin function specified by Id
7455 // with the specified CallArgs
7456 Expr *BuildBuiltinCallExpr(SourceLocation Loc, Builtin::ID Id,
7457 MultiExprArg CallArgs);
7458
7460
7461 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
7462 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
7463 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
7464 /// block-pointer type.
7465 ///
7466 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
7468 BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7469 ArrayRef<Expr *> Arg, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7470 Expr *Config = nullptr, bool IsExecConfig = false,
7471 ADLCallKind UsesADL = ADLCallKind::NotADL);
7472
7474 ParsedType &Ty, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7475 Expr *CastExpr);
7476
7477 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
7478 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
7480
7481 /// Build an altivec or OpenCL literal.
7483 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E,
7484 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo);
7485
7486 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn
7487 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators.
7489
7491 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr);
7492
7494 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7495 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7496 Expr *LiteralExpr);
7497
7498 ExprResult ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
7499 SourceLocation RBraceLoc);
7500
7501 ExprResult BuildInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
7502 SourceLocation RBraceLoc);
7503
7504 /// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
7506 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr);
7508 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7509 bool ForFoldExpression = false);
7510
7511 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
7512 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
7513 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
7515 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7516 bool ForFoldExpression = false);
7518 UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions);
7519
7520 /// Look for instances where it is likely the comma operator is confused with
7521 /// another operator. There is an explicit list of acceptable expressions for
7522 /// the left hand side of the comma operator, otherwise emit a warning.
7523 void DiagnoseCommaOperator(const Expr *LHS, SourceLocation Loc);
7524
7525 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
7526 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
7528 SourceLocation ColonLoc, Expr *CondExpr,
7529 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr);
7530
7531 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
7533 LabelDecl *TheDecl);
7534
7535 void ActOnStartStmtExpr();
7536 ExprResult ActOnStmtExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
7537 SourceLocation RPLoc);
7539 SourceLocation RPLoc, unsigned TemplateDepth);
7540 // Handle the final expression in a statement expression.
7542 void ActOnStmtExprError();
7543
7544 // __builtin_offsetof(type, identifier(.identifier|[expr])*)
7547 bool isBrackets; // true if [expr], false if .ident
7548 union {
7551 } U;
7552 };
7553
7554 /// __builtin_offsetof(type, a.b[123][456].c)
7556 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7557 ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components,
7558 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
7561 ParsedType ParsedArgTy,
7562 ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components,
7563 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
7564
7565 // __builtin_choose_expr(constExpr, expr1, expr2)
7566 ExprResult ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *CondExpr,
7567 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7568 SourceLocation RPLoc);
7569
7570 // __builtin_va_arg(expr, type)
7572 SourceLocation RPLoc);
7574 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation RPLoc);
7575
7576 // __builtin_LINE(), __builtin_FUNCTION(), __builtin_FUNCSIG(),
7577 // __builtin_FILE(), __builtin_COLUMN(), __builtin_source_location()
7579 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7580 SourceLocation RPLoc);
7581
7582 // #embed
7584 StringLiteral *BinaryData, StringRef FileName);
7585
7586 // Build a potentially resolved SourceLocExpr.
7588 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation RPLoc,
7589 DeclContext *ParentContext);
7590
7591 // __null
7593
7594 bool CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E);
7595
7596 //===------------------------- "Block" Extension ------------------------===//
7597
7598 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is
7599 /// started.
7600 void ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope);
7601
7602 /// ActOnBlockArguments - This callback allows processing of block arguments.
7603 /// If there are no arguments, this is still invoked.
7604 void ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo,
7605 Scope *CurScope);
7606
7607 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7608 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7609 void ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope);
7610
7611 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7612 /// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
7614 Scope *CurScope);
7615
7616 //===---------------------------- Clang Extensions ----------------------===//
7617
7618 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the
7619 /// provided arguments.
7620 ///
7621 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type )
7622 ///
7624 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7625 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
7626
7627 //===---------------------------- OpenCL Features -----------------------===//
7628
7629 /// Parse a __builtin_astype expression.
7630 ///
7631 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type )
7632 ///
7633 ExprResult ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
7634 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7635 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
7636
7637 /// Create a new AsTypeExpr node (bitcast) from the arguments.
7639 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7640 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
7641
7642 /// Attempts to produce a RecoveryExpr after some AST node cannot be created.
7644 ArrayRef<Expr *> SubExprs,
7645 QualType T = QualType());
7646
7647 /// Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
7648 ///
7649 /// There are two relevant checks:
7650 ///
7651 /// C++ [class.access.base]p7:
7652 ///
7653 /// If a class member access operator [...] is used to access a non-static
7654 /// data member or non-static member function, the reference is ill-formed
7655 /// if the left operand [...] cannot be implicitly converted to a pointer to
7656 /// the naming class of the right operand.
7657 ///
7658 /// C++ [expr.ref]p7:
7659 ///
7660 /// If E2 is a non-static data member or a non-static member function, the
7661 /// program is ill-formed if the class of which E2 is directly a member is
7662 /// an ambiguous base (11.8) of the naming class (11.9.3) of E2.
7663 ///
7664 /// Note that the latter check does not consider access; the access of the
7665 /// "real" base class is checked as appropriate when checking the access of
7666 /// the member name.
7668 NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier,
7669 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
7670 NamedDecl *Member);
7671
7672 /// CheckCallReturnType - Checks that a call expression's return type is
7673 /// complete. Returns true on failure. The location passed in is the location
7674 /// that best represents the call.
7675 bool CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7676 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD);
7677
7678 /// Emit a warning for all pending noderef expressions that we recorded.
7679 void WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Rec);
7680
7682
7683 /// Instantiate or parse a C++ default argument expression as necessary.
7684 /// Return true on error.
7686 ParmVarDecl *Param, Expr *Init = nullptr,
7687 bool SkipImmediateInvocations = true);
7688
7689 /// BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr - Creates a CXXDefaultArgExpr, instantiating
7690 /// the default expr if needed.
7692 ParmVarDecl *Param, Expr *Init = nullptr);
7693
7694 /// Wrap the expression in a ConstantExpr if it is a potential immediate
7695 /// invocation.
7697
7699
7700 // Check that the SME attributes for PSTATE.ZA and PSTATE.SM are compatible.
7701 bool IsInvalidSMECallConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType);
7702
7703 /// Abstract base class used for diagnosing integer constant
7704 /// expression violations.
7706 public:
7708
7710
7711 virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder
7712 diagnoseNotICEType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T);
7714 SourceLocation Loc) = 0;
7717 };
7718
7719 /// VerifyIntegerConstantExpression - Verifies that an expression is an ICE,
7720 /// and reports the appropriate diagnostics. Returns false on success.
7721 /// Can optionally return the value of the expression.
7724 VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
7728 unsigned DiagID,
7731 VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result = nullptr,
7735 AllowFoldKind CanFold = AllowFoldKind::No) {
7736 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, nullptr, CanFold);
7737 }
7738
7739 /// DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition - Given that an expression is
7740 /// being used as a boolean condition, warn if it's an assignment.
7742
7743 /// Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate
7744 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition.
7746
7748 public:
7750 FullExprArg(Sema &actions) : E(nullptr) {}
7751
7752 ExprResult release() { return E; }
7753
7754 Expr *get() const { return E; }
7755
7756 Expr *operator->() { return E; }
7757
7758 private:
7759 // FIXME: No need to make the entire Sema class a friend when it's just
7760 // Sema::MakeFullExpr that needs access to the constructor below.
7761 friend class Sema;
7762
7763 explicit FullExprArg(Expr *expr) : E(expr) {}
7764
7765 Expr *E;
7766 };
7767
7769 return MakeFullExpr(Arg, Arg ? Arg->getExprLoc() : SourceLocation());
7770 }
7772 return FullExprArg(
7773 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Arg, CC, /*DiscardedValue*/ false).get());
7774 }
7776 ExprResult FE =
7777 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Arg, Arg ? Arg->getExprLoc() : SourceLocation(),
7778 /*DiscardedValue*/ true);
7779 return FullExprArg(FE.get());
7780 }
7781
7782 class ConditionResult {
7783 Decl *ConditionVar;
7784 ExprResult Condition;
7785 bool Invalid;
7786 std::optional<bool> KnownValue;
7787
7788 friend class Sema;
7789 ConditionResult(Sema &S, Decl *ConditionVar, ExprResult Condition,
7790 bool IsConstexpr)
7791 : ConditionVar(ConditionVar), Condition(Condition), Invalid(false) {
7792 if (IsConstexpr && Condition.get()) {
7793 if (std::optional<llvm::APSInt> Val =
7794 Condition.get()->getIntegerConstantExpr(S.Context)) {
7795 KnownValue = !!(*Val);
7796 }
7797 }
7798 }
7799 explicit ConditionResult(bool Invalid)
7800 : ConditionVar(nullptr), Condition(Invalid), Invalid(Invalid),
7801 KnownValue(std::nullopt) {}
7802
7803 public:
7804 ConditionResult() : ConditionResult(false) {}
7805 bool isInvalid() const { return Invalid; }
7806 std::pair<VarDecl *, Expr *> get() const {
7807 return std::make_pair(cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ConditionVar),
7808 Condition.get());
7809 }
7810 std::optional<bool> getKnownValue() const { return KnownValue; }
7811 };
7813
7814 /// CheckBooleanCondition - Diagnose problems involving the use of
7815 /// the given expression as a boolean condition (e.g. in an if
7816 /// statement). Also performs the standard function and array
7817 /// decays, possibly changing the input variable.
7818 ///
7819 /// \param Loc - A location associated with the condition, e.g. the
7820 /// 'if' keyword.
7821 /// \return true iff there were any errors
7823 bool IsConstexpr = false);
7824
7825 enum class ConditionKind {
7826 Boolean, ///< A boolean condition, from 'if', 'while', 'for', or 'do'.
7827 ConstexprIf, ///< A constant boolean condition from 'if constexpr'.
7828 Switch ///< An integral condition for a 'switch' statement.
7829 };
7830
7831 ConditionResult ActOnCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *SubExpr,
7832 ConditionKind CK, bool MissingOK = false);
7833
7834 QualType CheckConditionalOperands( // C99 6.5.15
7836 ExprObjectKind &OK, SourceLocation QuestionLoc);
7837
7838 /// Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer
7839 /// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is
7840 /// emitted.
7841 bool DiagnoseConditionalForNull(const Expr *LHSExpr, const Expr *RHSExpr,
7842 SourceLocation QuestionLoc);
7843
7844 /// type checking for vector binary operators.
7846 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign,
7847 bool AllowBothBool, bool AllowBoolConversion,
7848 bool AllowBoolOperation, bool ReportInvalid);
7849
7850 /// Return a signed ext_vector_type that is of identical size and number of
7851 /// elements. For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical
7852 /// size and number of elements. In the non ext_vector_type case, search from
7853 /// the largest type to the smallest type to avoid cases where long long ==
7854 /// long, where long gets picked over long long.
7857
7858 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
7859 /// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
7860 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
7861 /// types.
7863 SourceLocation Loc,
7864 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
7866 SourceLocation Loc,
7867 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
7869 SourceLocation Loc,
7870 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
7872 SourceLocation Loc,
7873 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
7874 // type checking for sizeless vector binary operators.
7876 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign,
7877 ArithConvKind OperationKind);
7878
7879 /// Type checking for matrix binary operators.
7881 SourceLocation Loc,
7882 bool IsCompAssign);
7884 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign);
7885
7886 /// Are the two types SVE-bitcast-compatible types? I.e. is bitcasting from
7887 /// the first SVE type (e.g. an SVE VLAT) to the second type (e.g. an SVE
7888 /// VLST) allowed?
7889 ///
7890 /// This will also return false if the two given types do not make sense from
7891 /// the perspective of SVE bitcasts.
7892 bool isValidSveBitcast(QualType srcType, QualType destType);
7893
7894 /// Are the two types matrix types and do they have the same dimensions i.e.
7895 /// do they have the same number of rows and the same number of columns?
7897
7898 bool areVectorTypesSameSize(QualType srcType, QualType destType);
7899
7900 /// Are the two types lax-compatible vector types? That is, given
7901 /// that one of them is a vector, do they have equal storage sizes,
7902 /// where the storage size is the number of elements times the element
7903 /// size?
7904 ///
7905 /// This will also return false if either of the types is neither a
7906 /// vector nor a real type.
7907 bool areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType srcType, QualType destType);
7908
7909 /// Is this a legal conversion between two types, one of which is
7910 /// known to be a vector type?
7911 bool isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcType, QualType destType);
7912
7913 // This returns true if at least one of the types is an altivec vector.
7914 bool anyAltivecTypes(QualType srcType, QualType destType);
7915
7916 // type checking C++ declaration initializers (C++ [dcl.init]).
7917
7918 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only
7919 /// trigger this for C-style casts.
7922 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path);
7923
7924 /// Force an expression with unknown-type to an expression of the
7925 /// given type.
7927
7928 /// Type-check an expression that's being passed to an
7929 /// __unknown_anytype parameter.
7931 QualType &paramType);
7932
7933 // CheckMatrixCast - Check type constraints for matrix casts.
7934 // We allow casting between matrixes of the same dimensions i.e. when they
7935 // have the same number of rows and column. Returns true if the cast is
7936 // invalid.
7937 bool CheckMatrixCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, QualType SrcTy,
7938 CastKind &Kind);
7939
7940 // CheckVectorCast - check type constraints for vectors.
7941 // Since vectors are an extension, there are no C standard reference for this.
7942 // We allow casting between vectors and integer datatypes of the same size.
7943 // returns true if the cast is invalid
7944 bool CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
7945 CastKind &Kind);
7946
7947 /// Prepare `SplattedExpr` for a vector splat operation, adding
7948 /// implicit casts if necessary.
7949 ExprResult prepareVectorSplat(QualType VectorTy, Expr *SplattedExpr);
7950
7951 /// Prepare `SplattedExpr` for a matrix splat operation, adding
7952 /// implicit casts if necessary.
7953 ExprResult prepareMatrixSplat(QualType MatrixTy, Expr *SplattedExpr);
7954
7955 // CheckExtVectorCast - check type constraints for extended vectors.
7956 // Since vectors are an extension, there are no C standard reference for this.
7957 // We allow casting between vectors and integer datatypes of the same size,
7958 // or vectors and the element type of that vector.
7959 // returns the cast expr
7961 CastKind &Kind);
7962
7964 return K == ConditionKind::Switch ? Context.IntTy : Context.BoolTy;
7965 }
7966
7967 // UsualUnaryConversions - promotes integers (C99 6.3.1.1p2), converts
7968 // functions and arrays to their respective pointers (C99 6.3.2.1), and
7969 // promotes floating-piont types according to the language semantics.
7971
7972 // UsualUnaryFPConversions - promotes floating-point types according to the
7973 // current language semantics.
7975
7976 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion
7977 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression.
7979
7980 // DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - converts functions and arrays
7981 // to their respective pointers (C99 6.3.2.1).
7983
7984 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - converts functions and
7985 // arrays to their respective pointers and performs the
7986 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion.
7988 bool Diagnose = true);
7989
7990 // DefaultLvalueConversion - performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion on
7991 // the operand. This function is a no-op if the operand has a function type
7992 // or an array type.
7994
7995 // DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
7996 // do not have a prototype. Integer promotions are performed on each
7997 // argument, and arguments that have type float are promoted to double.
7999
8001 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
8002 Expr *Fn);
8003
8004 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression.
8005 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed
8006 /// when we're in an unevaluated context.
8008
8009 /// Check to see if the given expression is a valid argument to a variadic
8010 /// function, issuing a diagnostic if not.
8011 void checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT);
8012
8013 /// GatherArgumentsForCall - Collector argument expressions for various
8014 /// form of call prototypes.
8016 SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl,
8017 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, unsigned FirstParam,
8020 bool AllowExplicit = false, bool IsListInitialization = false);
8021
8022 // DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
8023 // will create a runtime trap if the resulting type is not a POD type.
8025 FunctionDecl *FDecl);
8026
8027 // Check that the usual arithmetic conversions can be performed on this pair
8028 // of expressions that might be of enumeration type.
8030 ArithConvKind ACK);
8031
8032 // UsualArithmeticConversions - performs the UsualUnaryConversions on it's
8033 // operands and then handles various conversions that are common to binary
8034 // operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
8035 // routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
8036 // responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
8038 SourceLocation Loc, ArithConvKind ACK);
8039
8041 switch (ConvTy) {
8042 default:
8043 return false;
8047 return true;
8048 }
8049 llvm_unreachable("impossible");
8050 }
8051
8052 /// DiagnoseAssignmentResult - Emit a diagnostic, if required, for the
8053 /// assignment conversion type specified by ConvTy. This returns true if the
8054 /// conversion was invalid or false if the conversion was accepted.
8056 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
8057 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
8058 bool *Complained = nullptr);
8059
8060 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints - Perform type checking for assignment,
8061 /// argument passing, variable initialization, and function return values.
8062 /// C99 6.5.16.
8064 QualType LHSType,
8065 QualType RHSType);
8066
8067 /// Check assignment constraints and optionally prepare for a conversion of
8068 /// the RHS to the LHS type. The conversion is prepared for if ConvertRHS
8069 /// is true.
8071 ExprResult &RHS, CastKind &Kind,
8072 bool ConvertRHS = true);
8073
8074 /// Check assignment constraints for an assignment of RHS to LHSType.
8075 ///
8076 /// \param LHSType The destination type for the assignment.
8077 /// \param RHS The source expression for the assignment.
8078 /// \param Diagnose If \c true, diagnostics may be produced when checking
8079 /// for assignability. If a diagnostic is produced, \p RHS will be
8080 /// set to ExprError(). Note that this function may still return
8081 /// without producing a diagnostic, even for an invalid assignment.
8082 /// \param DiagnoseCFAudited If \c true, the target is a function parameter
8083 /// in an audited Core Foundation API and does not need to be checked
8084 /// for ARC retain issues.
8085 /// \param ConvertRHS If \c true, \p RHS will be updated to model the
8086 /// conversions necessary to perform the assignment. If \c false,
8087 /// \p Diagnose must also be \c false.
8089 QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, bool Diagnose = true,
8090 bool DiagnoseCFAudited = false, bool ConvertRHS = true);
8091
8092 // If the lhs type is a transparent union, check whether we
8093 // can initialize the transparent union with the given expression.
8095 ExprResult &RHS);
8096
8097 /// the following "Check" methods will return a valid/converted QualType
8098 /// or a null QualType (indicating an error diagnostic was issued).
8099
8100 /// type checking binary operators (subroutines of CreateBuiltinBinOp).
8102 ExprResult &RHS);
8103
8104 /// Diagnose cases where a scalar was implicitly converted to a vector and
8105 /// diagnose the underlying types. Otherwise, diagnose the error
8106 /// as invalid vector logical operands for non-C++ cases.
8108 ExprResult &RHS);
8109
8111 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
8112 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
8113 QualType CheckRemainderOperands( // C99 6.5.5
8114 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
8115 bool IsCompAssign = false);
8116 QualType CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
8117 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
8118 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType *CompLHSTy = nullptr);
8120 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
8121 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType *CompLHSTy = nullptr);
8122 QualType CheckShiftOperands( // C99 6.5.7
8123 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
8124 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, bool IsCompAssign = false);
8126 QualType CheckCompareOperands( // C99 6.5.8/9
8127 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
8128 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
8129 QualType CheckBitwiseOperands( // C99 6.5.[10...12]
8130 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
8131 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
8132 QualType CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
8133 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc,
8134 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
8135 // CheckAssignmentOperands is used for both simple and compound assignment.
8136 // For simple assignment, pass both expressions and a null converted type.
8137 // For compound assignment, pass both expressions and the converted type.
8138 QualType CheckAssignmentOperands( // C99 6.5.16.[1,2]
8139 Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, QualType CompoundType,
8140 BinaryOperatorKind Opc);
8141
8142 /// To be used for checking whether the arguments being passed to
8143 /// function exceeds the number of parameters expected for it.
8144 static bool TooManyArguments(size_t NumParams, size_t NumArgs,
8145 bool PartialOverloading = false) {
8146 // We check whether we're just after a comma in code-completion.
8147 if (NumArgs > 0 && PartialOverloading)
8148 return NumArgs + 1 > NumParams; // If so, we view as an extra argument.
8149 return NumArgs > NumParams;
8150 }
8151
8152 /// Whether the AST is currently being rebuilt to correct immediate
8153 /// invocations. Immediate invocation candidates and references to consteval
8154 /// functions aren't tracked when this is set.
8156
8162
8163 /// Determines whether we are currently in a context that
8164 /// is not evaluated as per C++ [expr] p5.
8167 }
8168
8172
8176
8180
8187
8188 std::optional<ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::InitializationContext>
8190 assert(!ExprEvalContexts.empty() &&
8191 "Must be in an expression evaluation context");
8192 for (const auto &Ctx : llvm::reverse(ExprEvalContexts)) {
8194 Ctx.DelayedDefaultInitializationContext)
8195 return Ctx.DelayedDefaultInitializationContext;
8196 if (Ctx.isConstantEvaluated() || Ctx.isImmediateFunctionContext() ||
8197 Ctx.isUnevaluated())
8198 break;
8199 }
8200 return std::nullopt;
8201 }
8202
8203 std::optional<ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::InitializationContext>
8205 assert(!ExprEvalContexts.empty() &&
8206 "Must be in an expression evaluation context");
8207 std::optional<ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::InitializationContext> Res;
8208 for (auto &Ctx : llvm::reverse(ExprEvalContexts)) {
8210 !Ctx.DelayedDefaultInitializationContext && Res)
8211 break;
8212 if (Ctx.isConstantEvaluated() || Ctx.isImmediateFunctionContext() ||
8213 Ctx.isUnevaluated())
8214 break;
8215 Res = Ctx.DelayedDefaultInitializationContext;
8216 }
8217 return Res;
8218 }
8219
8223
8224 /// Returns a field in a CXXRecordDecl that has the same name as the decl \p
8225 /// SelfAssigned when inside a CXXMethodDecl.
8226 const FieldDecl *
8228
8230
8231 template <typename... Ts>
8233 const Ts &...Args) {
8234 SizelessTypeDiagnoser<Ts...> Diagnoser(DiagID, Args...);
8235 return RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, CompleteTypeKind::Normal, Diagnoser);
8236 }
8237
8238 template <typename... Ts>
8239 bool RequireCompleteSizedExprType(Expr *E, unsigned DiagID,
8240 const Ts &...Args) {
8241 SizelessTypeDiagnoser<Ts...> Diagnoser(DiagID, Args...);
8243 }
8244
8245 /// Abstract class used to diagnose incomplete types.
8248
8249 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) = 0;
8250 virtual ~TypeDiagnoser() {}
8251 };
8252
8253 template <typename... Ts> class BoundTypeDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser {
8254 protected:
8255 unsigned DiagID;
8256 std::tuple<const Ts &...> Args;
8257
8258 template <std::size_t... Is>
8260 std::index_sequence<Is...>) const {
8261 // Apply all tuple elements to the builder in order.
8262 bool Dummy[] = {false, (DB << getPrintable(std::get<Is>(Args)))...};
8263 (void)Dummy;
8264 }
8265
8266 public:
8267 BoundTypeDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
8268 : TypeDiagnoser(), DiagID(DiagID), Args(Args...) {
8269 assert(DiagID != 0 && "no diagnostic for type diagnoser");
8270 }
8271
8272 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
8273 const SemaDiagnosticBuilder &DB = S.Diag(Loc, DiagID);
8274 emit(DB, std::index_sequence_for<Ts...>());
8275 DB << T;
8276 }
8277 };
8278
8279 /// A derivative of BoundTypeDiagnoser for which the diagnostic's type
8280 /// parameter is preceded by a 0/1 enum that is 1 if the type is sizeless.
8281 /// For example, a diagnostic with no other parameters would generally have
8282 /// the form "...%select{incomplete|sizeless}0 type %1...".
8283 template <typename... Ts>
8285 public:
8286 SizelessTypeDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
8287 : BoundTypeDiagnoser<Ts...>(DiagID, Args...) {}
8288
8289 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
8290 const SemaDiagnosticBuilder &DB = S.Diag(Loc, this->DiagID);
8291 this->emit(DB, std::index_sequence_for<Ts...>());
8292 DB << T->isSizelessType() << T;
8293 }
8294 };
8295
8296 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to
8297 /// handle later.
8299
8300 /// The C++ "std::source_location::__impl" struct, defined in
8301 /// <source_location>.
8303
8304 /// A stack of expression evaluation contexts.
8306
8307 // Set of failed immediate invocations to avoid double diagnosing.
8309
8310 /// List of SourceLocations where 'self' is implicitly retained inside a
8311 /// block.
8314
8315 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC.
8317
8318 std::vector<std::pair<QualType, unsigned>> ExcessPrecisionNotSatisfied;
8321
8322private:
8323 static BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind);
8324
8325 /// Methods for marking which expressions involve dereferencing a pointer
8326 /// marked with the 'noderef' attribute. Expressions are checked bottom up as
8327 /// they are parsed, meaning that a noderef pointer may not be accessed. For
8328 /// example, in `&*p` where `p` is a noderef pointer, we will first parse the
8329 /// `*p`, but need to check that `address of` is called on it. This requires
8330 /// keeping a container of all pending expressions and checking if the address
8331 /// of them are eventually taken.
8332 void CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(const ArraySubscriptExpr *E);
8333 void CheckAddressOfNoDeref(const Expr *E);
8334
8335 ///@}
8336
8337 //
8338 //
8339 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
8340 //
8341 //
8342
8343 /// \name C++ Expressions
8344 /// Implementations are in SemaExprCXX.cpp
8345 ///@{
8346
8347public:
8348 /// The C++ "std::bad_alloc" class, which is defined by the C++
8349 /// standard library.
8351
8352 /// The C++ "std::align_val_t" enum class, which is defined by the C++
8353 /// standard library.
8355
8356 /// The C++ "type_info" declaration, which is defined in <typeinfo>.
8358
8359 /// A flag to remember whether the implicit forms of operator new and delete
8360 /// have been declared.
8362
8363 /// Delete-expressions to be analyzed at the end of translation unit
8364 ///
8365 /// This list contains class members, and locations of delete-expressions
8366 /// that could not be proven as to whether they mismatch with new-expression
8367 /// used in initializer of the field.
8368 llvm::MapVector<FieldDecl *, DeleteLocs> DeleteExprs;
8369
8370 /// Handle the result of the special case name lookup for inheriting
8371 /// constructor declarations. 'NS::X::X' and 'NS::X<...>::X' are treated as
8372 /// constructor names in member using declarations, even if 'X' is not the
8373 /// name of the corresponding type.
8375 SourceLocation NameLoc,
8376 const IdentifierInfo &Name);
8377
8379 SourceLocation NameLoc, Scope *S,
8380 CXXScopeSpec &SS, bool EnteringContext);
8382 Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
8383 ParsedType ObjectType, bool EnteringContext);
8384
8386 ParsedType ObjectType);
8387
8388 /// Build a C++ typeid expression with a type operand.
8389 ExprResult BuildCXXTypeId(QualType TypeInfoType, SourceLocation TypeidLoc,
8390 TypeSourceInfo *Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc);
8391
8392 /// Build a C++ typeid expression with an expression operand.
8393 ExprResult BuildCXXTypeId(QualType TypeInfoType, SourceLocation TypeidLoc,
8394 Expr *Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc);
8395
8396 /// ActOnCXXTypeid - Parse typeid( something ).
8398 bool isType, void *TyOrExpr,
8399 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
8400
8401 /// Build a Microsoft __uuidof expression with a type operand.
8402 ExprResult BuildCXXUuidof(QualType TypeInfoType, SourceLocation TypeidLoc,
8403 TypeSourceInfo *Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc);
8404
8405 /// Build a Microsoft __uuidof expression with an expression operand.
8406 ExprResult BuildCXXUuidof(QualType TypeInfoType, SourceLocation TypeidLoc,
8407 Expr *Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc);
8408
8409 /// ActOnCXXUuidof - Parse __uuidof( something ).
8411 bool isType, void *TyOrExpr,
8412 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
8413
8414 //// ActOnCXXThis - Parse 'this' pointer.
8416
8417 /// Check whether the type of 'this' is valid in the current context.
8419
8420 /// Build a CXXThisExpr and mark it referenced in the current context.
8421 Expr *BuildCXXThisExpr(SourceLocation Loc, QualType Type, bool IsImplicit);
8423
8424 /// Try to retrieve the type of the 'this' pointer.
8425 ///
8426 /// \returns The type of 'this', if possible. Otherwise, returns a NULL type.
8428
8429 /// When non-NULL, the C++ 'this' expression is allowed despite the
8430 /// current context not being a non-static member function. In such cases,
8431 /// this provides the type used for 'this'.
8433
8434 /// RAII object used to temporarily allow the C++ 'this' expression
8435 /// to be used, with the given qualifiers on the current class type.
8437 Sema &S;
8438 QualType OldCXXThisTypeOverride;
8439 bool Enabled;
8440
8441 public:
8442 /// Introduce a new scope where 'this' may be allowed (when enabled),
8443 /// using the given declaration (which is either a class template or a
8444 /// class) along with the given qualifiers.
8445 /// along with the qualifiers placed on '*this'.
8446 CXXThisScopeRAII(Sema &S, Decl *ContextDecl, Qualifiers CXXThisTypeQuals,
8447 bool Enabled = true);
8448
8450 };
8451
8452 /// Make sure the value of 'this' is actually available in the current
8453 /// context, if it is a potentially evaluated context.
8454 ///
8455 /// \param Loc The location at which the capture of 'this' occurs.
8456 ///
8457 /// \param Explicit Whether 'this' is explicitly captured in a lambda
8458 /// capture list.
8459 ///
8460 /// \param FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt If non-null, it points to the index
8461 /// of the FunctionScopeInfo stack beyond which we do not attempt to capture.
8462 /// This is useful when enclosing lambdas must speculatively capture
8463 /// 'this' that may or may not be used in certain specializations of
8464 /// a nested generic lambda (depending on whether the name resolves to
8465 /// a non-static member function or a static function).
8466 /// \return returns 'true' if failed, 'false' if success.
8468 SourceLocation Loc, bool Explicit = false, bool BuildAndDiagnose = true,
8469 const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt = nullptr,
8470 bool ByCopy = false);
8471
8472 /// Determine whether the given type is the type of *this that is used
8473 /// outside of the body of a member function for a type that is currently
8474 /// being defined.
8476
8477 /// ActOnCXXBoolLiteral - Parse {true,false} literals.
8479
8480 /// ActOnCXXNullPtrLiteral - Parse 'nullptr'.
8482
8483 //// ActOnCXXThrow - Parse throw expressions.
8486 bool IsThrownVarInScope);
8487
8488 /// CheckCXXThrowOperand - Validate the operand of a throw.
8489 bool CheckCXXThrowOperand(SourceLocation ThrowLoc, QualType ThrowTy, Expr *E);
8490
8491 /// ActOnCXXTypeConstructExpr - Parse construction of a specified type.
8492 /// Can be interpreted either as function-style casting ("int(x)")
8493 /// or class type construction ("ClassType(x,y,z)")
8494 /// or creation of a value-initialized type ("int()").
8496 SourceLocation LParenOrBraceLoc,
8497 MultiExprArg Exprs,
8498 SourceLocation RParenOrBraceLoc,
8499 bool ListInitialization);
8500
8502 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
8503 MultiExprArg Exprs,
8504 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
8505 bool ListInitialization);
8506
8507 /// Parsed a C++ 'new' expression (C++ 5.3.4).
8508 ///
8509 /// E.g.:
8510 /// @code new (memory) int[size][4] @endcode
8511 /// or
8512 /// @code ::new Foo(23, "hello") @endcode
8513 ///
8514 /// \param StartLoc The first location of the expression.
8515 /// \param UseGlobal True if 'new' was prefixed with '::'.
8516 /// \param PlacementLParen Opening paren of the placement arguments.
8517 /// \param PlacementArgs Placement new arguments.
8518 /// \param PlacementRParen Closing paren of the placement arguments.
8519 /// \param TypeIdParens If the type is in parens, the source range.
8520 /// \param D The type to be allocated, as well as array dimensions.
8521 /// \param Initializer The initializing expression or initializer-list, or
8522 /// null if there is none.
8523 ExprResult ActOnCXXNew(SourceLocation StartLoc, bool UseGlobal,
8524 SourceLocation PlacementLParen,
8525 MultiExprArg PlacementArgs,
8526 SourceLocation PlacementRParen,
8527 SourceRange TypeIdParens, Declarator &D,
8528 Expr *Initializer);
8530 BuildCXXNew(SourceRange Range, bool UseGlobal, SourceLocation PlacementLParen,
8531 MultiExprArg PlacementArgs, SourceLocation PlacementRParen,
8532 SourceRange TypeIdParens, QualType AllocType,
8533 TypeSourceInfo *AllocTypeInfo, std::optional<Expr *> ArraySize,
8534 SourceRange DirectInitRange, Expr *Initializer);
8535
8536 /// Determine whether \p FD is an aligned allocation or deallocation
8537 /// function that is unavailable.
8539
8540 /// Produce diagnostics if \p FD is an aligned allocation or deallocation
8541 /// function that is unavailable.
8543 SourceLocation Loc);
8544
8545 /// Checks that a type is suitable as the allocated type
8546 /// in a new-expression.
8547 bool CheckAllocatedType(QualType AllocType, SourceLocation Loc,
8548 SourceRange R);
8549
8550 /// Finds the overloads of operator new and delete that are appropriate
8551 /// for the allocation.
8553 SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceRange Range,
8555 QualType AllocType, bool IsArray, ImplicitAllocationParameters &IAP,
8556 MultiExprArg PlaceArgs, FunctionDecl *&OperatorNew,
8557 FunctionDecl *&OperatorDelete, bool Diagnose = true);
8558
8559 /// DeclareGlobalNewDelete - Declare the global forms of operator new and
8560 /// delete. These are:
8561 /// @code
8562 /// // C++03:
8563 /// void* operator new(std::size_t) throw(std::bad_alloc);
8564 /// void* operator new[](std::size_t) throw(std::bad_alloc);
8565 /// void operator delete(void *) throw();
8566 /// void operator delete[](void *) throw();
8567 /// // C++11:
8568 /// void* operator new(std::size_t);
8569 /// void* operator new[](std::size_t);
8570 /// void operator delete(void *) noexcept;
8571 /// void operator delete[](void *) noexcept;
8572 /// // C++1y:
8573 /// void* operator new(std::size_t);
8574 /// void* operator new[](std::size_t);
8575 /// void operator delete(void *) noexcept;
8576 /// void operator delete[](void *) noexcept;
8577 /// void operator delete(void *, std::size_t) noexcept;
8578 /// void operator delete[](void *, std::size_t) noexcept;
8579 /// @endcode
8580 /// Note that the placement and nothrow forms of new are *not* implicitly
8581 /// declared. Their use requires including <new>.
8584 ArrayRef<QualType> Params);
8585
8587 DeclarationName Name, FunctionDecl *&Operator,
8589 bool Diagnose = true);
8592 DeclarationName Name,
8593 bool Diagnose = true);
8595 CXXRecordDecl *RD,
8596 bool Diagnose,
8597 bool LookForGlobal,
8598 DeclarationName Name);
8599
8600 /// ActOnCXXDelete - Parsed a C++ 'delete' expression (C++ 5.3.5), as in:
8601 /// @code ::delete ptr; @endcode
8602 /// or
8603 /// @code delete [] ptr; @endcode
8604 ExprResult ActOnCXXDelete(SourceLocation StartLoc, bool UseGlobal,
8605 bool ArrayForm, Expr *Operand);
8607 bool IsDelete, bool CallCanBeVirtual,
8608 bool WarnOnNonAbstractTypes,
8609 SourceLocation DtorLoc);
8610
8612 Expr *Operand, SourceLocation RParen);
8614 SourceLocation RParen);
8615
8617 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8618 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
8619 ParsedType &ObjectType,
8620 bool &MayBePseudoDestructor);
8621
8623 Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind OpKind,
8624 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, TypeSourceInfo *ScopeType, SourceLocation CCLoc,
8625 SourceLocation TildeLoc, PseudoDestructorTypeStorage DestroyedType);
8626
8628 Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind OpKind,
8629 CXXScopeSpec &SS, UnqualifiedId &FirstTypeName, SourceLocation CCLoc,
8630 SourceLocation TildeLoc, UnqualifiedId &SecondTypeName);
8631
8633 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8634 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
8635 SourceLocation TildeLoc,
8636 const DeclSpec &DS);
8637
8638 /// MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups - If the current full-expression
8639 /// requires any cleanups, surround it with a ExprWithCleanups node.
8640 /// Otherwise, just returns the passed-in expression.
8644
8645 ExprResult ActOnFinishFullExpr(Expr *Expr, bool DiscardedValue) {
8646 return ActOnFinishFullExpr(
8647 Expr, Expr ? Expr->getExprLoc() : SourceLocation(), DiscardedValue);
8648 }
8650 bool DiscardedValue, bool IsConstexpr = false,
8651 bool IsTemplateArgument = false);
8653
8654 /// Process the expression contained within a decltype. For such expressions,
8655 /// certain semantic checks on temporaries are delayed until this point, and
8656 /// are omitted for the 'topmost' call in the decltype expression. If the
8657 /// topmost call bound a temporary, strip that temporary off the expression.
8659
8660 bool checkLiteralOperatorId(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const UnqualifiedId &Id,
8661 bool IsUDSuffix);
8662
8664
8665 ConditionResult ActOnConditionVariable(Decl *ConditionVar,
8666 SourceLocation StmtLoc,
8667 ConditionKind CK);
8668
8669 /// Check the use of the given variable as a C++ condition in an if,
8670 /// while, do-while, or switch statement.
8672 SourceLocation StmtLoc, ConditionKind CK);
8673
8674 /// CheckCXXBooleanCondition - Returns true if conversion to bool is invalid.
8675 ExprResult CheckCXXBooleanCondition(Expr *CondExpr, bool IsConstexpr = false);
8676
8677 /// Helper function to determine whether this is the (deprecated) C++
8678 /// conversion from a string literal to a pointer to non-const char or
8679 /// non-const wchar_t (for narrow and wide string literals,
8680 /// respectively).
8682
8683 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
8684 /// expression From to the type ToType using the pre-computed implicit
8685 /// conversion sequence ICS. Returns the converted
8686 /// expression. Action is the kind of conversion we're performing,
8687 /// used in the error message.
8689 Expr *From, QualType ToType, const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
8690 AssignmentAction Action,
8692
8693 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
8694 /// expression From to the type ToType by following the standard
8695 /// conversion sequence SCS. Returns the converted
8696 /// expression. Flavor is the context in which we're performing this
8697 /// conversion, for use in error messages.
8699 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
8700 AssignmentAction Action,
8702
8703 bool CheckTypeTraitArity(unsigned Arity, SourceLocation Loc, size_t N);
8704
8705 /// Parsed one of the type trait support pseudo-functions.
8708 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
8711 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
8712
8713 /// ActOnArrayTypeTrait - Parsed one of the binary type trait support
8714 /// pseudo-functions.
8716 ParsedType LhsTy, Expr *DimExpr,
8717 SourceLocation RParen);
8718
8720 TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, Expr *DimExpr,
8721 SourceLocation RParen);
8722
8723 /// ActOnExpressionTrait - Parsed one of the unary type trait support
8724 /// pseudo-functions.
8726 Expr *Queried, SourceLocation RParen);
8727
8729 Expr *Queried, SourceLocation RParen);
8730
8733 bool isIndirect);
8735 ExprResult &RHS,
8736 SourceLocation QuestionLoc);
8737
8738 //// Determines if a type is trivially relocatable
8739 /// according to the C++26 rules.
8740 // FIXME: This is in Sema because it requires
8741 // overload resolution, can we move to ASTContext?
8744
8745 /// Check the operands of ?: under C++ semantics.
8746 ///
8747 /// See C++ [expr.cond]. Note that LHS is never null, even for the GNU x ?: y
8748 /// extension. In this case, LHS == Cond. (But they're not aliases.)
8749 ///
8750 /// This function also implements GCC's vector extension and the
8751 /// OpenCL/ext_vector_type extension for conditionals. The vector extensions
8752 /// permit the use of a?b:c where the type of a is that of a integer vector
8753 /// with the same number of elements and size as the vectors of b and c. If
8754 /// one of either b or c is a scalar it is implicitly converted to match the
8755 /// type of the vector. Otherwise the expression is ill-formed. If both b and
8756 /// c are scalars, then b and c are checked and converted to the type of a if
8757 /// possible.
8758 ///
8759 /// The expressions are evaluated differently for GCC's and OpenCL's
8760 /// extensions. For the GCC extension, the ?: operator is evaluated as
8761 /// (a[0] != 0 ? b[0] : c[0], .. , a[n] != 0 ? b[n] : c[n]).
8762 /// For the OpenCL extensions, the ?: operator is evaluated as
8763 /// (most-significant-bit-set(a[0]) ? b[0] : c[0], .. ,
8764 /// most-significant-bit-set(a[n]) ? b[n] : c[n]).
8766 ExprResult &cond, ExprResult &lhs, ExprResult &rhs, ExprValueKind &VK,
8767 ExprObjectKind &OK, SourceLocation questionLoc);
8768
8769 /// Find a merged pointer type and convert the two expressions to it.
8770 ///
8771 /// This finds the composite pointer type for \p E1 and \p E2 according to
8772 /// C++2a [expr.type]p3. It converts both expressions to this type and returns
8773 /// it. It does not emit diagnostics (FIXME: that's not true if \p
8774 /// ConvertArgs is \c true).
8775 ///
8776 /// \param Loc The location of the operator requiring these two expressions to
8777 /// be converted to the composite pointer type.
8778 ///
8779 /// \param ConvertArgs If \c false, do not convert E1 and E2 to the target
8780 /// type.
8782 bool ConvertArgs = true);
8784 ExprResult &E2, bool ConvertArgs = true) {
8785 Expr *E1Tmp = E1.get(), *E2Tmp = E2.get();
8786 QualType Composite =
8787 FindCompositePointerType(Loc, E1Tmp, E2Tmp, ConvertArgs);
8788 E1 = E1Tmp;
8789 E2 = E2Tmp;
8790 return Composite;
8791 }
8792
8793 /// MaybeBindToTemporary - If the passed in expression has a record type with
8794 /// a non-trivial destructor, this will return CXXBindTemporaryExpr. Otherwise
8795 /// it simply returns the passed in expression.
8797
8798 /// IgnoredValueConversions - Given that an expression's result is
8799 /// syntactically ignored, perform any conversions that are
8800 /// required.
8802
8804
8807 const DeclarationNameInfo &TargetNameInfo);
8808
8810 SourceLocation KeywordLoc,
8811 bool IsIfExists, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
8812 UnqualifiedId &Name);
8813
8816 ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> LocalParameters,
8817 Scope *BodyScope);
8821 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
8822 SourceLocation NameLoc,
8823 const IdentifierInfo *TypeName,
8824 TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId);
8826 SourceLocation NoexceptLoc);
8828 Expr *E, SourceLocation NoexceptLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
8829 TemplateIdAnnotation *TypeConstraint, unsigned Depth);
8832 Expr *E, bool IsSatisfied, SourceLocation NoexceptLoc,
8836 bool IsSatisfied, SourceLocation NoexceptLoc,
8843 BuildNestedRequirement(StringRef InvalidConstraintEntity,
8844 const ASTConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction);
8847 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
8848 ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> LocalParameters,
8849 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
8851 SourceLocation ClosingBraceLoc);
8852
8853private:
8854 ExprResult BuiltinOperatorNewDeleteOverloaded(ExprResult TheCallResult,
8855 bool IsDelete);
8856
8857 void AnalyzeDeleteExprMismatch(const CXXDeleteExpr *DE);
8858 void AnalyzeDeleteExprMismatch(FieldDecl *Field, SourceLocation DeleteLoc,
8859 bool DeleteWasArrayForm);
8860
8861 ///@}
8862
8863 //
8864 //
8865 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
8866 //
8867 //
8868
8869 /// \name Member Access Expressions
8870 /// Implementations are in SemaExprMember.cpp
8871 ///@{
8872
8873public:
8874 /// Check whether an expression might be an implicit class member access.
8876 bool IsAddressOfOperand);
8877
8878 /// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
8880 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, LookupResult &R,
8881 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, const Scope *S);
8882
8883 /// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
8884 /// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
8885 /// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
8886 /// is from an appropriate type.
8888 BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
8889 LookupResult &R,
8890 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
8891 bool IsDefiniteInstance, const Scope *S);
8892
8894 Expr *Base, QualType BaseType, bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8895 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
8896 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
8897 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs);
8898
8899 /// The main callback when the parser finds something like
8900 /// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
8901 /// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
8902 /// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
8903 /// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
8904 ///
8905 /// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
8906 /// \param ObjCImpDecl the current Objective-C \@implementation
8907 /// decl; this is an ugly hack around the fact that Objective-C
8908 /// \@implementations aren't properly put in the context chain
8910 tok::TokenKind OpKind, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
8911 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
8912 UnqualifiedId &Member, Decl *ObjCImpDecl);
8913
8914 MemberExpr *
8915 BuildMemberExpr(Expr *Base, bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8916 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
8917 ValueDecl *Member, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
8918 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
8919 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo, QualType Ty,
8921 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = nullptr);
8922
8923 // Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
8924 // specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
8925 // type. The restriction here is:
8926 //
8927 // C++ [expr.ref]p2:
8928 // ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
8929 // member of the class or of one of its base classes.
8930 //
8931 // So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
8932 // an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
8933 // decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
8934 // we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
8935 bool CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
8936 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
8937 const LookupResult &R);
8938
8939 // This struct is for use by ActOnMemberAccess to allow
8940 // BuildMemberReferenceExpr to be able to reinvoke ActOnMemberAccess after
8941 // changing the access operator from a '.' to a '->' (to see if that is the
8942 // change needed to fix an error about an unknown member, e.g. when the class
8943 // defines a custom operator->).
8949
8951 Expr *Base, QualType BaseType, SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
8952 CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
8953 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
8954 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, const Scope *S,
8955 ActOnMemberAccessExtraArgs *ExtraArgs = nullptr);
8956
8959 bool IsArrow, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
8960 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
8961 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope, LookupResult &R,
8962 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
8963 const Scope *S, bool SuppressQualifierCheck = false,
8964 ActOnMemberAccessExtraArgs *ExtraArgs = nullptr);
8965
8966 ExprResult BuildFieldReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, bool IsArrow,
8967 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8968 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, FieldDecl *Field,
8969 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
8970 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo);
8971
8972 /// Perform conversions on the LHS of a member access expression.
8974
8976 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation nameLoc,
8977 IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField,
8978 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none),
8979 Expr *baseObjectExpr = nullptr, SourceLocation opLoc = SourceLocation());
8980
8981private:
8982 void CheckMemberAccessOfNoDeref(const MemberExpr *E);
8983
8984 ///@}
8985
8986 //
8987 //
8988 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
8989 //
8990 //
8991
8992 /// \name Initializers
8993 /// Implementations are in SemaInit.cpp
8994 ///@{
8995
8996public:
8997 /// Stack of types that correspond to the parameter entities that are
8998 /// currently being copy-initialized. Can be empty.
9000
9001 llvm::DenseMap<unsigned, CXXDeductionGuideDecl *>
9003
9004 bool IsStringInit(Expr *Init, const ArrayType *AT);
9005
9006 /// Determine whether we can perform aggregate initialization for the purposes
9007 /// of overload resolution.
9009 const InitializedEntity &Entity, InitListExpr *From);
9010
9012 SourceLocation EqualOrColonLoc,
9013 bool GNUSyntax, ExprResult Init);
9014
9015 /// Check that the lifetime of the initializer (and its subobjects) is
9016 /// sufficient for initializing the entity, and perform lifetime extension
9017 /// (when permitted) if not.
9019
9022 bool BoundToLvalueReference);
9023
9024 /// If \p E is a prvalue denoting an unmaterialized temporary, materialize
9025 /// it as an xvalue. In C++98, the result will still be a prvalue, because
9026 /// we don't have xvalues there.
9028
9032
9036 SourceLocation EqualLoc, ExprResult Init,
9037 bool TopLevelOfInitList = false,
9038 bool AllowExplicit = false);
9039
9041 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, const InitializedEntity &Entity,
9042 const InitializationKind &Kind, MultiExprArg Init);
9043
9044 ///@}
9045
9046 //
9047 //
9048 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
9049 //
9050 //
9051
9052 /// \name C++ Lambda Expressions
9053 /// Implementations are in SemaLambda.cpp
9054 ///@{
9055
9056public:
9057 /// Create a new lambda closure type.
9059 TypeSourceInfo *Info,
9060 unsigned LambdaDependencyKind,
9061 LambdaCaptureDefault CaptureDefault);
9062
9063 /// Number lambda for linkage purposes if necessary.
9065 std::optional<CXXRecordDecl::LambdaNumbering>
9066 NumberingOverride = std::nullopt);
9067
9068 /// Endow the lambda scope info with the relevant properties.
9069 void buildLambdaScope(sema::LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator,
9070 SourceRange IntroducerRange,
9071 LambdaCaptureDefault CaptureDefault,
9072 SourceLocation CaptureDefaultLoc, bool ExplicitParams,
9073 bool Mutable);
9074
9077
9079 CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, CXXRecordDecl *Class,
9080 TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams);
9081
9082 void
9084 SourceLocation CallOperatorLoc,
9085 const AssociatedConstraint &TrailingRequiresClause,
9086 TypeSourceInfo *MethodTyInfo,
9087 ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind, StorageClass SC,
9089 bool HasExplicitResultType);
9090
9091 /// Returns true if the explicit object parameter was invalid.
9093 SourceLocation CallLoc);
9094
9095 /// Perform initialization analysis of the init-capture and perform
9096 /// any implicit conversions such as an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion if
9097 /// not being used to initialize a reference.
9099 SourceLocation Loc, bool ByRef, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
9100 IdentifierInfo *Id, LambdaCaptureInitKind InitKind, Expr *&Init) {
9102 Loc, ByRef, EllipsisLoc, std::nullopt, Id,
9104 }
9106 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
9107 UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions,
9108 IdentifierInfo *Id,
9109 bool DirectInit, Expr *&Init);
9110
9111 /// Create a dummy variable within the declcontext of the lambda's
9112 /// call operator, for name lookup purposes for a lambda init capture.
9113 ///
9114 /// CodeGen handles emission of lambda captures, ignoring these dummy
9115 /// variables appropriately.
9117 SourceLocation Loc, QualType InitCaptureType, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
9118 IdentifierInfo *Id, unsigned InitStyle, Expr *Init, DeclContext *DeclCtx);
9119
9120 /// Add an init-capture to a lambda scope.
9121 void addInitCapture(sema::LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, VarDecl *Var, bool ByRef);
9122
9123 /// Note that we have finished the explicit captures for the
9124 /// given lambda.
9126
9127 /// Deduce a block or lambda's return type based on the return
9128 /// statements present in the body.
9130
9131 /// Once the Lambdas capture are known, we can start to create the closure,
9132 /// call operator method, and keep track of the captures.
9133 /// We do the capture lookup here, but they are not actually captured until
9134 /// after we know what the qualifiers of the call operator are.
9136 Scope *CurContext);
9137
9138 /// This is called after parsing the explicit template parameter list
9139 /// on a lambda (if it exists) in C++2a.
9141 SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
9142 ArrayRef<NamedDecl *> TParams,
9143 SourceLocation RAngleLoc,
9144 ExprResult RequiresClause);
9145
9147 SourceLocation MutableLoc);
9148
9150 Scope *LambdaScope,
9152
9153 /// ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition - This is called just before we start
9154 /// parsing the body of a lambda; it analyzes the explicit captures and
9155 /// arguments, and sets up various data-structures for the body of the
9156 /// lambda.
9158 Declarator &ParamInfo, const DeclSpec &DS);
9159
9160 /// ActOnLambdaError - If there is an error parsing a lambda, this callback
9161 /// is invoked to pop the information about the lambda.
9162 void ActOnLambdaError(SourceLocation StartLoc, Scope *CurScope,
9163 bool IsInstantiation = false);
9164
9165 /// ActOnLambdaExpr - This is called when the body of a lambda expression
9166 /// was successfully completed.
9168
9169 /// Does copying/destroying the captured variable have side effects?
9170 bool CaptureHasSideEffects(const sema::Capture &From);
9171
9172 /// Diagnose if an explicit lambda capture is unused. Returns true if a
9173 /// diagnostic is emitted.
9174 bool DiagnoseUnusedLambdaCapture(SourceRange CaptureRange,
9175 SourceRange FixItRange,
9176 const sema::Capture &From);
9177
9178 /// Build a FieldDecl suitable to hold the given capture.
9180
9181 /// Initialize the given capture with a suitable expression.
9183 SourceLocation ImplicitCaptureLoc,
9184 bool IsOpenMPMapping = false);
9185
9186 /// Complete a lambda-expression having processed and attached the
9187 /// lambda body.
9189
9190 /// Get the return type to use for a lambda's conversion function(s) to
9191 /// function pointer type, given the type of the call operator.
9192 QualType
9194 CallingConv CC);
9195
9197 SourceLocation ConvLocation,
9198 CXXConversionDecl *Conv, Expr *Src);
9199
9201 : private FunctionScopeRAII {
9202 public:
9204 Sema &SemasRef, FunctionDecl *FD, MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MLTAL,
9206 bool ShouldAddDeclsFromParentScope = true);
9207 };
9208
9209 /// Compute the mangling number context for a lambda expression or
9210 /// block literal. Also return the extra mangling decl if any.
9211 ///
9212 /// \param DC - The DeclContext containing the lambda expression or
9213 /// block literal.
9214 std::tuple<MangleNumberingContext *, Decl *>
9216
9217 ///@}
9218
9219 //
9220 //
9221 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
9222 //
9223 //
9224
9225 /// \name Name Lookup
9226 ///
9227 /// These routines provide name lookup that is used during semantic
9228 /// analysis to resolve the various kinds of names (identifiers,
9229 /// overloaded operator names, constructor names, etc.) into zero or
9230 /// more declarations within a particular scope. The major entry
9231 /// points are LookupName, which performs unqualified name lookup,
9232 /// and LookupQualifiedName, which performs qualified name lookup.
9233 ///
9234 /// All name lookup is performed based on some specific criteria,
9235 /// which specify what names will be visible to name lookup and how
9236 /// far name lookup should work. These criteria are important both
9237 /// for capturing language semantics (certain lookups will ignore
9238 /// certain names, for example) and for performance, since name
9239 /// lookup is often a bottleneck in the compilation of C++. Name
9240 /// lookup criteria is specified via the LookupCriteria enumeration.
9241 ///
9242 /// The results of name lookup can vary based on the kind of name
9243 /// lookup performed, the current language, and the translation
9244 /// unit. In C, for example, name lookup will either return nothing
9245 /// (no entity found) or a single declaration. In C++, name lookup
9246 /// can additionally refer to a set of overloaded functions or
9247 /// result in an ambiguity. All of the possible results of name
9248 /// lookup are captured by the LookupResult class, which provides
9249 /// the ability to distinguish among them.
9250 ///
9251 /// Implementations are in SemaLookup.cpp
9252 ///@{
9253
9254public:
9255 /// Tracks whether we are in a context where typo correction is
9256 /// disabled.
9258
9259 /// The number of typos corrected by CorrectTypo.
9261
9262 typedef llvm::SmallSet<SourceLocation, 2> SrcLocSet;
9263 typedef llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo *, SrcLocSet> IdentifierSourceLocations;
9264
9265 /// A cache containing identifiers for which typo correction failed and
9266 /// their locations, so that repeated attempts to correct an identifier in a
9267 /// given location are ignored if typo correction already failed for it.
9269
9270 /// SpecialMemberOverloadResult - The overloading result for a special member
9271 /// function.
9272 ///
9273 /// This is basically a wrapper around PointerIntPair. The lowest bits of the
9274 /// integer are used to determine whether overload resolution succeeded.
9276 public:
9278
9279 private:
9280 llvm::PointerIntPair<CXXMethodDecl *, 2> Pair;
9281
9282 public:
9285 : Pair(MD, MD->isDeleted() ? NoMemberOrDeleted : Success) {}
9286
9287 CXXMethodDecl *getMethod() const { return Pair.getPointer(); }
9288 void setMethod(CXXMethodDecl *MD) { Pair.setPointer(MD); }
9289
9290 Kind getKind() const { return static_cast<Kind>(Pair.getInt()); }
9291 void setKind(Kind K) { Pair.setInt(K); }
9292 };
9293
9294 class SpecialMemberOverloadResultEntry : public llvm::FastFoldingSetNode,
9296 public:
9297 SpecialMemberOverloadResultEntry(const llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
9298 : FastFoldingSetNode(ID) {}
9299 };
9300
9301 /// A cache of special member function overload resolution results
9302 /// for C++ records.
9303 llvm::FoldingSet<SpecialMemberOverloadResultEntry> SpecialMemberCache;
9304
9306
9307 // Members have to be NamespaceDecl* or TranslationUnitDecl*.
9308 // TODO: make this is a typesafe union.
9311
9312 /// Describes the kind of name lookup to perform.
9314 /// Ordinary name lookup, which finds ordinary names (functions,
9315 /// variables, typedefs, etc.) in C and most kinds of names
9316 /// (functions, variables, members, types, etc.) in C++.
9318 /// Tag name lookup, which finds the names of enums, classes,
9319 /// structs, and unions.
9321 /// Label name lookup.
9323 /// Member name lookup, which finds the names of
9324 /// class/struct/union members.
9326 /// Look up of an operator name (e.g., operator+) for use with
9327 /// operator overloading. This lookup is similar to ordinary name
9328 /// lookup, but will ignore any declarations that are class members.
9330 /// Look up a name following ~ in a destructor name. This is an ordinary
9331 /// lookup, but prefers tags to typedefs.
9333 /// Look up of a name that precedes the '::' scope resolution
9334 /// operator in C++. This lookup completely ignores operator, object,
9335 /// function, and enumerator names (C++ [basic.lookup.qual]p1).
9337 /// Look up a namespace name within a C++ using directive or
9338 /// namespace alias definition, ignoring non-namespace names (C++
9339 /// [basic.lookup.udir]p1).
9341 /// Look up all declarations in a scope with the given name,
9342 /// including resolved using declarations. This is appropriate
9343 /// for checking redeclarations for a using declaration.
9345 /// Look up an ordinary name that is going to be redeclared as a
9346 /// name with linkage. This lookup ignores any declarations that
9347 /// are outside of the current scope unless they have linkage. See
9348 /// C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6.
9350 /// Look up a friend of a local class. This lookup does not look
9351 /// outside the innermost non-class scope. See C++11 [class.friend]p11.
9353 /// Look up the name of an Objective-C protocol.
9355 /// Look up implicit 'self' parameter of an objective-c method.
9357 /// Look up the name of an OpenMP user-defined reduction operation.
9359 /// Look up the name of an OpenMP user-defined mapper.
9361 /// Look up any declaration with any name.
9363 };
9364
9365 /// The possible outcomes of name lookup for a literal operator.
9367 /// The lookup resulted in an error.
9369 /// The lookup found no match but no diagnostic was issued.
9371 /// The lookup found a single 'cooked' literal operator, which
9372 /// expects a normal literal to be built and passed to it.
9374 /// The lookup found a single 'raw' literal operator, which expects
9375 /// a string literal containing the spelling of the literal token.
9377 /// The lookup found an overload set of literal operator templates,
9378 /// which expect the characters of the spelling of the literal token to be
9379 /// passed as a non-type template argument pack.
9381 /// The lookup found an overload set of literal operator templates,
9382 /// which expect the character type and characters of the spelling of the
9383 /// string literal token to be passed as template arguments.
9385 };
9386
9387 SpecialMemberOverloadResult
9389 bool VolatileArg, bool RValueThis, bool ConstThis,
9390 bool VolatileThis);
9391
9393
9394 /// Look up a name, looking for a single declaration. Return
9395 /// null if the results were absent, ambiguous, or overloaded.
9396 ///
9397 /// It is preferable to use the elaborated form and explicitly handle
9398 /// ambiguity and overloaded.
9400 Scope *S, DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation Loc,
9401 LookupNameKind NameKind,
9403
9404 /// Lookup a builtin function, when name lookup would otherwise
9405 /// fail.
9406 bool LookupBuiltin(LookupResult &R);
9407 void LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(Scope *S, unsigned ID);
9408
9409 /// Perform unqualified name lookup starting from a given
9410 /// scope.
9411 ///
9412 /// Unqualified name lookup (C++ [basic.lookup.unqual], C99 6.2.1) is
9413 /// used to find names within the current scope. For example, 'x' in
9414 /// @code
9415 /// int x;
9416 /// int f() {
9417 /// return x; // unqualified name look finds 'x' in the global scope
9418 /// }
9419 /// @endcode
9420 ///
9421 /// Different lookup criteria can find different names. For example, a
9422 /// particular scope can have both a struct and a function of the same
9423 /// name, and each can be found by certain lookup criteria. For more
9424 /// information about lookup criteria, see the documentation for the
9425 /// class LookupCriteria.
9426 ///
9427 /// @param S The scope from which unqualified name lookup will
9428 /// begin. If the lookup criteria permits, name lookup may also search
9429 /// in the parent scopes.
9430 ///
9431 /// @param [in,out] R Specifies the lookup to perform (e.g., the name to
9432 /// look up and the lookup kind), and is updated with the results of lookup
9433 /// including zero or more declarations and possibly additional information
9434 /// used to diagnose ambiguities.
9435 ///
9436 /// @returns \c true if lookup succeeded and false otherwise.
9437 bool LookupName(LookupResult &R, Scope *S, bool AllowBuiltinCreation = false,
9438 bool ForceNoCPlusPlus = false);
9439
9440 /// Perform qualified name lookup into a given context.
9441 ///
9442 /// Qualified name lookup (C++ [basic.lookup.qual]) is used to find
9443 /// names when the context of those names is explicit specified, e.g.,
9444 /// "std::vector" or "x->member", or as part of unqualified name lookup.
9445 ///
9446 /// Different lookup criteria can find different names. For example, a
9447 /// particular scope can have both a struct and a function of the same
9448 /// name, and each can be found by certain lookup criteria. For more
9449 /// information about lookup criteria, see the documentation for the
9450 /// class LookupCriteria.
9451 ///
9452 /// \param R captures both the lookup criteria and any lookup results found.
9453 ///
9454 /// \param LookupCtx The context in which qualified name lookup will
9455 /// search. If the lookup criteria permits, name lookup may also search
9456 /// in the parent contexts or (for C++ classes) base classes.
9457 ///
9458 /// \param InUnqualifiedLookup true if this is qualified name lookup that
9459 /// occurs as part of unqualified name lookup.
9460 ///
9461 /// \returns true if lookup succeeded, false if it failed.
9462 bool LookupQualifiedName(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *LookupCtx,
9463 bool InUnqualifiedLookup = false);
9464
9465 /// Performs qualified name lookup or special type of lookup for
9466 /// "__super::" scope specifier.
9467 ///
9468 /// This routine is a convenience overload meant to be called from contexts
9469 /// that need to perform a qualified name lookup with an optional C++ scope
9470 /// specifier that might require special kind of lookup.
9471 ///
9472 /// \param R captures both the lookup criteria and any lookup results found.
9473 ///
9474 /// \param LookupCtx The context in which qualified name lookup will
9475 /// search.
9476 ///
9477 /// \param SS An optional C++ scope-specifier.
9478 ///
9479 /// \returns true if lookup succeeded, false if it failed.
9480 bool LookupQualifiedName(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *LookupCtx,
9481 CXXScopeSpec &SS);
9482
9483 /// Performs name lookup for a name that was parsed in the
9484 /// source code, and may contain a C++ scope specifier.
9485 ///
9486 /// This routine is a convenience routine meant to be called from
9487 /// contexts that receive a name and an optional C++ scope specifier
9488 /// (e.g., "N::M::x"). It will then perform either qualified or
9489 /// unqualified name lookup (with LookupQualifiedName or LookupName,
9490 /// respectively) on the given name and return those results. It will
9491 /// perform a special type of lookup for "__super::" scope specifier.
9492 ///
9493 /// @param S The scope from which unqualified name lookup will
9494 /// begin.
9495 ///
9496 /// @param SS An optional C++ scope-specifier, e.g., "::N::M".
9497 ///
9498 /// @param EnteringContext Indicates whether we are going to enter the
9499 /// context of the scope-specifier SS (if present).
9500 ///
9501 /// @returns True if any decls were found (but possibly ambiguous)
9503 QualType ObjectType, bool AllowBuiltinCreation = false,
9504 bool EnteringContext = false);
9505
9506 /// Perform qualified name lookup into all base classes of the given
9507 /// class.
9508 ///
9509 /// \param R captures both the lookup criteria and any lookup results found.
9510 ///
9511 /// \param Class The context in which qualified name lookup will
9512 /// search. Name lookup will search in all base classes merging the results.
9513 ///
9514 /// @returns True if any decls were found (but possibly ambiguous)
9516
9518 UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions);
9519
9520 /// LookupOrCreateLabel - Do a name lookup of a label with the specified name.
9521 /// If GnuLabelLoc is a valid source location, then this is a definition
9522 /// of an __label__ label name, otherwise it is a normal label definition
9523 /// or use.
9525 SourceLocation GnuLabelLoc = SourceLocation());
9526
9527 /// Perform a name lookup for a label with the specified name; this does not
9528 /// create a new label if the lookup fails.
9530
9531 /// Look up the constructors for the given class.
9533
9534 /// Look up the default constructor for the given class.
9536
9537 /// Look up the copying constructor for the given class.
9539 unsigned Quals);
9540
9541 /// Look up the copying assignment operator for the given class.
9543 bool RValueThis, unsigned ThisQuals);
9544
9545 /// Look up the moving constructor for the given class.
9547 unsigned Quals);
9548
9549 /// Look up the moving assignment operator for the given class.
9551 bool RValueThis, unsigned ThisQuals);
9552
9553 /// Look for the destructor of the given class.
9554 ///
9555 /// During semantic analysis, this routine should be used in lieu of
9556 /// CXXRecordDecl::getDestructor().
9557 ///
9558 /// \returns The destructor for this class.
9560
9561 /// Force the declaration of any implicitly-declared members of this
9562 /// class.
9564
9565 /// Make a merged definition of an existing hidden definition \p ND
9566 /// visible at the specified location.
9568
9569 /// Check ODR hashes for C/ObjC when merging types from modules.
9570 /// Differently from C++, actually parse the body and reject in case
9571 /// of a mismatch.
9572 template <typename T,
9573 typename = std::enable_if_t<std::is_base_of<NamedDecl, T>::value>>
9575 if (Duplicate->getODRHash() != Previous->getODRHash())
9576 return false;
9577
9578 // Make the previous decl visible.
9580 return true;
9581 }
9582
9583 /// Get the set of additional modules that should be checked during
9584 /// name lookup. A module and its imports become visible when instanting a
9585 /// template defined within it.
9586 llvm::DenseSet<Module *> &getLookupModules();
9587
9588 bool hasVisibleMergedDefinition(const NamedDecl *Def);
9590
9591 /// Determine if the template parameter \p D has a visible default argument.
9592 bool
9594 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr);
9595 /// Determine if the template parameter \p D has a reachable default argument.
9597 const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr);
9598 /// Determine if the template parameter \p D has a reachable default argument.
9602
9603 /// Determine if there is a visible declaration of \p D that is an explicit
9604 /// specialization declaration for a specialization of a template. (For a
9605 /// member specialization, use hasVisibleMemberSpecialization.)
9607 const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr);
9608 /// Determine if there is a reachable declaration of \p D that is an explicit
9609 /// specialization declaration for a specialization of a template. (For a
9610 /// member specialization, use hasReachableMemberSpecialization.)
9612 const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr);
9613
9614 /// Determine if there is a visible declaration of \p D that is a member
9615 /// specialization declaration (as opposed to an instantiated declaration).
9617 const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr);
9618 /// Determine if there is a reachable declaration of \p D that is a member
9619 /// specialization declaration (as opposed to an instantiated declaration).
9621 const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr);
9622
9623 bool isModuleVisible(const Module *M, bool ModulePrivate = false);
9624
9625 /// Determine whether any declaration of an entity is visible.
9626 bool
9628 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr) {
9629 return isVisible(D) || hasVisibleDeclarationSlow(D, Modules);
9630 }
9631
9634 /// Determine whether any declaration of an entity is reachable.
9635 bool
9637 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr) {
9638 return isReachable(D) || hasReachableDeclarationSlow(D, Modules);
9639 }
9641 const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl<Module *> *Modules = nullptr);
9642
9643 void diagnoseTypo(const TypoCorrection &Correction,
9644 const PartialDiagnostic &TypoDiag,
9645 bool ErrorRecovery = true);
9646
9647 /// Diagnose a successfully-corrected typo. Separated from the correction
9648 /// itself to allow external validation of the result, etc.
9649 ///
9650 /// \param Correction The result of performing typo correction.
9651 /// \param TypoDiag The diagnostic to produce. This will have the corrected
9652 /// string added to it (and usually also a fixit).
9653 /// \param PrevNote A note to use when indicating the location of the entity
9654 /// to which we are correcting. Will have the correction string added
9655 /// to it.
9656 /// \param ErrorRecovery If \c true (the default), the caller is going to
9657 /// recover from the typo as if the corrected string had been typed.
9658 /// In this case, \c PDiag must be an error, and we will attach a fixit
9659 /// to it.
9660 void diagnoseTypo(const TypoCorrection &Correction,
9661 const PartialDiagnostic &TypoDiag,
9662 const PartialDiagnostic &PrevNote,
9663 bool ErrorRecovery = true);
9664
9665 /// Find the associated classes and namespaces for
9666 /// argument-dependent lookup for a call with the given set of
9667 /// arguments.
9668 ///
9669 /// This routine computes the sets of associated classes and associated
9670 /// namespaces searched by argument-dependent lookup
9671 /// (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]) for a given set of arguments.
9673 SourceLocation InstantiationLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9674 AssociatedNamespaceSet &AssociatedNamespaces,
9675 AssociatedClassSet &AssociatedClasses);
9676
9677 /// Produce a diagnostic describing the ambiguity that resulted
9678 /// from name lookup.
9679 ///
9680 /// \param Result The result of the ambiguous lookup to be diagnosed.
9682
9683 /// LookupLiteralOperator - Determine which literal operator should be used
9684 /// for a user-defined literal, per C++11 [lex.ext].
9685 ///
9686 /// Normal overload resolution is not used to select which literal operator to
9687 /// call for a user-defined literal. Look up the provided literal operator
9688 /// name, and filter the results to the appropriate set for the given argument
9689 /// types.
9692 bool AllowRaw, bool AllowTemplate,
9693 bool AllowStringTemplate, bool DiagnoseMissing,
9694 StringLiteral *StringLit = nullptr);
9695
9697 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, ADLResult &Functions);
9698
9699 void LookupVisibleDecls(Scope *S, LookupNameKind Kind,
9701 bool IncludeGlobalScope = true,
9702 bool LoadExternal = true);
9703 void LookupVisibleDecls(DeclContext *Ctx, LookupNameKind Kind,
9705 bool IncludeGlobalScope = true,
9706 bool IncludeDependentBases = false,
9707 bool LoadExternal = true);
9708
9709 /// Try to "correct" a typo in the source code by finding
9710 /// visible declarations whose names are similar to the name that was
9711 /// present in the source code.
9712 ///
9713 /// \param TypoName the \c DeclarationNameInfo structure that contains
9714 /// the name that was present in the source code along with its location.
9715 ///
9716 /// \param LookupKind the name-lookup criteria used to search for the name.
9717 ///
9718 /// \param S the scope in which name lookup occurs.
9719 ///
9720 /// \param SS the nested-name-specifier that precedes the name we're
9721 /// looking for, if present.
9722 ///
9723 /// \param CCC A CorrectionCandidateCallback object that provides further
9724 /// validation of typo correction candidates. It also provides flags for
9725 /// determining the set of keywords permitted.
9726 ///
9727 /// \param MemberContext if non-NULL, the context in which to look for
9728 /// a member access expression.
9729 ///
9730 /// \param EnteringContext whether we're entering the context described by
9731 /// the nested-name-specifier SS.
9732 ///
9733 /// \param OPT when non-NULL, the search for visible declarations will
9734 /// also walk the protocols in the qualified interfaces of \p OPT.
9735 ///
9736 /// \returns a \c TypoCorrection containing the corrected name if the typo
9737 /// along with information such as the \c NamedDecl where the corrected name
9738 /// was declared, and any additional \c NestedNameSpecifier needed to access
9739 /// it (C++ only). The \c TypoCorrection is empty if there is no correction.
9741 Sema::LookupNameKind LookupKind, Scope *S,
9743 CorrectTypoKind Mode,
9744 DeclContext *MemberContext = nullptr,
9745 bool EnteringContext = false,
9746 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = nullptr,
9747 bool RecordFailure = true);
9748
9749 /// Kinds of missing import. Note, the values of these enumerators correspond
9750 /// to %select values in diagnostics.
9758
9759 /// Diagnose that the specified declaration needs to be visible but
9760 /// isn't, and suggest a module import that would resolve the problem.
9762 MissingImportKind MIK, bool Recover = true);
9764 SourceLocation DeclLoc, ArrayRef<Module *> Modules,
9765 MissingImportKind MIK, bool Recover);
9766
9767 /// Called on #pragma clang __debug dump II
9769
9770 /// Called on #pragma clang __debug dump E
9771 void ActOnPragmaDump(Expr *E);
9772
9773private:
9774 // The set of known/encountered (unique, canonicalized) NamespaceDecls.
9775 //
9776 // The boolean value will be true to indicate that the namespace was loaded
9777 // from an AST/PCH file, or false otherwise.
9778 llvm::MapVector<NamespaceDecl *, bool> KnownNamespaces;
9779
9780 /// Whether we have already loaded known namespaces from an extenal
9781 /// source.
9782 bool LoadedExternalKnownNamespaces;
9783
9784 bool CppLookupName(LookupResult &R, Scope *S);
9785
9786 /// Determine if we could use all the declarations in the module.
9787 bool isUsableModule(const Module *M);
9788
9789 /// Helper for CorrectTypo used to create and populate a new
9790 /// TypoCorrectionConsumer. Returns nullptr if typo correction should be
9791 /// skipped entirely.
9792 std::unique_ptr<TypoCorrectionConsumer> makeTypoCorrectionConsumer(
9793 const DeclarationNameInfo &Typo, Sema::LookupNameKind LookupKind,
9795 DeclContext *MemberContext, bool EnteringContext,
9796 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT, bool ErrorRecovery);
9797
9798 /// Cache for module units which is usable for current module.
9799 llvm::DenseSet<const Module *> UsableModuleUnitsCache;
9800
9801 /// Record the typo correction failure and return an empty correction.
9802 TypoCorrection FailedCorrection(IdentifierInfo *Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc,
9803 bool RecordFailure = true) {
9804 if (RecordFailure)
9805 TypoCorrectionFailures[Typo].insert(TypoLoc);
9806 return TypoCorrection();
9807 }
9808
9809 bool isAcceptableSlow(const NamedDecl *D, AcceptableKind Kind);
9810
9811 /// Determine whether two declarations should be linked together, given that
9812 /// the old declaration might not be visible and the new declaration might
9813 /// not have external linkage.
9814 bool shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(const NamedDecl *Old,
9815 const NamedDecl *New) {
9816 if (isVisible(Old))
9817 return true;
9818 // See comment in below overload for why it's safe to compute the linkage
9819 // of the new declaration here.
9820 if (New->isExternallyDeclarable()) {
9821 assert(Old->isExternallyDeclarable() &&
9822 "should not have found a non-externally-declarable previous decl");
9823 return true;
9824 }
9825 return false;
9826 }
9827 bool shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(LookupResult &Old, const NamedDecl *New);
9828
9829 ///@}
9830
9831 //
9832 //
9833 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
9834 //
9835 //
9836
9837 /// \name Modules
9838 /// Implementations are in SemaModule.cpp
9839 ///@{
9840
9841public:
9842 /// Get the module unit whose scope we are currently within.
9844 return ModuleScopes.empty() ? nullptr : ModuleScopes.back().Module;
9845 }
9846
9847 /// Is the module scope we are an implementation unit?
9849 return ModuleScopes.empty()
9850 ? false
9851 : ModuleScopes.back().Module->isModuleImplementation();
9852 }
9853
9854 // When loading a non-modular PCH files, this is used to restore module
9855 // visibility.
9857 VisibleModules.setVisible(Mod, ImportLoc);
9858 }
9859
9860 enum class ModuleDeclKind {
9861 Interface, ///< 'export module X;'
9862 Implementation, ///< 'module X;'
9863 PartitionInterface, ///< 'export module X:Y;'
9864 PartitionImplementation, ///< 'module X:Y;'
9865 };
9866
9867 /// An enumeration to represent the transition of states in parsing module
9868 /// fragments and imports. If we are not parsing a C++20 TU, or we find
9869 /// an error in state transition, the state is set to NotACXX20Module.
9871 FirstDecl, ///< Parsing the first decl in a TU.
9872 GlobalFragment, ///< after 'module;' but before 'module X;'
9873 ImportAllowed, ///< after 'module X;' but before any non-import decl.
9874 ImportFinished, ///< after any non-import decl.
9875 PrivateFragmentImportAllowed, ///< after 'module :private;' but before any
9876 ///< non-import decl.
9877 PrivateFragmentImportFinished, ///< after 'module :private;' but a
9878 ///< non-import decl has already been seen.
9879 NotACXX20Module ///< Not a C++20 TU, or an invalid state was found.
9880 };
9881
9882 /// The parser has processed a module-declaration that begins the definition
9883 /// of a module interface or implementation.
9885 SourceLocation ModuleLoc, ModuleDeclKind MDK,
9886 ModuleIdPath Path, ModuleIdPath Partition,
9887 ModuleImportState &ImportState,
9888 bool SeenNoTrivialPPDirective);
9889
9890 /// The parser has processed a global-module-fragment declaration that begins
9891 /// the definition of the global module fragment of the current module unit.
9892 /// \param ModuleLoc The location of the 'module' keyword.
9894
9895 /// The parser has processed a private-module-fragment declaration that begins
9896 /// the definition of the private module fragment of the current module unit.
9897 /// \param ModuleLoc The location of the 'module' keyword.
9898 /// \param PrivateLoc The location of the 'private' keyword.
9900 SourceLocation PrivateLoc);
9901
9902 /// The parser has processed a module import declaration.
9903 ///
9904 /// \param StartLoc The location of the first token in the declaration. This
9905 /// could be the location of an '@', 'export', or 'import'.
9906 /// \param ExportLoc The location of the 'export' keyword, if any.
9907 /// \param ImportLoc The location of the 'import' keyword.
9908 /// \param Path The module toplevel name as an access path.
9909 /// \param IsPartition If the name is for a partition.
9911 SourceLocation ExportLoc,
9912 SourceLocation ImportLoc, ModuleIdPath Path,
9913 bool IsPartition = false);
9915 SourceLocation ExportLoc,
9916 SourceLocation ImportLoc, Module *M,
9917 ModuleIdPath Path = {});
9918
9919 /// The parser has processed a module import translated from a
9920 /// #include or similar preprocessing directive.
9921 void ActOnAnnotModuleInclude(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod);
9922 void BuildModuleInclude(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod);
9923
9924 /// The parsed has entered a submodule.
9925 void ActOnAnnotModuleBegin(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod);
9926 /// The parser has left a submodule.
9927 void ActOnAnnotModuleEnd(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod);
9928
9929 /// Create an implicit import of the given module at the given
9930 /// source location, for error recovery, if possible.
9931 ///
9932 /// This routine is typically used when an entity found by name lookup
9933 /// is actually hidden within a module that we know about but the user
9934 /// has forgotten to import.
9935 void createImplicitModuleImportForErrorRecovery(SourceLocation Loc,
9936 Module *Mod);
9937
9938 /// We have parsed the start of an export declaration, including the '{'
9939 /// (if present).
9940 Decl *ActOnStartExportDecl(Scope *S, SourceLocation ExportLoc,
9941 SourceLocation LBraceLoc);
9942
9943 /// Complete the definition of an export declaration.
9944 Decl *ActOnFinishExportDecl(Scope *S, Decl *ExportDecl,
9945 SourceLocation RBraceLoc);
9946
9947private:
9948 /// The parser has begun a translation unit to be compiled as a C++20
9949 /// Header Unit, helper for ActOnStartOfTranslationUnit() only.
9950 void HandleStartOfHeaderUnit();
9951
9952 struct ModuleScope {
9953 SourceLocation BeginLoc;
9954 clang::Module *Module = nullptr;
9955 VisibleModuleSet OuterVisibleModules;
9956 };
9957 /// The modules we're currently parsing.
9958 llvm::SmallVector<ModuleScope, 16> ModuleScopes;
9959
9960 /// For an interface unit, this is the implicitly imported interface unit.
9961 clang::Module *ThePrimaryInterface = nullptr;
9962
9963 /// The explicit global module fragment of the current translation unit.
9964 /// The explicit Global Module Fragment, as specified in C++
9965 /// [module.global.frag].
9966 clang::Module *TheGlobalModuleFragment = nullptr;
9967
9968 /// The implicit global module fragments of the current translation unit.
9969 ///
9970 /// The contents in the implicit global module fragment can't be discarded.
9971 clang::Module *TheImplicitGlobalModuleFragment = nullptr;
9972
9973 /// Namespace definitions that we will export when they finish.
9974 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const NamespaceDecl *, 8> DeferredExportedNamespaces;
9975
9976 /// In a C++ standard module, inline declarations require a definition to be
9977 /// present at the end of a definition domain. This set holds the decls to
9978 /// be checked at the end of the TU.
9979 llvm::SmallPtrSet<const FunctionDecl *, 8> PendingInlineFuncDecls;
9980
9981 /// Helper function to judge if we are in module purview.
9982 /// Return false if we are not in a module.
9983 bool isCurrentModulePurview() const;
9984
9985 /// Enter the scope of the explicit global module fragment.
9986 Module *PushGlobalModuleFragment(SourceLocation BeginLoc);
9987 /// Leave the scope of the explicit global module fragment.
9988 void PopGlobalModuleFragment();
9989
9990 /// Enter the scope of an implicit global module fragment.
9991 Module *PushImplicitGlobalModuleFragment(SourceLocation BeginLoc);
9992 /// Leave the scope of an implicit global module fragment.
9993 void PopImplicitGlobalModuleFragment();
9994
9995 VisibleModuleSet VisibleModules;
9996
9997 /// Whether we had imported any named modules.
9998 bool HadImportedNamedModules = false;
9999 /// The set of instantiations we need to check if they references TU-local
10000 /// entity from TUs. This only makes sense if we imported any named modules.
10001 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, SourceLocation>>
10002 PendingCheckReferenceForTULocal;
10003 /// Implement [basic.link]p18, which requires that we can't use TU-local
10004 /// entities from other TUs (ignoring header units).
10005 void checkReferenceToTULocalFromOtherTU(FunctionDecl *FD,
10006 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation);
10007 /// Implement [basic.link]p17, which diagnose for non TU local exposure in
10008 /// module interface or module partition.
10009 void checkExposure(const TranslationUnitDecl *TU);
10010
10011 ///@}
10012
10013 //
10014 //
10015 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
10016 //
10017 //
10018
10019 /// \name C++ Overloading
10020 /// Implementations are in SemaOverload.cpp
10021 ///@{
10022
10023public:
10024 /// Whether deferrable diagnostics should be deferred.
10025 bool DeferDiags = false;
10026
10027 /// RAII class to control scope of DeferDiags.
10029 Sema &S;
10030 bool SavedDeferDiags = false;
10031
10032 public:
10034 : S(S), SavedDeferDiags(S.DeferDiags) {
10035 S.DeferDiags = SavedDeferDiags || DeferDiags;
10036 }
10037 ~DeferDiagsRAII() { S.DeferDiags = SavedDeferDiags; }
10038 };
10039
10040 /// Flag indicating if Sema is building a recovery call expression.
10041 ///
10042 /// This flag is used to avoid building recovery call expressions
10043 /// if Sema is already doing so, which would cause infinite recursions.
10045
10046 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the
10047 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns OverloadKind::Match or
10048 /// OverloadKind::NonFunction if New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if
10049 /// New has the same signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the
10050 /// Old declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When it
10051 /// does return OverloadKind::Match or OverloadKind::NonFunction, MatchedDecl
10052 /// will point to the decl that New cannot be overloaded with. This decl may
10053 /// be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying declaration.
10054 ///
10055 /// Example: Given the following input:
10056 ///
10057 /// void f(int, float); // #1
10058 /// void f(int, int); // #2
10059 /// int f(int, int); // #3
10060 ///
10061 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload
10062 /// will not be used.
10063 ///
10064 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
10065 /// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since
10066 /// they have different signatures), so this routine returns
10067 /// OverloadKind::Overload; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
10068 ///
10069 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
10070 /// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing)
10071 /// and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return
10072 /// types of functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns
10073 /// OverloadKind::Match and MatchedDecl will be set to point to the
10074 /// FunctionDecl for #2.
10075 ///
10076 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a
10077 /// class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow
10078 /// declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function
10079 /// template's signature.
10081 const LookupResult &OldDecls, NamedDecl *&OldDecl,
10082 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules);
10084 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs = true);
10085
10086 // Checks whether MD constitutes an override the base class method BaseMD.
10087 // When checking for overrides, the object object members are ignored.
10088 bool IsOverride(FunctionDecl *MD, FunctionDecl *BaseMD,
10089 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs = true);
10090
10091 enum class AllowedExplicit {
10092 /// Allow no explicit functions to be used.
10094 /// Allow explicit conversion functions but not explicit constructors.
10096 /// Allow both explicit conversion functions and explicit constructors.
10098 };
10099
10101 Expr *From, QualType ToType, bool SuppressUserConversions,
10102 AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, bool InOverloadResolution, bool CStyle,
10103 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
10104
10105 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
10106 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
10107 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
10108 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
10109 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
10111 AssignmentAction Action,
10112 bool AllowExplicit = false);
10113
10114 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
10115 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
10116 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
10117 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
10118 bool IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType);
10119
10120 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
10121 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
10122 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
10123 bool IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType);
10124
10125 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
10126 ///
10127 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
10128 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
10129 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
10130 bool IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType);
10131
10132 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
10133 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
10134 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
10135 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
10136 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
10137 /// ConvertedType.
10138 ///
10139 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
10140 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
10141 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
10142 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
10143 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
10144 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
10145 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
10146 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
10147 /// should result in a warning.
10148 bool IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
10149 bool InOverloadResolution, QualType &ConvertedType,
10150 bool &IncompatibleObjC);
10151
10152 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
10153 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
10154 /// with the same arguments and return values.
10155 bool isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
10156 QualType &ConvertedType, bool &IncompatibleObjC);
10157 bool IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
10158 QualType &ConvertedType);
10159
10160 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
10161 /// for equality of their parameter types. Caller has already checked that
10162 /// they have same number of parameters. If the parameters are different,
10163 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
10164 /// If `Reversed` is true, the parameters of `NewType` will be compared in
10165 /// reverse order. That's useful if one of the functions is being used as a
10166 /// C++20 synthesized operator overload with a reversed parameter order.
10169 unsigned *ArgPos = nullptr,
10170 bool Reversed = false);
10171
10173 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
10174 unsigned *ArgPos = nullptr,
10175 bool Reversed = false);
10176
10177 bool FunctionNonObjectParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionDecl *OldFunction,
10178 const FunctionDecl *NewFunction,
10179 unsigned *ArgPos = nullptr,
10180 bool Reversed = false);
10181
10182 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
10183 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
10184 /// parameter types, and different return types.
10186 QualType ToType);
10187
10188 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
10189 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
10190 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
10191 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
10192 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
10193 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
10194 bool CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, CastKind &Kind,
10195 CXXCastPath &BasePath, bool IgnoreBaseAccess,
10196 bool Diagnose = true);
10197
10198 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
10199 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
10200 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
10201 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
10202 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
10203 bool IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
10204 bool InOverloadResolution,
10205 QualType &ConvertedType);
10206
10216 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from
10217 /// the expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous
10218 /// or virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions for
10219 /// which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It produces a
10220 // diagnostic if there was an error.
10222 QualType FromType, const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType, CastKind &Kind,
10223 CXXCastPath &BasePath, SourceLocation CheckLoc, SourceRange OpRange,
10224 bool IgnoreBaseAccess, MemberPointerConversionDirection Direction);
10225
10226 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
10227 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
10228 /// (C++ 4.4).
10229 ///
10230 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to
10231 /// indicate when the qualification conversion involves a change in the
10232 /// Objective-C object lifetime.
10233 bool IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
10234 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion);
10235
10236 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
10237 /// conversion of ExtInfo/ExtProtoInfo on the nested function type.
10238 /// More precisely, this method checks whether FromType can be transformed
10239 /// into an exact match for ToType, by transforming its extended function
10240 /// type information in legal manner (e.g. by strictly stripping "noreturn"
10241 /// or "noexcept", or by stripping "noescape" for arguments).
10242 bool IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) const;
10243
10244 /// Same as `IsFunctionConversion`, but if this would return true, it sets
10245 /// `ResultTy` to `ToType`.
10246 bool TryFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
10247 QualType &ResultTy) const;
10248
10251 DeclarationName Name,
10252 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10253 FunctionDecl *Fn, MultiExprArg Args,
10254 bool IsMember = false);
10255
10257 FunctionDecl *Fun);
10259 Expr *From, NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
10261
10262 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
10263 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
10265
10266 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
10267 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
10268 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists.
10270
10272 CCEKind CCE,
10273 NamedDecl *Dest = nullptr);
10274
10276 llvm::APSInt &Value, CCEKind CCE);
10278 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE,
10279 NamedDecl *Dest = nullptr);
10280
10281 /// EvaluateConvertedConstantExpression - Evaluate an Expression
10282 /// That is a converted constant expression
10283 /// (which was built with BuildConvertedConstantExpression)
10286 CCEKind CCE, bool RequireInt,
10287 const APValue &PreNarrowingValue);
10288
10289 /// Abstract base class used to perform a contextual implicit
10290 /// conversion from an expression to any type passing a filter.
10292 public:
10295
10299
10300 /// Determine whether the specified type is a valid destination type
10301 /// for this conversion.
10302 virtual bool match(QualType T) = 0;
10303
10304 /// Emits a diagnostic complaining that the expression does not have
10305 /// integral or enumeration type.
10307 QualType T) = 0;
10308
10309 /// Emits a diagnostic when the expression has incomplete class type.
10310 virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder
10312
10313 /// Emits a diagnostic when the only matching conversion function
10314 /// is explicit.
10316 SourceLocation Loc,
10317 QualType T,
10318 QualType ConvTy) = 0;
10319
10320 /// Emits a note for the explicit conversion function.
10321 virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder
10323
10324 /// Emits a diagnostic when there are multiple possible conversion
10325 /// functions.
10327 QualType T) = 0;
10328
10329 /// Emits a note for one of the candidate conversions.
10330 virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder
10332
10333 /// Emits a diagnostic when we picked a conversion function
10334 /// (for cases when we are not allowed to pick a conversion function).
10336 SourceLocation Loc,
10337 QualType T,
10338 QualType ConvTy) = 0;
10339
10341 };
10342
10344 bool AllowScopedEnumerations;
10345
10346 public:
10347 ICEConvertDiagnoser(bool AllowScopedEnumerations, bool Suppress,
10348 bool SuppressConversion)
10350 AllowScopedEnumerations(AllowScopedEnumerations) {}
10351
10352 /// Match an integral or (possibly scoped) enumeration type.
10353 bool match(QualType T) override;
10354
10356 QualType T) override {
10357 return diagnoseNotInt(S, Loc, T);
10358 }
10359
10360 /// Emits a diagnostic complaining that the expression does not have
10361 /// integral or enumeration type.
10363 QualType T) = 0;
10364 };
10365
10366 /// Perform a contextual implicit conversion.
10369 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter);
10370
10371 /// ReferenceCompareResult - Expresses the result of comparing two
10372 /// types (cv1 T1 and cv2 T2) to determine their compatibility for the
10373 /// purposes of initialization by reference (C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4).
10375 /// Ref_Incompatible - The two types are incompatible, so direct
10376 /// reference binding is not possible.
10378 /// Ref_Related - The two types are reference-related, which means
10379 /// that their unqualified forms (T1 and T2) are either the same
10380 /// or T1 is a base class of T2.
10382 /// Ref_Compatible - The two types are reference-compatible.
10384 };
10385
10386 // Fake up a scoped enumeration that still contextually converts to bool.
10388 /// The conversions that would be performed on an lvalue of type T2 when
10389 /// binding a reference of type T1 to it, as determined when evaluating
10390 /// whether T1 is reference-compatible with T2.
10401 };
10403
10404 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
10405 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible,
10406 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
10407 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
10408 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
10409 /// type being initialized.
10412 ReferenceConversions *Conv = nullptr);
10413
10414 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
10415 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
10416 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
10417 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
10418 ///
10419 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
10420 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
10421 /// code completion.
10424 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions = false,
10425 bool PartialOverloading = false, bool AllowExplicit = true,
10426 bool AllowExplicitConversion = false,
10427 ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate = ADLCallKind::NotADL,
10428 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions = {},
10430 bool AggregateCandidateDeduction = false, bool StrictPackMatch = false);
10431
10432 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
10433 /// the overload candidate set.
10435 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10436 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10437 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr,
10438 bool SuppressUserConversions = false, bool PartialOverloading = false,
10439 bool FirstArgumentIsBase = false);
10440
10441 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
10442 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
10443 void AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType,
10444 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
10445 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10446 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10447 bool SuppressUserConversion = false,
10448 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO = {});
10449
10450 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
10451 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
10452 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
10453 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
10454 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
10455 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
10456 /// operators.
10457 void AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10458 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
10459 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
10460 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10461 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10462 bool SuppressUserConversions = false,
10463 bool PartialOverloading = false,
10464 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions = {},
10466 bool StrictPackMatch = false);
10467
10468 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
10469 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
10470 /// function template specialization.
10472 FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10473 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
10474 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType,
10475 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10476 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions = false,
10477 bool PartialOverloading = false, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO = {});
10478
10479 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
10480 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
10481 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
10483 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10484 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10485 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions = false,
10486 bool PartialOverloading = false, bool AllowExplicit = true,
10487 ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate = ADLCallKind::NotADL,
10489 bool AggregateCandidateDeduction = false);
10490
10492 /// Do not consider any user-defined conversions when constructing the
10493 /// initializing sequence.
10495
10496 /// Before constructing the initializing sequence, we check whether the
10497 /// parameter type and argument type contain any user defined conversions.
10498 /// If so, do not initialize them. This effectively bypasses some undesired
10499 /// instantiation before checking constaints, which might otherwise result
10500 /// in non-SFINAE errors e.g. recursive constraints.
10502
10509 };
10510
10511 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument
10512 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's
10513 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10.
10516 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10518 CheckNonDependentConversionsFlag UserConversionFlag,
10519 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = nullptr, QualType ObjectType = QualType(),
10520 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification = {},
10521 OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO = {});
10522
10523 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
10524 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
10525 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
10526 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
10527 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
10528 /// conversion function produces).
10530 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10531 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
10532 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
10533 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion = true,
10534 bool StrictPackMatch = false);
10535
10536 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization
10537 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
10538 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
10539 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
10540 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
10542 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10543 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
10544 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
10545 bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion = true);
10546
10547 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
10548 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
10549 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
10550 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
10551 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
10552 void AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
10553 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10554 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
10555 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, Expr *Object,
10556 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10557 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet);
10558
10559 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given
10560 /// function set to the overload candidate set.
10562 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10563 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10564 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr);
10565
10566 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
10567 /// member functions.
10568 ///
10569 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
10570 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
10571 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
10572 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
10573 /// [over.match.oper]).
10575 SourceLocation OpLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10576 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10578
10579 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
10580 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
10581 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
10582 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
10583 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
10584 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
10585 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
10586 /// converted to bool.
10587 void AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10588 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10589 bool IsAssignmentOperator = false,
10590 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments = 0);
10591
10592 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
10593 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
10594 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
10595 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
10596 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
10598 SourceLocation OpLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10599 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet);
10600
10601 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
10602 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
10603 ///
10604 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
10605 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
10606 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
10607 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
10609 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10610 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10611 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool PartialOverloading = false);
10612
10613 /// Check the enable_if expressions on the given function. Returns the first
10614 /// failing attribute, or NULL if they were all successful.
10615 EnableIfAttr *CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, SourceLocation CallLoc,
10616 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10617 bool MissingImplicitThis = false);
10618
10619 /// Emit diagnostics for the diagnose_if attributes on Function, ignoring any
10620 /// non-ArgDependent DiagnoseIfAttrs.
10621 ///
10622 /// Argument-dependent diagnose_if attributes should be checked each time a
10623 /// function is used as a direct callee of a function call.
10624 ///
10625 /// Returns true if any errors were emitted.
10626 bool diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function,
10627 const Expr *ThisArg,
10628 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args,
10629 SourceLocation Loc);
10630
10631 /// Emit diagnostics for the diagnose_if attributes on Function, ignoring any
10632 /// ArgDependent DiagnoseIfAttrs.
10633 ///
10634 /// Argument-independent diagnose_if attributes should be checked on every use
10635 /// of a function.
10636 ///
10637 /// Returns true if any errors were emitted.
10638 bool diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND,
10639 SourceLocation Loc);
10640
10641 /// Determine if \p A and \p B are equivalent internal linkage declarations
10642 /// from different modules, and thus an ambiguity error can be downgraded to
10643 /// an extension warning.
10644 bool isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A,
10645 const NamedDecl *B);
10647 SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D,
10648 ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv);
10649
10650 // Emit as a 'note' the specific overload candidate
10652 const NamedDecl *Found, const FunctionDecl *Fn,
10654 QualType DestType = QualType(), bool TakingAddress = false);
10655
10656 // Emit as a series of 'note's all template and non-templates identified by
10657 // the expression Expr
10658 void NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *E, QualType DestType = QualType(),
10659 bool TakingAddress = false);
10660
10661 /// Returns whether the given function's address can be taken or not,
10662 /// optionally emitting a diagnostic if the address can't be taken.
10663 ///
10664 /// Returns false if taking the address of the function is illegal.
10665 bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function,
10666 bool Complain = false,
10667 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation());
10668
10669 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
10670 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
10671 // R (A) --> R(A)
10672 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
10673 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
10674 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
10675 QualType ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType);
10676
10677 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
10678 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
10679 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
10680 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
10681 ///
10682 /// @code
10683 /// int f(double);
10684 /// int f(int);
10685 ///
10686 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
10687 /// @endcode
10688 ///
10689 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
10690 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
10691 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
10692 FunctionDecl *
10693 ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
10694 bool Complain, DeclAccessPair &Found,
10695 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates = nullptr);
10696
10697 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
10698 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address
10699 /// taken. This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null.
10700 ///
10701 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the
10702 /// overload set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one
10703 /// candidate that is more constrained than the rest.
10704 FunctionDecl *
10705 resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &FoundResult);
10706
10707 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded
10708 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This
10709 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and,
10710 /// if requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay.
10711 ///
10712 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails.
10713 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true.
10715 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConversion = false);
10716
10717 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
10718 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
10719 ///
10720 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
10721 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose
10722 /// template arguments are either provided by the template-id or have
10723 /// defaults, as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
10724 ///
10725 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
10726 /// returned.
10728 OverloadExpr *ovl, bool Complain = false, DeclAccessPair *Found = nullptr,
10729 TemplateSpecCandidateSet *FailedTSC = nullptr,
10730 bool ForTypeDeduction = false);
10731
10732 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
10733 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
10734 //
10735 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
10736 //
10737 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
10738 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
10739 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
10741 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConversion = false,
10742 bool Complain = false, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining = SourceRange(),
10743 QualType DestTypeForComplaining = QualType(),
10744 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining = 0);
10745
10746 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
10747 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
10748 void AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10749 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10750 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10751 bool PartialOverloading = false);
10752
10753 /// Add the call candidates from the given set of lookup results to the given
10754 /// overload set. Non-function lookup results are ignored.
10756 LookupResult &R, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10757 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet);
10758
10759 // An enum used to represent the different possible results of building a
10760 // range-based for loop.
10766
10767 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
10768 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
10769 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
10770 /// dependent lookup.
10771 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
10772 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
10773 /// is returned.
10775 SourceLocation RangeLoc,
10776 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
10777 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
10778 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10779 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr);
10780
10781 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
10782 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
10783 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
10784 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
10785 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
10786 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
10788 Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10789 MultiExprArg Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *ExecConfig,
10790 bool AllowTypoCorrection = true, bool CalleesAddressIsTaken = false);
10791
10792 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
10793 /// the given function.
10794 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
10796 MultiExprArg Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10797 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10799
10803 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
10804 bool PerformADL = true);
10805
10806 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10807 /// operator.
10808 ///
10809 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10810 ///
10811 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
10812 ///
10813 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
10814 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10815 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10816 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10817 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10818 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10819 ///
10820 /// \param Input The input argument.
10823 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *input,
10824 bool RequiresADL = true);
10825
10826 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator.
10829 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
10830 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool RequiresADL = true);
10831
10832 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10833 /// operator.
10834 ///
10835 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10836 ///
10837 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
10838 ///
10839 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
10840 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10841 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10842 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10843 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10844 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10845 ///
10846 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10847 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
10848 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL.
10849 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by
10850 /// C++20 operator rewrites.
10851 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function,
10852 /// the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in
10853 /// our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way
10854 /// comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1.
10856 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS,
10857 Expr *RHS, bool RequiresADL = true,
10858 bool AllowRewrittenCandidates = true,
10859 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn = nullptr);
10861 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
10862 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
10863 FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn);
10864
10866 SourceLocation RLoc, Expr *Base,
10867 MultiExprArg Args);
10868
10869 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10870 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10871 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10872 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10873 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
10874 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10875 /// member function.
10877 Scope *S, Expr *MemExpr, SourceLocation LParenLoc, MultiExprArg Args,
10878 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *ExecConfig = nullptr,
10879 bool IsExecConfig = false, bool AllowRecovery = false);
10880
10881 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10882 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10883 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10884 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
10886 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10887 MultiExprArg Args,
10888 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
10889
10890 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
10891 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
10892 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
10894 SourceLocation OpLoc,
10895 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound = nullptr);
10896
10899 bool HadMultipleCandidates);
10900
10901 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call
10902 /// to a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
10905 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
10906 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr);
10907
10908 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
10909 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
10910 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
10911 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
10912 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
10914 FunctionDecl *Fn);
10916 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10917 FunctionDecl *Fn);
10918
10919 /// - Returns a selector which best matches given argument list or
10920 /// nullptr if none could be found
10922 bool IsInstance,
10924
10925 ///@}
10926
10927 //
10928 //
10929 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
10930 //
10931 //
10932
10933 /// \name Statements
10934 /// Implementations are in SemaStmt.cpp
10935 ///@{
10936
10937public:
10938 /// Stack of active SEH __finally scopes. Can be empty.
10940
10941 /// Stack of '_Defer' statements that are currently being parsed, as well
10942 /// as the locations of their '_Defer' keywords. Can be empty.
10944
10945 StmtResult ActOnExprStmt(ExprResult Arg, bool DiscardedValue = true);
10947
10949 bool HasLeadingEmptyMacro = false);
10950
10952 SourceLocation EndLoc);
10954
10955 /// DiagnoseUnusedExprResult - If the statement passed in is an expression
10956 /// whose result is unused, warn.
10957 void DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(const Stmt *S, unsigned DiagID);
10958
10959 void ActOnStartOfCompoundStmt(bool IsStmtExpr);
10963 ArrayRef<Stmt *> Elts, bool isStmtExpr);
10964
10966
10969 SourceLocation DotDotDotLoc, ExprResult RHS,
10970 SourceLocation ColonLoc);
10971
10972 /// ActOnCaseStmtBody - This installs a statement as the body of a case.
10973 void ActOnCaseStmtBody(Stmt *CaseStmt, Stmt *SubStmt);
10974
10976 SourceLocation ColonLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
10977 Scope *CurScope);
10979 SourceLocation ColonLoc, Stmt *SubStmt);
10980
10982 ArrayRef<const Attr *> Attrs, Stmt *SubStmt);
10984 Stmt *SubStmt);
10985
10986 /// Check whether the given statement can have musttail applied to it,
10987 /// issuing a diagnostic and returning false if not. In the success case,
10988 /// the statement is rewritten to remove implicit nodes from the return
10989 /// value.
10990 bool checkAndRewriteMustTailAttr(Stmt *St, const Attr &MTA);
10991
10993 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Stmt *InitStmt,
10995 Stmt *ThenVal, SourceLocation ElseLoc, Stmt *ElseVal);
10997 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Stmt *InitStmt,
10999 Stmt *ThenVal, SourceLocation ElseLoc, Stmt *ElseVal);
11000
11002
11004 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Stmt *InitStmt,
11006 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
11008 Stmt *Body);
11009
11010 /// DiagnoseAssignmentEnum - Warn if assignment to enum is a constant
11011 /// integer not in the range of enum values.
11012 void DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
11013 Expr *SrcExpr);
11014
11017 Stmt *Body);
11019 SourceLocation WhileLoc, SourceLocation CondLParen,
11020 Expr *Cond, SourceLocation CondRParen);
11021
11023 Stmt *First, ConditionResult Second,
11024 FullExprArg Third, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
11025 Stmt *Body);
11026
11027 /// In an Objective C collection iteration statement:
11028 /// for (x in y)
11029 /// x can be an arbitrary l-value expression. Bind it up as a
11030 /// full-expression.
11032
11034 /// Initial building of a for-range statement.
11036 /// Instantiation or recovery rebuild of a for-range statement. Don't
11037 /// attempt any typo-correction.
11039 /// Determining whether a for-range statement could be built. Avoid any
11040 /// unnecessary or irreversible actions.
11042 };
11043
11044 /// ActOnCXXForRangeStmt - Check and build a C++11 for-range statement.
11045 ///
11046 /// C++11 [stmt.ranged]:
11047 /// A range-based for statement is equivalent to
11048 ///
11049 /// {
11050 /// auto && __range = range-init;
11051 /// for ( auto __begin = begin-expr,
11052 /// __end = end-expr;
11053 /// __begin != __end;
11054 /// ++__begin ) {
11055 /// for-range-declaration = *__begin;
11056 /// statement
11057 /// }
11058 /// }
11059 ///
11060 /// The body of the loop is not available yet, since it cannot be analysed
11061 /// until we have determined the type of the for-range-declaration.
11063 Scope *S, SourceLocation ForLoc, SourceLocation CoawaitLoc,
11064 Stmt *InitStmt, Stmt *LoopVar, SourceLocation ColonLoc, Expr *Collection,
11065 SourceLocation RParenLoc, BuildForRangeKind Kind,
11066 ArrayRef<MaterializeTemporaryExpr *> LifetimeExtendTemps = {});
11067
11068 /// BuildCXXForRangeStmt - Build or instantiate a C++11 for-range statement.
11069 StmtResult BuildCXXForRangeStmt(
11070 SourceLocation ForLoc, SourceLocation CoawaitLoc, Stmt *InitStmt,
11071 SourceLocation ColonLoc, Stmt *RangeDecl, Stmt *Begin, Stmt *End,
11072 Expr *Cond, Expr *Inc, Stmt *LoopVarDecl, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
11073 BuildForRangeKind Kind,
11074 ArrayRef<MaterializeTemporaryExpr *> LifetimeExtendTemps = {});
11075
11076 /// FinishCXXForRangeStmt - Attach the body to a C++0x for-range statement.
11077 /// This is a separate step from ActOnCXXForRangeStmt because analysis of the
11078 /// body cannot be performed until after the type of the range variable is
11079 /// determined.
11080 StmtResult FinishCXXForRangeStmt(Stmt *ForRange, Stmt *Body);
11081
11082 StmtResult ActOnGotoStmt(SourceLocation GotoLoc, SourceLocation LabelLoc,
11083 LabelDecl *TheDecl);
11084 StmtResult ActOnIndirectGotoStmt(SourceLocation GotoLoc,
11085 SourceLocation StarLoc, Expr *DestExp);
11086 StmtResult ActOnContinueStmt(SourceLocation ContinueLoc, Scope *CurScope,
11087 LabelDecl *Label, SourceLocation LabelLoc);
11088 StmtResult ActOnBreakStmt(SourceLocation BreakLoc, Scope *CurScope,
11089 LabelDecl *Label, SourceLocation LabelLoc);
11090
11091 void ActOnStartOfDeferStmt(SourceLocation DeferLoc, Scope *CurScope);
11092 void ActOnDeferStmtError(Scope *CurScope);
11093 StmtResult ActOnEndOfDeferStmt(Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope);
11094
11097
11100
11101 bool isMoveEligible() const { return S != None; };
11103 };
11105
11106 /// Determine whether the given expression might be move-eligible or
11107 /// copy-elidable in either a (co_)return statement or throw expression,
11108 /// without considering function return type, if applicable.
11109 ///
11110 /// \param E The expression being returned from the function or block,
11111 /// being thrown, or being co_returned from a coroutine. This expression
11112 /// might be modified by the implementation.
11113 ///
11114 /// \param Mode Overrides detection of current language mode
11115 /// and uses the rules for C++23.
11116 ///
11117 /// \returns An aggregate which contains the Candidate and isMoveEligible
11118 /// and isCopyElidable methods. If Candidate is non-null, it means
11119 /// isMoveEligible() would be true under the most permissive language
11120 /// standard.
11121 NamedReturnInfo getNamedReturnInfo(
11123
11124 /// Determine whether the given NRVO candidate variable is move-eligible or
11125 /// copy-elidable, without considering function return type.
11126 ///
11127 /// \param VD The NRVO candidate variable.
11128 ///
11129 /// \returns An aggregate which contains the Candidate and isMoveEligible
11130 /// and isCopyElidable methods. If Candidate is non-null, it means
11131 /// isMoveEligible() would be true under the most permissive language
11132 /// standard.
11133 NamedReturnInfo getNamedReturnInfo(const VarDecl *VD);
11134
11135 /// Updates given NamedReturnInfo's move-eligible and
11136 /// copy-elidable statuses, considering the function
11137 /// return type criteria as applicable to return statements.
11138 ///
11139 /// \param Info The NamedReturnInfo object to update.
11140 ///
11141 /// \param ReturnType This is the return type of the function.
11142 /// \returns The copy elision candidate, in case the initial return expression
11143 /// was copy elidable, or nullptr otherwise.
11144 const VarDecl *getCopyElisionCandidate(NamedReturnInfo &Info,
11145 QualType ReturnType);
11146
11147 /// Perform the initialization of a potentially-movable value, which
11148 /// is the result of return value.
11149 ///
11150 /// This routine implements C++20 [class.copy.elision]p3, which attempts to
11151 /// treat returned lvalues as rvalues in certain cases (to prefer move
11152 /// construction), then falls back to treating them as lvalues if that failed.
11155 const NamedReturnInfo &NRInfo, Expr *Value,
11156 bool SupressSimplerImplicitMoves = false);
11157
11159
11160 /// Deduce the return type for a function from a returned expression, per
11161 /// C++1y [dcl.spec.auto]p6.
11163 SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetExpr,
11164 const AutoType *AT);
11165
11166 StmtResult ActOnReturnStmt(SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetValExp,
11167 Scope *CurScope);
11168 StmtResult BuildReturnStmt(SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetValExp,
11169 bool AllowRecovery = false);
11170
11171 /// ActOnCapScopeReturnStmt - Utility routine to type-check return statements
11172 /// for capturing scopes.
11174 NamedReturnInfo &NRInfo,
11175 bool SupressSimplerImplicitMoves);
11176
11177 /// ActOnCXXCatchBlock - Takes an exception declaration and a handler block
11178 /// and creates a proper catch handler from them.
11180 Stmt *HandlerBlock);
11181
11182 /// ActOnCXXTryBlock - Takes a try compound-statement and a number of
11183 /// handlers and creates a try statement from them.
11185 ArrayRef<Stmt *> Handlers);
11186
11187 void DiagnoseExceptionUse(SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTry);
11188
11189 StmtResult ActOnSEHTryBlock(bool IsCXXTry, // try (true) or __try (false) ?
11190 SourceLocation TryLoc, Stmt *TryBlock,
11191 Stmt *Handler);
11193 Stmt *Block);
11198
11200 bool IsIfExists,
11201 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
11202 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo,
11203 Stmt *Nested);
11205 bool IsIfExists, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
11206 UnqualifiedId &Name, Stmt *Nested);
11207
11208 void ActOnCapturedRegionStart(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *CurScope,
11209 CapturedRegionKind Kind, unsigned NumParams);
11210 typedef std::pair<StringRef, QualType> CapturedParamNameType;
11211 void ActOnCapturedRegionStart(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *CurScope,
11212 CapturedRegionKind Kind,
11214 unsigned OpenMPCaptureLevel = 0);
11218 SourceLocation Loc,
11219 unsigned NumParams);
11220
11221private:
11222 /// Check whether the given statement can have musttail applied to it,
11223 /// issuing a diagnostic and returning false if not.
11224 bool checkMustTailAttr(const Stmt *St, const Attr &MTA);
11225
11226 /// Check if the given expression contains 'break' or 'continue'
11227 /// statement that produces control flow different from GCC.
11228 void CheckBreakContinueBinding(Expr *E);
11229
11230 ///@}
11231
11232 //
11233 //
11234 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
11235 //
11236 //
11237
11238 /// \name `inline asm` Statement
11239 /// Implementations are in SemaStmtAsm.cpp
11240 ///@{
11241
11242public:
11243 ExprResult ActOnGCCAsmStmtString(Expr *Stm, bool ForAsmLabel);
11244 StmtResult ActOnGCCAsmStmt(SourceLocation AsmLoc, bool IsSimple,
11245 bool IsVolatile, unsigned NumOutputs,
11246 unsigned NumInputs, IdentifierInfo **Names,
11247 MultiExprArg Constraints, MultiExprArg Exprs,
11248 Expr *AsmString, MultiExprArg Clobbers,
11249 unsigned NumLabels, SourceLocation RParenLoc);
11250
11252 llvm::InlineAsmIdentifierInfo &Info);
11254 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
11255 UnqualifiedId &Id,
11256 bool IsUnevaluatedContext);
11257 bool LookupInlineAsmField(StringRef Base, StringRef Member, unsigned &Offset,
11258 SourceLocation AsmLoc);
11260 SourceLocation AsmLoc);
11262 ArrayRef<Token> AsmToks, StringRef AsmString,
11263 unsigned NumOutputs, unsigned NumInputs,
11264 ArrayRef<StringRef> Constraints,
11265 ArrayRef<StringRef> Clobbers,
11266 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs, SourceLocation EndLoc);
11267 LabelDecl *GetOrCreateMSAsmLabel(StringRef ExternalLabelName,
11268 SourceLocation Location, bool AlwaysCreate);
11269
11270 ///@}
11271
11272 //
11273 //
11274 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
11275 //
11276 //
11277
11278 /// \name Statement Attribute Handling
11279 /// Implementations are in SemaStmtAttr.cpp
11280 ///@{
11281
11282public:
11283 bool CheckNoInlineAttr(const Stmt *OrigSt, const Stmt *CurSt,
11284 const AttributeCommonInfo &A);
11285 bool CheckAlwaysInlineAttr(const Stmt *OrigSt, const Stmt *CurSt,
11286 const AttributeCommonInfo &A);
11287
11288 CodeAlignAttr *BuildCodeAlignAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *E);
11290
11291 /// Process the attributes before creating an attributed statement. Returns
11292 /// the semantic attributes that have been processed.
11293 void ProcessStmtAttributes(Stmt *Stmt, const ParsedAttributes &InAttrs,
11295
11297 SourceRange Range);
11299 const IdentifierInfo *AttrName,
11300 SourceRange Range);
11301
11302 ///@}
11303
11304 //
11305 //
11306 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
11307 //
11308 //
11309
11310 /// \name C++ Templates
11311 /// Implementations are in SemaTemplate.cpp
11312 ///@{
11313
11314public:
11315 // Saves the current floating-point pragma stack and clear it in this Sema.
11317 public:
11319 : S(S), SavedStack(std::move(S.FpPragmaStack)) {
11320 S.FpPragmaStack.Stack.clear();
11321 }
11322 ~FpPragmaStackSaveRAII() { S.FpPragmaStack = std::move(SavedStack); }
11323
11324 private:
11325 Sema &S;
11327 };
11328
11330 CurFPFeatures = FPO;
11331 FpPragmaStack.CurrentValue = FPO.getChangesFrom(FPOptions(LangOpts));
11332 }
11333
11339
11344
11345 typedef llvm::MapVector<const FunctionDecl *,
11346 std::unique_ptr<LateParsedTemplate>>
11349
11350 /// Determine the number of levels of enclosing template parameters. This is
11351 /// only usable while parsing. Note that this does not include dependent
11352 /// contexts in which no template parameters have yet been declared, such as
11353 /// in a terse function template or generic lambda before the first 'auto' is
11354 /// encountered.
11355 unsigned getTemplateDepth(Scope *S) const;
11356
11358 bool AllowFunctionTemplates = true,
11359 bool AllowDependent = true);
11361 bool AllowFunctionTemplates = true,
11362 bool AllowDependent = true,
11363 bool AllowNonTemplateFunctions = false);
11364 /// Try to interpret the lookup result D as a template-name.
11365 ///
11366 /// \param D A declaration found by name lookup.
11367 /// \param AllowFunctionTemplates Whether function templates should be
11368 /// considered valid results.
11369 /// \param AllowDependent Whether unresolved using declarations (that might
11370 /// name templates) should be considered valid results.
11372 bool AllowFunctionTemplates = true,
11373 bool AllowDependent = true);
11374
11376 /// Whether and why a template name is required in this lookup.
11378 public:
11379 /// Template name is required if TemplateKWLoc is valid.
11381 : TemplateKW(TemplateKWLoc) {}
11382 /// Template name is unconditionally required.
11384
11386 return TemplateKW.value_or(SourceLocation());
11387 }
11388 bool hasTemplateKeyword() const {
11389 return getTemplateKeywordLoc().isValid();
11390 }
11391 bool isRequired() const { return TemplateKW != SourceLocation(); }
11392 explicit operator bool() const { return isRequired(); }
11393
11394 private:
11395 std::optional<SourceLocation> TemplateKW;
11396 };
11397
11399 /// This is not assumed to be a template name.
11401 /// This is assumed to be a template name because lookup found nothing.
11403 /// This is assumed to be a template name because lookup found one or more
11404 /// functions (but no function templates).
11406 };
11407
11408 bool
11410 QualType ObjectType, bool EnteringContext,
11411 RequiredTemplateKind RequiredTemplate = SourceLocation(),
11412 AssumedTemplateKind *ATK = nullptr,
11413 bool AllowTypoCorrection = true);
11414
11416 bool hasTemplateKeyword,
11417 const UnqualifiedId &Name,
11418 ParsedType ObjectType, bool EnteringContext,
11420 bool &MemberOfUnknownSpecialization,
11421 bool Disambiguation = false);
11422
11423 /// Try to resolve an undeclared template name as a type template.
11424 ///
11425 /// Sets II to the identifier corresponding to the template name, and updates
11426 /// Name to a corresponding (typo-corrected) type template name and TNK to
11427 /// the corresponding kind, if possible.
11429 TemplateNameKind &TNK,
11430 SourceLocation NameLoc,
11431 IdentifierInfo *&II);
11432
11433 /// Determine whether a particular identifier might be the name in a C++1z
11434 /// deduction-guide declaration.
11435 bool isDeductionGuideName(Scope *S, const IdentifierInfo &Name,
11436 SourceLocation NameLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
11437 ParsedTemplateTy *Template = nullptr);
11438
11440 SourceLocation IILoc, Scope *S,
11441 const CXXScopeSpec *SS,
11442 TemplateTy &SuggestedTemplate,
11443 TemplateNameKind &SuggestedKind);
11444
11445 /// Determine whether we would be unable to instantiate this template (because
11446 /// it either has no definition, or is in the process of being instantiated).
11448 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, NamedDecl *Instantiation,
11449 bool InstantiatedFromMember, const NamedDecl *Pattern,
11450 const NamedDecl *PatternDef, TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
11451 bool Complain = true, bool *Unreachable = nullptr);
11452
11453 /// DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow - Produce a diagnostic complaining
11454 /// that the template parameter 'PrevDecl' is being shadowed by a new
11455 /// declaration at location Loc. Returns true to indicate that this is
11456 /// an error, and false otherwise.
11457 ///
11458 /// \param Loc The location of the declaration that shadows a template
11459 /// parameter.
11460 ///
11461 /// \param PrevDecl The template parameter that the declaration shadows.
11462 ///
11463 /// \param SupportedForCompatibility Whether to issue the diagnostic as
11464 /// a warning for compatibility with older versions of clang.
11465 /// Ignored when MSVC compatibility is enabled.
11467 bool SupportedForCompatibility = false);
11468
11469 /// AdjustDeclIfTemplate - If the given decl happens to be a template, reset
11470 /// the parameter D to reference the templated declaration and return a
11471 /// pointer to the template declaration. Otherwise, do nothing to D and return
11472 /// null.
11474
11475 /// ActOnTypeParameter - Called when a C++ template type parameter
11476 /// (e.g., "typename T") has been parsed. Typename specifies whether
11477 /// the keyword "typename" was used to declare the type parameter
11478 /// (otherwise, "class" was used), and KeyLoc is the location of the
11479 /// "class" or "typename" keyword. ParamName is the name of the
11480 /// parameter (NULL indicates an unnamed template parameter) and
11481 /// ParamNameLoc is the location of the parameter name (if any).
11482 /// If the type parameter has a default argument, it will be added
11483 /// later via ActOnTypeParameterDefault.
11485 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
11486 SourceLocation KeyLoc,
11487 IdentifierInfo *ParamName,
11488 SourceLocation ParamNameLoc, unsigned Depth,
11489 unsigned Position, SourceLocation EqualLoc,
11490 ParsedType DefaultArg, bool HasTypeConstraint);
11491
11493
11494 bool ActOnTypeConstraint(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
11496 TemplateTypeParmDecl *ConstrainedParameter,
11497 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
11498 bool BuildTypeConstraint(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
11500 TemplateTypeParmDecl *ConstrainedParameter,
11501 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
11502 bool AllowUnexpandedPack);
11503
11504 /// Attach a type-constraint to a template parameter.
11505 /// \returns true if an error occurred. This can happen if the
11506 /// immediately-declared constraint could not be formed (e.g. incorrect number
11507 /// of arguments for the named concept).
11509 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo,
11510 TemplateDecl *NamedConcept, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
11511 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
11512 TemplateTypeParmDecl *ConstrainedParameter,
11513 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
11514
11516 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NewConstrainedParm,
11517 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *OrigConstrainedParm,
11518 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
11519
11520 /// Require the given type to be a structural type, and diagnose if it is not.
11521 ///
11522 /// \return \c true if an error was produced.
11524
11525 /// Check that the type of a non-type template parameter is
11526 /// well-formed.
11527 ///
11528 /// \returns the (possibly-promoted) parameter type if valid;
11529 /// otherwise, produces a diagnostic and returns a NULL type.
11531 SourceLocation Loc);
11533
11535 unsigned Depth, unsigned Position,
11536 SourceLocation EqualLoc,
11537 Expr *DefaultArg);
11538
11539 /// ActOnTemplateTemplateParameter - Called when a C++ template template
11540 /// parameter (e.g. T in template <template <typename> class T> class array)
11541 /// has been parsed. S is the current scope.
11543 Scope *S, SourceLocation TmpLoc, TemplateNameKind Kind,
11544 bool TypenameKeyword, TemplateParameterList *Params,
11545 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, IdentifierInfo *ParamName,
11546 SourceLocation ParamNameLoc, unsigned Depth, unsigned Position,
11547 SourceLocation EqualLoc, ParsedTemplateArgument DefaultArg);
11548
11549 /// ActOnTemplateParameterList - Builds a TemplateParameterList, optionally
11550 /// constrained by RequiresClause, that contains the template parameters in
11551 /// Params.
11553 unsigned Depth, SourceLocation ExportLoc, SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
11554 SourceLocation LAngleLoc, ArrayRef<NamedDecl *> Params,
11555 SourceLocation RAngleLoc, Expr *RequiresClause);
11556
11557 /// The context in which we are checking a template parameter list.
11559 // For this context, Class, Variable, TypeAlias, and non-pack Template
11560 // Template Parameters are treated uniformly.
11562
11569 };
11570
11571 /// Checks the validity of a template parameter list, possibly
11572 /// considering the template parameter list from a previous
11573 /// declaration.
11574 ///
11575 /// If an "old" template parameter list is provided, it must be
11576 /// equivalent (per TemplateParameterListsAreEqual) to the "new"
11577 /// template parameter list.
11578 ///
11579 /// \param NewParams Template parameter list for a new template
11580 /// declaration. This template parameter list will be updated with any
11581 /// default arguments that are carried through from the previous
11582 /// template parameter list.
11583 ///
11584 /// \param OldParams If provided, template parameter list from a
11585 /// previous declaration of the same template. Default template
11586 /// arguments will be merged from the old template parameter list to
11587 /// the new template parameter list.
11588 ///
11589 /// \param TPC Describes the context in which we are checking the given
11590 /// template parameter list.
11591 ///
11592 /// \param SkipBody If we might have already made a prior merged definition
11593 /// of this template visible, the corresponding body-skipping information.
11594 /// Default argument redefinition is not an error when skipping such a body,
11595 /// because (under the ODR) we can assume the default arguments are the same
11596 /// as the prior merged definition.
11597 ///
11598 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
11600 TemplateParameterList *OldParams,
11602 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody = nullptr);
11603
11604 /// Match the given template parameter lists to the given scope
11605 /// specifier, returning the template parameter list that applies to the
11606 /// name.
11607 ///
11608 /// \param DeclStartLoc the start of the declaration that has a scope
11609 /// specifier or a template parameter list.
11610 ///
11611 /// \param DeclLoc The location of the declaration itself.
11612 ///
11613 /// \param SS the scope specifier that will be matched to the given template
11614 /// parameter lists. This scope specifier precedes a qualified name that is
11615 /// being declared.
11616 ///
11617 /// \param TemplateId The template-id following the scope specifier, if there
11618 /// is one. Used to check for a missing 'template<>'.
11619 ///
11620 /// \param ParamLists the template parameter lists, from the outermost to the
11621 /// innermost template parameter lists.
11622 ///
11623 /// \param IsFriend Whether to apply the slightly different rules for
11624 /// matching template parameters to scope specifiers in friend
11625 /// declarations.
11626 ///
11627 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization will be set true if the scope specifier
11628 /// denotes a fully-specialized type, and therefore this is a declaration of
11629 /// a member specialization.
11630 ///
11631 /// \returns the template parameter list, if any, that corresponds to the
11632 /// name that is preceded by the scope specifier @p SS. This template
11633 /// parameter list may have template parameters (if we're declaring a
11634 /// template) or may have no template parameters (if we're declaring a
11635 /// template specialization), or may be NULL (if what we're declaring isn't
11636 /// itself a template).
11638 SourceLocation DeclStartLoc, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
11639 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId,
11640 ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *> ParamLists, bool IsFriend,
11641 bool &IsMemberSpecialization, bool &Invalid,
11642 bool SuppressDiagnostic = false);
11643
11644 /// Returns the template parameter list with all default template argument
11645 /// information.
11647
11649 Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, SourceLocation KWLoc,
11650 CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
11651 const ParsedAttributesView &Attr, TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams,
11652 AccessSpecifier AS, SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc,
11653 SourceLocation FriendLoc, unsigned NumOuterTemplateParamLists,
11654 TemplateParameterList **OuterTemplateParamLists,
11655 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody = nullptr);
11656
11657 /// Translates template arguments as provided by the parser
11658 /// into template arguments used by semantic analysis.
11661
11662 /// Convert a parsed type into a parsed template argument. This is mostly
11663 /// trivial, except that we may have parsed a C++17 deduced class template
11664 /// specialization type, in which case we should form a template template
11665 /// argument instead of a type template argument.
11667
11669
11672 SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
11673 TemplateArgumentListInfo &TemplateArgs,
11674 Scope *Scope, bool ForNestedNameSpecifier);
11675
11677 ActOnTemplateIdType(Scope *S, ElaboratedTypeKeyword ElaboratedKeyword,
11678 SourceLocation ElaboratedKeywordLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
11679 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, TemplateTy Template,
11680 const IdentifierInfo *TemplateII,
11681 SourceLocation TemplateIILoc, SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
11682 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgs, SourceLocation RAngleLoc,
11683 bool IsCtorOrDtorName = false, bool IsClassName = false,
11684 ImplicitTypenameContext AllowImplicitTypename =
11686
11687 /// Parsed an elaborated-type-specifier that refers to a template-id,
11688 /// such as \c class T::template apply<U>.
11690 TagUseKind TUK, TypeSpecifierType TagSpec, SourceLocation TagLoc,
11691 CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, TemplateTy TemplateD,
11692 SourceLocation TemplateLoc, SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
11693 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsIn, SourceLocation RAngleLoc);
11694
11697 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams,
11699
11700 /// Get the specialization of the given variable template corresponding to
11701 /// the specified argument list, or a null-but-valid result if the arguments
11702 /// are dependent.
11704 SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
11705 SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc,
11706 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &TemplateArgs,
11707 bool SetWrittenArgs);
11708
11709 /// Form a reference to the specialization of the given variable template
11710 /// corresponding to the specified argument list, or a null-but-valid result
11711 /// if the arguments are dependent.
11713 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11715 SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
11716 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs);
11717
11719 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11721 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs);
11722
11724 CheckConceptTemplateId(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
11725 const DeclarationNameInfo &ConceptNameInfo,
11726 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, TemplateDecl *NamedConcept,
11727 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
11728 bool DoCheckConstraintSatisfaction = true);
11729
11732 bool TemplateKeyword, TemplateDecl *TD,
11733 SourceLocation Loc);
11734
11736 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, LookupResult &R,
11737 bool RequiresADL,
11738 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs);
11739
11740 // We actually only call this from template instantiation.
11743 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11744 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
11745 bool IsAddressOfOperand);
11746
11748 return Pack.pack_size() - 1 - *ArgPackSubstIndex;
11749 }
11750
11753 Arg = Arg.pack_elements()[*ArgPackSubstIndex];
11754 if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
11755 Arg = Arg.getPackExpansionPattern();
11756 return Arg;
11757 }
11758
11760 Decl *AssociatedDecl, const NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP,
11761 SourceLocation loc, TemplateArgument Replacement,
11762 UnsignedOrNone PackIndex, bool Final);
11763
11764 /// Form a template name from a name that is syntactically required to name a
11765 /// template, either due to use of the 'template' keyword or because a name in
11766 /// this syntactic context is assumed to name a template (C++
11767 /// [temp.names]p2-4).
11768 ///
11769 /// This action forms a template name given the name of the template and its
11770 /// optional scope specifier. This is used when the 'template' keyword is used
11771 /// or when the parsing context unambiguously treats a following '<' as
11772 /// introducing a template argument list. Note that this may produce a
11773 /// non-dependent template name if we can perform the lookup now and identify
11774 /// the named template.
11775 ///
11776 /// For example, given "x.MetaFun::template apply", the scope specifier
11777 /// \p SS will be "MetaFun::", \p TemplateKWLoc contains the location
11778 /// of the "template" keyword, and "apply" is the \p Name.
11780 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
11781 const UnqualifiedId &Name,
11782 ParsedType ObjectType,
11783 bool EnteringContext, TemplateTy &Template,
11784 bool AllowInjectedClassName = false);
11785
11787 Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, SourceLocation KWLoc,
11788 SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
11790 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
11791 SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody = nullptr);
11792
11793 /// Check the non-type template arguments of a class template
11794 /// partial specialization according to C++ [temp.class.spec]p9.
11795 ///
11796 /// \param TemplateNameLoc the location of the template name.
11797 /// \param PrimaryTemplate the template parameters of the primary class
11798 /// template.
11799 /// \param NumExplicit the number of explicitly-specified template arguments.
11800 /// \param TemplateArgs the template arguments of the class template
11801 /// partial specialization.
11802 ///
11803 /// \returns \c true if there was an error, \c false otherwise.
11805 TemplateDecl *PrimaryTemplate,
11806 unsigned NumExplicitArgs,
11812
11814 MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
11815 Declarator &D);
11816
11817 /// Diagnose cases where we have an explicit template specialization
11818 /// before/after an explicit template instantiation, producing diagnostics
11819 /// for those cases where they are required and determining whether the
11820 /// new specialization/instantiation will have any effect.
11821 ///
11822 /// \param NewLoc the location of the new explicit specialization or
11823 /// instantiation.
11824 ///
11825 /// \param NewTSK the kind of the new explicit specialization or
11826 /// instantiation.
11827 ///
11828 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration of the entity.
11829 ///
11830 /// \param PrevTSK the kind of the old explicit specialization or
11831 /// instantiatin.
11832 ///
11833 /// \param PrevPointOfInstantiation if valid, indicates where the previous
11834 /// declaration was instantiated (either implicitly or explicitly).
11835 ///
11836 /// \param HasNoEffect will be set to true to indicate that the new
11837 /// specialization or instantiation has no effect and should be ignored.
11838 ///
11839 /// \returns true if there was an error that should prevent the introduction
11840 /// of the new declaration into the AST, false otherwise.
11842 SourceLocation NewLoc,
11843 TemplateSpecializationKind ActOnExplicitInstantiationNewTSK,
11844 NamedDecl *PrevDecl, TemplateSpecializationKind PrevTSK,
11845 SourceLocation PrevPtOfInstantiation, bool &SuppressNew);
11846
11847 /// Perform semantic analysis for the given dependent function
11848 /// template specialization.
11849 ///
11850 /// The only possible way to get a dependent function template specialization
11851 /// is with a friend declaration, like so:
11852 ///
11853 /// \code
11854 /// template <class T> void foo(T);
11855 /// template <class T> class A {
11856 /// friend void foo<>(T);
11857 /// };
11858 /// \endcode
11859 ///
11860 /// There really isn't any useful analysis we can do here, so we
11861 /// just store the information.
11863 FunctionDecl *FD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
11865
11866 /// Perform semantic analysis for the given function template
11867 /// specialization.
11868 ///
11869 /// This routine performs all of the semantic analysis required for an
11870 /// explicit function template specialization. On successful completion,
11871 /// the function declaration \p FD will become a function template
11872 /// specialization.
11873 ///
11874 /// \param FD the function declaration, which will be updated to become a
11875 /// function template specialization.
11876 ///
11877 /// \param ExplicitTemplateArgs the explicitly-provided template arguments,
11878 /// if any. Note that this may be valid info even when 0 arguments are
11879 /// explicitly provided as in, e.g., \c void sort<>(char*, char*);
11880 /// as it anyway contains info on the angle brackets locations.
11881 ///
11882 /// \param Previous the set of declarations that may be specialized by
11883 /// this function specialization.
11884 ///
11885 /// \param QualifiedFriend whether this is a lookup for a qualified friend
11886 /// declaration with no explicit template argument list that might be
11887 /// befriending a function template specialization.
11889 FunctionDecl *FD, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
11890 LookupResult &Previous, bool QualifiedFriend = false);
11891
11892 /// Perform semantic analysis for the given non-template member
11893 /// specialization.
11894 ///
11895 /// This routine performs all of the semantic analysis required for an
11896 /// explicit member function specialization. On successful completion,
11897 /// the function declaration \p FD will become a member function
11898 /// specialization.
11899 ///
11900 /// \param Member the member declaration, which will be updated to become a
11901 /// specialization.
11902 ///
11903 /// \param Previous the set of declarations, one of which may be specialized
11904 /// by this function specialization; the set will be modified to contain the
11905 /// redeclared member.
11908
11909 // Explicit instantiation of a class template specialization
11911 Scope *S, SourceLocation ExternLoc, SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
11912 unsigned TagSpec, SourceLocation KWLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
11913 TemplateTy Template, SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc,
11914 SourceLocation LAngleLoc, ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgs,
11915 SourceLocation RAngleLoc, const ParsedAttributesView &Attr);
11916
11917 // Explicit instantiation of a member class of a class template.
11919 SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
11920 unsigned TagSpec, SourceLocation KWLoc,
11921 CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *Name,
11922 SourceLocation NameLoc,
11923 const ParsedAttributesView &Attr);
11924
11926 SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
11927 Declarator &D);
11928
11929 /// If the given template parameter has a default template
11930 /// argument, substitute into that default template argument and
11931 /// return the corresponding template argument.
11933 TemplateDecl *Template, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
11934 SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc, SourceLocation RAngleLoc, Decl *Param,
11935 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> SugaredConverted,
11936 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> CanonicalConverted, bool &HasDefaultArg);
11937
11938 /// Returns the top most location responsible for the definition of \p N.
11939 /// If \p N is a a template specialization, this is the location
11940 /// of the top of the instantiation stack.
11941 /// Otherwise, the location of \p N is returned.
11943
11944 /// Specifies the context in which a particular template
11945 /// argument is being checked.
11947 /// The template argument was specified in the code or was
11948 /// instantiated with some deduced template arguments.
11950
11951 /// The template argument was deduced via template argument
11952 /// deduction.
11954
11955 /// The template argument was deduced from an array bound
11956 /// via template argument deduction.
11958 };
11959
11967
11968 /// The checked, converted argument will be added to the
11969 /// end of these vectors.
11971
11972 /// The check is being performed in the context of partial ordering.
11974
11975 /// If true, assume these template arguments are
11976 /// the injected template arguments for a template template parameter.
11977 /// This will relax the requirement that all its possible uses are valid:
11978 /// TTP checking is loose, and assumes that invalid uses will be diagnosed
11979 /// during instantiation.
11981
11982 /// Is set to true when, in the context of TTP matching, a pack parameter
11983 /// matches non-pack arguments.
11984 bool StrictPackMatch = false;
11985 };
11986
11987 /// Check that the given template argument corresponds to the given
11988 /// template parameter.
11989 ///
11990 /// \param Param The template parameter against which the argument will be
11991 /// checked.
11992 ///
11993 /// \param Arg The template argument, which may be updated due to conversions.
11994 ///
11995 /// \param Template The template in which the template argument resides.
11996 ///
11997 /// \param TemplateLoc The location of the template name for the template
11998 /// whose argument list we're matching.
11999 ///
12000 /// \param RAngleLoc The location of the right angle bracket ('>') that closes
12001 /// the template argument list.
12002 ///
12003 /// \param ArgumentPackIndex The index into the argument pack where this
12004 /// argument will be placed. Only valid if the parameter is a parameter pack.
12005 ///
12006 /// \param CTAK Describes how we arrived at this particular template argument:
12007 /// explicitly written, deduced, etc.
12008 ///
12009 /// \returns true on error, false otherwise.
12011 NamedDecl *Template, SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
12012 SourceLocation RAngleLoc,
12013 unsigned ArgumentPackIndex,
12016
12017 /// Check that the given template arguments can be provided to
12018 /// the given template, converting the arguments along the way.
12019 ///
12020 /// \param Template The template to which the template arguments are being
12021 /// provided.
12022 ///
12023 /// \param TemplateLoc The location of the template name in the source.
12024 ///
12025 /// \param TemplateArgs The list of template arguments. If the template is
12026 /// a template template parameter, this function may extend the set of
12027 /// template arguments to also include substituted, defaulted template
12028 /// arguments.
12029 ///
12030 /// \param PartialTemplateArgs True if the list of template arguments is
12031 /// intentionally partial, e.g., because we're checking just the initial
12032 /// set of template arguments.
12033 ///
12034 /// \param Converted Will receive the converted, canonicalized template
12035 /// arguments.
12036 ///
12037 /// \param UpdateArgsWithConversions If \c true, update \p TemplateArgs to
12038 /// contain the converted forms of the template arguments as written.
12039 /// Otherwise, \p TemplateArgs will not be modified.
12040 ///
12041 /// \param ConstraintsNotSatisfied If provided, and an error occurred, will
12042 /// receive true if the cause for the error is the associated constraints of
12043 /// the template not being satisfied by the template arguments.
12044 ///
12045 /// \param DefaultArgs any default arguments from template specialization
12046 /// deduction.
12047 ///
12048 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
12050 SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
12051 TemplateArgumentListInfo &TemplateArgs,
12052 const DefaultArguments &DefaultArgs,
12053 bool PartialTemplateArgs,
12055 bool UpdateArgsWithConversions = true,
12056 bool *ConstraintsNotSatisfied = nullptr);
12057
12060 SourceLocation TemplateLoc, TemplateArgumentListInfo &TemplateArgs,
12061 const DefaultArguments &DefaultArgs, bool PartialTemplateArgs,
12062 CheckTemplateArgumentInfo &CTAI, bool UpdateArgsWithConversions = true,
12063 bool *ConstraintsNotSatisfied = nullptr);
12064
12067 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &SugaredConverted,
12068 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &CanonicalConverted);
12069
12070 /// Check a template argument against its corresponding
12071 /// template type parameter.
12072 ///
12073 /// This routine implements the semantics of C++ [temp.arg.type]. It
12074 /// returns true if an error occurred, and false otherwise.
12076
12077 /// Check a template argument against its corresponding
12078 /// non-type template parameter.
12079 ///
12080 /// This routine implements the semantics of C++ [temp.arg.nontype].
12081 /// If an error occurred, it returns ExprError(); otherwise, it
12082 /// returns the converted template argument. \p ParamType is the
12083 /// type of the non-type template parameter after it has been instantiated.
12085 QualType InstantiatedParamType, Expr *Arg,
12086 TemplateArgument &SugaredConverted,
12087 TemplateArgument &CanonicalConverted,
12088 bool StrictCheck,
12090
12091 /// Check a template argument against its corresponding
12092 /// template template parameter.
12093 ///
12094 /// This routine implements the semantics of C++ [temp.arg.template].
12095 /// It returns true if an error occurred, and false otherwise.
12097 TemplateParameterList *Params,
12099 bool PartialOrdering,
12100 bool *StrictPackMatch);
12101
12104 const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg);
12105
12107 std::optional<SourceRange> ParamRange = {});
12109
12110 /// Given a non-type template argument that refers to a
12111 /// declaration and the type of its corresponding non-type template
12112 /// parameter, produce an expression that properly refers to that
12113 /// declaration.
12114 /// FIXME: This is used in some contexts where the resulting expression
12115 /// doesn't need to live too long. It would be useful if this function
12116 /// could return a temporary expression.
12118 const TemplateArgument &Arg, QualType ParamType, SourceLocation Loc,
12119 NamedDecl *TemplateParam = nullptr);
12122 SourceLocation Loc);
12123
12124 /// Enumeration describing how template parameter lists are compared
12125 /// for equality.
12127 /// We are matching the template parameter lists of two templates
12128 /// that might be redeclarations.
12129 ///
12130 /// \code
12131 /// template<typename T> struct X;
12132 /// template<typename T> struct X;
12133 /// \endcode
12135
12136 /// We are matching the template parameter lists of two template
12137 /// template parameters as part of matching the template parameter lists
12138 /// of two templates that might be redeclarations.
12139 ///
12140 /// \code
12141 /// template<template<int I> class TT> struct X;
12142 /// template<template<int Value> class Other> struct X;
12143 /// \endcode
12145
12146 /// We are determining whether the template-parameters are equivalent
12147 /// according to C++ [temp.over.link]/6. This comparison does not consider
12148 /// constraints.
12149 ///
12150 /// \code
12151 /// template<C1 T> void f(T);
12152 /// template<C2 T> void f(T);
12153 /// \endcode
12155 };
12156
12157 // A struct to represent the 'new' declaration, which is either itself just
12158 // the named decl, or the important information we need about it in order to
12159 // do constraint comparisons.
12161 const NamedDecl *ND = nullptr;
12162 const DeclContext *DC = nullptr;
12163 const DeclContext *LexicalDC = nullptr;
12164 SourceLocation Loc;
12165
12166 public:
12169 const DeclContext *LexicalDeclCtx,
12170 SourceLocation Loc)
12171
12172 : DC(DeclCtx), LexicalDC(LexicalDeclCtx), Loc(Loc) {
12173 assert(DC && LexicalDC &&
12174 "Constructor only for cases where we have the information to put "
12175 "in here");
12176 }
12177
12178 // If this was constructed with no information, we cannot do substitution
12179 // for constraint comparison, so make sure we can check that.
12180 bool isInvalid() const { return !ND && !DC; }
12181
12182 const NamedDecl *getDecl() const { return ND; }
12183
12184 bool ContainsDecl(const NamedDecl *ND) const { return this->ND == ND; }
12185
12187 return ND ? ND->getLexicalDeclContext() : LexicalDC;
12188 }
12189
12191 return ND ? ND->getDeclContext() : DC;
12192 }
12193
12194 SourceLocation getLocation() const { return ND ? ND->getLocation() : Loc; }
12195 };
12196
12197 /// Determine whether the given template parameter lists are
12198 /// equivalent.
12199 ///
12200 /// \param New The new template parameter list, typically written in the
12201 /// source code as part of a new template declaration.
12202 ///
12203 /// \param Old The old template parameter list, typically found via
12204 /// name lookup of the template declared with this template parameter
12205 /// list.
12206 ///
12207 /// \param Complain If true, this routine will produce a diagnostic if
12208 /// the template parameter lists are not equivalent.
12209 ///
12210 /// \param Kind describes how we are to match the template parameter lists.
12211 ///
12212 /// \param TemplateArgLoc If this source location is valid, then we
12213 /// are actually checking the template parameter list of a template
12214 /// argument (New) against the template parameter list of its
12215 /// corresponding template template parameter (Old). We produce
12216 /// slightly different diagnostics in this scenario.
12217 ///
12218 /// \returns True if the template parameter lists are equal, false
12219 /// otherwise.
12221 const TemplateCompareNewDeclInfo &NewInstFrom, TemplateParameterList *New,
12222 const NamedDecl *OldInstFrom, TemplateParameterList *Old, bool Complain,
12224 SourceLocation TemplateArgLoc = SourceLocation());
12225
12227 TemplateParameterList *New, TemplateParameterList *Old, bool Complain,
12229 SourceLocation TemplateArgLoc = SourceLocation()) {
12230 return TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(nullptr, New, nullptr, Old, Complain,
12231 Kind, TemplateArgLoc);
12232 }
12233
12234 /// Check whether a template can be declared within this scope.
12235 ///
12236 /// If the template declaration is valid in this scope, returns
12237 /// false. Otherwise, issues a diagnostic and returns true.
12238 bool CheckTemplateDeclScope(Scope *S, TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams);
12239
12240 /// Called when the parser has parsed a C++ typename
12241 /// specifier, e.g., "typename T::type".
12242 ///
12243 /// \param S The scope in which this typename type occurs.
12244 /// \param TypenameLoc the location of the 'typename' keyword
12245 /// \param SS the nested-name-specifier following the typename (e.g., 'T::').
12246 /// \param II the identifier we're retrieving (e.g., 'type' in the example).
12247 /// \param IdLoc the location of the identifier.
12248 /// \param IsImplicitTypename context where T::type refers to a type.
12250 Scope *S, SourceLocation TypenameLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
12251 const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation IdLoc,
12253
12254 /// Called when the parser has parsed a C++ typename
12255 /// specifier that ends in a template-id, e.g.,
12256 /// "typename MetaFun::template apply<T1, T2>".
12257 ///
12258 /// \param S The scope in which this typename type occurs.
12259 /// \param TypenameLoc the location of the 'typename' keyword
12260 /// \param SS the nested-name-specifier following the typename (e.g., 'T::').
12261 /// \param TemplateLoc the location of the 'template' keyword, if any.
12262 /// \param TemplateName The template name.
12263 /// \param TemplateII The identifier used to name the template.
12264 /// \param TemplateIILoc The location of the template name.
12265 /// \param LAngleLoc The location of the opening angle bracket ('<').
12266 /// \param TemplateArgs The template arguments.
12267 /// \param RAngleLoc The location of the closing angle bracket ('>').
12269 ActOnTypenameType(Scope *S, SourceLocation TypenameLoc,
12270 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateLoc,
12271 TemplateTy TemplateName, const IdentifierInfo *TemplateII,
12272 SourceLocation TemplateIILoc, SourceLocation LAngleLoc,
12273 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgs, SourceLocation RAngleLoc);
12274
12276 SourceLocation KeywordLoc,
12277 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
12278 const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation IILoc,
12279 TypeSourceInfo **TSI, bool DeducedTSTContext);
12280
12282 SourceLocation KeywordLoc,
12283 NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc,
12284 const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation IILoc,
12285 bool DeducedTSTContext = true);
12286
12287 /// Rebuilds a type within the context of the current instantiation.
12288 ///
12289 /// The type \p T is part of the type of an out-of-line member definition of
12290 /// a class template (or class template partial specialization) that was
12291 /// parsed and constructed before we entered the scope of the class template
12292 /// (or partial specialization thereof). This routine will rebuild that type
12293 /// now that we have entered the declarator's scope, which may produce
12294 /// different canonical types, e.g.,
12295 ///
12296 /// \code
12297 /// template<typename T>
12298 /// struct X {
12299 /// typedef T* pointer;
12300 /// pointer data();
12301 /// };
12302 ///
12303 /// template<typename T>
12304 /// typename X<T>::pointer X<T>::data() { ... }
12305 /// \endcode
12306 ///
12307 /// Here, the type "typename X<T>::pointer" will be created as a
12308 /// DependentNameType, since we do not know that we can look into X<T> when we
12309 /// parsed the type. This function will rebuild the type, performing the
12310 /// lookup of "pointer" in X<T> and returning an ElaboratedType whose
12311 /// canonical type is the same as the canonical type of T*, allowing the
12312 /// return types of the out-of-line definition and the declaration to match.
12314 SourceLocation Loc,
12315 DeclarationName Name);
12317
12319
12320 /// Rebuild the template parameters now that we know we're in a current
12321 /// instantiation.
12322 bool
12324
12325 /// Produces a formatted string that describes the binding of
12326 /// template parameters to template arguments.
12327 std::string
12329 const TemplateArgumentList &Args);
12330
12331 std::string
12333 const TemplateArgument *Args,
12334 unsigned NumArgs);
12335
12339
12340 /// ActOnDependentIdExpression - Handle a dependent id-expression that
12341 /// was just parsed. This is only possible with an explicit scope
12342 /// specifier naming a dependent type.
12344 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
12345 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, bool isAddressOfOperand,
12346 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs);
12347
12350 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
12351 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
12352 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs);
12353
12354 // Calculates whether the expression Constraint depends on an enclosing
12355 // template, for the purposes of [temp.friend] p9.
12356 // TemplateDepth is the 'depth' of the friend function, which is used to
12357 // compare whether a declaration reference is referring to a containing
12358 // template, or just the current friend function. A 'lower' TemplateDepth in
12359 // the AST refers to a 'containing' template. As the constraint is
12360 // uninstantiated, this is relative to the 'top' of the TU.
12361 bool
12363 unsigned TemplateDepth,
12364 const Expr *Constraint);
12365
12366 /// Find the failed Boolean condition within a given Boolean
12367 /// constant expression, and describe it with a string.
12368 std::pair<Expr *, std::string> findFailedBooleanCondition(Expr *Cond);
12369
12371
12373 Scope *S, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
12374 const IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc);
12375
12377 Expr *ConstraintExpr,
12378 const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs);
12379
12381 bool &AddToScope);
12383
12384 TypeResult ActOnDependentTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK,
12385 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
12386 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
12387 SourceLocation TagLoc, SourceLocation NameLoc);
12388
12390 CachedTokens &Toks);
12393
12394 /// We've found a use of a templated declaration that would trigger an
12395 /// implicit instantiation. Check that any relevant explicit specializations
12396 /// and partial specializations are visible/reachable, and diagnose if not.
12399
12400 ///@}
12401
12402 //
12403 //
12404 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
12405 //
12406 //
12407
12408 /// \name C++ Template Argument Deduction
12409 /// Implementations are in SemaTemplateDeduction.cpp
12410 ///@{
12411
12412public:
12413 class SFINAETrap;
12414
12417 : S(S), Prev(std::exchange(S.CurrentSFINAEContext, Cur)) {}
12418
12419 protected:
12421 ~SFINAEContextBase() { S.CurrentSFINAEContext = Prev; }
12422
12423 private:
12424 SFINAETrap *Prev;
12425 };
12426
12430
12431 /// RAII class used to determine whether SFINAE has
12432 /// trapped any errors that occur during template argument
12433 /// deduction.
12434 class SFINAETrap : SFINAEContextBase {
12435 bool HasErrorOcurred = false;
12436 bool WithAccessChecking = false;
12437 bool PrevLastDiagnosticIgnored =
12438 S.getDiagnostics().isLastDiagnosticIgnored();
12439 sema::TemplateDeductionInfo *DeductionInfo = nullptr;
12440
12441 SFINAETrap(Sema &S, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo *Info,
12442 bool WithAccessChecking)
12443 : SFINAEContextBase(S, this), WithAccessChecking(WithAccessChecking),
12444 DeductionInfo(Info) {}
12445
12446 public:
12447 /// \param WithAccessChecking If true, discard all diagnostics (from the
12448 /// immediate context) instead of adding them to the currently active
12449 /// \ref TemplateDeductionInfo.
12450 explicit SFINAETrap(Sema &S, bool WithAccessChecking = false)
12451 : SFINAETrap(S, /*Info=*/nullptr, WithAccessChecking) {}
12452
12454 : SFINAETrap(S, &Info, /*WithAccessChecking=*/false) {}
12455
12457 S.getDiagnostics().setLastDiagnosticIgnored(PrevLastDiagnosticIgnored);
12458 }
12459
12460 SFINAETrap(const SFINAETrap &) = delete;
12461 SFINAETrap &operator=(const SFINAETrap &) = delete;
12462
12464 return DeductionInfo;
12465 }
12466
12467 /// Determine whether any SFINAE errors have been trapped.
12468 bool hasErrorOccurred() const { return HasErrorOcurred; }
12469 void setErrorOccurred() { HasErrorOcurred = true; }
12470
12471 bool withAccessChecking() const { return WithAccessChecking; }
12472 };
12473
12474 /// RAII class used to indicate that we are performing provisional
12475 /// semantic analysis to determine the validity of a construct, so
12476 /// typo-correction and diagnostics in the immediate context (not within
12477 /// implicitly-instantiated templates) should be suppressed.
12479 Sema &SemaRef;
12480 // FIXME: Using a SFINAETrap for this is a hack.
12481 SFINAETrap Trap;
12482 bool PrevDisableTypoCorrection;
12483
12484 public:
12485 explicit TentativeAnalysisScope(Sema &SemaRef)
12486 : SemaRef(SemaRef), Trap(SemaRef, /*ForValidityCheck=*/true),
12487 PrevDisableTypoCorrection(SemaRef.DisableTypoCorrection) {
12488 SemaRef.DisableTypoCorrection = true;
12489 }
12491 SemaRef.DisableTypoCorrection = PrevDisableTypoCorrection;
12492 }
12493 };
12494
12495 /// For each declaration that involved template argument deduction, the
12496 /// set of diagnostics that were suppressed during that template argument
12497 /// deduction.
12498 ///
12499 /// FIXME: Serialize this structure to the AST file.
12500 typedef llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1>>
12503
12504 /// Compare types for equality with respect to possibly compatible
12505 /// function types (noreturn adjustment, implicit calling conventions). If any
12506 /// of parameter and argument is not a function, just perform type comparison.
12507 ///
12508 /// \param P the template parameter type.
12509 ///
12510 /// \param A the argument type.
12512
12513 /// Allocate a TemplateArgumentLoc where all locations have
12514 /// been initialized to the given location.
12515 ///
12516 /// \param Arg The template argument we are producing template argument
12517 /// location information for.
12518 ///
12519 /// \param NTTPType For a declaration template argument, the type of
12520 /// the non-type template parameter that corresponds to this template
12521 /// argument. Can be null if no type sugar is available to add to the
12522 /// type from the template argument.
12523 ///
12524 /// \param Loc The source location to use for the resulting template
12525 /// argument.
12528 SourceLocation Loc,
12529 NamedDecl *TemplateParam = nullptr);
12530
12531 /// Get a template argument mapping the given template parameter to itself,
12532 /// e.g. for X in \c template<int X>, this would return an expression template
12533 /// argument referencing X.
12535 SourceLocation Location);
12536
12537 /// Adjust the type \p ArgFunctionType to match the calling convention,
12538 /// noreturn, and optionally the exception specification of \p FunctionType.
12539 /// Deduction often wants to ignore these properties when matching function
12540 /// types.
12542 bool AdjustExceptionSpec = false);
12543
12546 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
12548
12551 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
12553
12554 /// Deduce the template arguments of the given template from \p FromType.
12555 /// Used to implement the IsDeducible constraint for alias CTAD per C++
12556 /// [over.match.class.deduct]p4.
12557 ///
12558 /// It only supports class or type alias templates.
12562
12567 bool NumberOfArgumentsMustMatch);
12568
12569 /// Substitute the explicitly-provided template arguments into the
12570 /// given function template according to C++ [temp.arg.explicit].
12571 ///
12572 /// \param FunctionTemplate the function template into which the explicit
12573 /// template arguments will be substituted.
12574 ///
12575 /// \param ExplicitTemplateArgs the explicitly-specified template
12576 /// arguments.
12577 ///
12578 /// \param Deduced the deduced template arguments, which will be populated
12579 /// with the converted and checked explicit template arguments.
12580 ///
12581 /// \param ParamTypes will be populated with the instantiated function
12582 /// parameters.
12583 ///
12584 /// \param FunctionType if non-NULL, the result type of the function template
12585 /// will also be instantiated and the pointed-to value will be updated with
12586 /// the instantiated function type.
12587 ///
12588 /// \param Info if substitution fails for any reason, this object will be
12589 /// populated with more information about the failure.
12590 ///
12591 /// \returns TemplateDeductionResult::Success if substitution was successful,
12592 /// or some failure condition.
12595 TemplateArgumentListInfo &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12599
12600 /// brief A function argument from which we performed template argument
12601 // deduction for a call.
12614
12615 /// Finish template argument deduction for a function template,
12616 /// checking the deduced template arguments for completeness and forming
12617 /// the function template specialization.
12618 ///
12619 /// \param OriginalCallArgs If non-NULL, the original call arguments against
12620 /// which the deduced argument types should be compared.
12621 /// \param CheckNonDependent Callback before substituting into the declaration
12622 /// with the deduced template arguments.
12623 /// \param OnlyInitializeNonUserDefinedConversions is used as a workaround for
12624 /// some breakages introduced by CWG2369, where non-user-defined conversions
12625 /// are checked first before the constraints.
12629 unsigned NumExplicitlySpecified, FunctionDecl *&Specialization,
12631 SmallVectorImpl<OriginalCallArg> const *OriginalCallArgs,
12632 bool PartialOverloading, bool PartialOrdering,
12633 bool ForOverloadSetAddressResolution,
12634 llvm::function_ref<bool(bool)> CheckNonDependent =
12635 [](bool /*OnlyInitializeNonUserDefinedConversions*/) {
12636 return false;
12637 });
12638
12639 /// Perform template argument deduction from a function call
12640 /// (C++ [temp.deduct.call]).
12641 ///
12642 /// \param FunctionTemplate the function template for which we are performing
12643 /// template argument deduction.
12644 ///
12645 /// \param ExplicitTemplateArgs the explicit template arguments provided
12646 /// for this call.
12647 ///
12648 /// \param Args the function call arguments
12649 ///
12650 /// \param Specialization if template argument deduction was successful,
12651 /// this will be set to the function template specialization produced by
12652 /// template argument deduction.
12653 ///
12654 /// \param Info the argument will be updated to provide additional information
12655 /// about template argument deduction.
12656 ///
12657 /// \param CheckNonDependent A callback to invoke to check conversions for
12658 /// non-dependent parameters, between deduction and substitution, per DR1391.
12659 /// If this returns true, substitution will be skipped and we return
12660 /// TemplateDeductionResult::NonDependentConversionFailure. The callback is
12661 /// passed the parameter types (after substituting explicit template
12662 /// arguments).
12663 ///
12664 /// \returns the result of template argument deduction.
12667 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12669 bool PartialOverloading, bool AggregateDeductionCandidate,
12670 bool PartialOrdering, QualType ObjectType,
12671 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
12672 bool ForOverloadSetAddressResolution,
12673 llvm::function_ref<bool(ArrayRef<QualType>, bool)> CheckNonDependent);
12674
12675 /// Deduce template arguments when taking the address of a function
12676 /// template (C++ [temp.deduct.funcaddr]) or matching a specialization to
12677 /// a template.
12678 ///
12679 /// \param FunctionTemplate the function template for which we are performing
12680 /// template argument deduction.
12681 ///
12682 /// \param ExplicitTemplateArgs the explicitly-specified template
12683 /// arguments.
12684 ///
12685 /// \param ArgFunctionType the function type that will be used as the
12686 /// "argument" type (A) when performing template argument deduction from the
12687 /// function template's function type. This type may be NULL, if there is no
12688 /// argument type to compare against, in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
12689 ///
12690 /// \param Specialization if template argument deduction was successful,
12691 /// this will be set to the function template specialization produced by
12692 /// template argument deduction.
12693 ///
12694 /// \param Info the argument will be updated to provide additional information
12695 /// about template argument deduction.
12696 ///
12697 /// \param IsAddressOfFunction If \c true, we are deducing as part of taking
12698 /// the address of a function template per [temp.deduct.funcaddr] and
12699 /// [over.over]. If \c false, we are looking up a function template
12700 /// specialization based on its signature, per [temp.deduct.decl].
12701 ///
12702 /// \returns the result of template argument deduction.
12705 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ArgFunctionType,
12707 bool IsAddressOfFunction = false);
12708
12709 /// Deduce template arguments for a templated conversion
12710 /// function (C++ [temp.deduct.conv]) and, if successful, produce a
12711 /// conversion function template specialization.
12714 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, QualType ToType,
12716
12717 /// Deduce template arguments for a function template when there is
12718 /// nothing to deduce against (C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3).
12719 ///
12720 /// \param FunctionTemplate the function template for which we are performing
12721 /// template argument deduction.
12722 ///
12723 /// \param ExplicitTemplateArgs the explicitly-specified template
12724 /// arguments.
12725 ///
12726 /// \param Specialization if template argument deduction was successful,
12727 /// this will be set to the function template specialization produced by
12728 /// template argument deduction.
12729 ///
12730 /// \param Info the argument will be updated to provide additional information
12731 /// about template argument deduction.
12732 ///
12733 /// \param IsAddressOfFunction If \c true, we are deducing as part of taking
12734 /// the address of a function template in a context where we do not have a
12735 /// target type, per [over.over]. If \c false, we are looking up a function
12736 /// template specialization based on its signature, which only happens when
12737 /// deducing a function parameter type from an argument that is a template-id
12738 /// naming a function template specialization.
12739 ///
12740 /// \returns the result of template argument deduction.
12743 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12746 bool IsAddressOfFunction = false);
12747
12748 /// Substitute Replacement for \p auto in \p TypeWithAuto
12749 QualType SubstAutoType(QualType TypeWithAuto, QualType Replacement);
12750 /// Substitute Replacement for auto in TypeWithAuto
12752 QualType Replacement);
12753
12754 // Substitute auto in TypeWithAuto for a Dependent auto type
12756
12757 // Substitute auto in TypeWithAuto for a Dependent auto type
12760
12761 /// Completely replace the \c auto in \p TypeWithAuto by
12762 /// \p Replacement. This does not retain any \c auto type sugar.
12763 QualType ReplaceAutoType(QualType TypeWithAuto, QualType Replacement);
12765 QualType Replacement);
12766
12767 /// Deduce the type for an auto type-specifier (C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p6)
12768 ///
12769 /// Note that this is done even if the initializer is dependent. (This is
12770 /// necessary to support partial ordering of templates using 'auto'.)
12771 /// A dependent type will be produced when deducing from a dependent type.
12772 ///
12773 /// \param Type the type pattern using the auto type-specifier.
12774 /// \param Init the initializer for the variable whose type is to be deduced.
12775 /// \param Result if type deduction was successful, this will be set to the
12776 /// deduced type.
12777 /// \param Info the argument will be updated to provide additional information
12778 /// about template argument deduction.
12779 /// \param DependentDeduction Set if we should permit deduction in
12780 /// dependent cases. This is necessary for template partial ordering
12781 /// with 'auto' template parameters. The template parameter depth to be
12782 /// used should be specified in the 'Info' parameter.
12783 /// \param IgnoreConstraints Set if we should not fail if the deduced type
12784 /// does not satisfy the type-constraint in the auto
12785 /// type.
12789 bool DependentDeduction = false,
12790 bool IgnoreConstraints = false,
12791 TemplateSpecCandidateSet *FailedTSC = nullptr);
12792 void DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(const VarDecl *VDecl, const Expr *Init);
12794 bool Diagnose = true);
12795
12797 SourceLocation Loc);
12798
12799 /// Returns the more specialized class template partial specialization
12800 /// according to the rules of partial ordering of class template partial
12801 /// specializations (C++ [temp.class.order]).
12802 ///
12803 /// \param PS1 the first class template partial specialization
12804 ///
12805 /// \param PS2 the second class template partial specialization
12806 ///
12807 /// \returns the more specialized class template partial specialization. If
12808 /// neither partial specialization is more specialized, returns NULL.
12813
12816
12820
12823
12825 TemplateParameterList *PParam, TemplateDecl *PArg, TemplateDecl *AArg,
12826 const DefaultArguments &DefaultArgs, SourceLocation ArgLoc,
12827 bool PartialOrdering, bool *StrictPackMatch);
12828
12829 /// Mark which template parameters are used in a given expression.
12830 ///
12831 /// \param E the expression from which template parameters will be deduced.
12832 ///
12833 /// \param Used a bit vector whose elements will be set to \c true
12834 /// to indicate when the corresponding template parameter will be
12835 /// deduced.
12836 void MarkUsedTemplateParameters(const Expr *E, bool OnlyDeduced,
12837 unsigned Depth, llvm::SmallBitVector &Used);
12838
12839 /// Mark which template parameters are named in a given expression.
12840 ///
12841 /// Unlike MarkUsedTemplateParameters, this excludes parameter that
12842 /// are used but not directly named by an expression - i.e. it excludes
12843 /// any template parameter that denotes the type of a referenced NTTP.
12844 ///
12845 /// \param Used a bit vector whose elements will be set to \c true
12846 /// to indicate when the corresponding template parameter will be
12847 /// deduced.
12849 const Expr *E, unsigned Depth, llvm::SmallBitVector &Used);
12850
12851 /// Mark which template parameters can be deduced from a given
12852 /// template argument list.
12853 ///
12854 /// \param TemplateArgs the template argument list from which template
12855 /// parameters will be deduced.
12856 ///
12857 /// \param Used a bit vector whose elements will be set to \c true
12858 /// to indicate when the corresponding template parameter will be
12859 /// deduced.
12860 void MarkUsedTemplateParameters(const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
12861 bool OnlyDeduced, unsigned Depth,
12862 llvm::SmallBitVector &Used);
12863
12865 unsigned Depth, llvm::SmallBitVector &Used);
12866
12868 unsigned Depth, llvm::SmallBitVector &Used);
12869
12870 void
12872 llvm::SmallBitVector &Deduced) {
12874 }
12875
12876 /// Marks all of the template parameters that will be deduced by a
12877 /// call to the given function template.
12878 static void
12881 llvm::SmallBitVector &Deduced);
12882
12883 /// Returns the more specialized function template according
12884 /// to the rules of function template partial ordering (C++
12885 /// [temp.func.order]).
12886 ///
12887 /// \param FT1 the first function template
12888 ///
12889 /// \param FT2 the second function template
12890 ///
12891 /// \param TPOC the context in which we are performing partial ordering of
12892 /// function templates.
12893 ///
12894 /// \param NumCallArguments1 The number of arguments in the call to FT1, used
12895 /// only when \c TPOC is \c TPOC_Call. Does not include the object argument
12896 /// when calling a member function.
12897 ///
12898 /// \param RawObj1Ty The type of the object parameter of FT1 if a member
12899 /// function only used if \c TPOC is \c TPOC_Call and FT1 is a Function
12900 /// template from a member function
12901 ///
12902 /// \param RawObj2Ty The type of the object parameter of FT2 if a member
12903 /// function only used if \c TPOC is \c TPOC_Call and FT2 is a Function
12904 /// template from a member function
12905 ///
12906 /// \param Reversed If \c true, exactly one of FT1 and FT2 is an overload
12907 /// candidate with a reversed parameter order. In this case, the corresponding
12908 /// P/A pairs between FT1 and FT2 are reversed.
12909 ///
12910 /// \returns the more specialized function template. If neither
12911 /// template is more specialized, returns NULL.
12914 TemplatePartialOrderingContext TPOC, unsigned NumCallArguments1,
12915 QualType RawObj1Ty = {}, QualType RawObj2Ty = {}, bool Reversed = false,
12916 bool PartialOverloading = false);
12917
12918 /// Retrieve the most specialized of the given function template
12919 /// specializations.
12920 ///
12921 /// \param SpecBegin the start iterator of the function template
12922 /// specializations that we will be comparing.
12923 ///
12924 /// \param SpecEnd the end iterator of the function template
12925 /// specializations, paired with \p SpecBegin.
12926 ///
12927 /// \param Loc the location where the ambiguity or no-specializations
12928 /// diagnostic should occur.
12929 ///
12930 /// \param NoneDiag partial diagnostic used to diagnose cases where there are
12931 /// no matching candidates.
12932 ///
12933 /// \param AmbigDiag partial diagnostic used to diagnose an ambiguity, if one
12934 /// occurs.
12935 ///
12936 /// \param CandidateDiag partial diagnostic used for each function template
12937 /// specialization that is a candidate in the ambiguous ordering. One
12938 /// parameter in this diagnostic should be unbound, which will correspond to
12939 /// the string describing the template arguments for the function template
12940 /// specialization.
12941 ///
12942 /// \returns the most specialized function template specialization, if
12943 /// found. Otherwise, returns SpecEnd.
12944 UnresolvedSetIterator
12945 getMostSpecialized(UnresolvedSetIterator SBegin, UnresolvedSetIterator SEnd,
12946 TemplateSpecCandidateSet &FailedCandidates,
12947 SourceLocation Loc, const PartialDiagnostic &NoneDiag,
12948 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
12949 const PartialDiagnostic &CandidateDiag,
12950 bool Complain = true, QualType TargetType = QualType());
12951
12952 /// Returns the more constrained function according to the rules of
12953 /// partial ordering by constraints (C++ [temp.constr.order]).
12954 ///
12955 /// \param FD1 the first function
12956 ///
12957 /// \param FD2 the second function
12958 ///
12959 /// \returns the more constrained function. If neither function is
12960 /// more constrained, returns NULL.
12961 FunctionDecl *getMoreConstrainedFunction(FunctionDecl *FD1,
12962 FunctionDecl *FD2);
12963
12964 ///@}
12965
12966 //
12967 //
12968 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
12969 //
12970 //
12971
12972 /// \name C++ Template Deduction Guide
12973 /// Implementations are in SemaTemplateDeductionGuide.cpp
12974 ///@{
12975
12976 /// Declare implicit deduction guides for a class template if we've
12977 /// not already done so.
12978 void DeclareImplicitDeductionGuides(TemplateDecl *Template,
12979 SourceLocation Loc);
12980
12981 FunctionTemplateDecl *DeclareAggregateDeductionGuideFromInitList(
12982 TemplateDecl *Template, MutableArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes,
12983 SourceLocation Loc);
12984
12985 ///@}
12986
12987 //
12988 //
12989 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
12990 //
12991 //
12992
12993 /// \name C++ Template Instantiation
12994 /// Implementations are in SemaTemplateInstantiate.cpp
12995 ///@{
12996
12997public:
12998 /// A helper class for building up ExtParameterInfos.
13001 bool HasInteresting = false;
13002
13003 public:
13004 /// Set the ExtParameterInfo for the parameter at the given index,
13005 ///
13007 assert(Infos.size() <= index);
13008 Infos.resize(index);
13009 Infos.push_back(info);
13010
13011 if (!HasInteresting)
13012 HasInteresting = (info != FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo());
13013 }
13014
13015 /// Return a pointer (suitable for setting in an ExtProtoInfo) to the
13016 /// ExtParameterInfo array we've built up.
13018 getPointerOrNull(unsigned numParams) {
13019 if (!HasInteresting)
13020 return nullptr;
13021 Infos.resize(numParams);
13022 return Infos.data();
13023 }
13024 };
13025
13026 /// The current instantiation scope used to store local
13027 /// variables.
13029
13030 typedef llvm::DenseMap<ParmVarDecl *, llvm::TinyPtrVector<ParmVarDecl *>>
13032
13033 /// A mapping from parameters with unparsed default arguments to the
13034 /// set of instantiations of each parameter.
13035 ///
13036 /// This mapping is a temporary data structure used when parsing
13037 /// nested class templates or nested classes of class templates,
13038 /// where we might end up instantiating an inner class before the
13039 /// default arguments of its methods have been parsed.
13041
13042 using InstantiatingSpecializationsKey = llvm::PointerIntPair<Decl *, 2>;
13043
13050
13052 : S(S), Key(D->getCanonicalDecl(), unsigned(Kind)) {
13053 auto [_, Created] = S.InstantiatingSpecializations.insert(Key);
13054 if (!Created)
13055 Key = {};
13056 }
13057
13059 if (Key.getOpaqueValue()) {
13060 [[maybe_unused]] bool Erased =
13061 S.InstantiatingSpecializations.erase(Key);
13062 assert(Erased);
13063 }
13064 }
13065
13066 operator bool() const { return Key.getOpaqueValue() == nullptr; }
13067
13068 private:
13069 Sema &S;
13071 };
13072
13073 /// A context in which code is being synthesized (where a source location
13074 /// alone is not sufficient to identify the context). This covers template
13075 /// instantiation and various forms of implicitly-generated functions.
13077 /// The kind of template instantiation we are performing
13079 /// We are instantiating a template declaration. The entity is
13080 /// the declaration we're instantiating (e.g., a CXXRecordDecl).
13082
13083 /// We are instantiating a default argument for a template
13084 /// parameter. The Entity is the template parameter whose argument is
13085 /// being instantiated, the Template is the template, and the
13086 /// TemplateArgs/NumTemplateArguments provide the template arguments as
13087 /// specified.
13089
13090 /// We are instantiating a default argument for a function.
13091 /// The Entity is the ParmVarDecl, and TemplateArgs/NumTemplateArgs
13092 /// provides the template arguments as specified.
13094
13095 /// We are substituting explicit template arguments provided for
13096 /// a function template. The entity is a FunctionTemplateDecl.
13098
13099 /// We are substituting template argument determined as part of
13100 /// template argument deduction for either a class template
13101 /// partial specialization or a function template. The
13102 /// Entity is either a {Class|Var}TemplatePartialSpecializationDecl or
13103 /// a TemplateDecl.
13105
13106 /// We are substituting into a lambda expression.
13108
13109 /// We are substituting prior template arguments into a new
13110 /// template parameter. The template parameter itself is either a
13111 /// NonTypeTemplateParmDecl or a TemplateTemplateParmDecl.
13113
13114 /// We are checking the validity of a default template argument that
13115 /// has been used when naming a template-id.
13117
13118 /// We are computing the exception specification for a defaulted special
13119 /// member function.
13121
13122 /// We are instantiating the exception specification for a function
13123 /// template which was deferred until it was needed.
13125
13126 /// We are instantiating a requirement of a requires expression.
13128
13129 /// We are checking the satisfaction of a nested requirement of a requires
13130 /// expression.
13132
13133 /// We are declaring an implicit special member function.
13135
13136 /// We are declaring an implicit 'operator==' for a defaulted
13137 /// 'operator<=>'.
13139
13140 /// We are defining a synthesized function (such as a defaulted special
13141 /// member).
13143
13144 // We are checking the constraints associated with a constrained entity or
13145 // the constraint expression of a concept. This includes the checks that
13146 // atomic constraints have the type 'bool' and that they can be constant
13147 // evaluated.
13149
13150 // We are substituting template arguments into a constraint expression.
13152
13153 // We are normalizing a constraint expression.
13155
13156 // Instantiating a Requires Expression parameter clause.
13158
13159 // We are substituting into the parameter mapping of an atomic constraint
13160 // during normalization.
13162
13163 /// We are rewriting a comparison operator in terms of an operator<=>.
13165
13166 /// We are initializing a structured binding.
13168
13169 /// We are marking a class as __dllexport.
13171
13172 /// We are building an implied call from __builtin_dump_struct. The
13173 /// arguments are in CallArgs.
13175
13176 /// Added for Template instantiation observation.
13177 /// Memoization means we are _not_ instantiating a template because
13178 /// it is already instantiated (but we entered a context where we
13179 /// would have had to if it was not already instantiated).
13181
13182 /// We are building deduction guides for a class.
13184
13185 /// We are instantiating a type alias template declaration.
13187
13188 /// We are performing partial ordering for template template parameters.
13190 } Kind;
13191
13192 /// Whether we're substituting into constraints.
13194
13195 /// Whether we're substituting into the parameter mapping of a constraint.
13197
13198 /// The point of instantiation or synthesis within the source code.
13200
13201 /// The entity that is being synthesized.
13203
13204 /// The template (or partial specialization) in which we are
13205 /// performing the instantiation, for substitutions of prior template
13206 /// arguments.
13208
13209 union {
13210 /// The list of template arguments we are substituting, if they
13211 /// are not part of the entity.
13213
13214 /// The list of argument expressions in a synthesized call.
13215 const Expr *const *CallArgs;
13216 };
13217
13218 // FIXME: Wrap this union around more members, or perhaps store the
13219 // kind-specific members in the RAII object owning the context.
13220 union {
13221 /// The number of template arguments in TemplateArgs.
13223
13224 /// The number of expressions in CallArgs.
13225 unsigned NumCallArgs;
13226
13227 /// The special member being declared or defined.
13229 };
13230
13235
13236 /// The source range that covers the construct that cause
13237 /// the instantiation, e.g., the template-id that causes a class
13238 /// template instantiation.
13240
13245
13246 /// Determines whether this template is an actual instantiation
13247 /// that should be counted toward the maximum instantiation depth.
13248 bool isInstantiationRecord() const;
13249 };
13250
13251 /// A stack object to be created when performing template
13252 /// instantiation.
13253 ///
13254 /// Construction of an object of type \c InstantiatingTemplate
13255 /// pushes the current instantiation onto the stack of active
13256 /// instantiations. If the size of this stack exceeds the maximum
13257 /// number of recursive template instantiations, construction
13258 /// produces an error and evaluates true.
13259 ///
13260 /// Destruction of this object will pop the named instantiation off
13261 /// the stack.
13263 /// Note that we are instantiating a class template,
13264 /// function template, variable template, alias template,
13265 /// or a member thereof.
13266 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13267 Decl *Entity,
13268 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13269
13271 /// Note that we are instantiating an exception specification
13272 /// of a function template.
13273 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13275 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13276
13277 /// Note that we are instantiating a type alias template declaration.
13278 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13279 TypeAliasTemplateDecl *Entity,
13280 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13281 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13282
13283 /// Note that we are instantiating a default argument in a
13284 /// template-id.
13285 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13287 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13288 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13289
13290 /// Note that we are substituting either explicitly-specified or
13291 /// deduced template arguments during function template argument deduction.
13292 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13294 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13296 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13297
13298 /// Note that we are instantiating as part of template
13299 /// argument deduction for a class template declaration.
13300 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13302 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13303 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13304
13305 /// Note that we are instantiating as part of template
13306 /// argument deduction for a class template partial
13307 /// specialization.
13308 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13310 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13311 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13312
13313 /// Note that we are instantiating as part of template
13314 /// argument deduction for a variable template partial
13315 /// specialization.
13316 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13318 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13319 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13320
13321 /// Note that we are instantiating a default argument for a function
13322 /// parameter.
13323 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13324 ParmVarDecl *Param,
13325 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13326 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13327
13328 /// Note that we are substituting prior template arguments into a
13329 /// non-type parameter.
13330 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13332 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13333 SourceRange InstantiationRange);
13334
13335 /// Note that we are substituting prior template arguments into a
13336 /// template template parameter.
13337 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13339 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13340 SourceRange InstantiationRange);
13341
13342 /// Note that we are checking the default template argument
13343 /// against the template parameter for a given template-id.
13344 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13346 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13347 SourceRange InstantiationRange);
13348
13350 /// \brief Note that we are checking the constraints associated with some
13351 /// constrained entity (a concept declaration or a template with associated
13352 /// constraints).
13353 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13355 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
13356 SourceRange InstantiationRange);
13357
13359 /// \brief Note that we are checking a constraint expression associated
13360 /// with a template declaration or as part of the satisfaction check of a
13361 /// concept.
13362 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13364 SourceRange InstantiationRange);
13365
13367 /// \brief Note that we are normalizing a constraint expression.
13368 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13370 SourceRange InstantiationRange);
13371
13373 /// \brief Note that we are subtituting into the parameter mapping of an
13374 /// atomic constraint during constraint normalization.
13375 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13377 SourceRange InstantiationRange);
13378
13379 /// \brief Note that we are substituting template arguments into a part of
13380 /// a requirement of a requires expression.
13381 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13383 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13384
13385 /// \brief Note that we are checking the satisfaction of the constraint
13386 /// expression inside of a nested requirement.
13387 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13389 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13390
13391 /// \brief Note that we are checking a requires clause.
13392 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13393 const RequiresExpr *E,
13394 SourceRange InstantiationRange);
13395
13397 /// \brief Note that we are building deduction guides.
13398 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13400 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13401
13403 /// \brief Note that we are partial ordering template template parameters.
13404 InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation ArgLoc,
13406 SourceRange InstantiationRange = SourceRange());
13407
13408 /// Note that we have finished instantiating this template.
13409 void Clear();
13410
13412
13413 /// Determines whether we have exceeded the maximum
13414 /// recursive template instantiations.
13415 bool isInvalid() const { return Invalid; }
13416
13417 private:
13418 Sema &SemaRef;
13419 bool Invalid;
13420
13423 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13424 SourceRange InstantiationRange, Decl *Entity,
13425 NamedDecl *Template = nullptr,
13426 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs = {});
13427
13429
13430 InstantiatingTemplate &operator=(const InstantiatingTemplate &) = delete;
13431 };
13432
13433 bool SubstTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgumentLoc &Input,
13434 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13435 TemplateArgumentLoc &Output,
13436 SourceLocation Loc = {},
13437 const DeclarationName &Entity = {});
13438 bool
13439 SubstTemplateArguments(ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args,
13440 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13441 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Outputs);
13442
13443 /// Substitute concept template arguments in the constraint expression
13444 /// of a concept-id. This is used to implement [temp.constr.normal].
13446 SubstConceptTemplateArguments(const ConceptSpecializationExpr *CSE,
13447 const Expr *ConstraintExpr,
13448 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &MLTAL);
13449
13451 ArrayRef<TemplateArgumentLoc> Args, SourceLocation BaseLoc,
13452 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13453 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Out, bool BuildPackExpansionTypes);
13454
13455 /// Retrieve the template argument list(s) that should be used to
13456 /// instantiate the definition of the given declaration.
13457 ///
13458 /// \param ND the declaration for which we are computing template
13459 /// instantiation arguments.
13460 ///
13461 /// \param DC In the event we don't HAVE a declaration yet, we instead provide
13462 /// the decl context where it will be created. In this case, the `Innermost`
13463 /// should likely be provided. If ND is non-null, this is ignored.
13464 ///
13465 /// \param Innermost if non-NULL, specifies a template argument list for the
13466 /// template declaration passed as ND.
13467 ///
13468 /// \param RelativeToPrimary true if we should get the template
13469 /// arguments relative to the primary template, even when we're
13470 /// dealing with a specialization. This is only relevant for function
13471 /// template specializations.
13472 ///
13473 /// \param Pattern If non-NULL, indicates the pattern from which we will be
13474 /// instantiating the definition of the given declaration, \p ND. This is
13475 /// used to determine the proper set of template instantiation arguments for
13476 /// friend function template specializations.
13477 ///
13478 /// \param ForConstraintInstantiation when collecting arguments,
13479 /// ForConstraintInstantiation indicates we should continue looking when
13480 /// encountering a lambda generic call operator, and continue looking for
13481 /// arguments on an enclosing class template.
13482 ///
13483 /// \param SkipForSpecialization when specified, any template specializations
13484 /// in a traversal would be ignored.
13485 ///
13486 /// \param ForDefaultArgumentSubstitution indicates we should continue looking
13487 /// when encountering a specialized member function template, rather than
13488 /// returning immediately.
13489 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList getTemplateInstantiationArgs(
13490 const NamedDecl *D, const DeclContext *DC = nullptr, bool Final = false,
13491 std::optional<ArrayRef<TemplateArgument>> Innermost = std::nullopt,
13492 bool RelativeToPrimary = false, const FunctionDecl *Pattern = nullptr,
13493 bool ForConstraintInstantiation = false,
13494 bool SkipForSpecialization = false,
13495 bool ForDefaultArgumentSubstitution = false);
13496
13497 /// RAII object to handle the state changes required to synthesize
13498 /// a function body.
13500 Sema &S;
13501 Sema::ContextRAII SavedContext;
13502 bool PushedCodeSynthesisContext = false;
13503
13504 public:
13506 : S(S), SavedContext(S, DC) {
13507 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC);
13508 S.PushFunctionScope();
13509 S.PushExpressionEvaluationContextForFunction(
13511 if (FD)
13512 FD->setWillHaveBody(true);
13513 else
13514 assert(isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(DC));
13515 }
13516
13518 assert(!PushedCodeSynthesisContext);
13519
13522 Ctx.PointOfInstantiation = UseLoc;
13523 Ctx.Entity = cast<Decl>(S.CurContext);
13524 S.pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx);
13525
13526 PushedCodeSynthesisContext = true;
13527 }
13528
13530 if (PushedCodeSynthesisContext)
13531 S.popCodeSynthesisContext();
13532 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) {
13533 FD->setWillHaveBody(false);
13534 S.CheckImmediateEscalatingFunctionDefinition(FD, S.getCurFunction());
13535 }
13536 S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
13537 S.PopFunctionScopeInfo();
13538 }
13539 };
13540
13541 /// List of active code synthesis contexts.
13542 ///
13543 /// This vector is treated as a stack. As synthesis of one entity requires
13544 /// synthesis of another, additional contexts are pushed onto the stack.
13546
13547 /// Specializations whose definitions are currently being instantiated.
13548 llvm::DenseSet<InstantiatingSpecializationsKey> InstantiatingSpecializations;
13549
13550 /// Non-dependent types used in templates that have already been instantiated
13551 /// by some template instantiation.
13552 llvm::DenseSet<QualType> InstantiatedNonDependentTypes;
13553
13554 /// Extra modules inspected when performing a lookup during a template
13555 /// instantiation. Computed lazily.
13557
13558 /// Cache of additional modules that should be used for name lookup
13559 /// within the current template instantiation. Computed lazily; use
13560 /// getLookupModules() to get a complete set.
13561 llvm::DenseSet<Module *> LookupModulesCache;
13562
13563 /// Map from the most recent declaration of a namespace to the most
13564 /// recent visible declaration of that namespace.
13565 llvm::DenseMap<NamedDecl *, NamedDecl *> VisibleNamespaceCache;
13566
13568
13569 /// The number of \p CodeSynthesisContexts that are not template
13570 /// instantiations and, therefore, should not be counted as part of the
13571 /// instantiation depth.
13572 ///
13573 /// When the instantiation depth reaches the user-configurable limit
13574 /// \p LangOptions::InstantiationDepth we will abort instantiation.
13575 // FIXME: Should we have a similar limit for other forms of synthesis?
13577
13578 /// The depth of the context stack at the point when the most recent
13579 /// error or warning was produced.
13580 ///
13581 /// This value is used to suppress printing of redundant context stacks
13582 /// when there are multiple errors or warnings in the same instantiation.
13583 // FIXME: Does this belong in Sema? It's tough to implement it anywhere else.
13585
13586 /// The template instantiation callbacks to trace or track
13587 /// instantiations (objects can be chained).
13588 ///
13589 /// This callbacks is used to print, trace or track template
13590 /// instantiations as they are being constructed.
13591 std::vector<std::unique_ptr<TemplateInstantiationCallback>>
13593
13594 /// The current index into pack expansion arguments that will be
13595 /// used for substitution of parameter packs.
13596 ///
13597 /// The pack expansion index will be none to indicate that parameter packs
13598 /// should be instantiated as themselves. Otherwise, the index specifies
13599 /// which argument within the parameter pack will be used for substitution.
13601
13602 /// RAII object used to change the argument pack substitution index
13603 /// within a \c Sema object.
13604 ///
13605 /// See \c ArgPackSubstIndex for more information.
13607 Sema &Self;
13608 UnsignedOrNone OldSubstIndex;
13609
13610 public:
13612 : Self(Self),
13613 OldSubstIndex(std::exchange(Self.ArgPackSubstIndex, NewSubstIndex)) {}
13614
13615 ~ArgPackSubstIndexRAII() { Self.ArgPackSubstIndex = OldSubstIndex; }
13616 };
13617
13618 bool pushCodeSynthesisContext(CodeSynthesisContext Ctx);
13620
13631 /// Prints the current instantiation stack through a series of
13632 /// notes.
13637
13638 /// Returns a pointer to the current SFINAE context, if any.
13639 [[nodiscard]] SFINAETrap *getSFINAEContext() const {
13640 return CurrentSFINAEContext;
13641 }
13642 [[nodiscard]] bool isSFINAEContext() const {
13643 return CurrentSFINAEContext != nullptr;
13644 }
13645
13646 /// Perform substitution on the type T with a given set of template
13647 /// arguments.
13648 ///
13649 /// This routine substitutes the given template arguments into the
13650 /// type T and produces the instantiated type.
13651 ///
13652 /// \param T the type into which the template arguments will be
13653 /// substituted. If this type is not dependent, it will be returned
13654 /// immediately.
13655 ///
13656 /// \param Args the template arguments that will be
13657 /// substituted for the top-level template parameters within T.
13658 ///
13659 /// \param Loc the location in the source code where this substitution
13660 /// is being performed. It will typically be the location of the
13661 /// declarator (if we're instantiating the type of some declaration)
13662 /// or the location of the type in the source code (if, e.g., we're
13663 /// instantiating the type of a cast expression).
13664 ///
13665 /// \param Entity the name of the entity associated with a declaration
13666 /// being instantiated (if any). May be empty to indicate that there
13667 /// is no such entity (if, e.g., this is a type that occurs as part of
13668 /// a cast expression) or that the entity has no name (e.g., an
13669 /// unnamed function parameter).
13670 ///
13671 /// \param AllowDeducedTST Whether a DeducedTemplateSpecializationType is
13672 /// acceptable as the top level type of the result.
13673 ///
13674 /// \param IsIncompleteSubstitution If provided, the pointee will be set
13675 /// whenever substitution would perform a replacement with a null or
13676 /// non-existent template argument.
13677 ///
13678 /// \returns If the instantiation succeeds, the instantiated
13679 /// type. Otherwise, produces diagnostics and returns a NULL type.
13681 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13682 SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity,
13683 bool AllowDeducedTST = false);
13684
13686 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13687 SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity,
13688 bool *IsIncompleteSubstitution = nullptr);
13689
13691 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13692 SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity);
13693
13694 /// A form of SubstType intended specifically for instantiating the
13695 /// type of a FunctionDecl. Its purpose is solely to force the
13696 /// instantiation of default-argument expressions and to avoid
13697 /// instantiating an exception-specification.
13699 TypeSourceInfo *T, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13700 SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity, CXXRecordDecl *ThisContext,
13701 Qualifiers ThisTypeQuals, bool EvaluateConstraints = true);
13703 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &Args);
13706 SmallVectorImpl<QualType> &ExceptionStorage,
13707 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &Args);
13708 ParmVarDecl *
13710 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13711 int indexAdjustment, UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions,
13712 bool ExpectParameterPack, bool EvaluateConstraints = true);
13713
13714 /// Substitute the given template arguments into the given set of
13715 /// parameters, producing the set of parameter types that would be generated
13716 /// from such a substitution.
13718 const FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo *ExtParamInfos,
13719 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13720 SmallVectorImpl<QualType> &ParamTypes,
13722 ExtParameterInfoBuilder &ParamInfos);
13723
13724 /// Substitute the given template arguments into the default argument.
13726 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13727 bool ForCallExpr = false);
13729 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13730 /// Substitute an expression as if it is a address-of-operand, which makes it
13731 /// act like a CXXIdExpression rather than an attempt to call.
13733 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13734
13735 // A RAII type used by the TemplateDeclInstantiator and TemplateInstantiator
13736 // to disable constraint evaluation, then restore the state.
13737 template <typename InstTy> struct ConstraintEvalRAII {
13738 InstTy &TI;
13740
13742 : TI(TI), OldValue(TI.getEvaluateConstraints()) {
13743 TI.setEvaluateConstraints(false);
13744 }
13745 ~ConstraintEvalRAII() { TI.setEvaluateConstraints(OldValue); }
13746 };
13747
13748 // Must be used instead of SubstExpr at 'constraint checking' time.
13751 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13752 // Unlike the above, this does not evaluate constraints.
13754 Expr *E, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13755
13756 /// Substitute the given template arguments into a list of
13757 /// expressions, expanding pack expansions if required.
13758 ///
13759 /// \param Exprs The list of expressions to substitute into.
13760 ///
13761 /// \param IsCall Whether this is some form of call, in which case
13762 /// default arguments will be dropped.
13763 ///
13764 /// \param TemplateArgs The set of template arguments to substitute.
13765 ///
13766 /// \param Outputs Will receive all of the substituted arguments.
13767 ///
13768 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
13769 bool SubstExprs(ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs, bool IsCall,
13770 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13771 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &Outputs);
13772
13774 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13775
13778 bool CXXDirectInit);
13779
13780 /// Perform substitution on the base class specifiers of the
13781 /// given class template specialization.
13782 ///
13783 /// Produces a diagnostic and returns true on error, returns false and
13784 /// attaches the instantiated base classes to the class template
13785 /// specialization if successful.
13786 bool SubstBaseSpecifiers(CXXRecordDecl *Instantiation, CXXRecordDecl *Pattern,
13787 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13788
13789 /// Instantiate the definition of a class from a given pattern.
13790 ///
13791 /// \param PointOfInstantiation The point of instantiation within the
13792 /// source code.
13793 ///
13794 /// \param Instantiation is the declaration whose definition is being
13795 /// instantiated. This will be either a class template specialization
13796 /// or a member class of a class template specialization.
13797 ///
13798 /// \param Pattern is the pattern from which the instantiation
13799 /// occurs. This will be either the declaration of a class template or
13800 /// the declaration of a member class of a class template.
13801 ///
13802 /// \param TemplateArgs The template arguments to be substituted into
13803 /// the pattern.
13804 ///
13805 /// \param TSK the kind of implicit or explicit instantiation to perform.
13806 ///
13807 /// \param Complain whether to complain if the class cannot be instantiated
13808 /// due to the lack of a definition.
13809 ///
13810 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
13811 bool InstantiateClass(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13812 CXXRecordDecl *Instantiation, CXXRecordDecl *Pattern,
13813 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13814 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK, bool Complain = true);
13815
13816private:
13817 bool InstantiateClassImpl(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13818 CXXRecordDecl *Instantiation,
13819 CXXRecordDecl *Pattern,
13820 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13821 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK, bool Complain);
13822
13823public:
13824 /// Instantiate the definition of an enum from a given pattern.
13825 ///
13826 /// \param PointOfInstantiation The point of instantiation within the
13827 /// source code.
13828 /// \param Instantiation is the declaration whose definition is being
13829 /// instantiated. This will be a member enumeration of a class
13830 /// temploid specialization, or a local enumeration within a
13831 /// function temploid specialization.
13832 /// \param Pattern The templated declaration from which the instantiation
13833 /// occurs.
13834 /// \param TemplateArgs The template arguments to be substituted into
13835 /// the pattern.
13836 /// \param TSK The kind of implicit or explicit instantiation to perform.
13837 ///
13838 /// \return \c true if an error occurred, \c false otherwise.
13839 bool InstantiateEnum(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13840 EnumDecl *Instantiation, EnumDecl *Pattern,
13841 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13843
13844 /// Instantiate the definition of a field from the given pattern.
13845 ///
13846 /// \param PointOfInstantiation The point of instantiation within the
13847 /// source code.
13848 /// \param Instantiation is the declaration whose definition is being
13849 /// instantiated. This will be a class of a class temploid
13850 /// specialization, or a local enumeration within a function temploid
13851 /// specialization.
13852 /// \param Pattern The templated declaration from which the instantiation
13853 /// occurs.
13854 /// \param TemplateArgs The template arguments to be substituted into
13855 /// the pattern.
13856 ///
13857 /// \return \c true if an error occurred, \c false otherwise.
13859 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, FieldDecl *Instantiation,
13860 FieldDecl *Pattern, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13861
13863 SourceLocation Loc, ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *ClassTemplateSpec);
13864
13866 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13867 ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *ClassTemplateSpec,
13868 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK, bool Complain,
13869 bool PrimaryStrictPackMatch);
13870
13871 /// Instantiates the definitions of all of the member
13872 /// of the given class, which is an instantiation of a class template
13873 /// or a member class of a template.
13874 void
13875 InstantiateClassMembers(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13876 CXXRecordDecl *Instantiation,
13877 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13879
13880 /// Instantiate the definitions of all of the members of the
13881 /// given class template specialization, which was named as part of an
13882 /// explicit instantiation.
13884 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
13885 ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *ClassTemplateSpec,
13887
13890 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13891
13892 /// Do template substitution on declaration name info.
13895 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13897 SubstTemplateName(SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
13898 NestedNameSpecifierLoc &QualifierLoc, TemplateName Name,
13899 SourceLocation NameLoc,
13900 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
13901
13903 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
13904 bool EvaluateConstraint);
13905
13906 /// Determine whether we are currently performing template instantiation.
13909 }
13910
13911 /// Determine whether we are currently performing constraint substitution.
13913 return !CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() &&
13914 CodeSynthesisContexts.back().InConstraintSubstitution;
13915 }
13916
13918 return !CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() &&
13919 CodeSynthesisContexts.back().InParameterMappingSubstitution &&
13921 }
13922
13923 using EntityPrinter = llvm::function_ref<void(llvm::raw_ostream &)>;
13924
13925 /// \brief create a Requirement::SubstitutionDiagnostic with only a
13926 /// SubstitutedEntity and DiagLoc using ASTContext's allocator.
13929
13930 ///@}
13931
13932 //
13933 //
13934 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
13935 //
13936 //
13937
13938 /// \name C++ Template Declaration Instantiation
13939 /// Implementations are in SemaTemplateInstantiateDecl.cpp
13940 ///@{
13941
13942public:
13943 /// An entity for which implicit template instantiation is required.
13944 ///
13945 /// The source location associated with the declaration is the first place in
13946 /// the source code where the declaration was "used". It is not necessarily
13947 /// the point of instantiation (which will be either before or after the
13948 /// namespace-scope declaration that triggered this implicit instantiation),
13949 /// However, it is the location that diagnostics should generally refer to,
13950 /// because users will need to know what code triggered the instantiation.
13951 typedef std::pair<ValueDecl *, SourceLocation> PendingImplicitInstantiation;
13952
13953 /// The queue of implicit template instantiations that are required
13954 /// but have not yet been performed.
13955 std::deque<PendingImplicitInstantiation> PendingInstantiations;
13956
13957 /// Queue of implicit template instantiations that cannot be performed
13958 /// eagerly.
13960
13964
13965 /// The queue of implicit template instantiations that are required
13966 /// and must be performed within the current local scope.
13967 ///
13968 /// This queue is only used for member functions of local classes in
13969 /// templates, which must be instantiated in the same scope as their
13970 /// enclosing function, so that they can reference function-local
13971 /// types, static variables, enumerators, etc.
13972 std::deque<PendingImplicitInstantiation> PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations;
13973
13975 public:
13977 : S(S), AtEndOfTU(AtEndOfTU) {
13978 SavedPendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.swap(
13979 S.PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations);
13980 }
13981
13982 void perform() {
13983 S.PerformPendingInstantiations(/*LocalOnly=*/true,
13984 /*AtEndOfTU=*/AtEndOfTU);
13985 }
13986
13988 assert(S.PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.empty() &&
13989 "there shouldn't be any pending local implicit instantiations");
13990 SavedPendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.swap(
13991 S.PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations);
13992 }
13993
13994 private:
13995 Sema &S;
13996 bool AtEndOfTU;
13997 std::deque<PendingImplicitInstantiation>
13998 SavedPendingLocalImplicitInstantiations;
13999 };
14000
14001 /// Records and restores the CurFPFeatures state on entry/exit of compound
14002 /// statements.
14004 public:
14007 FPOptionsOverride getOverrides() { return OldOverrides; }
14008
14009 private:
14010 Sema &S;
14011 FPOptions OldFPFeaturesState;
14012 FPOptionsOverride OldOverrides;
14013 LangOptions::FPEvalMethodKind OldEvalMethod;
14014 SourceLocation OldFPPragmaLocation;
14015 };
14016
14018 public:
14019 GlobalEagerInstantiationScope(Sema &S, bool Enabled, bool AtEndOfTU)
14020 : S(S), Enabled(Enabled), AtEndOfTU(AtEndOfTU) {
14021 if (!Enabled)
14022 return;
14023
14024 S.SavedPendingInstantiations.emplace_back();
14025 S.SavedPendingInstantiations.back().swap(S.PendingInstantiations);
14026
14027 S.SavedVTableUses.emplace_back();
14028 S.SavedVTableUses.back().swap(S.VTableUses);
14029 }
14030
14031 void perform() {
14032 if (Enabled) {
14033 S.DefineUsedVTables();
14034 S.PerformPendingInstantiations(/*LocalOnly=*/false,
14035 /*AtEndOfTU=*/AtEndOfTU);
14036 }
14037 }
14038
14040 if (!Enabled)
14041 return;
14042
14043 // Restore the set of pending vtables.
14044 assert(S.VTableUses.empty() &&
14045 "VTableUses should be empty before it is discarded.");
14046 S.VTableUses.swap(S.SavedVTableUses.back());
14047 S.SavedVTableUses.pop_back();
14048
14049 // Restore the set of pending implicit instantiations.
14050 if ((S.TUKind != TU_Prefix || !S.LangOpts.PCHInstantiateTemplates) &&
14051 AtEndOfTU) {
14052 assert(S.PendingInstantiations.empty() &&
14053 "PendingInstantiations should be empty before it is discarded.");
14054 S.PendingInstantiations.swap(S.SavedPendingInstantiations.back());
14055 S.SavedPendingInstantiations.pop_back();
14056 } else {
14057 // Template instantiations in the PCH may be delayed until the TU.
14058 S.PendingInstantiations.swap(S.SavedPendingInstantiations.back());
14059 S.PendingInstantiations.insert(
14060 S.PendingInstantiations.end(),
14061 S.SavedPendingInstantiations.back().begin(),
14062 S.SavedPendingInstantiations.back().end());
14063 S.SavedPendingInstantiations.pop_back();
14064 }
14065 }
14066
14067 private:
14068 Sema &S;
14069 bool Enabled;
14070 bool AtEndOfTU;
14071 };
14072
14074 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, ExplicitSpecifier ES);
14075
14086
14087 void InstantiateAttrs(const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
14088 const Decl *Pattern, Decl *Inst,
14089 LateInstantiatedAttrVec *LateAttrs = nullptr,
14090 LocalInstantiationScope *OuterMostScope = nullptr);
14091
14092 /// Update instantiation attributes after template was late parsed.
14093 ///
14094 /// Some attributes are evaluated based on the body of template. If it is
14095 /// late parsed, such attributes cannot be evaluated when declaration is
14096 /// instantiated. This function is used to update instantiation attributes
14097 /// when template definition is ready.
14098 void updateAttrsForLateParsedTemplate(const Decl *Pattern, Decl *Inst);
14099
14100 void
14102 const Decl *Pattern, Decl *Inst,
14103 LateInstantiatedAttrVec *LateAttrs = nullptr,
14104 LocalInstantiationScope *OuterMostScope = nullptr);
14105
14106 /// In the MS ABI, we need to instantiate default arguments of dllexported
14107 /// default constructors along with the constructor definition. This allows IR
14108 /// gen to emit a constructor closure which calls the default constructor with
14109 /// its default arguments.
14111
14113 ParmVarDecl *Param);
14114 void InstantiateExceptionSpec(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
14116
14117 /// Instantiate (or find existing instantiation of) a function template with a
14118 /// given set of template arguments.
14119 ///
14120 /// Usually this should not be used, and template argument deduction should be
14121 /// used in its place.
14124 SourceLocation Loc,
14127
14128 /// Instantiate the definition of the given function from its
14129 /// template.
14130 ///
14131 /// \param PointOfInstantiation the point at which the instantiation was
14132 /// required. Note that this is not precisely a "point of instantiation"
14133 /// for the function, but it's close.
14134 ///
14135 /// \param Function the already-instantiated declaration of a
14136 /// function template specialization or member function of a class template
14137 /// specialization.
14138 ///
14139 /// \param Recursive if true, recursively instantiates any functions that
14140 /// are required by this instantiation.
14141 ///
14142 /// \param DefinitionRequired if true, then we are performing an explicit
14143 /// instantiation where the body of the function is required. Complain if
14144 /// there is no such body.
14145 void InstantiateFunctionDefinition(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
14147 bool Recursive = false,
14148 bool DefinitionRequired = false,
14149 bool AtEndOfTU = false);
14152 const TemplateArgumentList *PartialSpecArgs,
14154 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
14155 LateInstantiatedAttrVec *LateAttrs = nullptr,
14156 LocalInstantiationScope *StartingScope = nullptr);
14157
14158 /// Instantiates a variable template specialization by completing it
14159 /// with appropriate type information and initializer.
14161 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec, VarDecl *PatternDecl,
14162 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14163
14164 /// BuildVariableInstantiation - Used after a new variable has been created.
14165 /// Sets basic variable data and decides whether to postpone the
14166 /// variable instantiation.
14167 void
14169 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
14170 LateInstantiatedAttrVec *LateAttrs,
14171 DeclContext *Owner,
14172 LocalInstantiationScope *StartingScope,
14173 bool InstantiatingVarTemplate = false,
14174 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *PrevVTSD = nullptr);
14175
14176 /// Instantiate the initializer of a variable.
14178 VarDecl *Var, VarDecl *OldVar,
14179 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14180
14181 /// Instantiate the definition of the given variable from its
14182 /// template.
14183 ///
14184 /// \param PointOfInstantiation the point at which the instantiation was
14185 /// required. Note that this is not precisely a "point of instantiation"
14186 /// for the variable, but it's close.
14187 ///
14188 /// \param Var the already-instantiated declaration of a templated variable.
14189 ///
14190 /// \param Recursive if true, recursively instantiates any functions that
14191 /// are required by this instantiation.
14192 ///
14193 /// \param DefinitionRequired if true, then we are performing an explicit
14194 /// instantiation where a definition of the variable is required. Complain
14195 /// if there is no such definition.
14196 void InstantiateVariableDefinition(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
14197 VarDecl *Var, bool Recursive = false,
14198 bool DefinitionRequired = false,
14199 bool AtEndOfTU = false);
14200
14203 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14204
14205 /// Find the instantiation of the given declaration within the
14206 /// current instantiation.
14207 ///
14208 /// This routine is intended to be used when \p D is a declaration
14209 /// referenced from within a template, that needs to mapped into the
14210 /// corresponding declaration within an instantiation. For example,
14211 /// given:
14212 ///
14213 /// \code
14214 /// template<typename T>
14215 /// struct X {
14216 /// enum Kind {
14217 /// KnownValue = sizeof(T)
14218 /// };
14219 ///
14220 /// bool getKind() const { return KnownValue; }
14221 /// };
14222 ///
14223 /// template struct X<int>;
14224 /// \endcode
14225 ///
14226 /// In the instantiation of X<int>::getKind(), we need to map the \p
14227 /// EnumConstantDecl for \p KnownValue (which refers to
14228 /// X<T>::<Kind>::KnownValue) to its instantiation
14229 /// (X<int>::<Kind>::KnownValue).
14230 /// \p FindInstantiatedDecl performs this mapping from within the
14231 /// instantiation of X<int>.
14232 NamedDecl *
14234 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
14235 bool FindingInstantiatedContext = false);
14236
14237 /// Finds the instantiation of the given declaration context
14238 /// within the current instantiation.
14239 ///
14240 /// \returns NULL if there was an error
14241 DeclContext *
14243 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14244
14245 Decl *SubstDecl(Decl *D, DeclContext *Owner,
14246 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14247
14248 /// Substitute the name and return type of a defaulted 'operator<=>' to form
14249 /// an implicit 'operator=='.
14251 FunctionDecl *Spaceship);
14252
14253 /// Performs template instantiation for all implicit template
14254 /// instantiations we have seen until this point.
14255 void PerformPendingInstantiations(bool LocalOnly = false,
14256 bool AtEndOfTU = true);
14257
14260 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
14261 bool EvaluateConstraints = true);
14262
14264 const DeclContext *Pattern,
14265 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14266
14267private:
14268 /// Introduce the instantiated local variables into the local
14269 /// instantiation scope.
14270 void addInstantiatedLocalVarsToScope(FunctionDecl *Function,
14271 const FunctionDecl *PatternDecl,
14273 /// Introduce the instantiated function parameters into the local
14274 /// instantiation scope, and set the parameter names to those used
14275 /// in the template.
14276 bool addInstantiatedParametersToScope(
14277 FunctionDecl *Function, const FunctionDecl *PatternDecl,
14279 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14280
14281 /// Introduce the instantiated captures of the lambda into the local
14282 /// instantiation scope.
14283 bool addInstantiatedCapturesToScope(
14284 FunctionDecl *Function, const FunctionDecl *PatternDecl,
14286 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14287
14288 int ParsingClassDepth = 0;
14289
14290 class SavePendingParsedClassStateRAII {
14291 public:
14292 SavePendingParsedClassStateRAII(Sema &S) : S(S) { swapSavedState(); }
14293
14294 ~SavePendingParsedClassStateRAII() {
14295 assert(S.DelayedOverridingExceptionSpecChecks.empty() &&
14296 "there shouldn't be any pending delayed exception spec checks");
14297 assert(S.DelayedEquivalentExceptionSpecChecks.empty() &&
14298 "there shouldn't be any pending delayed exception spec checks");
14299 swapSavedState();
14300 }
14301
14302 private:
14303 Sema &S;
14305 SavedOverridingExceptionSpecChecks;
14307 SavedEquivalentExceptionSpecChecks;
14308
14309 void swapSavedState() {
14310 SavedOverridingExceptionSpecChecks.swap(
14311 S.DelayedOverridingExceptionSpecChecks);
14312 SavedEquivalentExceptionSpecChecks.swap(
14313 S.DelayedEquivalentExceptionSpecChecks);
14314 }
14315 };
14316
14317 ///@}
14318
14319 //
14320 //
14321 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
14322 //
14323 //
14324
14325 /// \name C++ Variadic Templates
14326 /// Implementations are in SemaTemplateVariadic.cpp
14327 ///@{
14328
14329public:
14330 /// Determine whether an unexpanded parameter pack might be permitted in this
14331 /// location. Useful for error recovery.
14333
14334 /// The context in which an unexpanded parameter pack is
14335 /// being diagnosed.
14336 ///
14337 /// Note that the values of this enumeration line up with the first
14338 /// argument to the \c err_unexpanded_parameter_pack diagnostic.
14340 /// An arbitrary expression.
14342
14343 /// The base type of a class type.
14345
14346 /// The type of an arbitrary declaration.
14348
14349 /// The type of a data member.
14351
14352 /// The size of a bit-field.
14354
14355 /// The expression in a static assertion.
14357
14358 /// The fixed underlying type of an enumeration.
14360
14361 /// The enumerator value.
14363
14364 /// A using declaration.
14366
14367 /// A friend declaration.
14369
14370 /// A declaration qualifier.
14372
14373 /// An initializer.
14375
14376 /// A default argument.
14378
14379 /// The type of a non-type template parameter.
14381
14382 /// The type of an exception.
14384
14385 /// Explicit specialization.
14387
14388 /// Partial specialization.
14390
14391 /// Microsoft __if_exists.
14393
14394 /// Microsoft __if_not_exists.
14396
14397 /// Lambda expression.
14399
14400 /// Block expression.
14402
14403 /// A type constraint.
14405
14406 // A requirement in a requires-expression.
14408
14409 // A requires-clause.
14411 };
14412
14413 /// Diagnose unexpanded parameter packs.
14414 ///
14415 /// \param Loc The location at which we should emit the diagnostic.
14416 ///
14417 /// \param UPPC The context in which we are diagnosing unexpanded
14418 /// parameter packs.
14419 ///
14420 /// \param Unexpanded the set of unexpanded parameter packs.
14421 ///
14422 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14426
14427 /// If the given type contains an unexpanded parameter pack,
14428 /// diagnose the error.
14429 ///
14430 /// \param Loc The source location where a diagnostc should be emitted.
14431 ///
14432 /// \param T The type that is being checked for unexpanded parameter
14433 /// packs.
14434 ///
14435 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14438
14439 /// If the given expression contains an unexpanded parameter
14440 /// pack, diagnose the error.
14441 ///
14442 /// \param E The expression that is being checked for unexpanded
14443 /// parameter packs.
14444 ///
14445 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14448
14449 /// If the given requirees-expression contains an unexpanded reference to one
14450 /// of its own parameter packs, diagnose the error.
14451 ///
14452 /// \param RE The requiress-expression that is being checked for unexpanded
14453 /// parameter packs.
14454 ///
14455 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14457
14458 /// If the given nested-name-specifier contains an unexpanded
14459 /// parameter pack, diagnose the error.
14460 ///
14461 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier that is being checked for
14462 /// unexpanded parameter packs.
14463 ///
14464 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14467
14468 /// If the given name contains an unexpanded parameter pack,
14469 /// diagnose the error.
14470 ///
14471 /// \param NameInfo The name (with source location information) that
14472 /// is being checked for unexpanded parameter packs.
14473 ///
14474 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14477
14478 /// If the given template name contains an unexpanded parameter pack,
14479 /// diagnose the error.
14480 ///
14481 /// \param Loc The location of the template name.
14482 ///
14483 /// \param Template The template name that is being checked for unexpanded
14484 /// parameter packs.
14485 ///
14486 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14490
14491 /// If the given template argument contains an unexpanded parameter
14492 /// pack, diagnose the error.
14493 ///
14494 /// \param Arg The template argument that is being checked for unexpanded
14495 /// parameter packs.
14496 ///
14497 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14500
14501 /// Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
14502 /// template argument.
14503 ///
14504 /// \param Arg The template argument that will be traversed to find
14505 /// unexpanded parameter packs.
14507 TemplateArgument Arg,
14509
14510 /// Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
14511 /// template argument.
14512 ///
14513 /// \param Arg The template argument that will be traversed to find
14514 /// unexpanded parameter packs.
14518
14519 /// Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
14520 /// type.
14521 ///
14522 /// \param T The type that will be traversed to find
14523 /// unexpanded parameter packs.
14526
14527 /// Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
14528 /// type.
14529 ///
14530 /// \param TL The type that will be traversed to find
14531 /// unexpanded parameter packs.
14534
14535 /// Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
14536 /// nested-name-specifier.
14537 ///
14538 /// \param NNS The nested-name-specifier that will be traversed to find
14539 /// unexpanded parameter packs.
14543
14544 /// Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
14545 /// name.
14546 ///
14547 /// \param NameInfo The name that will be traversed to find
14548 /// unexpanded parameter packs.
14550 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
14552
14553 /// Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given
14554 /// expression.
14557
14558 /// Invoked when parsing a template argument.
14559 ///
14560 /// \param Arg the template argument, which may already be invalid.
14561 ///
14562 /// If it is followed by ellipsis, this function is called before
14563 /// `ActOnPackExpansion`.
14566
14567 /// Invoked when parsing a template argument followed by an
14568 /// ellipsis, which creates a pack expansion.
14569 ///
14570 /// \param Arg The template argument preceding the ellipsis, which
14571 /// may already be invalid.
14572 ///
14573 /// \param EllipsisLoc The location of the ellipsis.
14575 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
14576
14577 /// Invoked when parsing a type followed by an ellipsis, which
14578 /// creates a pack expansion.
14579 ///
14580 /// \param Type The type preceding the ellipsis, which will become
14581 /// the pattern of the pack expansion.
14582 ///
14583 /// \param EllipsisLoc The location of the ellipsis.
14585
14586 /// Construct a pack expansion type from the pattern of the pack
14587 /// expansion.
14589 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
14590 UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions);
14591
14592 /// Construct a pack expansion type from the pattern of the pack
14593 /// expansion.
14594 QualType CheckPackExpansion(QualType Pattern, SourceRange PatternRange,
14595 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
14596 UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions);
14597
14598 /// Invoked when parsing an expression followed by an ellipsis, which
14599 /// creates a pack expansion.
14600 ///
14601 /// \param Pattern The expression preceding the ellipsis, which will become
14602 /// the pattern of the pack expansion.
14603 ///
14604 /// \param EllipsisLoc The location of the ellipsis.
14605 ExprResult ActOnPackExpansion(Expr *Pattern, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
14606
14607 /// Invoked when parsing an expression followed by an ellipsis, which
14608 /// creates a pack expansion.
14609 ///
14610 /// \param Pattern The expression preceding the ellipsis, which will become
14611 /// the pattern of the pack expansion.
14612 ///
14613 /// \param EllipsisLoc The location of the ellipsis.
14614 ExprResult CheckPackExpansion(Expr *Pattern, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
14615 UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions);
14616
14617 /// Determine whether we could expand a pack expansion with the
14618 /// given set of parameter packs into separate arguments by repeatedly
14619 /// transforming the pattern.
14620 ///
14621 /// \param EllipsisLoc The location of the ellipsis that identifies the
14622 /// pack expansion.
14623 ///
14624 /// \param PatternRange The source range that covers the entire pattern of
14625 /// the pack expansion.
14626 ///
14627 /// \param Unexpanded The set of unexpanded parameter packs within the
14628 /// pattern.
14629 ///
14630 /// \param ShouldExpand Will be set to \c true if the transformer should
14631 /// expand the corresponding pack expansions into separate arguments. When
14632 /// set, \c NumExpansions must also be set.
14633 ///
14634 /// \param RetainExpansion Whether the caller should add an unexpanded
14635 /// pack expansion after all of the expanded arguments. This is used
14636 /// when extending explicitly-specified template argument packs per
14637 /// C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p9.
14638 ///
14639 /// \param NumExpansions The number of separate arguments that will be in
14640 /// the expanded form of the corresponding pack expansion. This is both an
14641 /// input and an output parameter, which can be set by the caller if the
14642 /// number of expansions is known a priori (e.g., due to a prior substitution)
14643 /// and will be set by the callee when the number of expansions is known.
14644 /// The callee must set this value when \c ShouldExpand is \c true; it may
14645 /// set this value in other cases.
14646 ///
14647 /// \returns true if an error occurred (e.g., because the parameter packs
14648 /// are to be instantiated with arguments of different lengths), false
14649 /// otherwise. If false, \c ShouldExpand (and possibly \c NumExpansions)
14650 /// must be set.
14652 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, SourceRange PatternRange,
14654 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
14655 bool FailOnPackProducingTemplates, bool &ShouldExpand,
14656 bool &RetainExpansion, UnsignedOrNone &NumExpansions,
14657 bool Diagnose = true);
14658
14659 /// Determine the number of arguments in the given pack expansion
14660 /// type.
14661 ///
14662 /// This routine assumes that the number of arguments in the expansion is
14663 /// consistent across all of the unexpanded parameter packs in its pattern.
14664 ///
14665 /// Returns an empty Optional if the type can't be expanded.
14667 QualType T, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14668
14671 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs);
14672
14673 /// Determine whether the given declarator contains any unexpanded
14674 /// parameter packs.
14675 ///
14676 /// This routine is used by the parser to disambiguate function declarators
14677 /// with an ellipsis prior to the ')', e.g.,
14678 ///
14679 /// \code
14680 /// void f(T...);
14681 /// \endcode
14682 ///
14683 /// To determine whether we have an (unnamed) function parameter pack or
14684 /// a variadic function.
14685 ///
14686 /// \returns true if the declarator contains any unexpanded parameter packs,
14687 /// false otherwise.
14689
14690 /// Returns the pattern of the pack expansion for a template argument.
14691 ///
14692 /// \param OrigLoc The template argument to expand.
14693 ///
14694 /// \param Ellipsis Will be set to the location of the ellipsis.
14695 ///
14696 /// \param NumExpansions Will be set to the number of expansions that will
14697 /// be generated from this pack expansion, if known a priori.
14700 SourceLocation &Ellipsis,
14701 UnsignedOrNone &NumExpansions) const;
14702
14703 /// Given a template argument that contains an unexpanded parameter pack, but
14704 /// which has already been substituted, attempt to determine the number of
14705 /// elements that will be produced once this argument is fully-expanded.
14706 ///
14707 /// This is intended for use when transforming 'sizeof...(Arg)' in order to
14708 /// avoid actually expanding the pack where possible.
14710
14711 /// Called when an expression computing the size of a parameter pack
14712 /// is parsed.
14713 ///
14714 /// \code
14715 /// template<typename ...Types> struct count {
14716 /// static const unsigned value = sizeof...(Types);
14717 /// };
14718 /// \endcode
14719 ///
14720 //
14721 /// \param OpLoc The location of the "sizeof" keyword.
14722 /// \param Name The name of the parameter pack whose size will be determined.
14723 /// \param NameLoc The source location of the name of the parameter pack.
14724 /// \param RParenLoc The location of the closing parentheses.
14726 IdentifierInfo &Name,
14727 SourceLocation NameLoc,
14728 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
14729
14730 ExprResult ActOnPackIndexingExpr(Scope *S, Expr *PackExpression,
14731 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
14732 SourceLocation LSquareLoc, Expr *IndexExpr,
14733 SourceLocation RSquareLoc);
14734
14735 ExprResult BuildPackIndexingExpr(Expr *PackExpression,
14736 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, Expr *IndexExpr,
14737 SourceLocation RSquareLoc,
14738 ArrayRef<Expr *> ExpandedExprs = {},
14739 bool FullySubstituted = false);
14740
14741 /// Handle a C++1z fold-expression: ( expr op ... op expr ).
14742 ExprResult ActOnCXXFoldExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr *LHS,
14743 tok::TokenKind Operator,
14744 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, Expr *RHS,
14745 SourceLocation RParenLoc);
14746 ExprResult BuildCXXFoldExpr(UnresolvedLookupExpr *Callee,
14747 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr *LHS,
14748 BinaryOperatorKind Operator,
14749 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, Expr *RHS,
14750 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
14751 UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions);
14752 ExprResult BuildEmptyCXXFoldExpr(SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
14753 BinaryOperatorKind Operator);
14754
14755 ///@}
14756
14757 //
14758 //
14759 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
14760 //
14761 //
14762
14763 /// \name Constraints and Concepts
14764 /// Implementations are in SemaConcept.cpp
14765 ///@{
14766
14767public:
14769 const llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) {
14770 const NamedDecl *Can = cast<NamedDecl>(D->getCanonicalDecl());
14771 SatisfactionStack.emplace_back(Can, ID);
14772 }
14773
14774 void PopSatisfactionStackEntry() { SatisfactionStack.pop_back(); }
14775
14777 const llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const {
14778 const NamedDecl *Can = cast<NamedDecl>(D->getCanonicalDecl());
14779 return llvm::is_contained(SatisfactionStack,
14780 SatisfactionStackEntryTy{Can, ID});
14781 }
14782
14784 std::pair<const NamedDecl *, llvm::FoldingSetNodeID>;
14785
14786 // Resets the current SatisfactionStack for cases where we are instantiating
14787 // constraints as a 'side effect' of normal instantiation in a way that is not
14788 // indicative of recursive definition.
14791 Sema &SemaRef;
14792
14793 public:
14795 SemaRef.SwapSatisfactionStack(BackupSatisfactionStack);
14796 }
14797
14799 SemaRef.SwapSatisfactionStack(BackupSatisfactionStack);
14800 }
14801 };
14802
14805 SatisfactionStack.swap(NewSS);
14806 }
14807
14809 llvm::PointerUnion<const NamedDecl *,
14811
14812 /// Check whether the given expression is a valid constraint expression.
14813 /// A diagnostic is emitted if it is not, false is returned, and
14814 /// PossibleNonPrimary will be set to true if the failure might be due to a
14815 /// non-primary expression being used as an atomic constraint.
14816 bool CheckConstraintExpression(const Expr *CE, Token NextToken = Token(),
14817 bool *PossibleNonPrimary = nullptr,
14818 bool IsTrailingRequiresClause = false);
14819
14820 /// \brief Check whether the given list of constraint expressions are
14821 /// satisfied (as if in a 'conjunction') given template arguments.
14822 /// \param Template the template-like entity that triggered the constraints
14823 /// check (either a concept or a constrained entity).
14824 /// \param ConstraintExprs a list of constraint expressions, treated as if
14825 /// they were 'AND'ed together.
14826 /// \param TemplateArgLists the list of template arguments to substitute into
14827 /// the constraint expression.
14828 /// \param TemplateIDRange The source range of the template id that
14829 /// caused the constraints check.
14830 /// \param Satisfaction if true is returned, will contain details of the
14831 /// satisfaction, with enough information to diagnose an unsatisfied
14832 /// expression.
14833 /// \returns true if an error occurred and satisfaction could not be checked,
14834 /// false otherwise.
14837 ArrayRef<AssociatedConstraint> AssociatedConstraints,
14838 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgLists,
14839 SourceRange TemplateIDRange, ConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction,
14840 const ConceptReference *TopLevelConceptId = nullptr,
14841 Expr **ConvertedExpr = nullptr);
14842
14843 /// \brief Check whether the given non-dependent constraint expression is
14844 /// satisfied. Returns false and updates Satisfaction with the satisfaction
14845 /// verdict if successful, emits a diagnostic and returns true if an error
14846 /// occurred and satisfaction could not be determined.
14847 ///
14848 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14849 bool
14851 ConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction);
14852
14853 /// Check whether the given function decl's trailing requires clause is
14854 /// satisfied, if any. Returns false and updates Satisfaction with the
14855 /// satisfaction verdict if successful, emits a diagnostic and returns true if
14856 /// an error occurred and satisfaction could not be determined.
14857 ///
14858 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14860 ConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction,
14861 SourceLocation UsageLoc = SourceLocation(),
14862 bool ForOverloadResolution = false);
14863
14864 // Calculates whether two constraint expressions are equal irrespective of a
14865 // difference in 'depth'. This takes a pair of optional 'NamedDecl's 'Old' and
14866 // 'New', which are the "source" of the constraint, since this is necessary
14867 // for figuring out the relative 'depth' of the constraint. The depth of the
14868 // 'primary template' and the 'instantiated from' templates aren't necessarily
14869 // the same, such as a case when one is a 'friend' defined in a class.
14871 const Expr *OldConstr,
14873 const Expr *NewConstr);
14874
14875 // Calculates whether the friend function depends on an enclosing template for
14876 // the purposes of [temp.friend] p9.
14878
14879 /// \brief Ensure that the given template arguments satisfy the constraints
14880 /// associated with the given template, emitting a diagnostic if they do not.
14881 ///
14882 /// \param Template The template to which the template arguments are being
14883 /// provided.
14884 ///
14885 /// \param TemplateArgs The converted, canonicalized template arguments.
14886 ///
14887 /// \param TemplateIDRange The source range of the template id that
14888 /// caused the constraints check.
14889 ///
14890 /// \returns true if the constrains are not satisfied or could not be checked
14891 /// for satisfaction, false if the constraints are satisfied.
14894 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs,
14895 SourceRange TemplateIDRange);
14896
14897 bool CheckFunctionTemplateConstraints(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation,
14899 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> TemplateArgs,
14900 ConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction);
14901
14902 /// \brief Emit diagnostics explaining why a constraint expression was deemed
14903 /// unsatisfied.
14904 /// \param First whether this is the first time an unsatisfied constraint is
14905 /// diagnosed for this error.
14907 SourceLocation Loc = {},
14908 bool First = true);
14909
14910 /// \brief Emit diagnostics explaining why a constraint expression was deemed
14911 /// unsatisfied.
14912 void
14914 bool First = true);
14915
14918 ArrayRef<AssociatedConstraint> AssociatedConstraints);
14919
14920 /// \brief Check whether the given declaration's associated constraints are
14921 /// at least as constrained than another declaration's according to the
14922 /// partial ordering of constraints.
14923 ///
14924 /// \param Result If no error occurred, receives the result of true if D1 is
14925 /// at least constrained than D2, and false otherwise.
14926 ///
14927 /// \returns true if an error occurred, false otherwise.
14928 bool IsAtLeastAsConstrained(const NamedDecl *D1,
14930 const NamedDecl *D2,
14932 bool &Result);
14933
14934 /// If D1 was not at least as constrained as D2, but would've been if a pair
14935 /// of atomic constraints involved had been declared in a concept and not
14936 /// repeated in two separate places in code.
14937 /// \returns true if such a diagnostic was emitted, false otherwise.
14941
14942 /// Cache the satisfaction of an atomic constraint.
14943 /// The key is based on the unsubstituted expression and the parameter
14944 /// mapping. This lets us not substituting the mapping more than once,
14945 /// which is (very!) expensive.
14946 /// FIXME: this should be private.
14947 llvm::DenseMap<llvm::FoldingSetNodeID,
14950
14951private:
14952 /// Caches pairs of template-like decls whose associated constraints were
14953 /// checked for subsumption and whether or not the first's constraints did in
14954 /// fact subsume the second's.
14955 llvm::DenseMap<std::pair<const NamedDecl *, const NamedDecl *>, bool>
14956 SubsumptionCache;
14957 /// Caches the normalized associated constraints of declarations (concepts or
14958 /// constrained declarations). If an error occurred while normalizing the
14959 /// associated constraints of the template or concept, nullptr will be cached
14960 /// here.
14961 llvm::DenseMap<ConstrainedDeclOrNestedRequirement, NormalizedConstraint *>
14962 NormalizationCache;
14963
14964 /// Cache whether the associated constraint of a declaration
14965 /// is satisfied.
14966 llvm::ContextualFoldingSet<ConstraintSatisfaction, const ASTContext &>
14967 SatisfactionCache;
14968
14969 // The current stack of constraint satisfactions, so we can exit-early.
14971
14972 /// Used by SetupConstraintCheckingTemplateArgumentsAndScope to set up the
14973 /// LocalInstantiationScope of the current non-lambda function. For lambdas,
14974 /// use LambdaScopeForCallOperatorInstantiationRAII.
14975 bool
14976 SetupConstraintScope(FunctionDecl *FD,
14977 std::optional<ArrayRef<TemplateArgument>> TemplateArgs,
14978 const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &MLTAL,
14980
14981 /// Used during constraint checking, sets up the constraint template argument
14982 /// lists, and calls SetupConstraintScope to set up the
14983 /// LocalInstantiationScope to have the proper set of ParVarDecls configured.
14984 std::optional<MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList>
14985 SetupConstraintCheckingTemplateArgumentsAndScope(
14986 FunctionDecl *FD, std::optional<ArrayRef<TemplateArgument>> TemplateArgs,
14988
14989 ///@}
14990
14991 //
14992 //
14993 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
14994 //
14995 //
14996
14997 /// \name Types
14998 /// Implementations are in SemaType.cpp
14999 ///@{
15000
15001public:
15002 /// A mapping that describes the nullability we've seen in each header file.
15004
15005 static int getPrintable(int I) { return I; }
15006 static unsigned getPrintable(unsigned I) { return I; }
15007 static bool getPrintable(bool B) { return B; }
15008 static const char *getPrintable(const char *S) { return S; }
15009 static StringRef getPrintable(StringRef S) { return S; }
15010 static const std::string &getPrintable(const std::string &S) { return S; }
15011 static const IdentifierInfo *getPrintable(const IdentifierInfo *II) {
15012 return II;
15013 }
15015 static QualType getPrintable(QualType T) { return T; }
15016 static SourceRange getPrintable(SourceRange R) { return R; }
15018 static SourceRange getPrintable(const Expr *E) { return E->getSourceRange(); }
15020
15021 enum class CompleteTypeKind {
15022 /// Apply the normal rules for complete types. In particular,
15023 /// treat all sizeless types as incomplete.
15025
15026 /// Relax the normal rules for complete types so that they include
15027 /// sizeless built-in types.
15029
15030 // FIXME: Eventually we should flip the default to Normal and opt in
15031 // to AcceptSizeless rather than opt out of it.
15033 };
15034
15036 const DeclSpec *DS = nullptr);
15038 const DeclSpec *DS = nullptr);
15039
15040 /// Build a pointer type.
15041 ///
15042 /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a pointer.
15043 ///
15044 /// \param Loc The location of the entity whose type involves this
15045 /// pointer type or, if there is no such entity, the location of the
15046 /// type that will have pointer type.
15047 ///
15048 /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the pointer
15049 /// type, if known.
15050 ///
15051 /// \returns A suitable pointer type, if there are no
15052 /// errors. Otherwise, returns a NULL type.
15054 DeclarationName Entity);
15055
15056 /// Build a reference type.
15057 ///
15058 /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a reference.
15059 ///
15060 /// \param Loc The location of the entity whose type involves this
15061 /// reference type or, if there is no such entity, the location of the
15062 /// type that will have reference type.
15063 ///
15064 /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the reference
15065 /// type, if known.
15066 ///
15067 /// \returns A suitable reference type, if there are no
15068 /// errors. Otherwise, returns a NULL type.
15070 DeclarationName Entity);
15071
15072 /// Build an array type.
15073 ///
15074 /// \param T The type of each element in the array.
15075 ///
15076 /// \param ASM C99 array size modifier (e.g., '*', 'static').
15077 ///
15078 /// \param ArraySize Expression describing the size of the array.
15079 ///
15080 /// \param Brackets The range from the opening '[' to the closing ']'.
15081 ///
15082 /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the array
15083 /// type, if known.
15084 ///
15085 /// \returns A suitable array type, if there are no errors. Otherwise,
15086 /// returns a NULL type.
15088 unsigned Quals, SourceRange Brackets,
15089 DeclarationName Entity);
15091
15092 /// Build an ext-vector type.
15093 ///
15094 /// Run the required checks for the extended vector type.
15096 SourceLocation AttrLoc);
15097 QualType BuildMatrixType(QualType T, Expr *NumRows, Expr *NumColumns,
15098 SourceLocation AttrLoc);
15099
15101 Expr *CountExpr,
15102 bool CountInBytes,
15103 bool OrNull);
15104
15105 /// BuildAddressSpaceAttr - Builds a DependentAddressSpaceType if an
15106 /// expression is uninstantiated. If instantiated it will apply the
15107 /// appropriate address space to the type. This function allows dependent
15108 /// template variables to be used in conjunction with the address_space
15109 /// attribute
15110 QualType BuildAddressSpaceAttr(QualType &T, LangAS ASIdx, Expr *AddrSpace,
15111 SourceLocation AttrLoc);
15112
15113 /// Same as above, but constructs the AddressSpace index if not provided.
15115 SourceLocation AttrLoc);
15116
15118
15120
15121 /// Build a function type.
15122 ///
15123 /// This routine checks the function type according to C++ rules and
15124 /// under the assumption that the result type and parameter types have
15125 /// just been instantiated from a template. It therefore duplicates
15126 /// some of the behavior of GetTypeForDeclarator, but in a much
15127 /// simpler form that is only suitable for this narrow use case.
15128 ///
15129 /// \param T The return type of the function.
15130 ///
15131 /// \param ParamTypes The parameter types of the function. This array
15132 /// will be modified to account for adjustments to the types of the
15133 /// function parameters.
15134 ///
15135 /// \param Loc The location of the entity whose type involves this
15136 /// function type or, if there is no such entity, the location of the
15137 /// type that will have function type.
15138 ///
15139 /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the function
15140 /// type, if known.
15141 ///
15142 /// \param EPI Extra information about the function type. Usually this will
15143 /// be taken from an existing function with the same prototype.
15144 ///
15145 /// \returns A suitable function type, if there are no errors. The
15146 /// unqualified type will always be a FunctionProtoType.
15147 /// Otherwise, returns a NULL type.
15149 SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity,
15151
15152 /// Build a member pointer type \c T Class::*.
15153 ///
15154 /// \param T the type to which the member pointer refers.
15155 /// \param Class the class type into which the member pointer points.
15156 /// \param Loc the location where this type begins
15157 /// \param Entity the name of the entity that will have this member pointer
15158 /// type
15159 ///
15160 /// \returns a member pointer type, if successful, or a NULL type if there was
15161 /// an error.
15163 CXXRecordDecl *Cls, SourceLocation Loc,
15164 DeclarationName Entity);
15165
15166 /// Build a block pointer type.
15167 ///
15168 /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a block pointer.
15169 ///
15170 /// \param Loc The source location, used for diagnostics.
15171 ///
15172 /// \param Entity The name of the entity that involves the block pointer
15173 /// type, if known.
15174 ///
15175 /// \returns A suitable block pointer type, if there are no
15176 /// errors. Otherwise, returns a NULL type.
15178 DeclarationName Entity);
15179
15180 /// Build a paren type including \p T.
15183
15184 /// Build a Read-only Pipe type.
15185 ///
15186 /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a Pipe.
15187 ///
15188 /// \param Loc We do not use it for now.
15189 ///
15190 /// \returns A suitable pipe type, if there are no errors. Otherwise, returns
15191 /// a NULL type.
15193
15194 /// Build a Write-only Pipe type.
15195 ///
15196 /// \param T The type to which we'll be building a Pipe.
15197 ///
15198 /// \param Loc We do not use it for now.
15199 ///
15200 /// \returns A suitable pipe type, if there are no errors. Otherwise, returns
15201 /// a NULL type.
15203
15204 /// Build a bit-precise integer type.
15205 ///
15206 /// \param IsUnsigned Boolean representing the signedness of the type.
15207 ///
15208 /// \param BitWidth Size of this int type in bits, or an expression
15209 /// representing that.
15210 ///
15211 /// \param Loc Location of the keyword.
15212 QualType BuildBitIntType(bool IsUnsigned, Expr *BitWidth, SourceLocation Loc);
15213
15214 /// GetTypeForDeclarator - Convert the type for the specified
15215 /// declarator to Type instances.
15216 ///
15217 /// The result of this call will never be null, but the associated
15218 /// type may be a null type if there's an unrecoverable error.
15221
15222 /// Package the given type and TSI into a ParsedType.
15225 TypeSourceInfo **TInfo = nullptr);
15226
15228
15229 // Check whether the size of array element of type \p EltTy is a multiple of
15230 // its alignment and return false if it isn't.
15232
15233 void
15234 diagnoseIgnoredQualifiers(unsigned DiagID, unsigned Quals,
15235 SourceLocation FallbackLoc,
15236 SourceLocation ConstQualLoc = SourceLocation(),
15237 SourceLocation VolatileQualLoc = SourceLocation(),
15238 SourceLocation RestrictQualLoc = SourceLocation(),
15239 SourceLocation AtomicQualLoc = SourceLocation(),
15240 SourceLocation UnalignedQualLoc = SourceLocation());
15241
15242 /// Retrieve the keyword associated
15244
15245 /// Adjust the calling convention of a method to be the ABI default if it
15246 /// wasn't specified explicitly. This handles method types formed from
15247 /// function type typedefs and typename template arguments.
15248 void adjustMemberFunctionCC(QualType &T, bool HasThisPointer,
15249 bool IsCtorOrDtor, SourceLocation Loc);
15250
15251 // Check if there is an explicit attribute, but only look through parens.
15252 // The intent is to look for an attribute on the current declarator, but not
15253 // one that came from a typedef.
15255
15256 /// Check whether a nullability type specifier can be added to the given
15257 /// type through some means not written in source (e.g. API notes).
15258 ///
15259 /// \param Type The type to which the nullability specifier will be
15260 /// added. On success, this type will be updated appropriately.
15261 ///
15262 /// \param Nullability The nullability specifier to add.
15263 ///
15264 /// \param DiagLoc The location to use for diagnostics.
15265 ///
15266 /// \param AllowArrayTypes Whether to accept nullability specifiers on an
15267 /// array type (e.g., because it will decay to a pointer).
15268 ///
15269 /// \param OverrideExisting Whether to override an existing, locally-specified
15270 /// nullability specifier rather than complaining about the conflict.
15271 ///
15272 /// \returns true if nullability cannot be applied, false otherwise.
15274 NullabilityKind Nullability,
15275 SourceLocation DiagLoc,
15276 bool AllowArrayTypes,
15277 bool OverrideExisting);
15278
15279 /// Get the type of expression E, triggering instantiation to complete the
15280 /// type if necessary -- that is, if the expression refers to a templated
15281 /// static data member of incomplete array type.
15282 ///
15283 /// May still return an incomplete type if instantiation was not possible or
15284 /// if the type is incomplete for a different reason. Use
15285 /// RequireCompleteExprType instead if a diagnostic is expected for an
15286 /// incomplete expression type.
15288
15290
15291 /// Ensure that the type of the given expression is complete.
15292 ///
15293 /// This routine checks whether the expression \p E has a complete type. If
15294 /// the expression refers to an instantiable construct, that instantiation is
15295 /// performed as needed to complete its type. Furthermore
15296 /// Sema::RequireCompleteType is called for the expression's type (or in the
15297 /// case of a reference type, the referred-to type).
15298 ///
15299 /// \param E The expression whose type is required to be complete.
15300 /// \param Kind Selects which completeness rules should be applied.
15301 /// \param Diagnoser The object that will emit a diagnostic if the type is
15302 /// incomplete.
15303 ///
15304 /// \returns \c true if the type of \p E is incomplete and diagnosed, \c false
15305 /// otherwise.
15307 TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser);
15308 bool RequireCompleteExprType(Expr *E, unsigned DiagID);
15309
15310 template <typename... Ts>
15311 bool RequireCompleteExprType(Expr *E, unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args) {
15312 BoundTypeDiagnoser<Ts...> Diagnoser(DiagID, Args...);
15314 }
15315
15316 // Returns the underlying type of a decltype with the given expression.
15318
15320 /// If AsUnevaluated is false, E is treated as though it were an evaluated
15321 /// context, such as when building a type for decltype(auto).
15322 QualType BuildDecltypeType(Expr *E, bool AsUnevaluated = true);
15323
15324 QualType ActOnPackIndexingType(QualType Pattern, Expr *IndexExpr,
15325 SourceLocation Loc,
15326 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc);
15327 QualType BuildPackIndexingType(QualType Pattern, Expr *IndexExpr,
15328 SourceLocation Loc, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
15329 bool FullySubstituted = false,
15330 ArrayRef<QualType> Expansions = {});
15331
15332 using UTTKind = UnaryTransformType::UTTKind;
15334 SourceLocation Loc);
15340 SourceLocation Loc);
15342 SourceLocation Loc);
15344 SourceLocation Loc);
15345
15347 return BuiltinRemoveReference(BaseType, UTTKind::RemoveCVRef, Loc);
15348 }
15349
15351 SourceLocation Loc);
15353 SourceLocation Loc);
15354
15355 bool BuiltinIsBaseOf(SourceLocation RhsTLoc, QualType LhsT, QualType RhsT);
15356
15357 /// Ensure that the type T is a literal type.
15358 ///
15359 /// This routine checks whether the type @p T is a literal type. If @p T is an
15360 /// incomplete type, an attempt is made to complete it. If @p T is a literal
15361 /// type, or @p AllowIncompleteType is true and @p T is an incomplete type,
15362 /// returns false. Otherwise, this routine issues the diagnostic @p PD (giving
15363 /// it the type @p T), along with notes explaining why the type is not a
15364 /// literal type, and returns true.
15365 ///
15366 /// @param Loc The location in the source that the non-literal type
15367 /// diagnostic should refer to.
15368 ///
15369 /// @param T The type that this routine is examining for literalness.
15370 ///
15371 /// @param Diagnoser Emits a diagnostic if T is not a literal type.
15372 ///
15373 /// @returns @c true if @p T is not a literal type and a diagnostic was
15374 /// emitted, @c false otherwise.
15376 TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser);
15377 bool RequireLiteralType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID);
15378
15379 template <typename... Ts>
15380 bool RequireLiteralType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID,
15381 const Ts &...Args) {
15382 BoundTypeDiagnoser<Ts...> Diagnoser(DiagID, Args...);
15383 return RequireLiteralType(Loc, T, Diagnoser);
15384 }
15385
15388 return !RequireCompleteTypeImpl(Loc, T, Kind, nullptr);
15389 }
15390
15391 /// Ensure that the type T is a complete type.
15392 ///
15393 /// This routine checks whether the type @p T is complete in any
15394 /// context where a complete type is required. If @p T is a complete
15395 /// type, returns false. If @p T is a class template specialization,
15396 /// this routine then attempts to perform class template
15397 /// instantiation. If instantiation fails, or if @p T is incomplete
15398 /// and cannot be completed, issues the diagnostic @p diag (giving it
15399 /// the type @p T) and returns true.
15400 ///
15401 /// @param Loc The location in the source that the incomplete type
15402 /// diagnostic should refer to.
15403 ///
15404 /// @param T The type that this routine is examining for completeness.
15405 ///
15406 /// @param Kind Selects which completeness rules should be applied.
15407 ///
15408 /// @returns @c true if @p T is incomplete and a diagnostic was emitted,
15409 /// @c false otherwise.
15411 CompleteTypeKind Kind, TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser);
15413 CompleteTypeKind Kind, unsigned DiagID);
15414
15416 TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser) {
15417 return RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, CompleteTypeKind::Default, Diagnoser);
15418 }
15419 bool RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID) {
15420 return RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, CompleteTypeKind::Default, DiagID);
15421 }
15422
15423 template <typename... Ts>
15424 bool RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID,
15425 const Ts &...Args) {
15426 BoundTypeDiagnoser<Ts...> Diagnoser(DiagID, Args...);
15427 return RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, Diagnoser);
15428 }
15429
15430 /// Determine whether a declaration is visible to name lookup.
15431 bool isVisible(const NamedDecl *D) {
15432 return D->isUnconditionallyVisible() ||
15433 isAcceptableSlow(D, AcceptableKind::Visible);
15434 }
15435
15436 /// Determine whether a declaration is reachable.
15437 bool isReachable(const NamedDecl *D) {
15438 // All visible declarations are reachable.
15439 return D->isUnconditionallyVisible() ||
15440 isAcceptableSlow(D, AcceptableKind::Reachable);
15441 }
15442
15443 /// Determine whether a declaration is acceptable (visible/reachable).
15445 return Kind == AcceptableKind::Visible ? isVisible(D) : isReachable(D);
15446 }
15447
15448 /// Determine if \p D and \p Suggested have a structurally compatible
15449 /// layout as described in C11 6.2.7/1.
15450 bool hasStructuralCompatLayout(Decl *D, Decl *Suggested);
15451
15452 /// Determine if \p D has a visible definition. If not, suggest a declaration
15453 /// that should be made visible to expose the definition.
15454 bool hasVisibleDefinition(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested,
15455 bool OnlyNeedComplete = false);
15457 NamedDecl *Hidden;
15458 return hasVisibleDefinition(const_cast<NamedDecl *>(D), &Hidden);
15459 }
15460 /// Determine if \p D has a definition which allows we redefine it in current
15461 /// TU. \p Suggested is the definition that should be made visible to expose
15462 /// the definition.
15463 bool isRedefinitionAllowedFor(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested,
15464 bool &Visible);
15466 NamedDecl *Hidden;
15467 return isRedefinitionAllowedFor(const_cast<NamedDecl *>(D), &Hidden,
15468 Visible);
15469 }
15470
15471 /// Determine if \p D has a reachable definition. If not, suggest a
15472 /// declaration that should be made reachable to expose the definition.
15473 bool hasReachableDefinition(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested,
15474 bool OnlyNeedComplete = false);
15476 NamedDecl *Hidden;
15477 return hasReachableDefinition(D, &Hidden);
15478 }
15479
15480 bool hasAcceptableDefinition(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested,
15481 AcceptableKind Kind,
15482 bool OnlyNeedComplete = false);
15484 NamedDecl *Hidden;
15485 return hasAcceptableDefinition(D, &Hidden, Kind);
15486 }
15487
15488 /// Try to parse the conditional expression attached to an effect attribute
15489 /// (e.g. 'nonblocking'). (c.f. Sema::ActOnNoexceptSpec). Return an empty
15490 /// optional on error.
15491 std::optional<FunctionEffectMode>
15492 ActOnEffectExpression(Expr *CondExpr, StringRef AttributeName);
15493
15494 void ActOnCleanupAttr(Decl *D, const Attr *A);
15495
15496private:
15497 /// The implementation of RequireCompleteType
15498 bool RequireCompleteTypeImpl(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T,
15499 CompleteTypeKind Kind, TypeDiagnoser *Diagnoser);
15500
15501 /// Nullability type specifiers.
15502 IdentifierInfo *Ident__Nonnull = nullptr;
15503 IdentifierInfo *Ident__Nullable = nullptr;
15504 IdentifierInfo *Ident__Nullable_result = nullptr;
15505 IdentifierInfo *Ident__Null_unspecified = nullptr;
15506
15507 ///@}
15508
15509 //
15510 //
15511 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
15512 //
15513 //
15514
15515 /// \name FixIt Helpers
15516 /// Implementations are in SemaFixItUtils.cpp
15517 ///@{
15518
15519public:
15520 /// Get a string to suggest for zero-initialization of a type.
15522 SourceLocation Loc) const;
15523 std::string getFixItZeroLiteralForType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc) const;
15524
15525 ///@}
15526
15527 //
15528 //
15529 // -------------------------------------------------------------------------
15530 //
15531 //
15532
15533 /// \name Function Effects
15534 /// Implementations are in SemaFunctionEffects.cpp
15535 ///@{
15536public:
15539
15542 std::optional<FunctionEffectWithCondition>
15543 Old; // Invalid when 'Kind' is 'Added'.
15544 std::optional<FunctionEffectWithCondition>
15545 New; // Invalid when 'Kind' is 'Removed'.
15546
15547 StringRef effectName() const {
15548 if (Old)
15549 return Old.value().Effect.name();
15550 return New.value().Effect.name();
15551 }
15552
15553 /// Describes the result of effects differing between a base class's virtual
15554 /// method and an overriding method in a subclass.
15555 enum class OverrideResult {
15558 Merge // Merge missing effect from base to derived.
15559 };
15560
15561 /// Return true if adding or removing the effect as part of a type
15562 /// conversion should generate a diagnostic.
15564 const FunctionEffectsRef &SrcFX,
15565 QualType DstType,
15566 const FunctionEffectsRef &DstFX) const;
15567
15568 /// Return true if adding or removing the effect in a redeclaration should
15569 /// generate a diagnostic.
15570 bool shouldDiagnoseRedeclaration(const FunctionDecl &OldFunction,
15571 const FunctionEffectsRef &OldFX,
15572 const FunctionDecl &NewFunction,
15573 const FunctionEffectsRef &NewFX) const;
15574
15575 /// Return true if adding or removing the effect in a C++ virtual method
15576 /// override should generate a diagnostic.
15578 const CXXMethodDecl &OldMethod, const FunctionEffectsRef &OldFX,
15579 const CXXMethodDecl &NewMethod, const FunctionEffectsRef &NewFX) const;
15580 };
15581
15582 struct FunctionEffectDiffVector : public SmallVector<FunctionEffectDiff> {
15583 /// Caller should short-circuit by checking for equality first.
15585 const FunctionEffectsRef &New);
15586 };
15587
15588 /// All functions/lambdas/blocks which have bodies and which have a non-empty
15589 /// FunctionEffectsRef to be verified.
15591
15592 /// The union of all effects present on DeclsWithEffectsToVerify. Conditions
15593 /// are all null.
15595
15596public:
15597 /// Warn and return true if adding a function effect to a set would create a
15598 /// conflict.
15601 SourceLocation NewAttrLoc);
15602
15603 // Report a failure to merge function effects between declarations due to a
15604 // conflict.
15605 void
15607 SourceLocation NewLoc,
15608 SourceLocation OldLoc);
15609
15610 /// Inline checks from the start of maybeAddDeclWithEffects, to
15611 /// minimize performance impact on code not using effects.
15612 template <class FuncOrBlockDecl>
15613 void maybeAddDeclWithEffects(FuncOrBlockDecl *D) {
15614 if (Context.hasAnyFunctionEffects())
15615 if (FunctionEffectsRef FX = D->getFunctionEffects(); !FX.empty())
15617 }
15618
15619 /// Potentially add a FunctionDecl or BlockDecl to DeclsWithEffectsToVerify.
15620 void maybeAddDeclWithEffects(const Decl *D, const FunctionEffectsRef &FX);
15621
15622 /// Unconditionally add a Decl to DeclsWithEfffectsToVerify.
15623 void addDeclWithEffects(const Decl *D, const FunctionEffectsRef &FX);
15624
15626
15627 ///@}
15628};
15629
15630DeductionFailureInfo
15632 sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info);
15633
15634/// Contains a late templated function.
15635/// Will be parsed at the end of the translation unit, used by Sema & Parser.
15638 /// The template function declaration to be late parsed.
15640 /// Floating-point options in the point of definition.
15642};
15643
15644template <>
15646 PragmaMsStackAction Action,
15647 llvm::StringRef StackSlotLabel,
15649
15650} // end namespace clang
15651
15652#endif
#define V(N, I)
Forward declaration of all AST node types.
This file provides some common utility functions for processing Lambda related AST Constructs.
Defines enum values for all the target-independent builtin functions.
Defines the C++ Decl subclasses, other than those for templates (found in DeclTemplate....
This file defines the classes used to store parsed information about declaration-specifiers and decla...
Defines the C++ template declaration subclasses.
Defines the ExceptionSpecificationType enumeration and various utility functions.
Defines the clang::Expr interface and subclasses for C++ expressions.
Defines Expressions and AST nodes for C++2a concepts.
Defines enumerations for expression traits intrinsics.
Token Tok
The Token.
FormatToken * Previous
The previous token in the unwrapped line.
static const Decl * getCanonicalDecl(const Decl *D)
#define X(type, name)
Definition Value.h:97
Forward-declares and imports various common LLVM datatypes that clang wants to use unqualified.
Defines several types used to describe C++ lambda expressions that are shared between the parser and ...
Defines the clang::LangOptions interface.
llvm::MachO::Record Record
Definition MachO.h:31
Defines the clang::Module class, which describes a module in the source code.
#define SM(sm)
Defines the clang::OpenCLOptions class.
Defines an enumeration for C++ overloaded operators.
Implements a partial diagnostic that can be emitted anwyhere in a DiagnosticBuilder stream.
RedeclarationKind
Specifies whether (or how) name lookup is being performed for a redeclaration (vs.
@ NotForRedeclaration
The lookup is a reference to this name that is not for the purpose of redeclaring the name.
llvm::SmallVector< std::pair< const MemRegion *, SVal >, 4 > Bindings
static std::string toString(const clang::SanitizerSet &Sanitizers)
Produce a string containing comma-separated names of sanitizers in Sanitizers set.
AccessResult
A copy of Sema's enum without AR_delayed.
CastType
Definition SemaCast.cpp:49
static void CheckFormatString(Sema &S, const FormatStringLiteral *FExpr, const StringLiteral *ReferenceFormatString, const Expr *OrigFormatExpr, ArrayRef< const Expr * > Args, Sema::FormatArgumentPassingKind APK, unsigned format_idx, unsigned firstDataArg, FormatStringType Type, bool inFunctionCall, VariadicCallType CallType, llvm::SmallBitVector &CheckedVarArgs, UncoveredArgHandler &UncoveredArg, bool IgnoreStringsWithoutSpecifiers)
static void CheckBoolLikeConversion(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation CC)
Check conversion of given expression to boolean.
Sema::AllowedExplicit AllowedExplicit
This file declares semantic analysis functions specific to RISC-V.
Defines the clang::SourceLocation class and associated facilities.
Defines various enumerations that describe declaration and type specifiers.
Defines a utilitiy for warning once when close to out of stack space.
Defines the clang::TemplateNameKind enum.
Defines the clang::TokenKind enum and support functions.
Defines the clang::TypeLoc interface and its subclasses.
Defines enumerations for the type traits support.
TypePropertyCache< Private > Cache
Definition Type.cpp:4786
C Language Family Type Representation.
Holds long-lived AST nodes (such as types and decls) that can be referred to throughout the semantic ...
Definition ASTContext.h:220
Represents a member of a struct/union/class.
Definition Decl.h:3160
a trap message and trap category.
A class for storing results from argument-dependent lookup.
Definition Lookup.h:871
APValue - This class implements a discriminated union of [uninitialized] [APSInt] [APFloat],...
Definition APValue.h:122
ASTConsumer - This is an abstract interface that should be implemented by clients that read ASTs.
Definition ASTConsumer.h:35
Holds long-lived AST nodes (such as types and decls) that can be referred to throughout the semantic ...
Definition ASTContext.h:220
An abstract interface that should be implemented by listeners that want to be notified when an AST en...
Reads an AST files chain containing the contents of a translation unit.
Definition ASTReader.h:430
Writes an AST file containing the contents of a translation unit.
Definition ASTWriter.h:97
Represents an access specifier followed by colon ':'.
Definition DeclCXX.h:86
PtrTy get() const
Definition Ownership.h:171
bool isInvalid() const
Definition Ownership.h:167
ArraySubscriptExpr - [C99 6.5.2.1] Array Subscripting.
Definition Expr.h:2721
Represents an array type, per C99 6.7.5.2 - Array Declarators.
Definition TypeBase.h:3723
Attr - This represents one attribute.
Definition Attr.h:45
Represents a C++ declaration that introduces decls from somewhere else.
Definition DeclCXX.h:3492
A binding in a decomposition declaration.
Definition DeclCXX.h:4181
Represents a block literal declaration, which is like an unnamed FunctionDecl.
Definition Decl.h:4668
Represents a path from a specific derived class (which is not represented as part of the path) to a p...
BasePaths - Represents the set of paths from a derived class to one of its (direct or indirect) bases...
Represents a base class of a C++ class.
Definition DeclCXX.h:146
Represents a C++ constructor within a class.
Definition DeclCXX.h:2604
Represents a C++ conversion function within a class.
Definition DeclCXX.h:2939
Represents a C++ base or member initializer.
Definition DeclCXX.h:2369
Represents a delete expression for memory deallocation and destructor calls, e.g.
Definition ExprCXX.h:2626
Represents a C++ destructor within a class.
Definition DeclCXX.h:2869
CXXFieldCollector - Used to keep track of CXXFieldDecls during parsing of C++ classes.
Represents a static or instance method of a struct/union/class.
Definition DeclCXX.h:2129
Represents a C++ struct/union/class.
Definition DeclCXX.h:258
Represents a C++ nested-name-specifier or a global scope specifier.
Definition DeclSpec.h:73
Represents the this expression in C++.
Definition ExprCXX.h:1154
CXXTryStmt - A C++ try block, including all handlers.
Definition StmtCXX.h:69
CallExpr - Represents a function call (C99 6.5.2.2, C++ [expr.call]).
Definition Expr.h:2943
Represents the body of a CapturedStmt, and serves as its DeclContext.
Definition Decl.h:4940
CaseStmt - Represent a case statement.
Definition Stmt.h:1911
CastExpr - Base class for type casts, including both implicit casts (ImplicitCastExpr) and explicit c...
Definition Expr.h:3676
CharUnits - This is an opaque type for sizes expressed in character units.
Definition CharUnits.h:38
Declaration of a class template.
Represents a class template specialization, which refers to a class template with a given set of temp...
Abstract interface for a consumer of code-completion information.
Declaration of a C++20 concept.
A reference to a concept and its template args, as it appears in the code.
Definition ASTConcept.h:130
Represents the specialization of a concept - evaluates to a prvalue of type bool.
The result of a constraint satisfaction check, containing the necessary information to diagnose an un...
Definition ASTConcept.h:47
Represents a shadow constructor declaration introduced into a class by a C++11 using-declaration that...
Definition DeclCXX.h:3673
Base class for callback objects used by Sema::CorrectTypo to check the validity of a potential typo c...
The information about the darwin SDK that was used during this compilation.
A POD class for pairing a NamedDecl* with an access specifier.
static DeclAccessPair make(NamedDecl *D, AccessSpecifier AS)
The results of name lookup within a DeclContext.
Definition DeclBase.h:1382
DeclContext - This is used only as base class of specific decl types that can act as declaration cont...
Definition DeclBase.h:1449
A reference to a declared variable, function, enum, etc.
Definition Expr.h:1270
Captures information about "declaration specifiers".
Definition DeclSpec.h:217
Decl - This represents one declaration (or definition), e.g.
Definition DeclBase.h:86
bool isUnconditionallyVisible() const
Determine whether this declaration is definitely visible to name lookup, independent of whether the o...
Definition DeclBase.h:859
Module * getOwningModule() const
Get the module that owns this declaration (for visibility purposes).
Definition DeclBase.h:842
virtual Decl * getCanonicalDecl()
Retrieves the "canonical" declaration of the given declaration.
Definition DeclBase.h:978
The name of a declaration.
Represents a ValueDecl that came out of a declarator.
Definition Decl.h:780
Information about one declarator, including the parsed type information and the identifier.
Definition DeclSpec.h:1874
A decomposition declaration.
Definition DeclCXX.h:4245
Captures a template argument whose value has been deduced via c++ template argument deduction.
Definition Template.h:331
A dependently-generated diagnostic.
Designation - Represent a full designation, which is a sequence of designators.
Definition Designator.h:208
A little helper class used to produce diagnostics.
Concrete class used by the front-end to report problems and issues.
Definition Diagnostic.h:232
An instance of this object exists for each enum constant that is defined.
Definition Decl.h:3423
Represents an enum.
Definition Decl.h:4007
Store information needed for an explicit specifier.
Definition DeclCXX.h:1924
The return type of classify().
Definition Expr.h:337
This represents one expression.
Definition Expr.h:112
bool isTypeDependent() const
Determines whether the type of this expression depends on.
Definition Expr.h:194
std::optional< llvm::APSInt > getIntegerConstantExpr(const ASTContext &Ctx) const
isIntegerConstantExpr - Return the value if this expression is a valid integer constant expression.
NullPointerConstantKind
Enumeration used to describe the kind of Null pointer constant returned from isNullPointerConstant().
Definition Expr.h:802
SourceLocation getExprLoc() const LLVM_READONLY
getExprLoc - Return the preferred location for the arrow when diagnosing a problem with a generic exp...
Definition Expr.cpp:276
An abstract interface that should be implemented by external AST sources that also provide informatio...
virtual void ReadTentativeDefinitions(SmallVectorImpl< VarDecl * > &TentativeDefs)
Read the set of tentative definitions known to the external Sema source.
virtual void ReadUnusedFileScopedDecls(SmallVectorImpl< const DeclaratorDecl * > &Decls)
Read the set of unused file-scope declarations known to the external Sema source.
virtual void ReadExtVectorDecls(SmallVectorImpl< TypedefNameDecl * > &Decls)
Read the set of ext_vector type declarations known to the external Sema source.
virtual void ReadDelegatingConstructors(SmallVectorImpl< CXXConstructorDecl * > &Decls)
Read the set of delegating constructors known to the external Sema source.
Represents difference between two FPOptions values.
FPOptionsOverride getChangesFrom(const FPOptions &Base) const
Return difference with the given option set.
Represents a member of a struct/union/class.
Definition Decl.h:3160
An opaque identifier used by SourceManager which refers to a source file (MemoryBuffer) along with it...
A mapping from file IDs to a record of whether we've seen nullability information in that file.
Definition Sema.h:259
FileNullability & operator[](FileID file)
Definition Sema.h:270
FileNullability Nullability
Definition Sema.h:266
Represents a function declaration or definition.
Definition Decl.h:2000
A mutable set of FunctionEffect::Kind.
Definition TypeBase.h:5123
SmallVector< Conflict > Conflicts
Definition TypeBase.h:5237
Kind
Identifies the particular effect.
Definition TypeBase.h:4885
An immutable set of FunctionEffects and possibly conditions attached to them.
Definition TypeBase.h:5069
Represents a reference to a function parameter pack, init-capture pack, or binding pack that has been...
Definition ExprCXX.h:4841
Represents a prototype with parameter type info, e.g.
Definition TypeBase.h:5269
Declaration of a template function.
Interesting information about a specific parameter that can't simply be reflected in parameter's type...
Definition TypeBase.h:4491
FunctionType - C99 6.7.5.3 - Function Declarators.
Definition TypeBase.h:4465
One of these records is kept for each identifier that is lexed.
IdentifierResolver - Keeps track of shadowed decls on enclosing scopes.
ImplicitConversionSequence - Represents an implicit conversion sequence, which may be a standard conv...
Definition Overload.h:621
Represents a field injected from an anonymous union/struct into the parent scope.
Definition Decl.h:3467
Describes an C or C++ initializer list.
Definition Expr.h:5299
Describes the kind of initialization being performed, along with location information for tokens rela...
Describes the sequence of initializations required to initialize a given object or reference with a s...
Describes an entity that is being initialized.
Represents the declaration of a label.
Definition Decl.h:524
FPEvalMethodKind
Possible float expression evaluation method choices.
ComplexRangeKind
Controls the various implementations for complex multiplication and.
FPExceptionModeKind
Possible floating point exception behavior.
Keeps track of the various options that can be enabled, which controls the dialect of C or C++ that i...
Represents a lazily-loaded vector of data.
A stack-allocated class that identifies which local variable declaration instantiations are present i...
Definition Template.h:369
Represents the results of name lookup.
Definition Lookup.h:147
A global _GUID constant.
Definition DeclCXX.h:4394
An instance of this class represents the declaration of a property member.
Definition DeclCXX.h:4340
Keeps track of the mangled names of lambda expressions and block literals within a particular context...
Represents a prvalue temporary that is written into memory so that a reference can bind to it.
Definition ExprCXX.h:4920
MemberExpr - [C99 6.5.2.3] Structure and Union Members.
Definition Expr.h:3364
A pointer to member type per C++ 8.3.3 - Pointers to members.
Definition TypeBase.h:3654
Abstract interface for a module loader.
Describes a module or submodule.
Definition Module.h:144
Data structure that captures multiple levels of template argument lists for use in template instantia...
Definition Template.h:76
This represents a decl that may have a name.
Definition Decl.h:274
Represent a C++ namespace.
Definition Decl.h:592
A C++ nested-name-specifier augmented with source location information.
Represents a C++ nested name specifier, such as "\::std::vector<int>::".
NonTypeTemplateParmDecl - Declares a non-type template parameter, e.g., "Size" in.
Represents an ObjC class declaration.
Definition DeclObjC.h:1154
ObjCMethodDecl - Represents an instance or class method declaration.
Definition DeclObjC.h:140
Represents a pointer to an Objective C object.
Definition TypeBase.h:7911
Wrapper for void* pointer.
Definition Ownership.h:51
static OpaquePtr make(QualType P)
Definition Ownership.h:61
OpenCL supported extensions and optional core features.
OverloadCandidateSet - A set of overload candidates, used in C++ overload resolution (C++ 13....
Definition Overload.h:1159
A single parameter index whose accessors require each use to make explicit the parameter index encodi...
Definition Attr.h:273
ParenExpr - This represents a parenthesized expression, e.g.
Definition Expr.h:2182
Represents a parameter to a function.
Definition Decl.h:1790
ParsedAttr - Represents a syntactic attribute.
Definition ParsedAttr.h:119
ParsedAttributes - A collection of parsed attributes.
Definition ParsedAttr.h:937
Represents the parsed form of a C++ template argument.
void Emit(const DiagnosticBuilder &DB) const
PreferredTypeBuilder(ASTContext *Ctx, bool Enabled)
Definition Sema.h:293
void enterFunctionArgument(SourceLocation Tok, llvm::function_ref< QualType()> ComputeType)
Computing a type for the function argument may require running overloading, so we postpone its comput...
void enterCondition(Sema &S, SourceLocation Tok)
void enterTypeCast(SourceLocation Tok, QualType CastType)
Handles all type casts, including C-style cast, C++ casts, etc.
void enterMemAccess(Sema &S, SourceLocation Tok, Expr *Base)
void enterSubscript(Sema &S, SourceLocation Tok, Expr *LHS)
void enterUnary(Sema &S, SourceLocation Tok, tok::TokenKind OpKind, SourceLocation OpLoc)
void enterReturn(Sema &S, SourceLocation Tok)
void enterDesignatedInitializer(SourceLocation Tok, QualType BaseType, const Designation &D)
Handles e.g. BaseType{ .D = Tok...
void enterBinary(Sema &S, SourceLocation Tok, Expr *LHS, tok::TokenKind Op)
void enterParenExpr(SourceLocation Tok, SourceLocation LParLoc)
void enterVariableInit(SourceLocation Tok, Decl *D)
QualType get(SourceLocation Tok) const
Get the expected type associated with this location, if any.
Definition Sema.h:329
Engages in a tight little dance with the lexer to efficiently preprocess tokens.
Stores the type being destroyed by a pseudo-destructor expression.
Definition ExprCXX.h:2694
A (possibly-)qualified type.
Definition TypeBase.h:937
The collection of all-type qualifiers we support.
Definition TypeBase.h:331
Represents a struct/union/class.
Definition Decl.h:4321
Represents the body of a requires-expression.
Definition DeclCXX.h:2098
C++2a [expr.prim.req]: A requires-expression provides a concise way to express requirements on templa...
Scope - A scope is a transient data structure that is used while parsing the program.
Definition Scope.h:41
Smart pointer class that efficiently represents Objective-C method names.
A generic diagnostic builder for errors which may or may not be deferred.
Definition SemaBase.h:111
PartialDiagnostic PDiag(unsigned DiagID=0)
Build a partial diagnostic.
Definition SemaBase.cpp:33
SemaBase(Sema &S)
Definition SemaBase.cpp:7
Sema & SemaRef
Definition SemaBase.h:40
SemaDiagnosticBuilder Diag(SourceLocation Loc, unsigned DiagID)
Emit a diagnostic.
Definition SemaBase.cpp:61
AlignPackInfo(AlignPackInfo::Mode M, unsigned Num, bool IsXL)
Definition Sema.h:1841
bool operator==(const AlignPackInfo &Info) const
Definition Sema.h:1901
static AlignPackInfo getFromRawEncoding(unsigned Encoding)
Definition Sema.h:1873
unsigned getPackNumber() const
Definition Sema.h:1891
bool IsXLStack() const
Definition Sema.h:1899
bool IsPackSet() const
Definition Sema.h:1893
AlignPackInfo(AlignPackInfo::Mode M, bool IsXL)
Definition Sema.h:1847
bool IsAlignAttr() const
Definition Sema.h:1887
bool IsPackAttr() const
Definition Sema.h:1885
bool operator!=(const AlignPackInfo &Info) const
Definition Sema.h:1907
AlignPackInfo(bool IsXL)
Definition Sema.h:1851
static uint32_t getRawEncoding(const AlignPackInfo &Info)
Definition Sema.h:1858
Mode getAlignMode() const
Definition Sema.h:1889
ArgPackSubstIndexRAII(Sema &Self, UnsignedOrNone NewSubstIndex)
Definition Sema.h:13611
BoundTypeDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
Definition Sema.h:8267
void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override
Definition Sema.h:8272
void emit(const SemaDiagnosticBuilder &DB, std::index_sequence< Is... >) const
Definition Sema.h:8259
std::tuple< const Ts &... > Args
Definition Sema.h:8256
CXXThisScopeRAII(Sema &S, Decl *ContextDecl, Qualifiers CXXThisTypeQuals, bool Enabled=true)
Introduce a new scope where 'this' may be allowed (when enabled), using the given declaration (which ...
CompoundScopeRAII(Sema &S, bool IsStmtExpr=false)
Definition Sema.h:1292
std::pair< VarDecl *, Expr * > get() const
Definition Sema.h:7806
std::optional< bool > getKnownValue() const
Definition Sema.h:7810
A RAII object to temporarily push a declaration context.
Definition Sema.h:3467
ContextRAII(Sema &S, DeclContext *ContextToPush, bool NewThisContext=true)
Definition Sema.h:3477
Abstract base class used to perform a contextual implicit conversion from an expression to any type p...
Definition Sema.h:10291
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous(Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy)=0
Emits a note for one of the candidate conversions.
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNoMatch(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T)=0
Emits a diagnostic complaining that the expression does not have integral or enumeration type.
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv(Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy)=0
Emits a note for the explicit conversion function.
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy)=0
Emits a diagnostic when the only matching conversion function is explicit.
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy)=0
Emits a diagnostic when we picked a conversion function (for cases when we are not allowed to pick a ...
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T)=0
Emits a diagnostic when there are multiple possible conversion functions.
ContextualImplicitConverter(bool Suppress=false, bool SuppressConversion=false)
Definition Sema.h:10296
virtual bool match(QualType T)=0
Determine whether the specified type is a valid destination type for this conversion.
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T)=0
Emits a diagnostic when the expression has incomplete class type.
DefaultedComparisonKind asComparison() const
Definition Sema.h:6374
DefaultedFunctionKind(CXXSpecialMemberKind CSM)
Definition Sema.h:6351
unsigned getDiagnosticIndex() const
Get the index of this function kind for use in diagnostics.
Definition Sema.h:6379
DefaultedFunctionKind(DefaultedComparisonKind Comp)
Definition Sema.h:6354
CXXSpecialMemberKind asSpecialMember() const
Definition Sema.h:6371
DeferDiagsRAII(Sema &S, bool DeferDiags)
Definition Sema.h:10033
A class which encapsulates the logic for delaying diagnostics during parsing and other processing.
Definition Sema.h:1355
DelayedDiagnosticsState push(sema::DelayedDiagnosticPool &pool)
Enter a new scope.
Definition Sema.h:1374
void popUndelayed(DelayedDiagnosticsState state)
Undo a previous pushUndelayed().
Definition Sema.h:1398
bool shouldDelayDiagnostics()
Determines whether diagnostics should be delayed.
Definition Sema.h:1367
sema::DelayedDiagnosticPool * getCurrentPool() const
Returns the current delayed-diagnostics pool.
Definition Sema.h:1370
void add(const sema::DelayedDiagnostic &diag)
Adds a delayed diagnostic.
void popWithoutEmitting(DelayedDiagnosticsState state)
Leave a delayed-diagnostic state that was previously pushed.
Definition Sema.h:1384
DelayedDiagnosticsState pushUndelayed()
Enter a new scope where access and deprecation diagnostics are not delayed.
Definition Sema.h:1390
A helper class for building up ExtParameterInfos.
Definition Sema.h:12999
const FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo * getPointerOrNull(unsigned numParams)
Return a pointer (suitable for setting in an ExtProtoInfo) to the ExtParameterInfo array we've built ...
Definition Sema.h:13018
void set(unsigned index, FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo info)
Set the ExtParameterInfo for the parameter at the given index,.
Definition Sema.h:13006
FPOptionsOverride getOverrides()
Definition Sema.h:14007
FullExprArg(Sema &actions)
Definition Sema.h:7750
ExprResult release()
Definition Sema.h:7752
friend class Sema
Definition Sema.h:7761
Expr * get() const
Definition Sema.h:7754
GlobalEagerInstantiationScope(Sema &S, bool Enabled, bool AtEndOfTU)
Definition Sema.h:14019
SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNoMatch(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override
Emits a diagnostic complaining that the expression does not have integral or enumeration type.
Definition Sema.h:10355
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T)=0
Emits a diagnostic complaining that the expression does not have integral or enumeration type.
bool match(QualType T) override
Match an integral or (possibly scoped) enumeration type.
ICEConvertDiagnoser(bool AllowScopedEnumerations, bool Suppress, bool SuppressConversion)
Definition Sema.h:10347
unsigned size() const
The number of exceptions in the exception specification.
Definition Sema.h:5473
ExceptionSpecificationType getExceptionSpecType() const
Get the computed exception specification type.
Definition Sema.h:5466
const QualType * data() const
The set of exceptions in the exception specification.
Definition Sema.h:5476
void CalledStmt(Stmt *S)
Integrate an invoked statement into the collected data.
void CalledExpr(Expr *E)
Integrate an invoked expression into the collected data.
Definition Sema.h:5482
FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo getExceptionSpec() const
Overwrite an EPI's exception specification with this computed exception specification.
Definition Sema.h:5489
LambdaScopeForCallOperatorInstantiationRAII(Sema &SemasRef, FunctionDecl *FD, MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MLTAL, LocalInstantiationScope &Scope, bool ShouldAddDeclsFromParentScope=true)
LocalEagerInstantiationScope(Sema &S, bool AtEndOfTU)
Definition Sema.h:13976
static NameClassification DependentNonType()
Definition Sema.h:3681
static NameClassification VarTemplate(TemplateName Name)
Definition Sema.h:3691
ExprResult getExpression() const
Definition Sema.h:3717
NameClassification(const IdentifierInfo *Keyword)
Definition Sema.h:3654
static NameClassification Unknown()
Definition Sema.h:3661
static NameClassification OverloadSet(ExprResult E)
Definition Sema.h:3665
NameClassificationKind getKind() const
Definition Sema.h:3715
static NameClassification UndeclaredTemplate(TemplateName Name)
Definition Sema.h:3709
static NameClassification FunctionTemplate(TemplateName Name)
Definition Sema.h:3697
NamedDecl * getNonTypeDecl() const
Definition Sema.h:3727
NameClassification(ParsedType Type)
Definition Sema.h:3651
TemplateName getTemplateName() const
Definition Sema.h:3732
ParsedType getType() const
Definition Sema.h:3722
TemplateNameKind getTemplateNameKind() const
Definition Sema.h:3741
static NameClassification NonType(NamedDecl *D)
Definition Sema.h:3671
static NameClassification Concept(TemplateName Name)
Definition Sema.h:3703
static NameClassification UndeclaredNonType()
Definition Sema.h:3677
static NameClassification TypeTemplate(TemplateName Name)
Definition Sema.h:3685
static NameClassification Error()
Definition Sema.h:3657
void operator()(sema::FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) const
Definition Sema.cpp:2467
PragmaStackSentinelRAII(Sema &S, StringRef SlotLabel, bool ShouldAct)
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:29
RequiredTemplateKind(TemplateNameIsRequiredTag)
Template name is unconditionally required.
Definition Sema.h:11383
SourceLocation getTemplateKeywordLoc() const
Definition Sema.h:11385
RequiredTemplateKind(SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc=SourceLocation())
Template name is required if TemplateKWLoc is valid.
Definition Sema.h:11380
RAII class used to determine whether SFINAE has trapped any errors that occur during template argumen...
Definition Sema.h:12434
SFINAETrap & operator=(const SFINAETrap &)=delete
SFINAETrap(const SFINAETrap &)=delete
bool hasErrorOccurred() const
Determine whether any SFINAE errors have been trapped.
Definition Sema.h:12468
SFINAETrap(Sema &S, bool WithAccessChecking=false)
Definition Sema.h:12450
bool withAccessChecking() const
Definition Sema.h:12471
sema::TemplateDeductionInfo * getDeductionInfo() const
Definition Sema.h:12463
SFINAETrap(Sema &S, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info)
Definition Sema.h:12453
A derivative of BoundTypeDiagnoser for which the diagnostic's type parameter is preceded by a 0/1 enu...
Definition Sema.h:8284
void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override
Definition Sema.h:8289
SizelessTypeDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
Definition Sema.h:8286
SpecialMemberOverloadResultEntry(const llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition Sema.h:9297
SpecialMemberOverloadResult(CXXMethodDecl *MD)
Definition Sema.h:9284
CXXMethodDecl * getMethod() const
Definition Sema.h:9287
void setMethod(CXXMethodDecl *MD)
Definition Sema.h:9288
void addContextNote(SourceLocation UseLoc)
Definition Sema.h:13517
SynthesizedFunctionScope(Sema &S, DeclContext *DC)
Definition Sema.h:13505
SourceLocation getLocation() const
Definition Sema.h:12194
bool ContainsDecl(const NamedDecl *ND) const
Definition Sema.h:12184
const DeclContext * getDeclContext() const
Definition Sema.h:12190
TemplateCompareNewDeclInfo(const DeclContext *DeclCtx, const DeclContext *LexicalDeclCtx, SourceLocation Loc)
Definition Sema.h:12168
const NamedDecl * getDecl() const
Definition Sema.h:12182
TemplateCompareNewDeclInfo(const NamedDecl *ND)
Definition Sema.h:12167
const DeclContext * getLexicalDeclContext() const
Definition Sema.h:12186
TentativeAnalysisScope(Sema &SemaRef)
Definition Sema.h:12485
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc)=0
VerifyICEDiagnoser(bool Suppress=false)
Definition Sema.h:7709
virtual SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc)
Sema - This implements semantic analysis and AST building for C.
Definition Sema.h:855
const FieldDecl * getSelfAssignmentClassMemberCandidate(const ValueDecl *SelfAssigned)
Returns a field in a CXXRecordDecl that has the same name as the decl SelfAssigned when inside a CXXM...
void DeclareGlobalNewDelete()
DeclareGlobalNewDelete - Declare the global forms of operator new and delete.
bool TryFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) const
Same as IsFunctionConversion, but if this would return true, it sets ResultTy to ToType.
StmtResult ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc, IdentifierInfo *Ident, ParsedAttributes &Attrs)
void DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(SourceLocation CurrentLoc, CXXConversionDecl *Conv)
Define the "body" of the conversion from a lambda object to a function pointer.
IfExistsResult CheckMicrosoftIfExistsSymbol(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &TargetNameInfo)
bool hasReachableDefinition(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested, bool OnlyNeedComplete=false)
Determine if D has a reachable definition.
QualType SubstAutoType(QualType TypeWithAuto, QualType Replacement)
Substitute Replacement for auto in TypeWithAuto.
CXXConstructorDecl * DeclareImplicitDefaultConstructor(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl)
Declare the implicit default constructor for the given class.
bool DiscardingCFIUncheckedCallee(QualType From, QualType To) const
Returns true if From is a function or pointer to a function with the cfi_unchecked_callee attribute b...
bool MergeCXXFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, Scope *S)
MergeCXXFunctionDecl - Merge two declarations of the same C++ function, once we already know that the...
Attr * getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD, bool IsDefinition)
Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a containing class.
QualType BuildParenType(QualType T)
Build a paren type including T.
SemaAMDGPU & AMDGPU()
Definition Sema.h:1416
MemInitResult BuildDelegatingInitializer(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, Expr *Init, CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl)
ParsedType CreateParsedType(QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo)
Package the given type and TSI into a ParsedType.
SmallVector< DeclaratorDecl *, 4 > ExternalDeclarations
All the external declarations encoutered and used in the TU.
Definition Sema.h:3559
FunctionDecl * FindUsualDeallocationFunction(SourceLocation StartLoc, ImplicitDeallocationParameters, DeclarationName Name, bool Diagnose=true)
void CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *D)
ExprResult ActOnCXXTypeid(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LParenLoc, bool isType, void *TyOrExpr, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
ActOnCXXTypeid - Parse typeid( something ).
llvm::DenseSet< Module * > LookupModulesCache
Cache of additional modules that should be used for name lookup within the current template instantia...
Definition Sema.h:13561
ExprResult ActOnCXXParenListInitExpr(ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, QualType T, unsigned NumUserSpecifiedExprs, SourceLocation InitLoc, SourceLocation LParenLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
void ActOnPragmaMSOptimize(SourceLocation Loc, bool IsOn)
pragma optimize("[optimization-list]", on | off).
QualType getCurrentThisType()
Try to retrieve the type of the 'this' pointer.
bool SubstTypeConstraint(TemplateTypeParmDecl *Inst, const TypeConstraint *TC, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, bool EvaluateConstraint)
DeclResult ActOnClassTemplateSpecialization(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, SourceLocation KWLoc, SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, TemplateIdAnnotation &TemplateId, const ParsedAttributesView &Attr, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody=nullptr)
ExprResult ActOnCXXUuidof(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LParenLoc, bool isType, void *TyOrExpr, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
ActOnCXXUuidof - Parse __uuidof( something ).
bool BuiltinConstantArgShiftedByte(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum, unsigned ArgBits)
BuiltinConstantArgShiftedByte - Check if argument ArgNum of TheCall is a constant expression represen...
bool CheckSpecifiedExceptionType(QualType &T, SourceRange Range)
CheckSpecifiedExceptionType - Check if the given type is valid in an exception specification.
ExprResult BuildOperatorCoawaitCall(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *E, UnresolvedLookupExpr *Lookup)
Build a call to 'operator co_await' if there is a suitable operator for the given expression.
ConceptDecl * ActOnStartConceptDefinition(Scope *S, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, const IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc)
std::optional< ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::InitializationContext > InnermostDeclarationWithDelayedImmediateInvocations() const
Definition Sema.h:8189
bool ConstantFoldAttrArgs(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, MutableArrayRef< Expr * > Args)
ConstantFoldAttrArgs - Folds attribute arguments into ConstantExprs (unless they are value dependent ...
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:503
ExprResult BuildBlockForLambdaConversion(SourceLocation CurrentLocation, SourceLocation ConvLocation, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, Expr *Src)
SmallVector< CodeSynthesisContext, 16 > CodeSynthesisContexts
List of active code synthesis contexts.
Definition Sema.h:13545
bool IsPointerInterconvertibleBaseOf(const TypeSourceInfo *Base, const TypeSourceInfo *Derived)
bool diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function, const Expr *ThisArg, ArrayRef< const Expr * > Args, SourceLocation Loc)
Emit diagnostics for the diagnose_if attributes on Function, ignoring any non-ArgDependent DiagnoseIf...
bool BuiltinConstantArgMultiple(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum, unsigned Multiple)
BuiltinConstantArgMultiple - Handle a check if argument ArgNum of CallExpr TheCall is a constant expr...
ExprResult PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From)
PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual conversion of the expression From to a...
bool buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, MultiExprArg Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc, OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, ExprResult *Result)
Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from the given function.
SmallVector< Scope *, 2 > CurrentSEHFinally
Stack of active SEH __finally scopes. Can be empty.
Definition Sema.h:10939
LocalInstantiationScope * CurrentInstantiationScope
The current instantiation scope used to store local variables.
Definition Sema.h:13028
sema::CapturingScopeInfo * getEnclosingLambdaOrBlock() const
Get the innermost lambda or block enclosing the current location, if any.
Definition Sema.cpp:2540
Decl * ActOnAliasDeclaration(Scope *CurScope, AccessSpecifier AS, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, SourceLocation UsingLoc, UnqualifiedId &Name, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList, TypeResult Type, Decl *DeclFromDeclSpec)
TemplateArgumentLoc getTrivialTemplateArgumentLoc(const TemplateArgument &Arg, QualType NTTPType, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *TemplateParam=nullptr)
Allocate a TemplateArgumentLoc where all locations have been initialized to the given location.
Scope * getCurScope() const
Retrieve the parser's current scope.
Definition Sema.h:1120
void MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New, LookupResult &OldDecls)
MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the same name and scope as a previous...
TemplateDeductionResult DeduceTemplateArgumentsFromType(TemplateDecl *TD, QualType FromType, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info)
Deduce the template arguments of the given template from FromType.
bool hasStructuralCompatLayout(Decl *D, Decl *Suggested)
Determine if D and Suggested have a structurally compatible layout as described in C11 6....
void RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S)
Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so that it can be found later for redeclarat...
friend class ASTWriter
Definition Sema.h:1559
BTFDeclTagAttr * mergeBTFDeclTagAttr(Decl *D, const BTFDeclTagAttr &AL)
StmtResult ActOnBreakStmt(SourceLocation BreakLoc, Scope *CurScope, LabelDecl *Label, SourceLocation LabelLoc)
SmallVector< SmallVector< VTableUse, 16 >, 8 > SavedVTableUses
Definition Sema.h:13961
NamedDecl * ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, bool &AddToScope)
void PopParsingClass(ParsingClassState state)
Definition Sema.h:6542
void DiagnoseAbstractType(const CXXRecordDecl *RD)
void HideUsingShadowDecl(Scope *S, UsingShadowDecl *Shadow)
Hides a using shadow declaration.
bool CheckUsingDeclQualifier(SourceLocation UsingLoc, bool HasTypename, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, SourceLocation NameLoc, const LookupResult *R=nullptr, const UsingDecl *UD=nullptr)
Checks that the given nested-name qualifier used in a using decl in the current context is appropriat...
bool IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr
Flag indicating if Sema is building a recovery call expression.
Definition Sema.h:10044
void LoadExternalWeakUndeclaredIdentifiers()
Load weak undeclared identifiers from the external source.
Definition Sema.cpp:1061
bool containsUnexpandedParameterPacks(Declarator &D)
Determine whether the given declarator contains any unexpanded parameter packs.
std::optional< QualType > BuiltinVectorMath(CallExpr *TheCall, EltwiseBuiltinArgTyRestriction ArgTyRestr=EltwiseBuiltinArgTyRestriction::None)
bool CheckExplicitObjectOverride(CXXMethodDecl *New, const CXXMethodDecl *Old)
llvm::SmallPtrSet< SpecialMemberDecl, 4 > SpecialMembersBeingDeclared
The C++ special members which we are currently in the process of declaring.
Definition Sema.h:6531
void ActOnParamUnparsedDefaultArgument(Decl *param, SourceLocation EqualLoc, SourceLocation ArgLoc)
ActOnParamUnparsedDefaultArgument - We've seen a default argument for a function parameter,...
QualType CheckVectorConditionalTypes(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation QuestionLoc)
DefaultedFunctionKind getDefaultedFunctionKind(const FunctionDecl *FD)
Determine the kind of defaulting that would be done for a given function.
bool checkArrayElementAlignment(QualType EltTy, SourceLocation Loc)
ExprResult BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType, SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, const Scope *S, ActOnMemberAccessExtraArgs *ExtraArgs=nullptr)
void ProcessStmtAttributes(Stmt *Stmt, const ParsedAttributes &InAttrs, SmallVectorImpl< const Attr * > &OutAttrs)
Process the attributes before creating an attributed statement.
ExprResult ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input, bool IsAfterAmp=false)
Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
bool RequireCompleteSizedExprType(Expr *E, unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
Definition Sema.h:8239
bool isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S=nullptr, bool AllowInlineNamespace=false) const
isDeclInScope - If 'Ctx' is a function/method, isDeclInScope returns true if 'D' is in Scope 'S',...
bool IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs=true)
ExprResult CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *InputExpr, bool IsAfterAmp=false)
llvm::DenseSet< Module * > & getLookupModules()
Get the set of additional modules that should be checked during name lookup.
void BuildBasePathArray(const CXXBasePaths &Paths, CXXCastPath &BasePath)
bool isAlwaysConstantEvaluatedContext() const
Definition Sema.h:8157
bool isExternalWithNoLinkageType(const ValueDecl *VD) const
Determine if VD, which must be a variable or function, is an external symbol that nonetheless can't b...
Definition Sema.cpp:935
bool isAttrContext() const
Definition Sema.h:6938
void DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef< ParmVarDecl * > Parameters)
Diagnose any unused parameters in the given sequence of ParmVarDecl pointers.
StmtResult BuildMSDependentExistsStmt(SourceLocation KeywordLoc, bool IsIfExists, NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc, DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo, Stmt *Nested)
void ActOnPragmaAttributeEmptyPush(SourceLocation PragmaLoc, const IdentifierInfo *Namespace)
ExprResult IgnoredValueConversions(Expr *E)
IgnoredValueConversions - Given that an expression's result is syntactically ignored,...
void MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old)
Merge the exception specifications of two variable declarations.
bool RequireCompleteSizedType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
Definition Sema.h:8232
bool tryExprAsCall(Expr &E, QualType &ZeroArgCallReturnTy, UnresolvedSetImpl &NonTemplateOverloads)
Figure out if an expression could be turned into a call.
Definition Sema.cpp:2640
CXXSpecialMemberKind getSpecialMember(const CXXMethodDecl *MD)
Definition Sema.h:6293
LookupNameKind
Describes the kind of name lookup to perform.
Definition Sema.h:9313
@ LookupLabel
Label name lookup.
Definition Sema.h:9322
@ LookupOrdinaryName
Ordinary name lookup, which finds ordinary names (functions, variables, typedefs, etc....
Definition Sema.h:9317
@ LookupUsingDeclName
Look up all declarations in a scope with the given name, including resolved using declarations.
Definition Sema.h:9344
@ LookupNestedNameSpecifierName
Look up of a name that precedes the '::' scope resolution operator in C++.
Definition Sema.h:9336
@ LookupOMPReductionName
Look up the name of an OpenMP user-defined reduction operation.
Definition Sema.h:9358
@ LookupLocalFriendName
Look up a friend of a local class.
Definition Sema.h:9352
@ LookupObjCProtocolName
Look up the name of an Objective-C protocol.
Definition Sema.h:9354
@ LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage
Look up an ordinary name that is going to be redeclared as a name with linkage.
Definition Sema.h:9349
@ LookupOperatorName
Look up of an operator name (e.g., operator+) for use with operator overloading.
Definition Sema.h:9329
@ LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam
Look up implicit 'self' parameter of an objective-c method.
Definition Sema.h:9356
@ LookupNamespaceName
Look up a namespace name within a C++ using directive or namespace alias definition,...
Definition Sema.h:9340
@ LookupMemberName
Member name lookup, which finds the names of class/struct/union members.
Definition Sema.h:9325
@ LookupDestructorName
Look up a name following ~ in a destructor name.
Definition Sema.h:9332
@ LookupTagName
Tag name lookup, which finds the names of enums, classes, structs, and unions.
Definition Sema.h:9320
@ LookupOMPMapperName
Look up the name of an OpenMP user-defined mapper.
Definition Sema.h:9360
@ LookupAnyName
Look up any declaration with any name.
Definition Sema.h:9362
void DiagnoseSentinelCalls(const NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args)
DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or message-send is to a declaration with t...
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:411
llvm::DenseMap< IdentifierInfo *, SrcLocSet > IdentifierSourceLocations
Definition Sema.h:9263
LazyVector< TypedefNameDecl *, ExternalSemaSource, &ExternalSemaSource::ReadExtVectorDecls, 2, 2 > ExtVectorDeclsType
Definition Sema.h:4874
UnaryTransformType::UTTKind UTTKind
Definition Sema.h:15332
bool checkFinalSuspendNoThrow(const Stmt *FinalSuspend)
Check that the expression co_await promise.final_suspend() shall not be potentially-throwing.
void DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS)
Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that does not identify a function.
QualType BuildAddressSpaceAttr(QualType &T, LangAS ASIdx, Expr *AddrSpace, SourceLocation AttrLoc)
BuildAddressSpaceAttr - Builds a DependentAddressSpaceType if an expression is uninstantiated.
void ActOnPragmaAttributePop(SourceLocation PragmaLoc, const IdentifierInfo *Namespace)
Called on well-formed '#pragma clang attribute pop'.
void ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S)
void ActOnDefinedDeclarationSpecifier(Decl *D)
Called once it is known whether a tag declaration is an anonymous union or struct.
ExprResult CreateBuiltinMatrixSingleSubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, Expr *RowIdx, SourceLocation RBLoc)
QualType ReplaceAutoType(QualType TypeWithAuto, QualType Replacement)
Completely replace the auto in TypeWithAuto by Replacement.
ExprResult ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res)
void ActOnPragmaDetectMismatch(SourceLocation Loc, StringRef Name, StringRef Value)
ActOnPragmaDetectMismatch - Call on well-formed #pragma detect_mismatch.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:628
QualType CheckLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
EnforceTCBAttr * mergeEnforceTCBAttr(Decl *D, const EnforceTCBAttr &AL)
ExprResult ActOnNoexceptExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, SourceLocation LParen, Expr *Operand, SourceLocation RParen)
Decl * ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl)
bool RequireNonAbstractType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
Definition Sema.h:6230
SemaM68k & M68k()
Definition Sema.h:1466
QualType deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl, DeclarationName Name, QualType Type, TypeSourceInfo *TSI, SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit, Expr *Init)
Decl * BuildStaticAssertDeclaration(SourceLocation StaticAssertLoc, Expr *AssertExpr, Expr *AssertMessageExpr, SourceLocation RParenLoc, bool Failed)
void EvaluateImplicitExceptionSpec(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *FD)
Evaluate the implicit exception specification for a defaulted special member function.
bool checkArgCountAtMost(CallExpr *Call, unsigned MaxArgCount)
Checks that a call expression's argument count is at most the desired number.
void ActOnAnnotModuleBegin(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod)
The parsed has entered a submodule.
bool checkPointerAuthDiscriminatorArg(Expr *Arg, PointerAuthDiscArgKind Kind, unsigned &IntVal)
void PrintContextStack(InstantiationContextDiagFuncRef DiagFunc)
Definition Sema.h:13621
StmtResult ActOnMSAsmStmt(SourceLocation AsmLoc, SourceLocation LBraceLoc, ArrayRef< Token > AsmToks, StringRef AsmString, unsigned NumOutputs, unsigned NumInputs, ArrayRef< StringRef > Constraints, ArrayRef< StringRef > Clobbers, ArrayRef< Expr * > Exprs, SourceLocation EndLoc)
ExplicitSpecifier ActOnExplicitBoolSpecifier(Expr *E)
ActOnExplicitBoolSpecifier - Build an ExplicitSpecifier from an expression found in an explicit(bool)...
bool ValueIsRunOfOnes(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum)
Returns true if the argument consists of one contiguous run of 1s with any number of 0s on either sid...
ExprResult ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr)
VarDecl * createLambdaInitCaptureVarDecl(SourceLocation Loc, QualType InitCaptureType, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, unsigned InitStyle, Expr *Init, DeclContext *DeclCtx)
Create a dummy variable within the declcontext of the lambda's call operator, for name lookup purpose...
bool DiagRedefinedPlaceholderFieldDecl(SourceLocation Loc, RecordDecl *ClassDecl, const IdentifierInfo *Name)
void ActOnFinishCXXNonNestedClass()
ExprResult ActOnLambdaExpr(SourceLocation StartLoc, Stmt *Body)
ActOnLambdaExpr - This is called when the body of a lambda expression was successfully completed.
ExprResult SubstConceptTemplateArguments(const ConceptSpecializationExpr *CSE, const Expr *ConstraintExpr, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &MLTAL)
Substitute concept template arguments in the constraint expression of a concept-id.
bool LookupTemplateName(LookupResult &R, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, QualType ObjectType, bool EnteringContext, RequiredTemplateKind RequiredTemplate=SourceLocation(), AssumedTemplateKind *ATK=nullptr, bool AllowTypoCorrection=true)
DelayedDiagnosticsState ParsingDeclState
Definition Sema.h:1350
bool SetMemberAccessSpecifier(NamedDecl *MemberDecl, NamedDecl *PrevMemberDecl, AccessSpecifier LexicalAS)
SetMemberAccessSpecifier - Set the access specifier of a member.
NamedDecl * FindInstantiatedDecl(SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, bool FindingInstantiatedContext=false)
Find the instantiation of the given declaration within the current instantiation.
bool BuildTypeConstraint(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, TemplateIdAnnotation *TypeConstraint, TemplateTypeParmDecl *ConstrainedParameter, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool AllowUnexpandedPack)
MemInitResult BuildBaseInitializer(QualType BaseType, TypeSourceInfo *BaseTInfo, Expr *Init, CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
const Decl * PragmaAttributeCurrentTargetDecl
The declaration that is currently receiving an attribute from the pragma attribute stack.
Definition Sema.h:2106
ImplicitConversionSequence TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, bool SuppressUserConversions, AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit, bool InOverloadResolution, bool CStyle, bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion)
StmtResult BuildCoroutineBodyStmt(CoroutineBodyStmt::CtorArgs)
ExprResult BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, SourceLocation LitEndLoc, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs=nullptr)
BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to a literal operator descri...
bool MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&Old, Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld, bool NewDeclIsDefn)
MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from declarator D which has the same name and sco...
void RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(const IdentifierInfo *ArgumentKind, uint64_t MagicValue, QualType Type, bool LayoutCompatible, bool MustBeNull)
Register a magic integral constant to be used as a type tag.
NonTagKind getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *D, TagTypeKind TTK)
Given a non-tag type declaration, returns an enum useful for indicating what kind of non-tag type thi...
bool hasReachableDeclarationSlow(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
MissingImportKind
Kinds of missing import.
Definition Sema.h:9751
bool isValidPointerAttrType(QualType T, bool RefOkay=false)
Determine if type T is a valid subject for a nonnull and similar attributes.
bool FindDeallocationFunction(SourceLocation StartLoc, CXXRecordDecl *RD, DeclarationName Name, FunctionDecl *&Operator, ImplicitDeallocationParameters, bool Diagnose=true)
ExprResult BuildCoyieldExpr(SourceLocation KwLoc, Expr *E)
void ForceDeclarationOfImplicitMembers(CXXRecordDecl *Class)
Force the declaration of any implicitly-declared members of this class.
void ActOnParamDefaultArgumentError(Decl *param, SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *DefaultArg)
ActOnParamDefaultArgumentError - Parsing or semantic analysis of the default argument for the paramet...
bool areVectorTypesSameSize(QualType srcType, QualType destType)
bool diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC, DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation Loc, TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId, bool IsMemberSpecialization)
Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given nested-name-specifier.
Decl * ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *EnumDecl, Decl *LastEnumConstant, SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody=nullptr)
bool hasVisibleDeclarationSlow(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules)
TemplateParameterList * ActOnTemplateParameterList(unsigned Depth, SourceLocation ExportLoc, SourceLocation TemplateLoc, SourceLocation LAngleLoc, ArrayRef< NamedDecl * > Params, SourceLocation RAngleLoc, Expr *RequiresClause)
ActOnTemplateParameterList - Builds a TemplateParameterList, optionally constrained by RequiresClause...
static std::enable_if_t< std::is_base_of_v< Attr, AttrInfo >, SourceLocation > getAttrLoc(const AttrInfo &AL)
A helper function to provide Attribute Location for the Attr types AND the ParsedAttr.
Definition Sema.h:4819
void LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(Scope *S, unsigned ID)
void DiagnoseStaticAssertDetails(const Expr *E)
Try to print more useful information about a failed static_assert with expression \E.
void ActOnAnnotModuleInclude(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod)
The parser has processed a module import translated from a include or similar preprocessing directive...
RetainOwnershipKind
Definition Sema.h:5029
OpaquePtr< QualType > TypeTy
Definition Sema.h:1276
void ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagDecl)
ActOnTagDefinitionError - Invoked when there was an unrecoverable error parsing the definition of a t...
void DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(Expr *E, Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullType, bool IsEqual, SourceRange Range)
Diagnose pointers that are always non-null.
bool IsStringInit(Expr *Init, const ArrayType *AT)
Definition SemaInit.cpp:170
void DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(SourceLocation CurrentLocation, CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl)
Defines an implicitly-declared move assignment operator.
void ActOnFinishDelayedMemberInitializers(Decl *Record)
VariadicCallType getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, Expr *Fn)
ExprResult CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, bool ForFoldExpression=false)
CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with operator Opc at location TokLoc.
bool CheckCXXThisType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType Type)
Check whether the type of 'this' is valid in the current context.
void CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FunctionDecl *FD, Stmt *&Body)
bool LookupInSuper(LookupResult &R, CXXRecordDecl *Class)
Perform qualified name lookup into all base classes of the given class.
void addImplicitTypedef(StringRef Name, QualType T)
Definition Sema.cpp:365
void PrintContextStack()
Definition Sema.h:13630
void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id, TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer, DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs)
Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and possibly a list of template a...
bool ActOnCoroutineBodyStart(Scope *S, SourceLocation KwLoc, StringRef Keyword)
QualType BuildVectorType(QualType T, Expr *VecSize, SourceLocation AttrLoc)
bool InstantiateDefaultArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param)
StmtResult BuildAttributedStmt(SourceLocation AttrsLoc, ArrayRef< const Attr * > Attrs, Stmt *SubStmt)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:631
NamedDecl * ActOnVariableDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef< BindingDecl * > Bindings={})
SemaOpenMP & OpenMP()
Definition Sema.h:1501
void CheckDelegatingCtorCycles()
llvm::SmallSet< SourceLocation, 2 > SrcLocSet
Definition Sema.h:9262
void ActOnStartStmtExpr()
bool ActOnTypeConstraint(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, TemplateIdAnnotation *TypeConstraint, TemplateTypeParmDecl *ConstrainedParameter, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
ExprResult CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, SourceLocation RLoc, Expr *Base, MultiExprArg Args)
llvm::function_ref< void(SourceLocation, PartialDiagnostic)> InstantiationContextDiagFuncRef
Definition Sema.h:2281
SmallVector< CXXMethodDecl *, 4 > DelayedDllExportMemberFunctions
Definition Sema.h:6268
bool hasVisibleDeclaration(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
Determine whether any declaration of an entity is visible.
Definition Sema.h:9627
bool FormatStringHasSArg(const StringLiteral *FExpr)
void WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Rec)
Emit a warning for all pending noderef expressions that we recorded.
TypeVisibilityAttr * mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, TypeVisibilityAttr::VisibilityType Vis)
void ActOnStmtExprError()
void MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E, bool SkipLocalVariables=false, ArrayRef< const Expr * > StopAt={})
Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any potentially-evaluated subexpressions ...
bool IsLastErrorImmediate
Is the last error level diagnostic immediate.
Definition Sema.h:1342
StmtResult ActOnSEHLeaveStmt(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *CurScope)
bool BoundsSafetyCheckAssignmentToCountAttrPtr(QualType LHSTy, Expr *RHSExpr, AssignmentAction Action, SourceLocation Loc, const ValueDecl *Assignee, bool ShowFullyQualifiedAssigneeName)
Perform Bounds Safety Semantic checks for assigning to a __counted_by or __counted_by_or_null pointer...
void ActOnPragmaFEnvRound(SourceLocation Loc, llvm::RoundingMode)
Called to set constant rounding mode for floating point operations.
void AddAlignedAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *E, bool IsPackExpansion)
AddAlignedAttr - Adds an aligned attribute to a particular declaration.
void CheckExplicitObjectMemberFunction(Declarator &D, DeclarationName Name, QualType R, bool IsLambda, DeclContext *DC=nullptr)
bool DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC, DeclarationNameInfo Info)
DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13: If T is the name of a class,...
AccessResult CheckFriendAccess(NamedDecl *D)
Checks access to the target of a friend declaration.
QualType UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, ArithConvKind ACK)
UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to binary operators (C99 6....
static const IdentifierInfo * getPrintable(const IdentifierInfo *II)
Definition Sema.h:15011
StmtResult ActOnForEachLValueExpr(Expr *E)
In an Objective C collection iteration statement: for (x in y) x can be an arbitrary l-value expressi...
void MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, CXXRecordDecl *Record)
MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced - Given a record decl, mark all the non-trivial destructors of...
const TranslationUnitKind TUKind
The kind of translation unit we are processing.
Definition Sema.h:1241
void ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagDecl, SourceRange BraceRange)
ActOnTagFinishDefinition - Invoked once we have finished parsing the definition of a tag (enumeration...
FunctionEmissionStatus
Status of the function emission on the CUDA/HIP/OpenMP host/device attrs.
Definition Sema.h:4730
void CheckFloatComparison(SourceLocation Loc, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS, BinaryOperatorKind Opcode)
Check for comparisons of floating-point values using == and !=.
llvm::SmallSetVector< const TypedefNameDecl *, 4 > UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates
Set containing all typedefs that are likely unused.
Definition Sema.h:3541
PragmaClangSection PragmaClangRodataSection
Definition Sema.h:1813
QualType tryBuildStdTypeIdentity(QualType Type, SourceLocation Loc)
Looks for the std::type_identity template and instantiates it with Type, or returns a null type if ty...
DeclResult ActOnCXXConditionDeclaration(Scope *S, Declarator &D)
ActOnCXXConditionDeclarationExpr - Parsed a condition declaration of a C++ if/switch/while/for statem...
std::optional< FunctionEffectMode > ActOnEffectExpression(Expr *CondExpr, StringRef AttributeName)
Try to parse the conditional expression attached to an effect attribute (e.g.
void CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(ExprResult &E, ExprResult &NullE)
void LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, bool RequiresADL=true)
Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator.
void NoteAllFoundTemplates(TemplateName Name)
CXXRecordDecl * createLambdaClosureType(SourceRange IntroducerRange, TypeSourceInfo *Info, unsigned LambdaDependencyKind, LambdaCaptureDefault CaptureDefault)
Create a new lambda closure type.
bool hasVisibleDefinition(const NamedDecl *D)
Definition Sema.h:15456
DelegatingCtorDeclsType DelegatingCtorDecls
All the delegating constructors seen so far in the file, used for cycle detection at the end of the T...
Definition Sema.h:6504
bool checkFunctionOrMethodParameterIndex(const Decl *D, const AttrInfo &AI, unsigned AttrArgNum, const Expr *IdxExpr, ParamIdx &Idx, bool CanIndexImplicitThis=false, bool CanIndexVariadicArguments=false)
Check if IdxExpr is a valid parameter index for a function or instance method D.
Definition Sema.h:5128
void emitAndClearUnusedLocalTypedefWarnings()
Definition Sema.cpp:1152
bool ActOnAccessSpecifier(AccessSpecifier Access, SourceLocation ASLoc, SourceLocation ColonLoc, const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs)
ActOnAccessSpecifier - Parsed an access specifier followed by a colon.
NamedDecl * ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc, IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S)
ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function call, forming a call to an...
std::unique_ptr< CXXFieldCollector > FieldCollector
FieldCollector - Collects CXXFieldDecls during parsing of C++ classes.
Definition Sema.h:6485
void ActOnForEachDeclStmt(DeclGroupPtrTy Decl)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:85
Decl * ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, SourceLocation ExplicitThisLoc={})
ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator() to introduce parameters into fun...
void InstantiateExceptionSpec(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, FunctionDecl *Function)
TemplateName SubstTemplateName(SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, NestedNameSpecifierLoc &QualifierLoc, TemplateName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
TypeResult ActOnDependentTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation TagLoc, SourceLocation NameLoc)
void AddAssumeAlignedAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *E, Expr *OE)
AddAssumeAlignedAttr - Adds an assume_aligned attribute to a particular declaration.
bool checkSectionName(SourceLocation LiteralLoc, StringRef Str)
VarDecl * buildCoroutinePromise(SourceLocation Loc)
unsigned CapturingFunctionScopes
Track the number of currently active capturing scopes.
Definition Sema.h:1230
void AddPragmaAttributes(Scope *S, Decl *D)
Adds the attributes that have been specified using the '#pragma clang attribute push' directives to t...
ParmVarDecl * SubstParmVarDecl(ParmVarDecl *D, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, int indexAdjustment, UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions, bool ExpectParameterPack, bool EvaluateConstraints=true)
ExprResult ActOnExpressionTrait(ExpressionTrait OET, SourceLocation KWLoc, Expr *Queried, SourceLocation RParen)
ActOnExpressionTrait - Parsed one of the unary type trait support pseudo-functions.
SemaCUDA & CUDA()
Definition Sema.h:1441
TemplateDecl * AdjustDeclIfTemplate(Decl *&Decl)
AdjustDeclIfTemplate - If the given decl happens to be a template, reset the parameter D to reference...
bool isImplicitlyDeleted(FunctionDecl *FD)
Determine whether the given function is an implicitly-deleted special member function.
void CheckImplicitSpecialMemberDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *FD)
Check a completed declaration of an implicit special member.
void PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, Decl *LambdaContextDecl=nullptr, ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind Type=ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::EK_Other)
bool checkCommonAttributeFeatures(const Decl *D, const ParsedAttr &A, bool SkipArgCountCheck=false)
Handles semantic checking for features that are common to all attributes, such as checking whether a ...
bool CompleteConstructorCall(CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, QualType DeclInitType, MultiExprArg ArgsPtr, SourceLocation Loc, SmallVectorImpl< Expr * > &ConvertedArgs, bool AllowExplicit=false, bool IsListInitialization=false)
Given a constructor and the set of arguments provided for the constructor, convert the arguments and ...
ExprResult CheckBooleanCondition(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *E, bool IsConstexpr=false)
CheckBooleanCondition - Diagnose problems involving the use of the given expression as a boolean cond...
void InstantiateClassTemplateSpecializationMembers(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *ClassTemplateSpec, TemplateSpecializationKind TSK)
Instantiate the definitions of all of the members of the given class template specialization,...
void Initialize()
Perform initialization that occurs after the parser has been initialized but before it parses anythin...
Definition Sema.cpp:371
@ Boolean
A boolean condition, from 'if', 'while', 'for', or 'do'.
Definition Sema.h:7826
@ Switch
An integral condition for a 'switch' statement.
Definition Sema.h:7828
@ ConstexprIf
A constant boolean condition from 'if constexpr'.
Definition Sema.h:7827
void LateTemplateParserCB(void *P, LateParsedTemplate &LPT)
Callback to the parser to parse templated functions when needed.
Definition Sema.h:1323
void AddOptnoneAttributeIfNoConflicts(FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc)
Adds the 'optnone' attribute to the function declaration if there are no conflicts; Loc represents th...
bool RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser)
Definition Sema.h:15415
bool RequireCompleteDeclContext(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC)
Require that the context specified by SS be complete.
static SourceRange getPrintable(SourceLocation L)
Definition Sema.h:15017
ExprResult ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id, bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand, CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC=nullptr, bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier=false, Token *KeywordReplacement=nullptr)
bool TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(const TemplateCompareNewDeclInfo &NewInstFrom, TemplateParameterList *New, const NamedDecl *OldInstFrom, TemplateParameterList *Old, bool Complain, TemplateParameterListEqualKind Kind, SourceLocation TemplateArgLoc=SourceLocation())
Determine whether the given template parameter lists are equivalent.
Decl * ActOnNamespaceAliasDef(Scope *CurScope, SourceLocation NamespaceLoc, SourceLocation AliasLoc, IdentifierInfo *Alias, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation IdentLoc, IdentifierInfo *Ident)
ExprResult BuildSubstNonTypeTemplateParmExpr(Decl *AssociatedDecl, const NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP, SourceLocation loc, TemplateArgument Replacement, UnsignedOrNone PackIndex, bool Final)
bool needsRebuildOfDefaultArgOrInit() const
Definition Sema.h:8177
void CheckOverrideControl(NamedDecl *D)
CheckOverrideControl - Check C++11 override control semantics.
bool GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, SmallVectorImpl< Expr * > &AllArgs, VariadicCallType CallType=VariadicCallType::DoesNotApply, bool AllowExplicit=false, bool IsListInitialization=false)
GatherArgumentsForCall - Collector argument expressions for various form of call prototypes.
@ PartitionImplementation
'module X:Y;'
Definition Sema.h:9864
@ Interface
'export module X;'
Definition Sema.h:9861
@ Implementation
'module X;'
Definition Sema.h:9862
@ PartitionInterface
'export module X:Y;'
Definition Sema.h:9863
SourceLocation LocationOfExcessPrecisionNotSatisfied
Definition Sema.h:8319
SmallVector< sema::FunctionScopeInfo *, 4 > FunctionScopes
Stack containing information about each of the nested function, block, and method scopes that are cur...
Definition Sema.h:1223
bool ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(CXXMethodDecl *MD, CXXSpecialMemberKind CSM, InheritedConstructorInfo *ICI=nullptr, bool Diagnose=false)
Determine if a special member function should have a deleted definition when it is defaulted.
void ActOnExitFunctionContext()
bool ActOnDuplicateODRHashDefinition(T *Duplicate, T *Previous)
Check ODR hashes for C/ObjC when merging types from modules.
Definition Sema.h:9574
ReferenceCompareResult
ReferenceCompareResult - Expresses the result of comparing two types (cv1 T1 and cv2 T2) to determine...
Definition Sema.h:10374
@ Ref_Incompatible
Ref_Incompatible - The two types are incompatible, so direct reference binding is not possible.
Definition Sema.h:10377
@ Ref_Compatible
Ref_Compatible - The two types are reference-compatible.
Definition Sema.h:10383
@ Ref_Related
Ref_Related - The two types are reference-related, which means that their unqualified forms (T1 and T...
Definition Sema.h:10381
void inferLifetimeCaptureByAttribute(FunctionDecl *FD)
Add [[clang:lifetime_capture_by(this)]] to STL container methods.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:277
void RefersToMemberWithReducedAlignment(Expr *E, llvm::function_ref< void(Expr *, RecordDecl *, FieldDecl *, CharUnits)> Action)
This function calls Action when it determines that E designates a misaligned member due to the packed...
bool isMemberAccessibleForDeletion(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, DeclAccessPair Found, QualType ObjectType)
Definition Sema.h:1771
ExprResult RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(Expr *E)
@ AR_dependent
Definition Sema.h:1656
@ AR_accessible
Definition Sema.h:1654
@ AR_inaccessible
Definition Sema.h:1655
@ AR_delayed
Definition Sema.h:1657
ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl * getMoreSpecializedPartialSpecialization(ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS1, ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS2, SourceLocation Loc)
Returns the more specialized class template partial specialization according to the rules of partial ...
@ Normal
Apply the normal rules for complete types.
Definition Sema.h:15024
@ AcceptSizeless
Relax the normal rules for complete types so that they include sizeless built-in types.
Definition Sema.h:15028
bool checkAndRewriteMustTailAttr(Stmt *St, const Attr &MTA)
Check whether the given statement can have musttail applied to it, issuing a diagnostic and returning...
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:660
ExprResult BuildCXXFunctionalCastExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, QualType Type, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
DeclResult ActOnTemplatedFriendTag(Scope *S, SourceLocation FriendLoc, unsigned TagSpec, SourceLocation TagLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, const ParsedAttributesView &Attr, MultiTemplateParamsArg TempParamLists)
Handle a friend tag declaration where the scope specifier was templated.
void AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion=true)
Adds a conversion function template specialization candidate to the overload set, using template argu...
Preprocessor & getPreprocessor() const
Definition Sema.h:925
const ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord & currentEvaluationContext() const
Definition Sema.h:6916
Scope * getScopeForContext(DeclContext *Ctx)
Determines the active Scope associated with the given declaration context.
Definition Sema.cpp:2312
StmtResult ActOnContinueStmt(SourceLocation ContinueLoc, Scope *CurScope, LabelDecl *Label, SourceLocation LabelLoc)
QualType GetSignedSizelessVectorType(QualType V)
bool CheckCXXThisCapture(SourceLocation Loc, bool Explicit=false, bool BuildAndDiagnose=true, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt=nullptr, bool ByCopy=false)
Make sure the value of 'this' is actually available in the current context, if it is a potentially ev...
void ActOnLambdaExpressionAfterIntroducer(LambdaIntroducer &Intro, Scope *CurContext)
Once the Lambdas capture are known, we can start to create the closure, call operator method,...
FunctionTemplateDecl * DeclareAggregateDeductionGuideFromInitList(TemplateDecl *Template, MutableArrayRef< QualType > ParamTypes, SourceLocation Loc)
ExprResult BuildBuiltinBitCastExpr(SourceLocation KWLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TSI, Expr *Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Definition SemaCast.cpp:438
void AddTemplateParametersToLambdaCallOperator(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, CXXRecordDecl *Class, TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams)
CXXConstructorDecl * DeclareImplicitMoveConstructor(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl)
Declare the implicit move constructor for the given class.
class clang::Sema::DelayedDiagnostics DelayedDiagnostics
bool ProcessAccessDeclAttributeList(AccessSpecDecl *ASDecl, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList)
Annotation attributes are the only attributes allowed after an access specifier.
FunctionDecl * getMoreConstrainedFunction(FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2)
Returns the more constrained function according to the rules of partial ordering by constraints (C++ ...
void AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool IsAssignmentOperator=false, unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments=0)
AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in operator.
llvm::SmallPtrSet< ConstantExpr *, 4 > FailedImmediateInvocations
Definition Sema.h:8308
void deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *decl)
ExprResult ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope=nullptr)
StmtResult ActOnGotoStmt(SourceLocation GotoLoc, SourceLocation LabelLoc, LabelDecl *TheDecl)
PragmaStack< FPOptionsOverride > FpPragmaStack
Definition Sema.h:2044
FunctionDecl * InstantiateFunctionDeclaration(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD, const TemplateArgumentList *Args, SourceLocation Loc, CodeSynthesisContext::SynthesisKind CSC=CodeSynthesisContext::ExplicitTemplateArgumentSubstitution)
Instantiate (or find existing instantiation of) a function template with a given set of template argu...
DefaultedComparisonKind getDefaultedComparisonKind(const FunctionDecl *FD)
Definition Sema.h:8220
void SetFunctionBodyKind(Decl *D, SourceLocation Loc, FnBodyKind BodyKind, StringLiteral *DeletedMessage=nullptr)
static SourceRange getPrintable(const Expr *E)
Definition Sema.h:15018
PragmaStack< StringLiteral * > CodeSegStack
Definition Sema.h:2038
ExprResult MaybeBindToTemporary(Expr *E)
MaybeBindToTemporary - If the passed in expression has a record type with a non-trivial destructor,...
StmtResult ActOnReturnStmt(SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetValExp, Scope *CurScope)
void AddRangeBasedOptnone(FunctionDecl *FD)
Only called on function definitions; if there is a pragma in scope with the effect of a range-based o...
void referenceDLLExportedClassMethods()
StmtResult BuildCoreturnStmt(SourceLocation KwLoc, Expr *E, bool IsImplicit=false)
void CheckCompleteDestructorVariant(SourceLocation CurrentLocation, CXXDestructorDecl *Dtor)
Do semantic checks to allow the complete destructor variant to be emitted when the destructor is defi...
NamedDecl * ActOnCXXMemberDeclarator(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, Declarator &D, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, Expr *BitfieldWidth, const VirtSpecifiers &VS, InClassInitStyle InitStyle)
ActOnCXXMemberDeclarator - This is invoked when a C++ class member declarator is parsed.
void MarkCaptureUsedInEnclosingContext(ValueDecl *Capture, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned CapturingScopeIndex)
bool CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(const CXXMethodDecl *New, const CXXMethodDecl *Old)
CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal - Checks whether a virtual member function overrides a virtual...
DLLImportAttr * mergeDLLImportAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI)
static NamedDecl * getAsTemplateNameDecl(NamedDecl *D, bool AllowFunctionTemplates=true, bool AllowDependent=true)
Try to interpret the lookup result D as a template-name.
void AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool PartialOverloading=false)
Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup to the set of overloading candidates.
void addDeclWithEffects(const Decl *D, const FunctionEffectsRef &FX)
Unconditionally add a Decl to DeclsWithEfffectsToVerify.
FunctionEffectKindSet AllEffectsToVerify
The union of all effects present on DeclsWithEffectsToVerify.
Definition Sema.h:15594
void setFunctionHasBranchIntoScope()
Definition Sema.cpp:2493
ExprResult ActOnStartCXXMemberReference(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind OpKind, ParsedType &ObjectType, bool &MayBePseudoDestructor)
ExprResult BuildCXXAssumeExpr(Expr *Assumption, const IdentifierInfo *AttrName, SourceRange Range)
ExtVectorDeclsType ExtVectorDecls
ExtVectorDecls - This is a list all the extended vector types.
Definition Sema.h:4879
ExprResult ActOnCaseExpr(SourceLocation CaseLoc, ExprResult Val)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:485
SourceLocation getOptimizeOffPragmaLocation() const
Get the location for the currently active "\#pragma clang optimizeoff". If this location is invalid,...
Definition Sema.h:2115
llvm::SmallSetVector< Expr *, 4 > MaybeODRUseExprSet
Store a set of either DeclRefExprs or MemberExprs that contain a reference to a variable (constant) t...
Definition Sema.h:6745
NamedDecl * HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists)
bool CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(CXXMethodDecl *New, const CXXMethodDecl *Old)
void ActOnPragmaMSComment(SourceLocation CommentLoc, PragmaMSCommentKind Kind, StringRef Arg)
ActOnPragmaMSComment - Called on well formed #pragma comment(kind, "arg").
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:620
TemplateParameterList * MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(SourceLocation DeclStartLoc, SourceLocation DeclLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId, ArrayRef< TemplateParameterList * > ParamLists, bool IsFriend, bool &IsMemberSpecialization, bool &Invalid, bool SuppressDiagnostic=false)
Match the given template parameter lists to the given scope specifier, returning the template paramet...
QualType BuildExtVectorType(QualType T, Expr *ArraySize, SourceLocation AttrLoc)
Build an ext-vector type.
void handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope)
SmallVector< AlignPackIncludeState, 8 > AlignPackIncludeStack
Definition Sema.h:2033
void AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl)
AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass - Adds any implicitly-declared special functions,...
bool tryResolveExplicitSpecifier(ExplicitSpecifier &ExplicitSpec)
tryResolveExplicitSpecifier - Attempt to resolve the explict specifier.
SimplerImplicitMoveMode
Definition Sema.h:11104
Expr * BuildBuiltinCallExpr(SourceLocation Loc, Builtin::ID Id, MultiExprArg CallArgs)
BuildBuiltinCallExpr - Create a call to a builtin function specified by Id.
void AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RecordDecl *RD)
AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord - Adds any needed alignment attributes to a the record decl,...
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:54
void PopParsingDeclaration(ParsingDeclState state, Decl *decl)
ErrorAttr * mergeErrorAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, StringRef NewUserDiagnostic)
Decl * ActOnConversionDeclarator(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion)
ActOnConversionDeclarator - Called by ActOnDeclarator to complete the declaration of the given C++ co...
bool CheckFormatStringsCompatible(FormatStringType FST, const StringLiteral *AuthoritativeFormatString, const StringLiteral *TestedFormatString, const Expr *FunctionCallArg=nullptr)
Verify that two format strings (as understood by attribute(format) and attribute(format_matches) are ...
void CheckMain(FunctionDecl *FD, const DeclSpec &D)
void AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD)
Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the declaration of this function.
void DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD, DiagReceiverTy DiagReceiver)
If VD is set but not otherwise used, diagnose, for a parameter or a variable.
ExprResult SubstInitializer(Expr *E, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, bool CXXDirectInit)
ExprResult LookupInlineAsmIdentifier(CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id, bool IsUnevaluatedContext)
QualType CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign, bool AllowBothBool, bool AllowBoolConversion, bool AllowBoolOperation, bool ReportInvalid)
type checking for vector binary operators.
void ActOnComment(SourceRange Comment)
Definition Sema.cpp:2592
bool IsCXXTriviallyRelocatableType(QualType T)
Determines if a type is trivially relocatable according to the C++26 rules.
ExprResult ActOnDesignatedInitializer(Designation &Desig, SourceLocation EqualOrColonLoc, bool GNUSyntax, ExprResult Init)
@ Other
C++26 [dcl.fct.def.general]p1 function-body: ctor-initializer[opt] compound-statement function-try-bl...
Definition Sema.h:4130
@ Default
= default ;
Definition Sema.h:4132
@ Delete
deleted-function-body
Definition Sema.h:4138
LiteralOperatorLookupResult LookupLiteralOperator(Scope *S, LookupResult &R, ArrayRef< QualType > ArgTys, bool AllowRaw, bool AllowTemplate, bool AllowStringTemplate, bool DiagnoseMissing, StringLiteral *StringLit=nullptr)
LookupLiteralOperator - Determine which literal operator should be used for a user-defined literal,...
QualType BuildStdInitializerList(QualType Element, SourceLocation Loc)
Looks for the std::initializer_list template and instantiates it with Element, or emits an error if i...
bool RequireStructuralType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc)
Require the given type to be a structural type, and diagnose if it is not.
ExprResult VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc, const IdentifierInfo *FieldName, QualType FieldTy, bool IsMsStruct, Expr *BitWidth)
VerifyBitField - verifies that a bit field expression is an ICE and has the correct width,...
concepts::Requirement * ActOnSimpleRequirement(Expr *E)
llvm::function_ref< void(llvm::raw_ostream &)> EntityPrinter
Definition Sema.h:13923
MemInitResult BuildMemberInitializer(ValueDecl *Member, Expr *Init, SourceLocation IdLoc)
StmtResult ActOnExprStmt(ExprResult Arg, bool DiscardedValue=true)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:48
FieldDecl * HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, InClassInitStyle InitStyle, AccessSpecifier AS)
HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member.
TemplateDeductionResult FinishTemplateArgumentDeduction(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, SmallVectorImpl< DeducedTemplateArgument > &Deduced, unsigned NumExplicitlySpecified, FunctionDecl *&Specialization, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info, SmallVectorImpl< OriginalCallArg > const *OriginalCallArgs, bool PartialOverloading, bool PartialOrdering, bool ForOverloadSetAddressResolution, llvm::function_ref< bool(bool)> CheckNonDependent=[](bool) { return false;})
Finish template argument deduction for a function template, checking the deduced template arguments f...
void ActOnEndOfTranslationUnit()
ActOnEndOfTranslationUnit - This is called at the very end of the translation unit when EOF is reache...
Definition Sema.cpp:1231
VarTemplateSpecializationDecl * BuildVarTemplateInstantiation(VarTemplateDecl *VarTemplate, VarDecl *FromVar, const TemplateArgumentList *PartialSpecArgs, SmallVectorImpl< TemplateArgument > &Converted, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, LateInstantiatedAttrVec *LateAttrs=nullptr, LocalInstantiationScope *StartingScope=nullptr)
ExprResult EvaluateConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *E, QualType T, APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE, bool RequireInt, const APValue &PreNarrowingValue)
EvaluateConvertedConstantExpression - Evaluate an Expression That is a converted constant expression ...
ConceptDecl * ActOnFinishConceptDefinition(Scope *S, ConceptDecl *C, Expr *ConstraintExpr, const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs)
FPOptionsOverride CurFPFeatureOverrides()
Definition Sema.h:2045
void redelayDiagnostics(sema::DelayedDiagnosticPool &pool)
Given a set of delayed diagnostics, re-emit them as if they had been delayed in the current context i...
void DiagnoseHiddenVirtualMethods(CXXMethodDecl *MD)
Diagnose methods which overload virtual methods in a base class without overriding any.
SemaHexagon & Hexagon()
Definition Sema.h:1456
Decl * ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *Decl, Stmt *Body, bool IsInstantiation=false, bool RetainFunctionScopeInfo=false)
Performs semantic analysis at the end of a function body.
bool isValidSveBitcast(QualType srcType, QualType destType)
Are the two types SVE-bitcast-compatible types?
ExprResult ActOnDependentIdExpression(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, bool isAddressOfOperand, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs)
ActOnDependentIdExpression - Handle a dependent id-expression that was just parsed.
void addInitCapture(sema::LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, VarDecl *Var, bool ByRef)
Add an init-capture to a lambda scope.
FieldDecl * BuildCaptureField(RecordDecl *RD, const sema::Capture &Capture)
Build a FieldDecl suitable to hold the given capture.
concepts::Requirement * ActOnCompoundRequirement(Expr *E, SourceLocation NoexceptLoc)
void ActOnPragmaMSSeg(SourceLocation PragmaLocation, PragmaMsStackAction Action, llvm::StringRef StackSlotLabel, StringLiteral *SegmentName, llvm::StringRef PragmaName)
Called on well formed #pragma bss_seg/data_seg/const_seg/code_seg.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:847
UsingShadowDecl * BuildUsingShadowDecl(Scope *S, BaseUsingDecl *BUD, NamedDecl *Target, UsingShadowDecl *PrevDecl)
Builds a shadow declaration corresponding to a 'using' declaration.
void CheckThreadLocalForLargeAlignment(VarDecl *VD)
ExprResult BuildStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, SourceLocation RPLoc, unsigned TemplateDepth)
bool ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifierDecltype(CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclSpec &DS, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc)
bool hasVisibleExplicitSpecialization(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
Determine if there is a visible declaration of D that is an explicit specialization declaration for a...
bool IsInsideALocalClassWithinATemplateFunction()
ExprResult BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, bool *NoArrowOperatorFound=nullptr)
BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded operator-> (if one exists),...
ExprResult BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExpr, SourceLocation LParenLoc, MultiExprArg Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *ExecConfig=nullptr, bool IsExecConfig=false, bool AllowRecovery=false)
BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member function.
llvm::DenseMap< llvm::FoldingSetNodeID, UnsubstitutedConstraintSatisfactionCacheResult > UnsubstitutedConstraintSatisfactionCache
Cache the satisfaction of an atomic constraint.
Definition Sema.h:14949
Decl * ActOnTemplateDeclarator(Scope *S, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, Declarator &D)
void ActOnTranslationUnitScope(Scope *S)
Scope actions.
Definition Sema.cpp:172
FunctionDecl * FindDeallocationFunctionForDestructor(SourceLocation StartLoc, CXXRecordDecl *RD, bool Diagnose, bool LookForGlobal, DeclarationName Name)
NamedDecl * LookupSingleName(Scope *S, DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation Loc, LookupNameKind NameKind, RedeclarationKind Redecl=RedeclarationKind::NotForRedeclaration)
Look up a name, looking for a single declaration.
AssignConvertType CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, bool Diagnose=true, bool DiagnoseCFAudited=false, bool ConvertRHS=true)
Check assignment constraints for an assignment of RHS to LHSType.
void SubstExceptionSpec(FunctionDecl *New, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &Args)
void ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope *S, Decl *D)
Push the parameters of D, which must be a function, into scope.
ExprResult BuildResolvedCoawaitExpr(SourceLocation KwLoc, Expr *Operand, Expr *Awaiter, bool IsImplicit=false)
SemaSYCL & SYCL()
Definition Sema.h:1526
bool isMemberAccessibleForDeletion(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, DeclAccessPair Found, QualType ObjectType, SourceLocation Loc, const PartialDiagnostic &Diag)
Is the given member accessible for the purposes of deciding whether to define a special member functi...
concepts::Requirement::SubstitutionDiagnostic * createSubstDiagAt(SourceLocation Location, EntityPrinter Printer)
create a Requirement::SubstitutionDiagnostic with only a SubstitutedEntity and DiagLoc using ASTConte...
sema::LambdaScopeInfo * RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator)
ExprResult BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation RPLoc)
IdentifierInfo * getSuperIdentifier() const
Definition Sema.cpp:2867
StmtResult BuildIfStmt(SourceLocation IfLoc, IfStatementKind StatementKind, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Stmt *InitStmt, ConditionResult Cond, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Stmt *ThenVal, SourceLocation ElseLoc, Stmt *ElseVal)
ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord & parentEvaluationContext()
Definition Sema.h:6928
FunctionDecl * getCurFunctionDecl(bool AllowLambda=false) const
Returns a pointer to the innermost enclosing function, or nullptr if the current context is not insid...
Definition Sema.cpp:1654
ExprResult PerformContextualImplicitConversion(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *FromE, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter)
Perform a contextual implicit conversion.
bool CheckConceptUseInDefinition(NamedDecl *Concept, SourceLocation Loc)
void ActOnPragmaFloatControl(SourceLocation Loc, PragmaMsStackAction Action, PragmaFloatControlKind Value)
ActOnPragmaFloatControl - Call on well-formed #pragma float_control.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:663
ExprResult UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E)
UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most operators (C99 6....
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:833
bool checkPointerAuthEnabled(SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range)
LateParsedTemplateMapT LateParsedTemplateMap
Definition Sema.h:11348
void UnmarkAsLateParsedTemplate(FunctionDecl *FD)
const AttributedType * getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const
Get the outermost AttributedType node that sets a calling convention.
bool BuiltinIsBaseOf(SourceLocation RhsTLoc, QualType LhsT, QualType RhsT)
CheckTemplateArgumentKind
Specifies the context in which a particular template argument is being checked.
Definition Sema.h:11946
@ CTAK_DeducedFromArrayBound
The template argument was deduced from an array bound via template argument deduction.
Definition Sema.h:11957
@ CTAK_Specified
The template argument was specified in the code or was instantiated with some deduced template argume...
Definition Sema.h:11949
@ CTAK_Deduced
The template argument was deduced via template argument deduction.
Definition Sema.h:11953
bool SubstExprs(ArrayRef< Expr * > Exprs, bool IsCall, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, SmallVectorImpl< Expr * > &Outputs)
Substitute the given template arguments into a list of expressions, expanding pack expansions if requ...
BaseResult ActOnBaseSpecifier(Decl *classdecl, SourceRange SpecifierRange, const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, bool Virtual, AccessSpecifier Access, ParsedType basetype, SourceLocation BaseLoc, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
ActOnBaseSpecifier - Parsed a base specifier.
TypeSpecifierType isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S)
isTagName() - This method is called for error recovery purposes only to determine if the specified na...
Definition SemaDecl.cpp:675
void ActOnFinishFunctionDeclarationDeclarator(Declarator &D)
Called after parsing a function declarator belonging to a function declaration.
void ActOnPragmaMSPointersToMembers(LangOptions::PragmaMSPointersToMembersKind Kind, SourceLocation PragmaLoc)
ActOnPragmaMSPointersToMembers - called on well formed #pragma pointers_to_members(representation met...
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:717
bool CheckRedeclarationExported(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old)
[module.interface]p6: A redeclaration of an entity X is implicitly exported if X was introduced by an...
void DiagnosePrecisionLossInComplexDivision()
ExprResult CheckUnevaluatedOperand(Expr *E)
void CheckTemplatePartialSpecialization(ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *Partial)
void ActOnParamDefaultArgument(Decl *param, SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *defarg)
ActOnParamDefaultArgument - Check whether the default argument provided for a function parameter is w...
bool DisableTypoCorrection
Tracks whether we are in a context where typo correction is disabled.
Definition Sema.h:9257
void CheckConversionDeclarator(Declarator &D, QualType &R, StorageClass &SC)
CheckConversionDeclarator - Called by ActOnDeclarator to check the well-formednes of the conversion f...
ExprResult ActOnCXXDelete(SourceLocation StartLoc, bool UseGlobal, bool ArrayForm, Expr *Operand)
ActOnCXXDelete - Parsed a C++ 'delete' expression (C++ 5.3.5), as in:
VisibilityAttr * mergeVisibilityAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, VisibilityAttr::VisibilityType Vis)
SemaX86 & X86()
Definition Sema.h:1546
ExprResult DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT, FunctionDecl *FDecl)
void DiagnoseCommaOperator(const Expr *LHS, SourceLocation Loc)
Look for instances where it is likely the comma operator is confused with another operator.
TemplateNameKind isTemplateName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, bool hasTemplateKeyword, const UnqualifiedId &Name, ParsedType ObjectType, bool EnteringContext, TemplateTy &Template, bool &MemberOfUnknownSpecialization, bool Disambiguation=false)
llvm::DenseMap< NamedDecl *, NamedDecl * > VisibleNamespaceCache
Map from the most recent declaration of a namespace to the most recent visible declaration of that na...
Definition Sema.h:13565
ExprResult tryConvertExprToType(Expr *E, QualType Ty)
Try to convert an expression E to type Ty.
Decl * ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr, SourceLocation AsmLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
bool hasMergedDefinitionInCurrentModule(const NamedDecl *Def)
bool DeduceReturnType(FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc, bool Diagnose=true)
std::vector< Token > ExpandFunctionLocalPredefinedMacros(ArrayRef< Token > Toks)
StmtResult SubstStmt(Stmt *S, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
bool CheckMatrixCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, QualType SrcTy, CastKind &Kind)
QualType CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &Operand, SourceLocation OpLoc)
CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function designator or an lvalue designatin...
ParsedTemplateArgument ActOnTemplateTypeArgument(TypeResult ParsedType)
Convert a parsed type into a parsed template argument.
ParmVarDecl * BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T)
Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a typedef.
void DiagnoseExceptionUse(SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTry)
ExprResult CheckSwitchCondition(SourceLocation SwitchLoc, Expr *Cond)
bool DiagnoseUnknownTemplateName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation IILoc, Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec *SS, TemplateTy &SuggestedTemplate, TemplateNameKind &SuggestedKind)
ASTContext & Context
Definition Sema.h:1283
bool InstantiateClassTemplateSpecialization(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *ClassTemplateSpec, TemplateSpecializationKind TSK, bool Complain, bool PrimaryStrictPackMatch)
static bool TooManyArguments(size_t NumParams, size_t NumArgs, bool PartialOverloading=false)
To be used for checking whether the arguments being passed to function exceeds the number of paramete...
Definition Sema.h:8144
bool IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion)
IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from an rvalue of type FromType to ToTy...
void diagnoseNullableToNonnullConversion(QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, SourceLocation Loc)
Warn if we're implicitly casting from a _Nullable pointer type to a _Nonnull one.
Definition Sema.cpp:680
bool ShouldSplatAltivecScalarInCast(const VectorType *VecTy)
QualType CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
QualType InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS)
the following "Check" methods will return a valid/converted QualType or a null QualType (indicating a...
bool DiagIfReachable(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef< const Stmt * > Stmts, const PartialDiagnostic &PD)
Conditionally issue a diagnostic based on the statements's reachability analysis.
void FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *D)
FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform any semantic actions neces...
ExprResult ActOnCoyieldExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation KwLoc, Expr *E)
LLVM_DECLARE_VIRTUAL_ANCHOR_FUNCTION()
This virtual key function only exists to limit the emission of debug info describing the Sema class.
bool ConstraintExpressionDependsOnEnclosingTemplate(const FunctionDecl *Friend, unsigned TemplateDepth, const Expr *Constraint)
bool BoundsSafetyCheckUseOfCountAttrPtr(const Expr *E)
Perform Bounds Safety semantic checks for uses of invalid uses counted_by or counted_by_or_null point...
void LazyProcessLifetimeCaptureByParams(FunctionDecl *FD)
bool CheckTemplatePartialSpecializationArgs(SourceLocation Loc, TemplateDecl *PrimaryTemplate, unsigned NumExplicitArgs, ArrayRef< TemplateArgument > Args)
Check the non-type template arguments of a class template partial specialization according to C++ [te...
ExprResult ActOnCXXNullPtrLiteral(SourceLocation Loc)
ActOnCXXNullPtrLiteral - Parse 'nullptr'.
void ActOnCapturedRegionError()
void ActOnFinishDelayedCXXMethodDeclaration(Scope *S, Decl *Method)
ActOnFinishDelayedCXXMethodDeclaration - We have finished processing the delayed method declaration f...
ExprResult BuildCXXTypeId(QualType TypeInfoType, SourceLocation TypeidLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Build a C++ typeid expression with a type operand.
void MarkUsedTemplateParametersForSubsumptionParameterMapping(const Expr *E, unsigned Depth, llvm::SmallBitVector &Used)
Mark which template parameters are named in a given expression.
IdentifierSourceLocations TypoCorrectionFailures
A cache containing identifiers for which typo correction failed and their locations,...
Definition Sema.h:9268
FullExprArg MakeFullExpr(Expr *Arg, SourceLocation CC)
Definition Sema.h:7771
QualType BuildFunctionType(QualType T, MutableArrayRef< QualType > ParamTypes, SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity, const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI)
Build a function type.
QualType CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, bool IsCompAssign=false)
void ActOnPragmaUnused(const Token &Identifier, Scope *curScope, SourceLocation PragmaLoc)
ActOnPragmaUnused - Called on well-formed '#pragma unused'.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:935
DeclarationNameInfo GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D)
GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the given Declarator.
ExprResult PerformMemberExprBaseConversion(Expr *Base, bool IsArrow)
Perform conversions on the LHS of a member access expression.
ExprResult SubstExpr(Expr *E, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
DiagnosticsEngine & getDiagnostics() const
Definition Sema.h:923
ExprResult MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *ME)
This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn the ParenListExpr into a s...
concepts::TypeRequirement * BuildTypeRequirement(TypeSourceInfo *Type)
void DiagnoseTypeTraitDetails(const Expr *E)
If E represents a built-in type trait, or a known standard type trait, try to print more information ...
void ActOnFinishTopLevelStmtDecl(TopLevelStmtDecl *D, Stmt *Statement)
bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function, bool Complain=false, SourceLocation Loc=SourceLocation())
Returns whether the given function's address can be taken or not, optionally emitting a diagnostic if...
void ActOnAnnotModuleEnd(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod)
The parser has left a submodule.
void CheckImplicitConversion(Expr *E, QualType T, SourceLocation CC, bool *ICContext=nullptr, bool IsListInit=false)
bool CheckNonDependentConversions(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef< QualType > ParamTypes, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, CheckNonDependentConversionsFlag UserConversionFlag, CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext=nullptr, QualType ObjectType=QualType(), Expr::Classification ObjectClassification={}, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO={})
Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument whose corresponding paramete...
void * SkippedDefinitionContext
Definition Sema.h:4356
ExprResult BuildExpressionFromNonTypeTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg, SourceLocation Loc)
bool RequireLiteralType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
Definition Sema.h:15380
AccessResult CheckDestructorAccess(SourceLocation Loc, CXXDestructorDecl *Dtor, const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, QualType objectType=QualType())
bool CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E)
void resetFPOptions(FPOptions FPO)
Definition Sema.h:11329
bool hasAcceptableDefinition(NamedDecl *D, AcceptableKind Kind)
Definition Sema.h:15483
bool CheckParameterPacksForExpansion(SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, SourceRange PatternRange, ArrayRef< UnexpandedParameterPack > Unexpanded, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, bool FailOnPackProducingTemplates, bool &ShouldExpand, bool &RetainExpansion, UnsignedOrNone &NumExpansions, bool Diagnose=true)
Determine whether we could expand a pack expansion with the given set of parameter packs into separat...
bool isStdTypeIdentity(QualType Ty, QualType *TypeArgument, const Decl **MalformedDecl=nullptr)
Tests whether Ty is an instance of std::type_identity and, if it is and TypeArgument is not NULL,...
bool isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, QualType &ConvertedType, bool &IncompatibleObjC)
isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an Objective-C pointer conversion.
bool currentModuleIsImplementation() const
Is the module scope we are an implementation unit?
Definition Sema.h:9848
DeclResult ActOnModuleImport(SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceLocation ExportLoc, SourceLocation ImportLoc, ModuleIdPath Path, bool IsPartition=false)
The parser has processed a module import declaration.
static bool getPrintable(bool B)
Definition Sema.h:15007
bool LookupBuiltin(LookupResult &R)
Lookup a builtin function, when name lookup would otherwise fail.
SemaObjC & ObjC()
Definition Sema.h:1486
std::string getFixItZeroLiteralForType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc) const
ExprResult SubstConstraintExprWithoutSatisfaction(Expr *E, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
void propagateDLLAttrToBaseClassTemplate(CXXRecordDecl *Class, Attr *ClassAttr, ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *BaseTemplateSpec, SourceLocation BaseLoc)
Perform propagation of DLL attributes from a derived class to a templated base class for MS compatibi...
bool SpecialMemberIsTrivial(CXXMethodDecl *MD, CXXSpecialMemberKind CSM, TrivialABIHandling TAH=TrivialABIHandling::IgnoreTrivialABI, bool Diagnose=false)
Determine whether a defaulted or deleted special member function is trivial, as specified in C++11 [c...
void DiagPlaceholderFieldDeclDefinitions(RecordDecl *Record)
Emit diagnostic warnings for placeholder members.
NamedDecl * ActOnFriendFunctionDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams)
void setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD)
QualType CheckMatrixElementwiseOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign)
Type checking for matrix binary operators.
bool tryToRecoverWithCall(ExprResult &E, const PartialDiagnostic &PD, bool ForceComplain=false, bool(*IsPlausibleResult)(QualType)=nullptr)
Try to recover by turning the given expression into a call.
Definition Sema.cpp:2822
bool isRedefinitionAllowedFor(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested, bool &Visible)
Determine if D has a definition which allows we redefine it in current TU.
FunctionDecl * ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType, bool Complain, DeclAccessPair &Found, bool *pHadMultipleCandidates=nullptr)
ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of an overloaded function (C++ [over....
bool FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(ArrayRef< QualType > Old, ArrayRef< QualType > New, unsigned *ArgPos=nullptr, bool Reversed=false)
FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types for equality of their param...
SemaDiagnosticBuilder::DeferredDiagnosticsType DeviceDeferredDiags
Diagnostics that are emitted only if we discover that the given function must be codegen'ed.
Definition Sema.h:1411
void CheckDelayedMemberExceptionSpecs()
DeclGroupPtrTy ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType=nullptr)
Definition SemaDecl.cpp:79
void ActOnReenterCXXMethodParameter(Scope *S, ParmVarDecl *Param)
This is used to implement the constant expression evaluation part of the attribute enable_if extensio...
ExprResult BuildPackIndexingExpr(Expr *PackExpression, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, Expr *IndexExpr, SourceLocation RSquareLoc, ArrayRef< Expr * > ExpandedExprs={}, bool FullySubstituted=false)
void InstantiateMemInitializers(CXXConstructorDecl *New, const CXXConstructorDecl *Tmpl, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
void PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext=true)
Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains.
ParsedType getDestructorName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, ParsedType ObjectType, bool EnteringContext)
void ActOnPragmaMSAllocText(SourceLocation PragmaLocation, StringRef Section, const SmallVector< std::tuple< IdentifierInfo *, SourceLocation > > &Functions)
Called on well-formed #pragma alloc_text().
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:899
ClassTemplateDecl * StdCoroutineTraitsCache
The C++ "std::coroutine_traits" template, which is defined in <coroutine_traits>
Definition Sema.h:3140
bool captureSwiftVersionIndependentAPINotes()
Whether APINotes should be gathered for all applicable Swift language versions, without being applied...
Definition Sema.h:1637
PragmaStack< bool > StrictGuardStackCheckStack
Definition Sema.h:2041
void LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, Scope *S, UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions)
void PrintInstantiationStack()
Definition Sema.h:13634
void checkSpecializationReachability(SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *Spec)
UnusedFileScopedDeclsType UnusedFileScopedDecls
The set of file scoped decls seen so far that have not been used and must warn if not used.
Definition Sema.h:3549
bool hasVisibleDefaultArgument(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
Determine if the template parameter D has a visible default argument.
void CleanupVarDeclMarking()
bool CheckConstraintExpression(const Expr *CE, Token NextToken=Token(), bool *PossibleNonPrimary=nullptr, bool IsTrailingRequiresClause=false)
Check whether the given expression is a valid constraint expression.
ExprResult PerformImplicitObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, CXXMethodDecl *Method)
PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of the implicit object parameter for the...
ExprResult DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose=true)
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:754
bool isImmediateFunctionContext() const
Definition Sema.h:8169
NamedDecl * LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID, Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration, SourceLocation Loc)
LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at file scope.
ASTContext & getASTContext() const
Definition Sema.h:926
std::unique_ptr< sema::FunctionScopeInfo, PoppedFunctionScopeDeleter > PoppedFunctionScopePtr
Definition Sema.h:1060
void addExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr< ExternalSemaSource > E)
Registers an external source.
Definition Sema.cpp:655
ExprResult CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E)
CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion performed on a function designator o...
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:764
void translateTemplateArguments(const ASTTemplateArgsPtr &In, TemplateArgumentListInfo &Out)
Translates template arguments as provided by the parser into template arguments used by semantic anal...
void DeclareGlobalAllocationFunction(DeclarationName Name, QualType Return, ArrayRef< QualType > Params)
DeclareGlobalAllocationFunction - Declares a single implicit global allocation function if it doesn't...
UnresolvedSetIterator getMostSpecialized(UnresolvedSetIterator SBegin, UnresolvedSetIterator SEnd, TemplateSpecCandidateSet &FailedCandidates, SourceLocation Loc, const PartialDiagnostic &NoneDiag, const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag, const PartialDiagnostic &CandidateDiag, bool Complain=true, QualType TargetType=QualType())
Retrieve the most specialized of the given function template specializations.
bool IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType)
IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the expression From (whose potentially-a...
bool DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPackInRequiresExpr(RequiresExpr *RE)
If the given requirees-expression contains an unexpanded reference to one of its own parameter packs,...
TypeSourceInfo * SubstType(TypeSourceInfo *T, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity, bool AllowDeducedTST=false)
Perform substitution on the type T with a given set of template arguments.
void CheckCoroutineWrapper(FunctionDecl *FD)
bool IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType)
IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a floating po...
ClassTemplateDecl * StdInitializerList
The C++ "std::initializer_list" template, which is defined in <initializer_list>.
Definition Sema.h:6511
CXXDestructorDecl * LookupDestructor(CXXRecordDecl *Class)
Look for the destructor of the given class.
ExprResult BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input, bool IsAfterAmp=false)
void CheckExplicitlyDefaultedFunction(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *MD)
ParsingDeclState PushParsingDeclaration(sema::DelayedDiagnosticPool &pool)
Definition Sema.h:1404
void ActOnPragmaAttributeAttribute(ParsedAttr &Attribute, SourceLocation PragmaLoc, attr::ParsedSubjectMatchRuleSet Rules)
bool isCurrentClassName(const IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec *SS=nullptr)
isCurrentClassName - Determine whether the identifier II is the name of the class type currently bein...
bool tryCaptureVariable(ValueDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType, QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt)
Try to capture the given variable.
void MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var)
Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,...
bool IsRedefinitionInModule(const NamedDecl *New, const NamedDecl *Old) const
Check the redefinition in C++20 Modules.
Decl * ActOnStartExportDecl(Scope *S, SourceLocation ExportLoc, SourceLocation LBraceLoc)
We have parsed the start of an export declaration, including the '{' (if present).
void checkExceptionSpecification(bool IsTopLevel, ExceptionSpecificationType EST, ArrayRef< ParsedType > DynamicExceptions, ArrayRef< SourceRange > DynamicExceptionRanges, Expr *NoexceptExpr, SmallVectorImpl< QualType > &Exceptions, FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI)
Check the given exception-specification and update the exception specification information with the r...
SmallVector< std::pair< FunctionDecl *, FunctionDecl * >, 2 > DelayedEquivalentExceptionSpecChecks
All the function redeclarations seen during a class definition that had their exception spec checks d...
Definition Sema.h:6595
void LookupBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions)
bool checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(CXXMethodDecl *Method)
Check whether 'this' shows up in the type of a static member function after the (naturally empty) cv-...
ExprResult BuildTemplateIdExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, LookupResult &R, bool RequiresADL, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs)
void DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(Decl *FD)
Issue any -Wunguarded-availability warnings in FD.
void PopExpressionEvaluationContext()
NamespaceDecl * getOrCreateStdNamespace()
Retrieve the special "std" namespace, which may require us to implicitly define the namespace.
ExprResult CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, bool RequiresADL=true, bool AllowRewrittenCandidates=true, FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn=nullptr)
Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded operator.
bool CheckTypeTraitArity(unsigned Arity, SourceLocation Loc, size_t N)
PragmaStack< StringLiteral * > ConstSegStack
Definition Sema.h:2037
StmtResult ActOnSEHTryBlock(bool IsCXXTry, SourceLocation TryLoc, Stmt *TryBlock, Stmt *Handler)
ExprResult ImpCastExprToType(Expr *E, QualType Type, CastKind CK, ExprValueKind VK=VK_PRValue, const CXXCastPath *BasePath=nullptr, CheckedConversionKind CCK=CheckedConversionKind::Implicit)
ImpCastExprToType - If Expr is not of type 'Type', insert an implicit cast.
Definition Sema.cpp:756
void ActOnPragmaOptionsAlign(PragmaOptionsAlignKind Kind, SourceLocation PragmaLoc)
ActOnPragmaOptionsAlign - Called on well formed #pragma options align.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:334
bool FunctionNonObjectParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionDecl *OldFunction, const FunctionDecl *NewFunction, unsigned *ArgPos=nullptr, bool Reversed=false)
ExprResult DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E)
DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:883
bool isInitListConstructor(const FunctionDecl *Ctor)
Determine whether Ctor is an initializer-list constructor, as defined in [dcl.init....
ExprResult BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, PredefinedIdentKind IK)
void ActOnStartFunctionDeclarationDeclarator(Declarator &D, unsigned TemplateParameterDepth)
Called before parsing a function declarator belonging to a function declaration.
ExprResult ActOnPseudoDestructorExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind OpKind, CXXScopeSpec &SS, UnqualifiedId &FirstTypeName, SourceLocation CCLoc, SourceLocation TildeLoc, UnqualifiedId &SecondTypeName)
bool isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S)
isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope, if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal...
Definition SemaDecl.cpp:699
bool isConstantEvaluatedOverride
Used to change context to isConstantEvaluated without pushing a heavy ExpressionEvaluationContextReco...
Definition Sema.h:2585
ExprResult CheckConceptTemplateId(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, const DeclarationNameInfo &ConceptNameInfo, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, TemplateDecl *NamedConcept, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, bool DoCheckConstraintSatisfaction=true)
ParsingClassState PushParsingClass()
Definition Sema.h:6538
@ FRS_Success
Definition Sema.h:10762
@ FRS_DiagnosticIssued
Definition Sema.h:10764
@ FRS_NoViableFunction
Definition Sema.h:10763
bool CheckArgsForPlaceholders(MultiExprArg args)
Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to handle later.
void ActOnPragmaCXLimitedRange(SourceLocation Loc, LangOptions::ComplexRangeKind Range)
ActOnPragmaCXLimitedRange - Called on well formed #pragma STDC CX_LIMITED_RANGE.
bool UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const LookupResult &R, bool HasTrailingLParen)
TemplateParameterList * GetTemplateParameterList(TemplateDecl *TD)
Returns the template parameter list with all default template argument information.
void ActOnPragmaFPExceptions(SourceLocation Loc, LangOptions::FPExceptionModeKind)
Called on well formed '#pragma clang fp' that has option 'exceptions'.
void InstantiateVariableDefinition(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, VarDecl *Var, bool Recursive=false, bool DefinitionRequired=false, bool AtEndOfTU=false)
Instantiate the definition of the given variable from its template.
void inferGslPointerAttribute(NamedDecl *ND, CXXRecordDecl *UnderlyingRecord)
Add gsl::Pointer attribute to std::container::iterator.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:112
SmallVector< LateInstantiatedAttribute, 1 > LateInstantiatedAttrVec
Definition Sema.h:14085
ExprResult BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr)
ExprResult ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc, LabelDecl *TheDecl)
ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
void MarkAsLateParsedTemplate(FunctionDecl *FD, Decl *FnD, CachedTokens &Toks)
llvm::SmallVector< DeleteExprLoc, 4 > DeleteLocs
Definition Sema.h:968
llvm::SmallSetVector< CXXRecordDecl *, 16 > AssociatedClassSet
Definition Sema.h:9310
QualType CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType *CompLHSTy=nullptr)
AccessResult CheckAllocationAccess(SourceLocation OperatorLoc, SourceRange PlacementRange, CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, bool Diagnose=true)
Checks access to an overloaded operator new or delete.
bool isTemplateTemplateParameterAtLeastAsSpecializedAs(TemplateParameterList *PParam, TemplateDecl *PArg, TemplateDecl *AArg, const DefaultArguments &DefaultArgs, SourceLocation ArgLoc, bool PartialOrdering, bool *StrictPackMatch)
std::string getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(CXXBasePaths &Paths)
Builds a string representing ambiguous paths from a specific derived class to different subobjects of...
unsigned TyposCorrected
The number of typos corrected by CorrectTypo.
Definition Sema.h:9260
bool BuiltinVectorToScalarMath(CallExpr *TheCall)
bool checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *OldDefn, VarDecl *NewDefn)
We've just determined that Old and New both appear to be definitions of the same variable.
DefaultedComparisonKind
Kinds of defaulted comparison operator functions.
Definition Sema.h:6063
@ Relational
This is an <, <=, >, or >= that should be implemented as a rewrite in terms of a <=> comparison.
Definition Sema.h:6077
@ NotEqual
This is an operator!= that should be implemented as a rewrite in terms of a == comparison.
Definition Sema.h:6074
@ ThreeWay
This is an operator<=> that should be implemented as a series of subobject comparisons.
Definition Sema.h:6071
@ None
This is not a defaultable comparison operator.
Definition Sema.h:6065
@ Equal
This is an operator== that should be implemented as a series of subobject comparisons.
Definition Sema.h:6068
bool CheckCallingConvAttr(const ParsedAttr &attr, CallingConv &CC, const FunctionDecl *FD=nullptr, CUDAFunctionTarget CFT=CUDAFunctionTarget::InvalidTarget)
Check validaty of calling convention attribute attr.
AccessResult CheckMemberOperatorAccess(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *ObjectExpr, const SourceRange &, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl)
OverloadKind CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &OldDecls, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules)
Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the declarations in Old.
ExprResult ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, MultiExprArg Val)
ExprResult ActOnArrayTypeTrait(ArrayTypeTrait ATT, SourceLocation KWLoc, ParsedType LhsTy, Expr *DimExpr, SourceLocation RParen)
ActOnArrayTypeTrait - Parsed one of the binary type trait support pseudo-functions.
QualType ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType)
llvm::SmallVector< QualType, 4 > CurrentParameterCopyTypes
Stack of types that correspond to the parameter entities that are currently being copy-initialized.
Definition Sema.h:8999
bool IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, bool InOverloadResolution, QualType &ConvertedType, bool &IncompatibleObjC)
IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the expression From, which has the (possib...
bool RequireLiteralType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser)
Ensure that the type T is a literal type.
SmallVector< const Decl * > DeclsWithEffectsToVerify
All functions/lambdas/blocks which have bodies and which have a non-empty FunctionEffectsRef to be ve...
Definition Sema.h:15590
@ Conversions
Allow explicit conversion functions but not explicit constructors.
Definition Sema.h:10095
@ All
Allow both explicit conversion functions and explicit constructors.
Definition Sema.h:10097
void ActOnFinishRequiresExpr()
QualType BuildCountAttributedArrayOrPointerType(QualType WrappedTy, Expr *CountExpr, bool CountInBytes, bool OrNull)
static const unsigned MaxAlignmentExponent
The maximum alignment, same as in llvm::Value.
Definition Sema.h:1213
llvm::PointerIntPair< CXXRecordDecl *, 3, CXXSpecialMemberKind > SpecialMemberDecl
Definition Sema.h:6526
QualType CheckMatrixMultiplyOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign)
ExprResult BuildCXXNew(SourceRange Range, bool UseGlobal, SourceLocation PlacementLParen, MultiExprArg PlacementArgs, SourceLocation PlacementRParen, SourceRange TypeIdParens, QualType AllocType, TypeSourceInfo *AllocTypeInfo, std::optional< Expr * > ArraySize, SourceRange DirectInitRange, Expr *Initializer)
void ActOnStartCXXInClassMemberInitializer()
Enter a new C++ default initializer scope.
void * SaveNestedNameSpecifierAnnotation(CXXScopeSpec &SS)
Given a C++ nested-name-specifier, produce an annotation value that the parser can use later to recon...
ValueDecl * tryLookupCtorInitMemberDecl(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl, CXXScopeSpec &SS, ParsedType TemplateTypeTy, IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase)
void ProcessPragmaWeak(Scope *S, Decl *D)
void DiagnoseUseOfDeletedFunction(SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range, DeclarationName Name, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, FunctionDecl *Fn, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsMember=false)
bool shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee)
NamedDecl * BuildUsingDeclaration(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, SourceLocation UsingLoc, bool HasTypenameKeyword, SourceLocation TypenameLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList, bool IsInstantiation, bool IsUsingIfExists)
Builds a using declaration.
bool BuiltinConstantArg(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum, llvm::APSInt &Result)
BuiltinConstantArg - Handle a check if argument ArgNum of CallExpr TheCall is a constant expression.
PrintingPolicy getPrintingPolicy() const
Retrieve a suitable printing policy for diagnostics.
Definition Sema.h:1191
std::string getFixItZeroInitializerForType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc) const
Get a string to suggest for zero-initialization of a type.
bool IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType)
Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
llvm::PointerUnion< const NamedDecl *, const concepts::NestedRequirement * > ConstrainedDeclOrNestedRequirement
Definition Sema.h:14808
Decl * BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, AccessSpecifier AS, RecordDecl *Record, const PrintingPolicy &Policy)
BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an anonymous structure or union.
bool CheckDeclCompatibleWithTemplateTemplate(TemplateDecl *Template, TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param, const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg)
bool pushCodeSynthesisContext(CodeSynthesisContext Ctx)
void ActOnPragmaFPEvalMethod(SourceLocation Loc, LangOptions::FPEvalMethodKind Value)
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:636
Module * getOwningModule(const Decl *Entity)
Get the module owning an entity.
Definition Sema.h:3572
bool SubstTemplateArguments(ArrayRef< TemplateArgumentLoc > Args, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, TemplateArgumentListInfo &Outputs)
bool CheckAttrNoArgs(const ParsedAttr &CurrAttr)
ObjCMethodDecl * getCurMethodDecl()
getCurMethodDecl - If inside of a method body, this returns a pointer to the method decl for the meth...
Definition Sema.cpp:1659
bool isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous, TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition, SourceLocation NewTagLoc, const IdentifierInfo *Name)
Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable as a redeclaration of the given tag declarati...
ExprResult ActOnCXXThrow(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *expr)
sema::LambdaScopeInfo * getCurGenericLambda()
Retrieve the current generic lambda info, if any.
Definition Sema.cpp:2583
unsigned InventedParameterInfosStart
The index of the first InventedParameterInfo that refers to the current context.
Definition Sema.h:3464
void MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F)
DeclRefExpr * BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, SourceLocation Loc, const CXXScopeSpec *SS=nullptr)
ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, llvm::APSInt &Value, CCEKind CCE)
void CheckAttributesOnDeducedType(Decl *D)
CheckAttributesOnDeducedType - Calls Sema functions for attributes that requires the type to be deduc...
void handleLambdaNumbering(CXXRecordDecl *Class, CXXMethodDecl *Method, std::optional< CXXRecordDecl::LambdaNumbering > NumberingOverride=std::nullopt)
Number lambda for linkage purposes if necessary.
ExprResult BuildCXXFoldExpr(UnresolvedLookupExpr *Callee, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr *LHS, BinaryOperatorKind Operator, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, Expr *RHS, SourceLocation RParenLoc, UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions)
void setFunctionHasIndirectGoto()
Definition Sema.cpp:2503
void HandleDependentAccessCheck(const DependentDiagnostic &DD, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
void DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation, CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor)
DefineImplicitMoveConstructor - Checks for feasibility of defining this constructor as the move const...
bool CheckConstraintSatisfaction(ConstrainedDeclOrNestedRequirement Entity, ArrayRef< AssociatedConstraint > AssociatedConstraints, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgLists, SourceRange TemplateIDRange, ConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction, const ConceptReference *TopLevelConceptId=nullptr, Expr **ConvertedExpr=nullptr)
Check whether the given list of constraint expressions are satisfied (as if in a 'conjunction') given...
QualType BuildBitIntType(bool IsUnsigned, Expr *BitWidth, SourceLocation Loc)
Build a bit-precise integer type.
TemplateParameterListEqualKind
Enumeration describing how template parameter lists are compared for equality.
Definition Sema.h:12126
@ TPL_TemplateTemplateParmMatch
We are matching the template parameter lists of two template template parameters as part of matching ...
Definition Sema.h:12144
@ TPL_TemplateMatch
We are matching the template parameter lists of two templates that might be redeclarations.
Definition Sema.h:12134
@ TPL_TemplateParamsEquivalent
We are determining whether the template-parameters are equivalent according to C++ [temp....
Definition Sema.h:12154
ExprResult ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, SourceLocation RPLoc)
NamedDecl * ActOnTypeParameter(Scope *S, bool Typename, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, SourceLocation KeyLoc, IdentifierInfo *ParamName, SourceLocation ParamNameLoc, unsigned Depth, unsigned Position, SourceLocation EqualLoc, ParsedType DefaultArg, bool HasTypeConstraint)
ActOnTypeParameter - Called when a C++ template type parameter (e.g., "typename T") has been parsed.
SmallVectorImpl< Decl * > & WeakTopLevelDecls()
WeakTopLevelDeclDecls - access to #pragma weak-generated Decls.
Definition Sema.h:4870
EnumDecl * getStdAlignValT() const
const NormalizedConstraint * getNormalizedAssociatedConstraints(ConstrainedDeclOrNestedRequirement Entity, ArrayRef< AssociatedConstraint > AssociatedConstraints)
void ActOnFinishDelayedMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *Record)
LangAS getDefaultCXXMethodAddrSpace() const
Returns default addr space for method qualifiers.
Definition Sema.cpp:1673
QualType BuiltinRemoveReference(QualType BaseType, UTTKind UKind, SourceLocation Loc)
ExprResult CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, SourceLocation DefaultLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc, bool PredicateIsExpr, void *ControllingExprOrType, ArrayRef< TypeSourceInfo * > Types, ArrayRef< Expr * > Exprs)
ControllingExprOrType is either a TypeSourceInfo * or an Expr *.
ExprResult BuildCaptureInit(const sema::Capture &Capture, SourceLocation ImplicitCaptureLoc, bool IsOpenMPMapping=false)
Initialize the given capture with a suitable expression.
void AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion=true, bool StrictPackMatch=false)
AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over...
LazyDeclPtr StdBadAlloc
The C++ "std::bad_alloc" class, which is defined by the C++ standard library.
Definition Sema.h:8350
void ActOnPragmaClangSection(SourceLocation PragmaLoc, PragmaClangSectionAction Action, PragmaClangSectionKind SecKind, StringRef SecName)
ActOnPragmaClangSection - Called on well formed #pragma clang section.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:389
bool IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, QualType &ConvertedType)
bool CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(FunctionDecl *FD, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, LookupResult &Previous, bool QualifiedFriend=false)
Perform semantic analysis for the given function template specialization.
void FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(SourceLocation InstantiationLoc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, AssociatedNamespaceSet &AssociatedNamespaces, AssociatedClassSet &AssociatedClasses)
Find the associated classes and namespaces for argument-dependent lookup for a call with the given se...
AssumedTemplateKind
Definition Sema.h:11398
@ FoundFunctions
This is assumed to be a template name because lookup found one or more functions (but no function tem...
Definition Sema.h:11405
@ FoundNothing
This is assumed to be a template name because lookup found nothing.
Definition Sema.h:11402
bool CheckParamExceptionSpec(const PartialDiagnostic &NestedDiagID, const PartialDiagnostic &NoteID, const FunctionProtoType *Target, bool SkipTargetFirstParameter, SourceLocation TargetLoc, const FunctionProtoType *Source, bool SkipSourceFirstParameter, SourceLocation SourceLoc)
CheckParamExceptionSpec - Check if the parameter and return types of the two functions have equivalen...
void AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType, Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions=false, bool PartialOverloading=false, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO={})
Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate set, using template argument deduc...
bool UnifySection(StringRef SectionName, int SectionFlags, NamedDecl *TheDecl)
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:795
bool CheckTemplateArgument(NamedDecl *Param, TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg, NamedDecl *Template, SourceLocation TemplateLoc, SourceLocation RAngleLoc, unsigned ArgumentPackIndex, CheckTemplateArgumentInfo &CTAI, CheckTemplateArgumentKind CTAK)
Check that the given template argument corresponds to the given template parameter.
void MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old, bool MergeTypeWithOld)
MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and scope as a previous declar...
ExprResult ActOnUnevaluatedStringLiteral(ArrayRef< Token > StringToks)
QualType BuildQualifiedType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc, Qualifiers Qs, const DeclSpec *DS=nullptr)
void DiagnoseSelfMove(const Expr *LHSExpr, const Expr *RHSExpr, SourceLocation OpLoc)
DiagnoseSelfMove - Emits a warning if a value is moved to itself.
bool isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(QualType Param, QualType Arg)
Compare types for equality with respect to possibly compatible function types (noreturn adjustment,...
StmtResult ActOnFinishSwitchStmt(SourceLocation SwitchLoc, Stmt *Switch, Stmt *Body)
AtomicArgumentOrder
Definition Sema.h:2692
void PushFunctionScope()
Enter a new function scope.
Definition Sema.cpp:2331
ExprResult ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, NamedDecl *Found, SourceLocation NameLoc, const Token &NextToken)
Act on the result of classifying a name as a specific non-type declaration.
bool RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(CXXScopeSpec &SS)
ExprResult ActOnBuiltinBitCastExpr(SourceLocation KWLoc, Declarator &Dcl, ExprResult Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Definition SemaCast.cpp:426
SourceRange getExprRange(Expr *E) const
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:506
bool ActOnCXXGlobalScopeSpecifier(SourceLocation CCLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS)
The parser has parsed a global nested-name-specifier '::'.
void SetDeclDefaulted(Decl *dcl, SourceLocation DefaultLoc)
NamedReturnInfo getNamedReturnInfo(Expr *&E, SimplerImplicitMoveMode Mode=SimplerImplicitMoveMode::Normal)
Determine whether the given expression might be move-eligible or copy-elidable in either a (co_)retur...
void setExceptionMode(SourceLocation Loc, LangOptions::FPExceptionModeKind)
Called to set exception behavior for floating point operations.
bool ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifier(Scope *S, NestedNameSpecInfo &IdInfo, bool EnteringContext, CXXScopeSpec &SS, bool *IsCorrectedToColon=nullptr, bool OnlyNamespace=false)
The parser has parsed a nested-name-specifier 'identifier::'.
void AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions=false, bool PartialOverloading=false, bool AllowExplicit=true, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate=ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO={}, bool AggregateCandidateDeduction=false)
Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate in the candidate set, using template argume...
bool CheckFunctionReturnType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc)
ArrayRef< InventedTemplateParameterInfo > getInventedParameterInfos() const
Definition Sema.h:11334
void inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRecordDecl *Record)
Add [[gsl::Owner]] and [[gsl::Pointer]] attributes for std:: types.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:168
void DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation, CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor)
DefineImplicitCopyConstructor - Checks for feasibility of defining this constructor as the copy const...
LazyVector< const DeclaratorDecl *, ExternalSemaSource, &ExternalSemaSource::ReadUnusedFileScopedDecls, 2, 2 > UnusedFileScopedDeclsType
Definition Sema.h:3545
std::optional< ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::InitializationContext > OutermostDeclarationWithDelayedImmediateInvocations() const
Definition Sema.h:8204
NamedDecl * ActOnTemplateTemplateParameter(Scope *S, SourceLocation TmpLoc, TemplateNameKind Kind, bool TypenameKeyword, TemplateParameterList *Params, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, IdentifierInfo *ParamName, SourceLocation ParamNameLoc, unsigned Depth, unsigned Position, SourceLocation EqualLoc, ParsedTemplateArgument DefaultArg)
ActOnTemplateTemplateParameter - Called when a C++ template template parameter (e....
static DeclarationName getPrintable(DeclarationName N)
Definition Sema.h:15014
llvm::function_ref< void(SourceLocation Loc, PartialDiagnostic PD)> DiagReceiverTy
Definition Sema.h:4568
bool CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI)
Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration.
bool checkLiteralOperatorId(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const UnqualifiedId &Id, bool IsUDSuffix)
friend class ASTReader
Definition Sema.h:1557
bool FriendConstraintsDependOnEnclosingTemplate(const FunctionDecl *FD)
void addNoClusterAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI)
Add a no_cluster attribute to a particular declaration.
void DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(const Stmt *S, unsigned DiagID)
DiagnoseUnusedExprResult - If the statement passed in is an expression whose result is unused,...
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:405
FPOptions & getCurFPFeatures()
Definition Sema.h:921
RecordDecl * StdSourceLocationImplDecl
The C++ "std::source_location::__impl" struct, defined in <source_location>.
Definition Sema.h:8302
Sema(Preprocessor &pp, ASTContext &ctxt, ASTConsumer &consumer, TranslationUnitKind TUKind=TU_Complete, CodeCompleteConsumer *CompletionConsumer=nullptr)
Definition Sema.cpp:272
ConditionResult ActOnCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *SubExpr, ConditionKind CK, bool MissingOK=false)
SourceLocation getLocForEndOfToken(SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Offset=0)
Calls Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken()
Definition Sema.cpp:83
sema::LambdaScopeInfo * PushLambdaScope()
Definition Sema.cpp:2349
StmtResult ActOnCoreturnStmt(Scope *S, SourceLocation KwLoc, Expr *E)
void InstantiateAttrs(const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, const Decl *Pattern, Decl *Inst, LateInstantiatedAttrVec *LateAttrs=nullptr, LocalInstantiationScope *OuterMostScope=nullptr)
void PopCompoundScope()
Definition Sema.cpp:2482
bool RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
Definition Sema.h:15424
bool EnsureTemplateArgumentListConstraints(TemplateDecl *Template, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, SourceRange TemplateIDRange)
Ensure that the given template arguments satisfy the constraints associated with the given template,...
SkipBodyInfo shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II, SourceLocation IILoc)
Determine whether the body of an anonymous enumeration should be skipped.
UnexpandedParameterPackContext
The context in which an unexpanded parameter pack is being diagnosed.
Definition Sema.h:14339
@ UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType
The fixed underlying type of an enumeration.
Definition Sema.h:14359
@ UPPC_RequiresClause
Definition Sema.h:14410
@ UPPC_UsingDeclaration
A using declaration.
Definition Sema.h:14365
@ UPPC_IfExists
Microsoft __if_exists.
Definition Sema.h:14392
@ UPPC_Requirement
Definition Sema.h:14407
@ UPPC_ExceptionType
The type of an exception.
Definition Sema.h:14383
@ UPPC_EnumeratorValue
The enumerator value.
Definition Sema.h:14362
@ UPPC_Lambda
Lambda expression.
Definition Sema.h:14398
@ UPPC_IfNotExists
Microsoft __if_not_exists.
Definition Sema.h:14395
@ UPPC_PartialSpecialization
Partial specialization.
Definition Sema.h:14389
@ UPPC_Initializer
An initializer.
Definition Sema.h:14374
@ UPPC_BaseType
The base type of a class type.
Definition Sema.h:14344
@ UPPC_FriendDeclaration
A friend declaration.
Definition Sema.h:14368
@ UPPC_DefaultArgument
A default argument.
Definition Sema.h:14377
@ UPPC_DeclarationType
The type of an arbitrary declaration.
Definition Sema.h:14347
@ UPPC_Expression
An arbitrary expression.
Definition Sema.h:14341
@ UPPC_ExplicitSpecialization
Explicit specialization.
Definition Sema.h:14386
@ UPPC_DeclarationQualifier
A declaration qualifier.
Definition Sema.h:14371
@ UPPC_DataMemberType
The type of a data member.
Definition Sema.h:14350
@ UPPC_StaticAssertExpression
The expression in a static assertion.
Definition Sema.h:14356
@ UPPC_Block
Block expression.
Definition Sema.h:14401
@ UPPC_BitFieldWidth
The size of a bit-field.
Definition Sema.h:14353
@ UPPC_NonTypeTemplateParameterType
The type of a non-type template parameter.
Definition Sema.h:14380
@ UPPC_TypeConstraint
A type constraint.
Definition Sema.h:14404
api_notes::APINotesManager APINotes
Definition Sema.h:1287
bool BuiltinConstantArgRange(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum, int Low, int High, bool RangeIsError=true)
BuiltinConstantArgRange - Handle a check if argument ArgNum of CallExpr TheCall is a constant express...
CXXConstructorDecl * LookupDefaultConstructor(CXXRecordDecl *Class)
Look up the default constructor for the given class.
bool IsLayoutCompatible(QualType T1, QualType T2) const
Decl * ActOnStartNamespaceDef(Scope *S, SourceLocation InlineLoc, SourceLocation NamespaceLoc, SourceLocation IdentLoc, IdentifierInfo *Ident, SourceLocation LBrace, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList, UsingDirectiveDecl *&UsingDecl, bool IsNested)
ActOnStartNamespaceDef - This is called at the start of a namespace definition.
llvm::DenseMap< Decl *, SmallVector< PartialDiagnosticAt, 1 > > SuppressedDiagnosticsMap
For each declaration that involved template argument deduction, the set of diagnostics that were supp...
Definition Sema.h:12501
void buildLambdaScope(sema::LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator, SourceRange IntroducerRange, LambdaCaptureDefault CaptureDefault, SourceLocation CaptureDefaultLoc, bool ExplicitParams, bool Mutable)
Endow the lambda scope info with the relevant properties.
const LangOptions & getLangOpts() const
Definition Sema.h:919
void DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *PrevDecl, bool SupportedForCompatibility=false)
DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow - Produce a diagnostic complaining that the template parameter 'PrevD...
TypoCorrection CorrectTypo(const DeclarationNameInfo &Typo, Sema::LookupNameKind LookupKind, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, CorrectionCandidateCallback &CCC, CorrectTypoKind Mode, DeclContext *MemberContext=nullptr, bool EnteringContext=false, const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT=nullptr, bool RecordFailure=true)
Try to "correct" a typo in the source code by finding visible declarations whose names are similar to...
QualType CheckComparisonCategoryType(ComparisonCategoryType Kind, SourceLocation Loc, ComparisonCategoryUsage Usage)
Lookup the specified comparison category types in the standard library, an check the VarDecls possibl...
bool RequireCompleteExprType(Expr *E, CompleteTypeKind Kind, TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser)
Ensure that the type of the given expression is complete.
bool RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParameterList *Params)
Rebuild the template parameters now that we know we're in a current instantiation.
void DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Stmt *Body)
bool CaptureHasSideEffects(const sema::Capture &From)
Does copying/destroying the captured variable have side effects?
llvm::PointerIntPair< Decl *, 2 > InstantiatingSpecializationsKey
Definition Sema.h:13042
void DiagnoseAbsenceOfOverrideControl(NamedDecl *D, bool Inconsistent)
DiagnoseAbsenceOfOverrideControl - Diagnose if 'override' keyword was not used in the declaration of ...
StmtResult ActOnFinishFullStmt(Stmt *Stmt)
SmallVector< VTableUse, 16 > VTableUses
The list of vtables that are required but have not yet been materialized.
Definition Sema.h:5842
PoppedFunctionScopePtr PopFunctionScopeInfo(const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *WP=nullptr, Decl *D=nullptr, QualType BlockType=QualType())
Pop a function (or block or lambda or captured region) scope from the stack.
Definition Sema.cpp:2443
void AddModeAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, IdentifierInfo *Name, bool InInstantiation=false)
AddModeAttr - Adds a mode attribute to a particular declaration.
AccessResult CheckStructuredBindingMemberAccess(SourceLocation UseLoc, CXXRecordDecl *DecomposedClass, DeclAccessPair Field)
Checks implicit access to a member in a structured binding.
void LookupVisibleDecls(Scope *S, LookupNameKind Kind, VisibleDeclConsumer &Consumer, bool IncludeGlobalScope=true, bool LoadExternal=true)
StmtResult ActOnWhileStmt(SourceLocation WhileLoc, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ConditionResult Cond, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Stmt *Body)
QualType CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
SourceLocation CurInitSegLoc
Definition Sema.h:2077
CastKind PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &src, QualType destType)
Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages except the final cast and returning t...
void ActOnPragmaMSVtorDisp(PragmaMsStackAction Action, SourceLocation PragmaLoc, MSVtorDispMode Value)
Called on well formed #pragma vtordisp().
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:724
SemaCodeCompletion & CodeCompletion()
Definition Sema.h:1436
void inferLifetimeBoundAttribute(FunctionDecl *FD)
Add [[clang:lifetimebound]] attr for std:: functions and methods.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:220
bool currentModuleIsHeaderUnit() const
Is the module scope we are in a C++ Header Unit?
Definition Sema.h:3566
void ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition(LambdaIntroducer &Intro, Declarator &ParamInfo, const DeclSpec &DS)
ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition - This is called just before we start parsing the body of a lambda; it a...
SemaOpenACC & OpenACC()
Definition Sema.h:1491
void SwapSatisfactionStack(llvm::SmallVectorImpl< SatisfactionStackEntryTy > &NewSS)
Definition Sema.h:14803
void EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC)
Enter a template parameter scope, after it's been associated with a particular DeclContext.
ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t
Definition Sema.h:7004
@ ReuseLambdaContextDecl
Definition Sema.h:7004
void ActOnBaseSpecifiers(Decl *ClassDecl, MutableArrayRef< CXXBaseSpecifier * > Bases)
ActOnBaseSpecifiers - Attach the given base specifiers to the class, after checking whether there are...
bool tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo, QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned FailedFoldDiagID)
Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning true if we were successful.
const FunctionProtoType * ResolveExceptionSpec(SourceLocation Loc, const FunctionProtoType *FPT)
ExprResult ActOnNoexceptSpec(Expr *NoexceptExpr, ExceptionSpecificationType &EST)
Check the given noexcept-specifier, convert its expression, and compute the appropriate ExceptionSpec...
void MarkExpressionAsImmediateEscalating(Expr *E)
void NoteTemplateLocation(const NamedDecl &Decl, std::optional< SourceRange > ParamRange={})
NamedDecl * findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name)
Look for a locally scoped extern "C" declaration by the given name.
bool CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old)
We've determined that New is a redeclaration of Old.
void ActOnLambdaClosureParameters(Scope *LambdaScope, MutableArrayRef< DeclaratorChunk::ParamInfo > ParamInfo)
void CheckCastAlign(Expr *Op, QualType T, SourceRange TRange)
CheckCastAlign - Implements -Wcast-align, which warns when a pointer cast increases the alignment req...
ASTConsumer & getASTConsumer() const
Definition Sema.h:927
NonOdrUseReason getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(ValueDecl *D)
If D cannot be odr-used in the current expression evaluation context, return a reason explaining why.
void DefineDefaultedComparison(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *FD, DefaultedComparisonKind DCK)
bool isUnexpandedParameterPackPermitted()
Determine whether an unexpanded parameter pack might be permitted in this location.
bool isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A, const NamedDecl *B)
Determine if A and B are equivalent internal linkage declarations from different modules,...
void diagnoseUnavailableAlignedAllocation(const FunctionDecl &FD, SourceLocation Loc)
Produce diagnostics if FD is an aligned allocation or deallocation function that is unavailable.
SemaBPF & BPF()
Definition Sema.h:1431
bool LookupParsedName(LookupResult &R, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, QualType ObjectType, bool AllowBuiltinCreation=false, bool EnteringContext=false)
Performs name lookup for a name that was parsed in the source code, and may contain a C++ scope speci...
void MarkFunctionParmPackReferenced(FunctionParmPackExpr *E)
Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a FunctionParmPackExpr.
void * OpaqueParser
Definition Sema.h:1325
bool DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, CorrectionCandidateCallback &CCC, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs=nullptr, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args={}, DeclContext *LookupCtx=nullptr)
Diagnose an empty lookup.
Preprocessor & PP
Definition Sema.h:1282
QualType CheckAdditionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType *CompLHSTy=nullptr)
bool CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(const FunctionDecl *FD, CheckConstexprKind Kind)
bool isPotentialImplicitMemberAccess(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, bool IsAddressOfOperand)
Check whether an expression might be an implicit class member access.
ExprResult BuildCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *ExecConfig=nullptr, bool IsExecConfig=false, bool AllowRecovery=false)
BuildCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
ExprResult BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn)
QualType BuiltinEnumUnderlyingType(QualType BaseType, SourceLocation Loc)
AccessResult CheckBaseClassAccess(SourceLocation AccessLoc, QualType Base, QualType Derived, const CXXBasePath &Path, unsigned DiagID, bool ForceCheck=false, bool ForceUnprivileged=false)
Checks access for a hierarchy conversion.
bool CheckUseOfCXXMethodAsAddressOfOperand(SourceLocation OpLoc, const Expr *Op, const CXXMethodDecl *MD)
bool MSPragmaOptimizeIsOn
The "on" or "off" argument passed by #pragma optimize, that denotes whether the optimizations in the ...
Definition Sema.h:2124
void collectUnexpandedParameterPacks(TemplateArgument Arg, SmallVectorImpl< UnexpandedParameterPack > &Unexpanded)
Collect the set of unexpanded parameter packs within the given template argument.
ExprResult BuildSourceLocExpr(SourceLocIdentKind Kind, QualType ResultTy, SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation RPLoc, DeclContext *ParentContext)
bool ActOnAlignasTypeArgument(StringRef KWName, ParsedType Ty, SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceRange R)
ActOnAlignasTypeArgument - Handle alignas(type-id) and _Alignas(type-name) .
bool DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(SourceLocation Loc, TypeSourceInfo *T, UnexpandedParameterPackContext UPPC)
If the given type contains an unexpanded parameter pack, diagnose the error.
bool RequireNonAbstractType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser)
threadSafety::BeforeSet * ThreadSafetyDeclCache
Definition Sema.h:1320
SmallVector< PragmaAttributeGroup, 2 > PragmaAttributeStack
Definition Sema.h:2102
MinSizeAttr * mergeMinSizeAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI)
AccessResult CheckBaseClassAccess(SourceLocation AccessLoc, CXXRecordDecl *Base, CXXRecordDecl *Derived, const CXXBasePath &Path, unsigned DiagID, llvm::function_ref< void(PartialDiagnostic &PD)> SetupPDiag, bool ForceCheck=false, bool ForceUnprivileged=false)
NamedDecl * getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D, const LookupResult &R)
Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef D, or null if it doesn't shadow any declaration ...
void checkTypeSupport(QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc, ValueDecl *D=nullptr)
Check if the type is allowed to be used for the current target.
Definition Sema.cpp:2121
AccessResult CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresolvedMemberExpr *E, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl)
Perform access-control checking on a previously-unresolved member access which has now been resolved ...
bool hasVisibleMemberSpecialization(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
Determine if there is a visible declaration of D that is a member specialization declaration (as oppo...
bool areMatrixTypesOfTheSameDimension(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy)
Are the two types matrix types and do they have the same dimensions i.e.
void AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, SourceLocation OpLoc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in operator overloads to the candidate set (...
ExprResult ActOnCXXBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind)
ActOnCXXBoolLiteral - Parse {true,false} literals.
LazyVector< VarDecl *, ExternalSemaSource, &ExternalSemaSource::ReadTentativeDefinitions, 2, 2 > TentativeDefinitionsType
Definition Sema.h:3553
SemaDirectX & DirectX()
Definition Sema.h:1446
llvm::SmallSetVector< const NamedDecl *, 16 > NamedDeclSetType
Definition Sema.h:6487
void CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(Declarator &D)
CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments - Check for any extra default arguments in the declarator,...
ExprResult BuildCXXTypeConstructExpr(TypeSourceInfo *Type, SourceLocation LParenLoc, MultiExprArg Exprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, bool ListInitialization)
SemaMSP430 & MSP430()
Definition Sema.h:1476
void CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DecompositionDecl *DD)
bool hasCStrMethod(const Expr *E)
Check to see if a given expression could have '.c_str()' called on it.
friend class ASTDeclReader
Definition Sema.h:1558
AssignConvertType CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType)
CheckAssignmentConstraints - Perform type checking for assignment, argument passing,...
void checkClassLevelDLLAttribute(CXXRecordDecl *Class)
Check class-level dllimport/dllexport attribute.
void AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions=false, bool PartialOverloading=false, bool AllowExplicit=true, bool AllowExplicitConversion=false, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate=ADLCallKind::NotADL, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions={}, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO={}, bool AggregateCandidateDeduction=false, bool StrictPackMatch=false)
AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of candidate functions, using the given fun...
const LangOptions & LangOpts
Definition Sema.h:1281
void InstantiateClassMembers(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, CXXRecordDecl *Instantiation, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, TemplateSpecializationKind TSK)
Instantiates the definitions of all of the member of the given class, which is an instantiation of a ...
NamedDecl * FindFirstQualifierInScope(Scope *S, NestedNameSpecifier NNS)
If the given nested-name-specifier begins with a bare identifier (e.g., Base::), perform name lookup ...
bool ActOnDuplicateDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *Prev, SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody)
Perform ODR-like check for C/ObjC when merging tag types from modules.
void ActOnCXXExitDeclaratorScope(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS)
ActOnCXXExitDeclaratorScope - Called when a declarator that previously invoked ActOnCXXEnterDeclarato...
std::pair< Expr *, std::string > findFailedBooleanCondition(Expr *Cond)
Find the failed Boolean condition within a given Boolean constant expression, and describe it with a ...
ExprResult PerformQualificationConversion(Expr *E, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK=VK_PRValue, CheckedConversionKind CCK=CheckedConversionKind::Implicit)
void DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(CXXTryStmt *TryBlock)
void MarkVirtualMembersReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, const CXXRecordDecl *RD, bool ConstexprOnly=false)
MarkVirtualMembersReferenced - Will mark all members of the given CXXRecordDecl referenced.
void PushExpressionEvaluationContextForFunction(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, FunctionDecl *FD)
bool IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, bool InOverloadResolution, QualType &ConvertedType)
IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the expression From,...
ExprResult BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, ArrayRef< OffsetOfComponent > Components, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
__builtin_offsetof(type, a.b[123][456].c)
std::unique_ptr< sema::FunctionScopeInfo > CachedFunctionScope
Definition Sema.h:1219
sema::LambdaScopeInfo * getCurLambda(bool IgnoreNonLambdaCapturingScope=false)
Retrieve the current lambda scope info, if any.
Definition Sema.cpp:2558
ExprResult BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Arg, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Config=nullptr, bool IsExecConfig=false, ADLCallKind UsesADL=ADLCallKind::NotADL)
BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression, i.e.
static const uint64_t MaximumAlignment
Definition Sema.h:1214
ExprResult BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Expr *Exp, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, CXXConversionDecl *Method, bool HadMultipleCandidates)
llvm::DenseMap< unsigned, CXXDeductionGuideDecl * > AggregateDeductionCandidates
Definition Sema.h:9002
ExprResult CheckConditionVariable(VarDecl *ConditionVar, SourceLocation StmtLoc, ConditionKind CK)
Check the use of the given variable as a C++ condition in an if, while, do-while, or switch statement...
ExprResult CheckForImmediateInvocation(ExprResult E, FunctionDecl *Decl)
Wrap the expression in a ConstantExpr if it is a potential immediate invocation.
ExprResult TemporaryMaterializationConversion(Expr *E)
If E is a prvalue denoting an unmaterialized temporary, materialize it as an xvalue.
bool ShouldEnterDeclaratorScope(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS)
VarArgKind isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty)
Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression.
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:952
void ActOnStartOfCompoundStmt(bool IsStmtExpr)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:416
bool isReachable(const NamedDecl *D)
Determine whether a declaration is reachable.
Definition Sema.h:15437
CUDAClusterDimsAttr * createClusterDimsAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *X, Expr *Y, Expr *Z)
Add a cluster_dims attribute to a particular declaration.
Decl * ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *S, Declarator &D, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody=nullptr, FnBodyKind BodyKind=FnBodyKind::Other)
NamedDeclSetType UnusedPrivateFields
Set containing all declared private fields that are not used.
Definition Sema.h:6489
SemaHLSL & HLSL()
Definition Sema.h:1451
VarTemplateSpecializationDecl * CompleteVarTemplateSpecializationDecl(VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec, VarDecl *PatternDecl, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
Instantiates a variable template specialization by completing it with appropriate type information an...
llvm::MapVector< const FunctionDecl *, std::unique_ptr< LateParsedTemplate > > LateParsedTemplateMapT
Definition Sema.h:11347
bool CollectStats
Flag indicating whether or not to collect detailed statistics.
Definition Sema.h:1217
llvm::SmallSetVector< DeclContext *, 16 > AssociatedNamespaceSet
Definition Sema.h:9309
void DefineInheritingConstructor(SourceLocation UseLoc, CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor)
Define the specified inheriting constructor.
ExprResult ConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
ConvertVectorExpr - Handle __builtin_convertvector.
void ActOnEndOfTranslationUnitFragment(TUFragmentKind Kind)
Definition Sema.cpp:1171
bool ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const
bool CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD, LookupResult &Previous, bool IsMemberSpecialization, bool DeclIsDefn)
Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration.
CXXRecordDecl * getStdBadAlloc() const
ExprResult ActOnCXXTypeConstructExpr(ParsedType TypeRep, SourceLocation LParenOrBraceLoc, MultiExprArg Exprs, SourceLocation RParenOrBraceLoc, bool ListInitialization)
ActOnCXXTypeConstructExpr - Parse construction of a specified type.
AlwaysInlineAttr * mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, const IdentifierInfo *Ident)
FieldDecl * CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc, bool Mutable, Expr *BitfieldWidth, InClassInitStyle InitStyle, SourceLocation TSSL, AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, Declarator *D=nullptr)
Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness.
ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord & currentEvaluationContext()
Definition Sema.h:6922
void CheckUnusedVolatileAssignment(Expr *E)
Check whether E, which is either a discarded-value expression or an unevaluated operand,...
void updateAttrsForLateParsedTemplate(const Decl *Pattern, Decl *Inst)
Update instantiation attributes after template was late parsed.
QualType CheckDestructorDeclarator(Declarator &D, QualType R, StorageClass &SC)
CheckDestructorDeclarator - Called by ActOnDeclarator to check the well-formednes of the destructor d...
bool CheckPureMethod(CXXMethodDecl *Method, SourceRange InitRange)
Mark the given method pure.
void SetParamDefaultArgument(ParmVarDecl *Param, Expr *DefaultArg, SourceLocation EqualLoc)
PragmaClangSection PragmaClangRelroSection
Definition Sema.h:1814
void NoteHiddenVirtualMethods(CXXMethodDecl *MD, SmallVectorImpl< CXXMethodDecl * > &OverloadedMethods)
static StringRef GetFormatStringTypeName(FormatStringType FST)
SemaMIPS & MIPS()
Definition Sema.h:1471
IdentifierInfo * InventAbbreviatedTemplateParameterTypeName(const IdentifierInfo *ParamName, unsigned Index)
Invent a new identifier for parameters of abbreviated templates.
Definition Sema.cpp:139
void InstantiateVariableInitializer(VarDecl *Var, VarDecl *OldVar, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
Instantiate the initializer of a variable.
void CompleteLambdaCallOperator(CXXMethodDecl *Method, SourceLocation LambdaLoc, SourceLocation CallOperatorLoc, const AssociatedConstraint &TrailingRequiresClause, TypeSourceInfo *MethodTyInfo, ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind, StorageClass SC, ArrayRef< ParmVarDecl * > Params, bool HasExplicitResultType)
CXXMethodDecl * DeclareImplicitMoveAssignment(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl)
Declare the implicit move assignment operator for the given class.
SemaRISCV & RISCV()
Definition Sema.h:1516
bool IsSimplyAccessible(NamedDecl *Decl, CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, QualType BaseType)
Checks access to Target from the given class.
QualType CheckTypenameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, SourceLocation KeywordLoc, NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc, const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation IILoc, TypeSourceInfo **TSI, bool DeducedTSTContext)
void maybeAddDeclWithEffects(FuncOrBlockDecl *D)
Inline checks from the start of maybeAddDeclWithEffects, to minimize performance impact on code not u...
Definition Sema.h:15613
bool checkConstantPointerAuthKey(Expr *keyExpr, unsigned &key)
SourceLocation ImplicitMSInheritanceAttrLoc
Source location for newly created implicit MSInheritanceAttrs.
Definition Sema.h:1803
llvm::DenseMap< CXXRecordDecl *, bool > VTablesUsed
The set of classes whose vtables have been used within this translation unit, and a bit that will be ...
Definition Sema.h:5848
bool DeduceFunctionTypeFromReturnExpr(FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetExpr, const AutoType *AT)
Deduce the return type for a function from a returned expression, per C++1y [dcl.spec....
ExprResult prepareMatrixSplat(QualType MatrixTy, Expr *SplattedExpr)
Prepare SplattedExpr for a matrix splat operation, adding implicit casts if necessary.
void MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *D)
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:213
void CheckCXXDefaultArguments(FunctionDecl *FD)
Helpers for dealing with blocks and functions.
bool CheckCountedByAttrOnField(FieldDecl *FD, Expr *E, bool CountInBytes, bool OrNull)
Check if applying the specified attribute variant from the "counted by" family of attributes to Field...
ComparisonCategoryUsage
Definition Sema.h:5222
@ OperatorInExpression
The '<=>' operator was used in an expression and a builtin operator was selected.
Definition Sema.h:5225
@ DefaultedOperator
A defaulted 'operator<=>' needed the comparison category.
Definition Sema.h:5229
MemberPointerConversionDirection
Definition Sema.h:10215
SmallVector< PendingImplicitInstantiation, 1 > LateParsedInstantiations
Queue of implicit template instantiations that cannot be performed eagerly.
Definition Sema.h:13959
SmallVector< InventedTemplateParameterInfo, 4 > InventedParameterInfos
Stack containing information needed when in C++2a an 'auto' is encountered in a function declaration ...
Definition Sema.h:6482
DeclarationNameInfo SubstDeclarationNameInfo(const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
Do template substitution on declaration name info.
bool CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D, bool TreatUnavailableAsInvalid)
Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without emitting diagnostics.
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:75
ConditionResult ActOnConditionVariable(Decl *ConditionVar, SourceLocation StmtLoc, ConditionKind CK)
bool checkUnsafeAssigns(SourceLocation Loc, QualType LHS, Expr *RHS)
checkUnsafeAssigns - Check whether +1 expr is being assigned to weak/__unsafe_unretained type.
void performFunctionEffectAnalysis(TranslationUnitDecl *TU)
void MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, bool MightBeOdrUse)
Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration.
EltwiseBuiltinArgTyRestriction
Definition Sema.h:2758
void ProcessDeclAttributeList(Scope *S, Decl *D, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList, const ProcessDeclAttributeOptions &Options=ProcessDeclAttributeOptions())
ProcessDeclAttributeList - Apply all the decl attributes in the specified attribute list to the speci...
void MarkVTableUsed(SourceLocation Loc, CXXRecordDecl *Class, bool DefinitionRequired=false)
Note that the vtable for the given class was used at the given location.
bool CheckAllocatedType(QualType AllocType, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange R)
Checks that a type is suitable as the allocated type in a new-expression.
QualType InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS)
Diagnose cases where a scalar was implicitly converted to a vector and diagnose the underlying types.
bool diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND, SourceLocation Loc)
Emit diagnostics for the diagnose_if attributes on Function, ignoring any ArgDependent DiagnoseIfAttr...
static StringRef getPrintable(StringRef S)
Definition Sema.h:15009
SemaSwift & Swift()
Definition Sema.h:1531
NamedDecl * BuildUsingEnumDeclaration(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, SourceLocation UsingLoc, SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceLocation NameLoc, TypeSourceInfo *EnumType, EnumDecl *ED)
void AddImplicitMSFunctionNoBuiltinAttr(FunctionDecl *FD)
Only called on function definitions; if there is a pragma in scope with the effect of a range-based n...
TypeLoc getReturnTypeLoc(FunctionDecl *FD) const
PragmaStack< AlignPackInfo > AlignPackStack
Definition Sema.h:2026
bool canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D)
Determine whether we can delay parsing the body of a function or function template until it is used,...
SmallVector< std::pair< const CXXMethodDecl *, const CXXMethodDecl * >, 2 > DelayedOverridingExceptionSpecChecks
All the overriding functions seen during a class definition that had their exception spec checks dela...
Definition Sema.h:6587
CleanupInfo Cleanup
Used to control the generation of ExprWithCleanups.
Definition Sema.h:6949
std::vector< std::unique_ptr< TemplateInstantiationCallback > > TemplateInstCallbacks
The template instantiation callbacks to trace or track instantiations (objects can be chained).
Definition Sema.h:13592
llvm::DenseMap< ParmVarDecl *, SourceLocation > UnparsedDefaultArgLocs
Definition Sema.h:6519
StmtResult ActOnExprStmtError()
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:65
PragmaStack< StringLiteral * > BSSSegStack
Definition Sema.h:2036
ExprResult BuildTypeTrait(TypeTrait Kind, SourceLocation KWLoc, ArrayRef< TypeSourceInfo * > Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
const VarDecl * getCopyElisionCandidate(NamedReturnInfo &Info, QualType ReturnType)
Updates given NamedReturnInfo's move-eligible and copy-elidable statuses, considering the function re...
CXXRecordDecl * getCurrentInstantiationOf(NestedNameSpecifier NNS)
If the given nested name specifier refers to the current instantiation, return the declaration that c...
void MarkVirtualMemberExceptionSpecsNeeded(SourceLocation Loc, const CXXRecordDecl *RD)
Mark the exception specifications of all virtual member functions in the given class as needed.
bool hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(LookupResult &R, bool AllowFunctionTemplates=true, bool AllowDependent=true, bool AllowNonTemplateFunctions=false)
void completeExprArrayBound(Expr *E)
DeclContext * getCurLexicalContext() const
Definition Sema.h:1124
std::function< TypeResult(StringRef, StringRef, SourceLocation)> ParseTypeFromStringCallback
Callback to the parser to parse a type expressed as a string.
Definition Sema.h:1334
ExprResult BuildConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, CCEKind CCE, NamedDecl *Dest=nullptr)
llvm::StringMap< std::tuple< StringRef, SourceLocation > > FunctionToSectionMap
Sections used with pragma alloc_text.
Definition Sema.h:2080
bool ActOnSuperScopeSpecifier(SourceLocation SuperLoc, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS)
The parser has parsed a '__super' nested-name-specifier.
bool CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(FunctionDecl *FD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, LookupResult &Previous)
Perform semantic analysis for the given dependent function template specialization.
NamedDecl * getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() const
getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl - Return the Decl for the current ObjC method or C function we're in,...
Definition Sema.cpp:1666
bool RequireCompleteEnumDecl(EnumDecl *D, SourceLocation L, CXXScopeSpec *SS=nullptr)
Require that the EnumDecl is completed with its enumerators defined or instantiated.
ExprResult ActOnRequiresExpr(SourceLocation RequiresKWLoc, RequiresExprBodyDecl *Body, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ArrayRef< ParmVarDecl * > LocalParameters, SourceLocation RParenLoc, ArrayRef< concepts::Requirement * > Requirements, SourceLocation ClosingBraceLoc)
bool CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(FunctionDecl *FnDecl)
CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration - Check whether the declaration of this overloaded operator is wel...
void AddAllocAlignAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *ParamExpr)
AddAllocAlignAttr - Adds an alloc_align attribute to a particular declaration.
bool hasExplicitCallingConv(QualType T)
NameClassification ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *&Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, const Token &NextToken, CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC=nullptr)
Perform name lookup on the given name, classifying it based on the results of name lookup and the fol...
Definition SemaDecl.cpp:898
QualType CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
StmtResult ActOnNullStmt(SourceLocation SemiLoc, bool HasLeadingEmptyMacro=false)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:70
OpenCLOptions OpenCLFeatures
Definition Sema.h:1278
QualType FindCompositePointerType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&E1, Expr *&E2, bool ConvertArgs=true)
Find a merged pointer type and convert the two expressions to it.
TemplateArgument getPackSubstitutedTemplateArgument(TemplateArgument Arg) const
Definition Sema.h:11752
ExprResult BuildUnresolvedCoawaitExpr(SourceLocation KwLoc, Expr *Operand, UnresolvedLookupExpr *Lookup)
SmallVector< std::deque< PendingImplicitInstantiation >, 8 > SavedPendingInstantiations
Definition Sema.h:13963
void MarkVirtualBaseDestructorsReferenced(SourceLocation Location, CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl, llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl< const CXXRecordDecl * > *DirectVirtualBases=nullptr)
Mark destructors of virtual bases of this class referenced.
llvm::SmallSetVector< StringRef, 4 > MSFunctionNoBuiltins
Set of no-builtin functions listed by #pragma function.
Definition Sema.h:2127
ExprResult BuildExpressionTrait(ExpressionTrait OET, SourceLocation KWLoc, Expr *Queried, SourceLocation RParen)
void ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S)
bool isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E)
Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member access expression, of a form that could ...
bool CheckRegparmAttr(const ParsedAttr &attr, unsigned &value)
Checks a regparm attribute, returning true if it is ill-formed and otherwise setting numParams to the...
void DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const sema::LambdaScopeInfo *LSI)
Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record LambdaRD when these variables are capt...
static CastKind ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(QualType ScalarTy)
ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind - Returns the cast kind corresponding to the conversion from scalar type ...
Definition Sema.cpp:849
void PushUsingDirective(Scope *S, UsingDirectiveDecl *UDir)
RecordDecl * CreateCapturedStmtRecordDecl(CapturedDecl *&CD, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned NumParams)
bool isLibstdcxxEagerExceptionSpecHack(const Declarator &D)
Determine if we're in a case where we need to (incorrectly) eagerly parse an exception specification ...
void CheckConstructor(CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor)
CheckConstructor - Checks a fully-formed constructor for well-formedness, issuing any diagnostics req...
void DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(SourceLocation CurrentLoc, CXXConversionDecl *Conv)
Define the "body" of the conversion from a lambda object to a block pointer.
bool buildCoroutineParameterMoves(SourceLocation Loc)
void DefineImplicitDestructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation, CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor)
DefineImplicitDestructor - Checks for feasibility of defining this destructor as the default destruct...
void DiagnoseNontrivial(const CXXRecordDecl *Record, CXXSpecialMemberKind CSM)
Diagnose why the specified class does not have a trivial special member of the given kind.
ExprResult BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op)
llvm::SmallSetVector< Decl *, 4 > DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags
Function or variable declarations to be checked for whether the deferred diagnostics should be emitte...
Definition Sema.h:4745
Decl * ActOnUsingEnumDeclaration(Scope *CurScope, AccessSpecifier AS, SourceLocation UsingLoc, SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange TyLoc, const IdentifierInfo &II, ParsedType Ty, const CXXScopeSpec &SS)
DeclGroupPtrTy ActOnGlobalModuleFragmentDecl(SourceLocation ModuleLoc)
The parser has processed a global-module-fragment declaration that begins the definition of the globa...
bool CheckTemplateTypeArgument(TemplateTypeParmDecl *Param, TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg, SmallVectorImpl< TemplateArgument > &SugaredConverted, SmallVectorImpl< TemplateArgument > &CanonicalConverted)
void ActOnCapturedRegionStart(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *CurScope, CapturedRegionKind Kind, unsigned NumParams)
bool AreConstraintExpressionsEqual(const NamedDecl *Old, const Expr *OldConstr, const TemplateCompareNewDeclInfo &New, const Expr *NewConstr)
void CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD)
UnsignedOrNone getNumArgumentsInExpansion(QualType T, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
Determine the number of arguments in the given pack expansion type.
ReferenceConversionsScope::ReferenceConversions ReferenceConversions
Definition Sema.h:10402
FileNullabilityMap NullabilityMap
A mapping that describes the nullability we've seen in each header file.
Definition Sema.h:15003
ProcessingContextState ParsingClassState
Definition Sema.h:6537
void DiagnoseMisalignedMembers()
Diagnoses the current set of gathered accesses.
CXXRecordDecl * getCurrentClass(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec *SS)
Get the class that is directly named by the current context.
ExprResult BuildCXXUuidof(QualType TypeInfoType, SourceLocation TypeidLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Operand, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Build a Microsoft __uuidof expression with a type operand.
sema::FunctionScopeInfo * getCurFunction() const
Definition Sema.h:1314
void checkUnsafeExprAssigns(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS)
checkUnsafeExprAssigns - Check whether +1 expr is being assigned to weak/__unsafe_unretained expressi...
void PushCompoundScope(bool IsStmtExpr)
Definition Sema.cpp:2477
bool usesPartialOrExplicitSpecialization(SourceLocation Loc, ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *ClassTemplateSpec)
MemberPointerConversionResult CheckMemberPointerConversion(QualType FromType, const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType, CastKind &Kind, CXXCastPath &BasePath, SourceLocation CheckLoc, SourceRange OpRange, bool IgnoreBaseAccess, MemberPointerConversionDirection Direction)
CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the expression From to the ty...
bool EvaluateAsString(Expr *Message, APValue &Result, ASTContext &Ctx, StringEvaluationContext EvalContext, bool ErrorOnInvalidMessage)
DeclGroupPtrTy BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef< Decl * > Group)
BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration group, performing any necess...
FunctionDecl * CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type, unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc)
ExprResult ActOnEmbedExpr(SourceLocation EmbedKeywordLoc, StringLiteral *BinaryData, StringRef FileName)
Scope * getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S)
getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting from S, where a non-field would be dec...
Expr * BuildCXXThisExpr(SourceLocation Loc, QualType Type, bool IsImplicit)
Build a CXXThisExpr and mark it referenced in the current context.
bool isDeclaratorFunctionLike(Declarator &D)
Determine whether.
Definition Sema.cpp:2911
bool CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, bool AllowZero)
QualType BuildReferenceType(QualType T, bool LValueRef, SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity)
Build a reference type.
bool mightBeIntendedToBeTemplateName(ExprResult E, bool &Dependent)
Determine whether it's plausible that E was intended to be a template-name.
Definition Sema.h:3818
std::pair< const IdentifierInfo *, uint64_t > TypeTagMagicValue
A pair of ArgumentKind identifier and magic value.
Definition Sema.h:2665
void ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo *WeakName, SourceLocation PragmaLoc, SourceLocation WeakNameLoc)
ActOnPragmaWeakID - Called on well formed #pragma weak ident.
QualType BuiltinRemoveCVRef(QualType BaseType, SourceLocation Loc)
Definition Sema.h:15346
QualType CheckSizelessVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign, ArithConvKind OperationKind)
bool CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD)
void ProcessDeclAttributeDelayed(Decl *D, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList)
Helper for delayed processing TransparentUnion or BPFPreserveAccessIndexAttr attribute.
void DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, Expr *SrcExpr)
DiagnoseAssignmentEnum - Warn if assignment to enum is a constant integer not in the range of enum va...
llvm::DenseMap< const VarDecl *, int > RefsMinusAssignments
Increment when we find a reference; decrement when we find an ignored assignment.
Definition Sema.h:6946
ExprResult ActOnFinishTrailingRequiresClause(ExprResult ConstraintExpr)
void AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Decl *RD)
AddPushedVisibilityAttribute - If '#pragma GCC visibility' was used, add an appropriate visibility at...
bool checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(CXXMethodDecl *Method)
Check whether 'this' shows up in the attributes of the given static member function.
bool CheckExceptionSpecSubset(const PartialDiagnostic &DiagID, const PartialDiagnostic &NestedDiagID, const PartialDiagnostic &NoteID, const PartialDiagnostic &NoThrowDiagID, const FunctionProtoType *Superset, bool SkipSupersetFirstParameter, SourceLocation SuperLoc, const FunctionProtoType *Subset, bool SkipSubsetFirstParameter, SourceLocation SubLoc)
CheckExceptionSpecSubset - Check whether the second function type's exception specification is a subs...
ExplicitSpecifier instantiateExplicitSpecifier(const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, ExplicitSpecifier ES)
StmtResult ActOnEndOfDeferStmt(Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope)
ExprResult CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *input, bool RequiresADL=true)
Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded operator.
TemplateDeductionResult SubstituteExplicitTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, TemplateArgumentListInfo &ExplicitTemplateArgs, SmallVectorImpl< DeducedTemplateArgument > &Deduced, SmallVectorImpl< QualType > &ParamTypes, QualType *FunctionType, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info)
Substitute the explicitly-provided template arguments into the given function template according to C...
ExprResult ActOnCoawaitExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation KwLoc, Expr *E)
CXXBaseSpecifier * CheckBaseSpecifier(CXXRecordDecl *Class, SourceRange SpecifierRange, bool Virtual, AccessSpecifier Access, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
Check the validity of a C++ base class specifier.
bool findMacroSpelling(SourceLocation &loc, StringRef name)
Looks through the macro-expansion chain for the given location, looking for a macro expansion with th...
Definition Sema.cpp:2295
DeclResult CheckClassTemplate(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, const ParsedAttributesView &Attr, TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams, AccessSpecifier AS, SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, SourceLocation FriendLoc, unsigned NumOuterTemplateParamLists, TemplateParameterList **OuterTemplateParamLists, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody=nullptr)
QualType BuildMemberPointerType(QualType T, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, CXXRecordDecl *Cls, SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity)
Build a member pointer type T Class::*.
UnsignedOrNone getPackIndex(TemplateArgument Pack) const
Definition Sema.h:11747
ExprResult ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind OpKind, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Member, Decl *ObjCImpDecl)
The main callback when the parser finds something like expression .
ExprResult BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, LookupResult &R, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, bool IsDefiniteInstance, const Scope *S)
Builds an implicit member access expression.
UnparsedDefaultArgInstantiationsMap UnparsedDefaultArgInstantiations
A mapping from parameters with unparsed default arguments to the set of instantiations of each parame...
Definition Sema.h:13040
QualType DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, const InitializedEntity &Entity, const InitializationKind &Kind, MultiExprArg Init)
void DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(SourceLocation CurrentLocation, CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor)
DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor - Checks for feasibility of defining this constructor as the default...
bool checkUInt32Argument(const AttrInfo &AI, const Expr *Expr, uint32_t &Val, unsigned Idx=UINT_MAX, bool StrictlyUnsigned=false)
If Expr is a valid integer constant, get the value of the integer expression and return success or fa...
Definition Sema.h:4830
bool SubstParmTypes(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef< ParmVarDecl * > Params, const FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo *ExtParamInfos, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, SmallVectorImpl< QualType > &ParamTypes, SmallVectorImpl< ParmVarDecl * > *OutParams, ExtParameterInfoBuilder &ParamInfos)
Substitute the given template arguments into the given set of parameters, producing the set of parame...
void DiagnoseEmptyStmtBody(SourceLocation StmtLoc, const Stmt *Body, unsigned DiagID)
Emit DiagID if statement located on StmtLoc has a suspicious null statement as a Body,...
void AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool PartialOverloading=false)
Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument dependent lookup to the given ov...
bool CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous)
Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable declaration.
std::pair< CXXRecordDecl *, SourceLocation > VTableUse
The list of classes whose vtables have been used within this translation unit, and the source locatio...
Definition Sema.h:5838
DeclGroupPtrTy ActOnModuleDecl(SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceLocation ModuleLoc, ModuleDeclKind MDK, ModuleIdPath Path, ModuleIdPath Partition, ModuleImportState &ImportState, bool SeenNoTrivialPPDirective)
The parser has processed a module-declaration that begins the definition of a module interface or imp...
void MarkThisReferenced(CXXThisExpr *This)
void DiagnoseEmptyLoopBody(const Stmt *S, const Stmt *PossibleBody)
Warn if a for/while loop statement S, which is followed by PossibleBody, has a suspicious null statem...
ExprResult DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E)
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:639
MSInheritanceAttr * mergeMSInheritanceAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, bool BestCase, MSInheritanceModel Model)
bool CheckUsingShadowDecl(BaseUsingDecl *BUD, NamedDecl *Target, const LookupResult &PreviousDecls, UsingShadowDecl *&PrevShadow)
Determines whether to create a using shadow decl for a particular decl, given the set of decls existi...
ExprResult BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL, bool AcceptInvalidDecl=false)
SourceLocation getLocationOfStringLiteralByte(const StringLiteral *SL, unsigned ByteNo) const
bool isVisible(const NamedDecl *D)
Determine whether a declaration is visible to name lookup.
Definition Sema.h:15431
bool CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(QualType Derived, QualType Base, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range, CXXCastPath *BasePath=nullptr, bool IgnoreAccess=false)
bool isInLifetimeExtendingContext() const
Definition Sema.h:8173
StringLiteral * CurInitSeg
Last section used with pragma init_seg.
Definition Sema.h:2076
FunctionEmissionStatus getEmissionStatus(const FunctionDecl *Decl, bool Final=false)
Module * getCurrentModule() const
Get the module unit whose scope we are currently within.
Definition Sema.h:9843
AssignConvertType CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, ExprResult &RHS)
bool CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(Declarator &D, QualType &R, StorageClass &SC)
Check the validity of a declarator that we parsed for a deduction-guide.
bool AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD)
AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes, and if so,...
InternalLinkageAttr * mergeInternalLinkageAttr(Decl *D, const ParsedAttr &AL)
void maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult &E)
Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC.
static bool isCast(CheckedConversionKind CCK)
Definition Sema.h:2520
ExprResult ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, SourceLocation DefaultLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc, bool PredicateIsExpr, void *ControllingExprOrType, ArrayRef< ParsedType > ArgTypes, ArrayRef< Expr * > ArgExprs)
ControllingExprOrType is either an opaque pointer coming out of a ParsedType or an Expr *.
void DiagPlaceholderVariableDefinition(SourceLocation Loc)
void ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope)
ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback is invoked to pop the informati...
ExprResult prepareVectorSplat(QualType VectorTy, Expr *SplattedExpr)
Prepare SplattedExpr for a vector splat operation, adding implicit casts if necessary.
void NoteOverloadCandidate(const NamedDecl *Found, const FunctionDecl *Fn, OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind=OverloadCandidateRewriteKind(), QualType DestType=QualType(), bool TakingAddress=false)
void CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition=nullptr, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody=nullptr)
bool IsAssignConvertCompatible(AssignConvertType ConvTy)
Definition Sema.h:8040
bool hasReachableDefaultArgument(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
Determine if the template parameter D has a reachable default argument.
sema::BlockScopeInfo * getCurBlock()
Retrieve the current block, if any.
Definition Sema.cpp:2513
ParsedTemplateArgument ActOnTemplateTemplateArgument(const ParsedTemplateArgument &Arg)
Invoked when parsing a template argument.
bool DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType)
bool DiagnoseUseOfOverloadedDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc)
Definition Sema.h:6961
void ArgumentDependentLookup(DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, ADLResult &Functions)
void DiagnoseUniqueObjectDuplication(const VarDecl *Dcl)
std::unique_ptr< RecordDeclSetTy > PureVirtualClassDiagSet
PureVirtualClassDiagSet - a set of class declarations which we have emitted a list of pure virtual fu...
Definition Sema.h:6496
void CheckTCBEnforcement(const SourceLocation CallExprLoc, const NamedDecl *Callee)
Enforce the bounds of a TCB CheckTCBEnforcement - Enforces that every function in a named TCB only di...
void ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D)
FunctionDecl * resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &FoundResult)
Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to resolve that function to a single f...
DeclContext * CurContext
CurContext - This is the current declaration context of parsing.
Definition Sema.h:1414
auto getDefaultDiagFunc()
Definition Sema.h:2283
MaterializeTemporaryExpr * CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(QualType T, Expr *Temporary, bool BoundToLvalueReference)
VarDecl * BuildExceptionDeclaration(Scope *S, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceLocation IdLoc, const IdentifierInfo *Id)
Perform semantic analysis for the variable declaration that occurs within a C++ catch clause,...
bool checkArgCountAtLeast(CallExpr *Call, unsigned MinArgCount)
Checks that a call expression's argument count is at least the desired number.
bool FindAllocationFunctions(SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceRange Range, AllocationFunctionScope NewScope, AllocationFunctionScope DeleteScope, QualType AllocType, bool IsArray, ImplicitAllocationParameters &IAP, MultiExprArg PlaceArgs, FunctionDecl *&OperatorNew, FunctionDecl *&OperatorDelete, bool Diagnose=true)
Finds the overloads of operator new and delete that are appropriate for the allocation.
ExprResult checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType, Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind, ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path)
Check a cast of an unknown-any type.
MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList getTemplateInstantiationArgs(const NamedDecl *D, const DeclContext *DC=nullptr, bool Final=false, std::optional< ArrayRef< TemplateArgument > > Innermost=std::nullopt, bool RelativeToPrimary=false, const FunctionDecl *Pattern=nullptr, bool ForConstraintInstantiation=false, bool SkipForSpecialization=false, bool ForDefaultArgumentSubstitution=false)
Retrieve the template argument list(s) that should be used to instantiate the definition of the given...
ExprResult ActOnCXXNamedCast(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind, SourceLocation LAngleBracketLoc, Declarator &D, SourceLocation RAngleBracketLoc, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr *E, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
ActOnCXXNamedCast - Parse {dynamic,static,reinterpret,const,addrspace}_cast's.
Definition SemaCast.cpp:314
DeclGroupPtrTy ActOnPrivateModuleFragmentDecl(SourceLocation ModuleLoc, SourceLocation PrivateLoc)
The parser has processed a private-module-fragment declaration that begins the definition of the priv...
void ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D)
Should be called on all declarations that might have attached documentation comments.
SuppressedDiagnosticsMap SuppressedDiagnostics
Definition Sema.h:12502
ClassTemplateDecl * StdTypeIdentity
The C++ "std::type_identity" template, which is defined in <type_traits>.
Definition Sema.h:6515
SemaOpenCL & OpenCL()
Definition Sema.h:1496
void ActOnPragmaMSFunction(SourceLocation Loc, const llvm::SmallVectorImpl< StringRef > &NoBuiltins)
Call on well formed #pragma function.
DeclarationNameInfo GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name)
Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id.
std::deque< PendingImplicitInstantiation > PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations
The queue of implicit template instantiations that are required and must be performed within the curr...
Definition Sema.h:13972
TypeSourceInfo * RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TypeSourceInfo *T, SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Name)
Rebuilds a type within the context of the current instantiation.
void DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(const ConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction, SourceLocation Loc={}, bool First=true)
Emit diagnostics explaining why a constraint expression was deemed unsatisfied.
Decl * ActOnFriendTypeDecl(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
Handle a friend type declaration.
QualType BuiltinDecay(QualType BaseType, SourceLocation Loc)
void ActOnPragmaMSStruct(PragmaMSStructKind Kind)
ActOnPragmaMSStruct - Called on well formed #pragma ms_struct [on|off].
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:616
ExprResult ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc)
void CompleteMemberSpecialization(NamedDecl *Member, LookupResult &Previous)
bool isPreciseFPEnabled()
Are precise floating point semantics currently enabled?
Definition Sema.h:2207
ParmVarDecl * CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceLocation NameLoc, const IdentifierInfo *Name, QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, StorageClass SC)
IdentifierInfo * getNullabilityKeyword(NullabilityKind nullability)
Retrieve the keyword associated.
ExprResult PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From)
PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion of the expression From to bool (C+...
ExprResult ActOnPackIndexingExpr(Scope *S, Expr *PackExpression, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, SourceLocation LSquareLoc, Expr *IndexExpr, SourceLocation RSquareLoc)
void DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(SourceLocation CurrentLocation, CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl)
Defines an implicitly-declared copy assignment operator.
void ActOnPragmaMSInitSeg(SourceLocation PragmaLocation, StringLiteral *SegmentName)
Called on well-formed #pragma init_seg().
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:890
AccessResult CheckConstructorAccess(SourceLocation Loc, CXXConstructorDecl *D, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, const InitializedEntity &Entity, bool IsCopyBindingRefToTemp=false)
Checks access to a constructor.
static SourceRange getPrintable(TypeLoc TL)
Definition Sema.h:15019
bool DiagnoseConditionalForNull(const Expr *LHSExpr, const Expr *RHSExpr, SourceLocation QuestionLoc)
Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer constant and the other is not a p...
void ActOnStartOfDeferStmt(SourceLocation DeferLoc, Scope *CurScope)
bool CheckFunctionConstraints(const FunctionDecl *FD, ConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction, SourceLocation UsageLoc=SourceLocation(), bool ForOverloadResolution=false)
Check whether the given function decl's trailing requires clause is satisfied, if any.
bool SetDelegatingInitializer(CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, CXXCtorInitializer *Initializer)
ParsedType getDestructorTypeForDecltype(const DeclSpec &DS, ParsedType ObjectType)
FormatArgumentPassingKind
Definition Sema.h:2595
@ FAPK_Elsewhere
Definition Sema.h:2599
@ FAPK_Fixed
Definition Sema.h:2596
@ FAPK_Variadic
Definition Sema.h:2597
@ FAPK_VAList
Definition Sema.h:2598
void FillInlineAsmIdentifierInfo(Expr *Res, llvm::InlineAsmIdentifierInfo &Info)
bool IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation Loc, CXXRecordDecl *Derived, CXXRecordDecl *Base, CXXBasePaths &Paths)
Determine whether the type Derived is a C++ class that is derived from the type Base.
CXXMethodDecl * LookupMovingAssignment(CXXRecordDecl *Class, unsigned Quals, bool RValueThis, unsigned ThisQuals)
Look up the moving assignment operator for the given class.
void MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T)
Mark all of the declarations referenced within a particular AST node as referenced.
bool BuildCXXNestedNameSpecifier(Scope *S, NestedNameSpecInfo &IdInfo, bool EnteringContext, CXXScopeSpec &SS, NamedDecl *ScopeLookupResult, bool ErrorRecoveryLookup, bool *IsCorrectedToColon=nullptr, bool OnlyNamespace=false)
Build a new nested-name-specifier for "identifier::", as described by ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifier.
bool isUnevaluatedContext() const
Determines whether we are currently in a context that is not evaluated as per C++ [expr] p5.
Definition Sema.h:8165
ObjCMethodDecl * SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance, SmallVectorImpl< ObjCMethodDecl * > &Methods)
llvm::DenseMap< ParmVarDecl *, llvm::TinyPtrVector< ParmVarDecl * > > UnparsedDefaultArgInstantiationsMap
Definition Sema.h:13031
DeclContext * getFunctionLevelDeclContext(bool AllowLambda=false) const
If AllowLambda is true, treat lambda as function.
Definition Sema.cpp:1634
StmtResult ActOnCapScopeReturnStmt(SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetValExp, NamedReturnInfo &NRInfo, bool SupressSimplerImplicitMoves)
ActOnCapScopeReturnStmt - Utility routine to type-check return statements for capturing scopes.
FunctionDecl * ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, bool Complain=false, DeclAccessPair *Found=nullptr, TemplateSpecCandidateSet *FailedTSC=nullptr, bool ForTypeDeduction=false)
Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to resolve that overloaded function ex...
Stmt * MaybeCreateStmtWithCleanups(Stmt *SubStmt)
AccessResult CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(Expr *OvlExpr, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl)
bool CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(FunctionDecl *FnDecl)
CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration - Check whether the declaration of this literal operator function is ...
bool DefineUsedVTables()
Define all of the vtables that have been used in this translation unit and reference any virtual memb...
CXXMethodDecl * DeclareImplicitCopyAssignment(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl)
Declare the implicit copy assignment operator for the given class.
ExprResult ActOnCXXNew(SourceLocation StartLoc, bool UseGlobal, SourceLocation PlacementLParen, MultiExprArg PlacementArgs, SourceLocation PlacementRParen, SourceRange TypeIdParens, Declarator &D, Expr *Initializer)
Parsed a C++ 'new' expression (C++ 5.3.4).
CXXConstructorDecl * LookupMovingConstructor(CXXRecordDecl *Class, unsigned Quals)
Look up the moving constructor for the given class.
void checkIllFormedTrivialABIStruct(CXXRecordDecl &RD)
Check that the C++ class annoated with "trivial_abi" satisfies all the conditions that are needed for...
void CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc)
Warn if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers to a shadowing declaration.
TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name)
StmtResult ActOnCapturedRegionEnd(Stmt *S)
void notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New)
void MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E, const Expr *Base=nullptr)
Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr.
void applyFunctionAttributesBeforeParsingBody(Decl *FD)
ExprResult BuildCXXNoexceptExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, Expr *Operand, SourceLocation RParen)
bool CheckSpecializationInstantiationRedecl(SourceLocation NewLoc, TemplateSpecializationKind ActOnExplicitInstantiationNewTSK, NamedDecl *PrevDecl, TemplateSpecializationKind PrevTSK, SourceLocation PrevPtOfInstantiation, bool &SuppressNew)
Diagnose cases where we have an explicit template specialization before/after an explicit template in...
bool isAcceptable(const NamedDecl *D, AcceptableKind Kind)
Determine whether a declaration is acceptable (visible/reachable).
Definition Sema.h:15444
void RestoreNestedNameSpecifierAnnotation(void *Annotation, SourceRange AnnotationRange, CXXScopeSpec &SS)
Given an annotation pointer for a nested-name-specifier, restore the nested-name-specifier structure.
QualType getDecltypeForExpr(Expr *E)
getDecltypeForExpr - Given an expr, will return the decltype for that expression, according to the ru...
NamedDecl * DeclClonePragmaWeak(NamedDecl *ND, const IdentifierInfo *II, SourceLocation Loc)
DeclClonePragmaWeak - clone existing decl (maybe definition), #pragma weak needs a non-definition dec...
ExprResult BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, bool IsAddressOfOperand, TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI=nullptr)
BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified declaration name, generally during template...
DLLExportAttr * mergeDLLExportAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI)
CXXMethodDecl * LookupCopyingAssignment(CXXRecordDecl *Class, unsigned Quals, bool RValueThis, unsigned ThisQuals)
Look up the copying assignment operator for the given class.
bool CheckTypeConstraint(TemplateIdAnnotation *TypeConstraint)
std::pair< const NamedDecl *, llvm::FoldingSetNodeID > SatisfactionStackEntryTy
Definition Sema.h:14783
StmtResult ActOnForStmt(SourceLocation ForLoc, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Stmt *First, ConditionResult Second, FullExprArg Third, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Stmt *Body)
void CleanupMergedEnum(Scope *S, Decl *New)
CleanupMergedEnum - We have just merged the decl 'New' by making another definition visible.
StmtResult ActOnIndirectGotoStmt(SourceLocation GotoLoc, SourceLocation StarLoc, Expr *DestExp)
bool GlobalNewDeleteDeclared
A flag to remember whether the implicit forms of operator new and delete have been declared.
Definition Sema.h:8361
TemplateNameKind ActOnTemplateName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, const UnqualifiedId &Name, ParsedType ObjectType, bool EnteringContext, TemplateTy &Template, bool AllowInjectedClassName=false)
Form a template name from a name that is syntactically required to name a template,...
ExprResult ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E)
ExprResult ActOnSourceLocExpr(SourceLocIdentKind Kind, SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation RPLoc)
DeclContext * OriginalLexicalContext
Generally null except when we temporarily switch decl contexts, like in.
Definition Sema.h:3563
llvm::PointerIntPair< ConstantExpr *, 1 > ImmediateInvocationCandidate
Definition Sema.h:6748
bool MSStructPragmaOn
Definition Sema.h:1800
ExprResult CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E)
Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
bool hasVisibleDefinition(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested, bool OnlyNeedComplete=false)
Determine if D has a visible definition.
ExprResult TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E)
CodeSegAttr * mergeCodeSegAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, StringRef Name)
void deduceHLSLAddressSpace(VarDecl *decl)
unsigned ActOnReenterTemplateScope(Decl *Template, llvm::function_ref< Scope *()> EnterScope)
EnableIfAttr * CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, SourceLocation CallLoc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, bool MissingImplicitThis=false)
Check the enable_if expressions on the given function.
SectionAttr * mergeSectionAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, StringRef Name)
ExprResult BuildCXXConstructExpr(SourceLocation ConstructLoc, QualType DeclInitType, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, MultiExprArg Exprs, bool HadMultipleCandidates, bool IsListInitialization, bool IsStdInitListInitialization, bool RequiresZeroInit, CXXConstructionKind ConstructKind, SourceRange ParenRange)
BuildCXXConstructExpr - Creates a complete call to a constructor, including handling of its default a...
unsigned NonInstantiationEntries
The number of CodeSynthesisContexts that are not template instantiations and, therefore,...
Definition Sema.h:13576
bool canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D)
Determine whether we can skip parsing the body of a function definition, assuming we don't care about...
bool canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD, QualType NewT, QualType OldT)
Determines if we can perform a correct type check for D as a redeclaration of PrevDecl.
ExprResult CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc, DeclarationNameInfo DNI, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, bool PerformADL=true)
bool inTemplateInstantiation() const
Determine whether we are currently performing template instantiation.
Definition Sema.h:13907
bool RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, unsigned DiagID)
Definition Sema.h:15419
SourceManager & getSourceManager() const
Definition Sema.h:924
void BuildModuleInclude(SourceLocation DirectiveLoc, Module *Mod)
QualType BuiltinAddReference(QualType BaseType, UTTKind UKind, SourceLocation Loc)
void ActOnCleanupAttr(Decl *D, const Attr *A)
QualType CXXThisTypeOverride
When non-NULL, the C++ 'this' expression is allowed despite the current context not being a non-stati...
Definition Sema.h:8432
FunctionDecl * SubstSpaceshipAsEqualEqual(CXXRecordDecl *RD, FunctionDecl *Spaceship)
Substitute the name and return type of a defaulted 'operator<=>' to form an implicit 'operator=='.
static FormatStringType GetFormatStringType(StringRef FormatFlavor)
CallingConventionIgnoredReason
Describes the reason a calling convention specification was ignored, used for diagnostics.
Definition Sema.h:4808
NamedDecl * ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists)
ExprResult BuildAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, QualType DestTy, SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Create a new AsTypeExpr node (bitcast) from the arguments.
bool CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E)
bool makeUnavailableInSystemHeader(SourceLocation loc, UnavailableAttr::ImplicitReason reason)
makeUnavailableInSystemHeader - There is an error in the current context.
Definition Sema.cpp:630
bool isModuleVisible(const Module *M, bool ModulePrivate=false)
void AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType, Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversion=false, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO={})
AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of method) as a method candidate to the gi...
llvm::DenseMap< const EnumDecl *, llvm::APInt > FlagBitsCache
A cache of the flags available in enumerations with the flag_bits attribute.
Definition Sema.h:3516
bool checkTargetAttr(SourceLocation LiteralLoc, StringRef Str)
ExprResult BuildFieldReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, FieldDecl *Field, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo)
bool CheckRebuiltStmtAttributes(ArrayRef< const Attr * > Attrs)
void diagnoseExprIntendedAsTemplateName(Scope *S, ExprResult TemplateName, SourceLocation Less, SourceLocation Greater)
bool MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld)
Completes the merge of two function declarations that are known to be compatible.
bool hasVisibleMergedDefinition(const NamedDecl *Def)
void diagnoseFunctionEffectMergeConflicts(const FunctionEffectSet::Conflicts &Errs, SourceLocation NewLoc, SourceLocation OldLoc)
void getUndefinedButUsed(SmallVectorImpl< std::pair< NamedDecl *, SourceLocation > > &Undefined)
Obtain a sorted list of functions that are undefined but ODR-used.
Definition Sema.cpp:946
void ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange, Decl *EnumDecl, ArrayRef< Decl * > Elements, Scope *S, const ParsedAttributesView &Attr)
void DeclareImplicitDeductionGuides(TemplateDecl *Template, SourceLocation Loc)
Declare implicit deduction guides for a class template if we've not already done so.
void diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef< const NamedDecl * > Equiv)
void EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC)
EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context of a declarator's nested name ...
void diagnoseFunctionEffectConversion(QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, SourceLocation Loc)
Warn when implicitly changing function effects.
Definition Sema.cpp:696
ClassTemplateDecl * lookupCoroutineTraits(SourceLocation KwLoc, SourceLocation FuncLoc)
Lookup 'coroutine_traits' in std namespace and std::experimental namespace.
bool CheckNoInlineAttr(const Stmt *OrigSt, const Stmt *CurSt, const AttributeCommonInfo &A)
ExprResult FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, FunctionDecl *Fn)
FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to a C++ overloaded function (possibl...
bool TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(TemplateParameterList *New, TemplateParameterList *Old, bool Complain, TemplateParameterListEqualKind Kind, SourceLocation TemplateArgLoc=SourceLocation())
Definition Sema.h:12226
void PerformPendingInstantiations(bool LocalOnly=false, bool AtEndOfTU=true)
Performs template instantiation for all implicit template instantiations we have seen until this poin...
bool areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible(const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD, const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID, const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt, const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt, const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported, bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer)
Checks if the variant/multiversion functions are compatible.
ExprResult PerformMoveOrCopyInitialization(const InitializedEntity &Entity, const NamedReturnInfo &NRInfo, Expr *Value, bool SupressSimplerImplicitMoves=false)
Perform the initialization of a potentially-movable value, which is the result of return value.
bool CheckExplicitlyDefaultedComparison(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *MD, DefaultedComparisonKind DCK)
bool checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionExceptionSpec(CXXMethodDecl *Method)
Whether this' shows up in the exception specification of a static member function.
void ActOnFinishCXXInClassMemberInitializer(Decl *VarDecl, SourceLocation EqualLoc, ExprResult Init)
This is invoked after parsing an in-class initializer for a non-static C++ class member,...
ExprResult ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc, SourceLocation ColonLoc, Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr)
ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?
QualType CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that operates on extended vecto...
ExprResult ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType, bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs)
void ActOnLambdaExplicitTemplateParameterList(LambdaIntroducer &Intro, SourceLocation LAngleLoc, ArrayRef< NamedDecl * > TParams, SourceLocation RAngleLoc, ExprResult RequiresClause)
This is called after parsing the explicit template parameter list on a lambda (if it exists) in C++2a...
void PrintPragmaAttributeInstantiationPoint()
Definition Sema.h:2295
ExprResult CheckCXXBooleanCondition(Expr *CondExpr, bool IsConstexpr=false)
CheckCXXBooleanCondition - Returns true if conversion to bool is invalid.
llvm::FoldingSet< SpecialMemberOverloadResultEntry > SpecialMemberCache
A cache of special member function overload resolution results for C++ records.
Definition Sema.h:9303
ExprResult CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Expr *E)
QualType BuildPackIndexingType(QualType Pattern, Expr *IndexExpr, SourceLocation Loc, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool FullySubstituted=false, ArrayRef< QualType > Expansions={})
QualType CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, QualType CompoundType, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
void DiagnoseNonDefaultPragmaAlignPack(PragmaAlignPackDiagnoseKind Kind, SourceLocation IncludeLoc)
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:550
Decl * ActOnStartLinkageSpecification(Scope *S, SourceLocation ExternLoc, Expr *LangStr, SourceLocation LBraceLoc)
ActOnStartLinkageSpecification - Parsed the beginning of a C++ linkage specification,...
bool ActOnCXXNestedNameSpecifierIndexedPack(CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclSpec &DS, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc, QualType Type)
void ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagDecl)
ActOnTagStartDefinition - Invoked when we have entered the scope of a tag's definition (e....
bool checkArgCountRange(CallExpr *Call, unsigned MinArgCount, unsigned MaxArgCount)
Checks that a call expression's argument count is in the desired range.
void FilterUsingLookup(Scope *S, LookupResult &lookup)
Remove decls we can't actually see from a lookup being used to declare shadow using decls.
bool inConstraintSubstitution() const
Determine whether we are currently performing constraint substitution.
Definition Sema.h:13912
CanThrowResult canThrow(const Stmt *E)
Decl * SubstDecl(Decl *D, DeclContext *Owner, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
bool isThisOutsideMemberFunctionBody(QualType BaseType)
Determine whether the given type is the type of *this that is used outside of the body of a member fu...
bool ValidateFormatString(FormatStringType FST, const StringLiteral *Str)
Verify that one format string (as understood by attribute(format)) is self-consistent; for instance,...
Decl * ActOnExceptionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D)
ActOnExceptionDeclarator - Parsed the exception-declarator in a C++ catch handler.
bool CheckAlwaysInlineAttr(const Stmt *OrigSt, const Stmt *CurSt, const AttributeCommonInfo &A)
void DiscardMisalignedMemberAddress(const Type *T, Expr *E)
This function checks if the expression is in the sef of potentially misaligned members and it is conv...
StringEvaluationContext
Definition Sema.h:5958
ExprResult BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, LookupResult &R, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, const Scope *S)
Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
DeclContext * computeDeclContext(QualType T)
Compute the DeclContext that is associated with the given type.
bool LookupInlineAsmField(StringRef Base, StringRef Member, unsigned &Offset, SourceLocation AsmLoc)
PragmaClangSection PragmaClangTextSection
Definition Sema.h:1815
bool resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConversion=false)
Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded function reference using resolve...
void DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef< SourceLocation > Locs, const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, bool ObjCPropertyAccess, bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks, ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReceiver)
CallExpr::ADLCallKind ADLCallKind
Definition Sema.h:7459
bool BoundsSafetyCheckInitialization(const InitializedEntity &Entity, const InitializationKind &Kind, AssignmentAction Action, QualType LHSType, Expr *RHSExpr)
Perform Bounds Safety Semantic checks for initializing a Bounds Safety pointer.
LabelDecl * LookupOrCreateLabel(IdentifierInfo *II, SourceLocation IdentLoc, SourceLocation GnuLabelLoc=SourceLocation())
LookupOrCreateLabel - Do a name lookup of a label with the specified name.
NonTrivialCUnionKind
Definition Sema.h:4069
@ NTCUK_Destruct
Definition Sema.h:4071
@ NTCUK_Init
Definition Sema.h:4070
@ NTCUK_Copy
Definition Sema.h:4072
QualType CheckNonTypeTemplateParameterType(TypeSourceInfo *&TSI, SourceLocation Loc)
Check that the type of a non-type template parameter is well-formed.
bool PrepareBuiltinElementwiseMathOneArgCall(CallExpr *TheCall, EltwiseBuiltinArgTyRestriction ArgTyRestr=EltwiseBuiltinArgTyRestriction::None)
QualType CheckPointerToMemberOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK, SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isIndirect)
DelayedDiagnosticsState ProcessingContextState
Definition Sema.h:1351
void CheckLookupAccess(const LookupResult &R)
Checks access to all the declarations in the given result set.
concepts::ExprRequirement * BuildExprRequirement(Expr *E, bool IsSatisfied, SourceLocation NoexceptLoc, concepts::ExprRequirement::ReturnTypeRequirement ReturnTypeRequirement)
void ActOnPragmaFPValueChangingOption(SourceLocation Loc, PragmaFPKind Kind, bool IsEnabled)
Called on well formed #pragma clang fp reassociate or #pragma clang fp reciprocal.
QualType BuildAtomicType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc)
std::vector< std::pair< QualType, unsigned > > ExcessPrecisionNotSatisfied
Definition Sema.h:8318
PragmaClangSection PragmaClangDataSection
Definition Sema.h:1812
bool DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement, const PartialDiagnostic &PD)
Conditionally issue a diagnostic based on the current evaluation context.
ExprResult BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param, Expr *Init=nullptr)
BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr - Creates a CXXDefaultArgExpr, instantiating the default expr if needed.
llvm::Error isValidSectionSpecifier(StringRef Str)
Used to implement to perform semantic checking on attribute((section("foo"))) specifiers.
void diagnoseMissingImport(SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *Decl, MissingImportKind MIK, bool Recover=true)
Diagnose that the specified declaration needs to be visible but isn't, and suggest a module import th...
bool AttachTypeConstraint(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NS, DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo, TemplateDecl *NamedConcept, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, TemplateTypeParmDecl *ConstrainedParameter, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
Attach a type-constraint to a template parameter.
ParsedType actOnLambdaInitCaptureInitialization(SourceLocation Loc, bool ByRef, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, LambdaCaptureInitKind InitKind, Expr *&Init)
Perform initialization analysis of the init-capture and perform any implicit conversions such as an l...
Definition Sema.h:9098
TemplateArgumentLoc SubstDefaultTemplateArgumentIfAvailable(TemplateDecl *Template, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc, SourceLocation RAngleLoc, Decl *Param, ArrayRef< TemplateArgument > SugaredConverted, ArrayRef< TemplateArgument > CanonicalConverted, bool &HasDefaultArg)
If the given template parameter has a default template argument, substitute into that default templat...
void ActOnInitializerError(Decl *Dcl)
ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an initializer for the given declaratio...
bool anyAltivecTypes(QualType srcType, QualType destType)
void FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(LookupResult &R, bool AllowFunctionTemplates=true, bool AllowDependent=true)
TypeSourceInfo * SubstAutoTypeSourceInfoDependent(TypeSourceInfo *TypeWithAuto)
bool isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcType, QualType destType)
Is this a legal conversion between two types, one of which is known to be a vector type?
void PushNamespaceVisibilityAttr(const VisibilityAttr *Attr, SourceLocation Loc)
PushNamespaceVisibilityAttr - Note that we've entered a namespace with a visibility attribute.
ExprResult LookupInlineAsmVarDeclField(Expr *RefExpr, StringRef Member, SourceLocation AsmLoc)
std::pair< AvailabilityResult, const NamedDecl * > ShouldDiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(const NamedDecl *D, std::string *Message, ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReceiver)
The diagnostic we should emit for D, and the declaration that originated it, or AR_Available.
ExprResult ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc)
Act on the result of classifying a name as an undeclared (ADL-only) non-type declaration.
StmtResult ActOnCXXForRangeStmt(Scope *S, SourceLocation ForLoc, SourceLocation CoawaitLoc, Stmt *InitStmt, Stmt *LoopVar, SourceLocation ColonLoc, Expr *Collection, SourceLocation RParenLoc, BuildForRangeKind Kind, ArrayRef< MaterializeTemporaryExpr * > LifetimeExtendTemps={})
ActOnCXXForRangeStmt - Check and build a C++11 for-range statement.
void PushBlockScope(Scope *BlockScope, BlockDecl *Block)
Definition Sema.cpp:2343
bool diagnoseConflictingFunctionEffect(const FunctionEffectsRef &FX, const FunctionEffectWithCondition &EC, SourceLocation NewAttrLoc)
Warn and return true if adding a function effect to a set would create a conflict.
sema::FunctionScopeInfo * getCurFunctionAvailabilityContext()
Retrieve the current function, if any, that should be analyzed for potential availability violations.
void ActOnDefaultCtorInitializers(Decl *CDtorDecl)
void ActOnMemInitializers(Decl *ConstructorDecl, SourceLocation ColonLoc, ArrayRef< CXXCtorInitializer * > MemInits, bool AnyErrors)
ActOnMemInitializers - Handle the member initializers for a constructor.
ExprResult BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, SourceLocation LParenLoc, MultiExprArg Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *ExecConfig, bool AllowTypoCorrection=true, bool CalleesAddressIsTaken=false)
BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn (which eventually refers to the dec...
void ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo *WeakName, IdentifierInfo *AliasName, SourceLocation PragmaLoc, SourceLocation WeakNameLoc, SourceLocation AliasNameLoc)
ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname - Called on well formed #pragma redefine_extname oldname newname.
bool CheckTemplateDeclScope(Scope *S, TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams)
Check whether a template can be declared within this scope.
PragmaStack< MSVtorDispMode > VtorDispStack
Whether to insert vtordisps prior to virtual bases in the Microsoft C++ ABI.
Definition Sema.h:2025
TypeSourceInfo * ReplaceAutoTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TypeWithAuto, QualType Replacement)
void AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RecordDecl *RD)
AddMsStructLayoutForRecord - Adds ms_struct layout attribute to record.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:90
QualType CXXCheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &cond, ExprResult &lhs, ExprResult &rhs, ExprValueKind &VK, ExprObjectKind &OK, SourceLocation questionLoc)
Check the operands of ?
ExprResult BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation nameLoc, IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl=DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none), Expr *baseObjectExpr=nullptr, SourceLocation opLoc=SourceLocation())
TypeResult ActOnTypeName(Declarator &D)
TemplateParameterList * SubstTemplateParams(TemplateParameterList *Params, DeclContext *Owner, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, bool EvaluateConstraints=true)
MaybeODRUseExprSet MaybeODRUseExprs
Definition Sema.h:6746
void ActOnLambdaClosureQualifiers(LambdaIntroducer &Intro, SourceLocation MutableLoc)
ExternalSemaSource * getExternalSource() const
Definition Sema.h:929
ExprResult PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, AssignmentAction Action, CheckedConversionKind CCK=CheckedConversionKind::Implicit)
PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the expression From to the type ToType ...
void ActOnCXXEnterDeclInitializer(Scope *S, Decl *Dcl)
ActOnCXXEnterDeclInitializer - Invoked when we are about to parse an initializer for the declaration ...
unsigned FunctionScopesStart
The index of the first FunctionScope that corresponds to the current context.
Definition Sema.h:1227
void * VisContext
VisContext - Manages the stack for #pragma GCC visibility.
Definition Sema.h:2083
SourceLocation getTopMostPointOfInstantiation(const NamedDecl *) const
Returns the top most location responsible for the definition of N.
bool isSFINAEContext() const
Definition Sema.h:13642
FunctionDecl * BuildTypeAwareUsualDelete(FunctionTemplateDecl *FnDecl, QualType AllocType, SourceLocation)
QualType FindCompositePointerType(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &E1, ExprResult &E2, bool ConvertArgs=true)
Definition Sema.h:8783
bool InstantiateInClassInitializer(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, FieldDecl *Instantiation, FieldDecl *Pattern, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
Instantiate the definition of a field from the given pattern.
void ActOnLambdaError(SourceLocation StartLoc, Scope *CurScope, bool IsInstantiation=false)
ActOnLambdaError - If there is an error parsing a lambda, this callback is invoked to pop the informa...
bool DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef< SourceLocation > Locs, const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass=nullptr, bool ObjCPropertyAccess=false, bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks=false, ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReciever=nullptr, bool SkipTrailingRequiresClause=false)
Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and emit any corresponding diagnostics.
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:224
static SourceRange getPrintable(SourceRange R)
Definition Sema.h:15016
void AddLaunchBoundsAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *MaxThreads, Expr *MinBlocks, Expr *MaxBlocks)
AddLaunchBoundsAttr - Adds a launch_bounds attribute to a particular declaration.
bool CheckParmsForFunctionDef(ArrayRef< ParmVarDecl * > Parameters, bool CheckParameterNames)
CheckParmsForFunctionDef - Check that the parameters of the given function are appropriate for the de...
void ActOnFinishCXXMemberSpecification(Scope *S, SourceLocation RLoc, Decl *TagDecl, SourceLocation LBrac, SourceLocation RBrac, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList)
TopLevelStmtDecl * ActOnStartTopLevelStmtDecl(Scope *S)
concepts::Requirement * ActOnTypeRequirement(SourceLocation TypenameKWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation NameLoc, const IdentifierInfo *TypeName, TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId)
void CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl, const LookupResult &R)
Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing.
UnsignedOrNone ArgPackSubstIndex
The current index into pack expansion arguments that will be used for substitution of parameter packs...
Definition Sema.h:13600
ParsedTemplateArgument ActOnPackExpansion(const ParsedTemplateArgument &Arg, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
Invoked when parsing a template argument followed by an ellipsis, which creates a pack expansion.
void ActOnUndeclaredTypeTemplateName(Scope *S, TemplateTy &Name, TemplateNameKind &TNK, SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *&II)
Try to resolve an undeclared template name as a type template.
ParsedType getInheritingConstructorName(CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation NameLoc, const IdentifierInfo &Name)
Handle the result of the special case name lookup for inheriting constructor declarations.
ExprResult BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Object, SourceLocation LParenLoc, MultiExprArg Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class type (C++ [over....
void AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor)
Build an exception spec for destructors that don't have one.
Decl * ActOnStaticAssertDeclaration(SourceLocation StaticAssertLoc, Expr *AssertExpr, Expr *AssertMessageExpr, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
ExprResult ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef< Token > StringToks, Scope *UDLScope=nullptr)
ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string fragments (e....
bool CheckMemberSpecialization(NamedDecl *Member, LookupResult &Previous)
Perform semantic analysis for the given non-template member specialization.
void DiagnoseUnknownAttribute(const ParsedAttr &AL)
void PushSatisfactionStackEntry(const NamedDecl *D, const llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID)
Definition Sema.h:14768
TypeResult ActOnTypenameType(Scope *S, SourceLocation TypenameLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation IdLoc, ImplicitTypenameContext IsImplicitTypename=ImplicitTypenameContext::No)
Called when the parser has parsed a C++ typename specifier, e.g., "typename T::type".
StmtResult BuildReturnStmt(SourceLocation ReturnLoc, Expr *RetValExp, bool AllowRecovery=false)
bool isCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, CompleteTypeKind Kind=CompleteTypeKind::Default)
Definition Sema.h:15386
SemaDiagnosticBuilder targetDiag(SourceLocation Loc, const PartialDiagnostic &PD, const FunctionDecl *FD=nullptr)
Definition Sema.h:1130
ExprResult ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr)
Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
void PushCapturedRegionScope(Scope *RegionScope, CapturedDecl *CD, RecordDecl *RD, CapturedRegionKind K, unsigned OpenMPCaptureLevel=0)
Definition Sema.cpp:2873
bool InstantiateClass(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, CXXRecordDecl *Instantiation, CXXRecordDecl *Pattern, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, TemplateSpecializationKind TSK, bool Complain=true)
Instantiate the definition of a class from a given pattern.
OptimizeNoneAttr * mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI)
bool CheckImmediateEscalatingFunctionDefinition(FunctionDecl *FD, const sema::FunctionScopeInfo *FSI)
void emitDeferredDiags()
Definition Sema.cpp:2014
void setFunctionHasMustTail()
Definition Sema.cpp:2508
ExprResult BuildPseudoDestructorExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind OpKind, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, TypeSourceInfo *ScopeType, SourceLocation CCLoc, SourceLocation TildeLoc, PseudoDestructorTypeStorage DestroyedType)
void checkUnusedDeclAttributes(Declarator &D)
checkUnusedDeclAttributes - Given a declarator which is not being used to build a declaration,...
bool hasReachableMemberSpecialization(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
Determine if there is a reachable declaration of D that is a member specialization declaration (as op...
ExprResult CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind)
RecordDecl * CXXTypeInfoDecl
The C++ "type_info" declaration, which is defined in <typeinfo>.
Definition Sema.h:8357
void InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor)
In the MS ABI, we need to instantiate default arguments of dllexported default constructors along wit...
bool DiagnoseUnusedLambdaCapture(SourceRange CaptureRange, SourceRange FixItRange, const sema::Capture &From)
Diagnose if an explicit lambda capture is unused.
void CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *VD)
bool CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(const InitializedEntity &Entity, InitListExpr *From)
Determine whether we can perform aggregate initialization for the purposes of overload resolution.
ExprResult ActOnRequiresClause(ExprResult ConstraintExpr)
bool IsOverride(FunctionDecl *MD, FunctionDecl *BaseMD, bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs=true)
QualType CheckTemplateIdType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword, TemplateName Template, SourceLocation TemplateLoc, TemplateArgumentListInfo &TemplateArgs, Scope *Scope, bool ForNestedNameSpecifier)
void PopSatisfactionStackEntry()
Definition Sema.h:14774
void checkClassLevelCodeSegAttribute(CXXRecordDecl *Class)
QualType BuildPointerType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity)
Build a pointer type.
bool isStdInitializerList(QualType Ty, QualType *Element)
Tests whether Ty is an instance of std::initializer_list and, if it is and Element is not NULL,...
DeclGroupPtrTy FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS, ArrayRef< Decl * > Group)
void setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope()
Definition Sema.cpp:2498
RedeclarationKind forRedeclarationInCurContext() const
bool hasReachableDefinition(NamedDecl *D)
Definition Sema.h:15475
void MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous)
MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and scope as a previous declar...
bool isConstantEvaluatedContext() const
Definition Sema.h:2587
bool CheckAttrTarget(const ParsedAttr &CurrAttr)
LazyDeclPtr StdNamespace
The C++ "std" namespace, where the standard library resides.
Definition Sema.h:6507
QualType buildLambdaInitCaptureInitialization(SourceLocation Loc, bool ByRef, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions, IdentifierInfo *Id, bool DirectInit, Expr *&Init)
StmtResult ActOnFinishSEHFinallyBlock(SourceLocation Loc, Stmt *Block)
bool SubstTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgumentLoc &Input, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, TemplateArgumentLoc &Output, SourceLocation Loc={}, const DeclarationName &Entity={})
ParsedType ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, bool IsTemplateTypeArg)
Attempt to behave like MSVC in situations where lookup of an unqualified type name has failed in a de...
Definition SemaDecl.cpp:627
void InstantiateFunctionDefinition(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, FunctionDecl *Function, bool Recursive=false, bool DefinitionRequired=false, bool AtEndOfTU=false)
Instantiate the definition of the given function from its template.
bool CheckUsingDeclRedeclaration(SourceLocation UsingLoc, bool HasTypenameKeyword, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation NameLoc, const LookupResult &Previous)
Checks that the given using declaration is not an invalid redeclaration.
bool SubstDefaultArgument(SourceLocation Loc, ParmVarDecl *Param, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, bool ForCallExpr=false)
Substitute the given template arguments into the default argument.
QualType BuiltinAddPointer(QualType BaseType, SourceLocation Loc)
EnforceTCBLeafAttr * mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(Decl *D, const EnforceTCBLeafAttr &AL)
bool BuiltinElementwiseTernaryMath(CallExpr *TheCall, EltwiseBuiltinArgTyRestriction ArgTyRestr=EltwiseBuiltinArgTyRestriction::FloatTy)
void ActOnStartOfTranslationUnit()
This is called before the very first declaration in the translation unit is parsed.
Definition Sema.cpp:1165
StmtResult BuildCXXForRangeStmt(SourceLocation ForLoc, SourceLocation CoawaitLoc, Stmt *InitStmt, SourceLocation ColonLoc, Stmt *RangeDecl, Stmt *Begin, Stmt *End, Expr *Cond, Expr *Inc, Stmt *LoopVarDecl, SourceLocation RParenLoc, BuildForRangeKind Kind, ArrayRef< MaterializeTemporaryExpr * > LifetimeExtendTemps={})
BuildCXXForRangeStmt - Build or instantiate a C++11 for-range statement.
friend class Parser
Definition Sema.h:1555
ExprResult ActOnCXXAssumeAttr(Stmt *St, const ParsedAttr &A, SourceRange Range)
StmtResult ActOnDoStmt(SourceLocation DoLoc, Stmt *Body, SourceLocation WhileLoc, SourceLocation CondLParen, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation CondRParen)
CXXConstructorDecl * LookupCopyingConstructor(CXXRecordDecl *Class, unsigned Quals)
Look up the copying constructor for the given class.
void ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclStart, SmallVectorImpl< Decl * > &AllIvarDecls)
ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for class and class extensions.
void InstantiateAttrsForDecl(const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, const Decl *Pattern, Decl *Inst, LateInstantiatedAttrVec *LateAttrs=nullptr, LocalInstantiationScope *OuterMostScope=nullptr)
std::pair< StringRef, QualType > CapturedParamNameType
Definition Sema.h:11210
void FinalizeVarWithDestructor(VarDecl *VD, CXXRecordDecl *DeclInit)
FinalizeVarWithDestructor - Prepare for calling destructor on the constructed variable.
StmtResult ActOnStartOfSwitchStmt(SourceLocation SwitchLoc, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Stmt *InitStmt, ConditionResult Cond, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
void ApplyNullability(Decl *D, NullabilityKind Nullability)
Apply the 'Nullability:' annotation to the specified declaration.
void MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D)
If it's a file scoped decl that must warn if not used, keep track of it.
llvm::DenseMap< IdentifierInfo *, AsmLabelAttr * > ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers
ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers - Identifiers contained in #pragma redefine_extname before declared.
Definition Sema.h:3537
ExprResult VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result, VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser, AllowFoldKind CanFold=AllowFoldKind::No)
VerifyIntegerConstantExpression - Verifies that an expression is an ICE, and reports the appropriate ...
ParsedType getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS=nullptr, bool isClassName=false, bool HasTrailingDot=false, ParsedType ObjectType=nullptr, bool IsCtorOrDtorName=false, bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=false, bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext=true, ImplicitTypenameContext AllowImplicitTypename=ImplicitTypenameContext::No, IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII=nullptr)
If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope, return the declaration of that type.
Definition SemaDecl.cpp:274
ExprResult SubstConstraintExpr(Expr *E, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
EnumConstantDecl * CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum, EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst, SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id, Expr *val)
IntrusiveRefCntPtr< ExternalSemaSource > ExternalSource
Source of additional semantic information.
Definition Sema.h:1552
DeclResult ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization(Scope *S, Declarator &D, TypeSourceInfo *TSI, LookupResult &Previous, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams, StorageClass SC, bool IsPartialSpecialization)
bool CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, unsigned DiagID=diag::err_init_element_not_constant)
type checking declaration initializers (C99 6.7.8)
ASTConsumer & Consumer
Definition Sema.h:1284
bool handlerCanCatch(QualType HandlerType, QualType ExceptionType)
RequiresExprBodyDecl * ActOnStartRequiresExpr(SourceLocation RequiresKWLoc, ArrayRef< ParmVarDecl * > LocalParameters, Scope *BodyScope)
void AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs=nullptr, bool SuppressUserConversions=false, bool PartialOverloading=false, bool FirstArgumentIsBase=false)
Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to the overload candidate set.
ExprResult BuildQualifiedTemplateIdExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, bool IsAddressOfOperand)
void ActOnFinishCXXMemberDecls()
Perform any semantic analysis which needs to be delayed until all pending class member declarations h...
llvm::SmallPtrSet< const Decl *, 4 > ParsingInitForAutoVars
ParsingInitForAutoVars - a set of declarations with auto types for which we are currently parsing the...
Definition Sema.h:4631
bool checkArgCount(CallExpr *Call, unsigned DesiredArgCount)
Checks that a call expression's argument count is the desired number.
PragmaAlignPackDiagnoseKind
Definition Sema.h:2185
bool CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, CastKind &Kind, CXXCastPath &BasePath, bool IgnoreBaseAccess, bool Diagnose=true)
CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the expression From to the type ToType.
SmallVector< ExprWithCleanups::CleanupObject, 8 > ExprCleanupObjects
ExprCleanupObjects - This is the stack of objects requiring cleanup that are created by the current f...
Definition Sema.h:6953
void NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *FD)
Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted.
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:123
void DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D)
sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings AnalysisWarnings
Worker object for performing CFG-based warnings.
Definition Sema.h:1319
bool CheckTemplateTemplateArgument(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param, TemplateParameterList *Params, TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg, bool PartialOrdering, bool *StrictPackMatch)
Check a template argument against its corresponding template template parameter.
bool hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() const
Whether uncompilable error has occurred.
Definition Sema.cpp:1780
std::deque< PendingImplicitInstantiation > PendingInstantiations
The queue of implicit template instantiations that are required but have not yet been performed.
Definition Sema.h:13955
ExprResult CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc, Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc)
ExprResult BuiltinShuffleVector(CallExpr *TheCall)
BuiltinShuffleVector - Handle __builtin_shufflevector.
bool CheckImplicitNullabilityTypeSpecifier(QualType &Type, NullabilityKind Nullability, SourceLocation DiagLoc, bool AllowArrayTypes, bool OverrideExisting)
Check whether a nullability type specifier can be added to the given type through some means not writ...
Decl * ActOnFinishLinkageSpecification(Scope *S, Decl *LinkageSpec, SourceLocation RBraceLoc)
ActOnFinishLinkageSpecification - Complete the definition of the C++ linkage specification LinkageSpe...
ModuleImportState
An enumeration to represent the transition of states in parsing module fragments and imports.
Definition Sema.h:9870
@ PrivateFragmentImportFinished
after 'module :private;' but a non-import decl has already been seen.
Definition Sema.h:9877
@ ImportFinished
after any non-import decl.
Definition Sema.h:9874
@ PrivateFragmentImportAllowed
after 'module :private;' but before any non-import decl.
Definition Sema.h:9875
@ FirstDecl
Parsing the first decl in a TU.
Definition Sema.h:9871
@ GlobalFragment
after 'module;' but before 'module X;'
Definition Sema.h:9872
@ NotACXX20Module
Not a C++20 TU, or an invalid state was found.
Definition Sema.h:9879
@ ImportAllowed
after 'module X;' but before any non-import decl.
Definition Sema.h:9873
void NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *E, QualType DestType=QualType(), bool TakingAddress=false)
void MarkUsedTemplateParameters(const Expr *E, bool OnlyDeduced, unsigned Depth, llvm::SmallBitVector &Used)
Mark which template parameters are used in a given expression.
static QualType getPrintable(QualType T)
Definition Sema.h:15015
ExprResult ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind)
QualType GetSignedVectorType(QualType V)
Return a signed ext_vector_type that is of identical size and number of elements.
ModuleLoader & getModuleLoader() const
Retrieve the module loader associated with the preprocessor.
Definition Sema.cpp:109
StmtResult ActOnMSDependentExistsStmt(SourceLocation KeywordLoc, bool IsIfExists, CXXScopeSpec &SS, UnqualifiedId &Name, Stmt *Nested)
AccessResult CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(UnresolvedLookupExpr *E, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl)
void incrementMSManglingNumber() const
Definition Sema.h:1248
void CheckConstrainedAuto(const AutoType *AutoT, SourceLocation Loc)
bool CheckDistantExceptionSpec(QualType T)
CheckDistantExceptionSpec - Check if the given type is a pointer or pointer to member to a function w...
bool isAcceptableNestedNameSpecifier(const NamedDecl *SD, bool *CanCorrect=nullptr)
Determines whether the given declaration is an valid acceptable result for name lookup of a nested-na...
DeclResult ActOnExplicitInstantiation(Scope *S, SourceLocation ExternLoc, SourceLocation TemplateLoc, unsigned TagSpec, SourceLocation KWLoc, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, TemplateTy Template, SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc, SourceLocation LAngleLoc, ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgs, SourceLocation RAngleLoc, const ParsedAttributesView &Attr)
ModularFormatAttr * mergeModularFormatAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, IdentifierInfo *ModularImplFn, StringRef ImplName, MutableArrayRef< StringRef > Aspects)
bool CheckInheritingConstructorUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UD)
Additional checks for a using declaration referring to a constructor name.
void AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs=nullptr)
Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given function set to the overload ca...
QualType CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK, ExprObjectKind &OK, SourceLocation QuestionLoc)
Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
void addClusterDimsAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *X, Expr *Y, Expr *Z)
void AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FunctionDecl *FD)
If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function (C++2a [basic.stc....
ExpressionEvaluationContext
Describes how the expressions currently being parsed are evaluated at run-time, if at all.
Definition Sema.h:6690
@ UnevaluatedAbstract
The current expression occurs within an unevaluated operand that unconditionally permits abstract ref...
Definition Sema.h:6712
@ UnevaluatedList
The current expression occurs within a braced-init-list within an unevaluated operand.
Definition Sema.h:6702
@ ConstantEvaluated
The current context is "potentially evaluated" in C++11 terms, but the expression is evaluated at com...
Definition Sema.h:6717
@ DiscardedStatement
The current expression occurs within a discarded statement.
Definition Sema.h:6707
@ PotentiallyEvaluated
The current expression is potentially evaluated at run time, which means that code may be generated t...
Definition Sema.h:6727
@ Unevaluated
The current expression and its subexpressions occur within an unevaluated operand (C++11 [expr]p7),...
Definition Sema.h:6696
@ ImmediateFunctionContext
In addition of being constant evaluated, the current expression occurs in an immediate function conte...
Definition Sema.h:6722
@ PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed
The current expression is potentially evaluated, but any declarations referenced inside that expressi...
Definition Sema.h:6737
void CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(QualType SrcType, QualType DestType, bool IsDereference, SourceRange Range)
QualType BuildDecltypeType(Expr *E, bool AsUnevaluated=true)
If AsUnevaluated is false, E is treated as though it were an evaluated context, such as when building...
unsigned LastEmittedCodeSynthesisContextDepth
The depth of the context stack at the point when the most recent error or warning was produced.
Definition Sema.h:13584
FormatAttr * mergeFormatAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, IdentifierInfo *Format, int FormatIdx, int FirstArg)
ExprResult BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs)
QualType BuildUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType, UTTKind UKind, SourceLocation Loc)
AvailabilityPriority
Describes the kind of priority given to an availability attribute.
Definition Sema.h:4793
@ AP_PragmaClangAttribute
The availability attribute was applied using 'pragma clang attribute'.
Definition Sema.h:4799
@ AP_InferredFromOtherPlatform
The availability attribute for a specific platform was inferred from an availability attribute for an...
Definition Sema.h:4803
@ AP_Explicit
The availability attribute was specified explicitly next to the declaration.
Definition Sema.h:4796
void ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef< Decl * > Group)
ExprResult ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Parse a __builtin_astype expression.
StmtResult ActOnSEHExceptBlock(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *FilterExpr, Stmt *Block)
ExprResult CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, SourceRange R)
Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
TypeSourceInfo * GetTypeForDeclarator(Declarator &D)
GetTypeForDeclarator - Convert the type for the specified declarator to Type instances.
void CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD)
Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a dllexport/import function.
ExprResult BuildOperatorCoawaitLookupExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc)
std::pair< SourceLocation, bool > DeleteExprLoc
Definition Sema.h:967
void diagnoseTypo(const TypoCorrection &Correction, const PartialDiagnostic &TypoDiag, bool ErrorRecovery=true)
bool CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc, CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD)
CheckCallReturnType - Checks that a call expression's return type is complete.
bool CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E, UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind)
Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression and type traits.
DeclResult ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK, SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, const ParsedAttributesView &Attr, AccessSpecifier AS, SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists, bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent, SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc, bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType, bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg, OffsetOfKind OOK, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody=nullptr)
This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'.
Decl * ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS, const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs, RecordDecl *&AnonRecord)
ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with no declarator (e....
bool inParameterMappingSubstitution() const
Definition Sema.h:13917
SemaPPC & PPC()
Definition Sema.h:1506
void ActOnFinishNamespaceDef(Decl *Dcl, SourceLocation RBrace)
ActOnFinishNamespaceDef - This callback is called after a namespace is exited.
NestedNameSpecifierLoc SubstNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
void RecordParsingTemplateParameterDepth(unsigned Depth)
This is used to inform Sema what the current TemplateParameterDepth is during Parsing.
Definition Sema.cpp:2356
ExprResult ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *E, ParsedType Ty, SourceLocation RPLoc)
MemInitResult BuildMemInitializer(Decl *ConstructorD, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase, ParsedType TemplateTypeTy, const DeclSpec &DS, SourceLocation IdLoc, Expr *Init, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
Handle a C++ member initializer.
void ActOnAfterCompoundStatementLeadingPragmas()
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:420
TypeSourceInfo * GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(Declarator &D, QualType FromTy)
StmtResult ActOnDeclStmt(DeclGroupPtrTy Decl, SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceLocation EndLoc)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:75
SmallVector< Decl *, 2 > WeakTopLevelDecl
WeakTopLevelDecl - Translation-unit scoped declarations generated by #pragma weak during processing o...
Definition Sema.h:4867
bool RequireCompleteType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, CompleteTypeKind Kind, TypeDiagnoser &Diagnoser)
Ensure that the type T is a complete type.
void ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D, SourceLocation LocAfterDecls)
void actOnDelayedExceptionSpecification(Decl *D, ExceptionSpecificationType EST, SourceRange SpecificationRange, ArrayRef< ParsedType > DynamicExceptions, ArrayRef< SourceRange > DynamicExceptionRanges, Expr *NoexceptExpr)
Add an exception-specification to the given member or friend function (or function template).
Scope * TUScope
Translation Unit Scope - useful to Objective-C actions that need to lookup file scope declarations in...
Definition Sema.h:1246
ReferenceCompareResult CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T1, QualType T2, ReferenceConversions *Conv=nullptr)
CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to determine whether they are referenc...
void ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context)
void DiagnoseUnterminatedPragmaAttribute()
void FreeVisContext()
FreeVisContext - Deallocate and null out VisContext.
bool SatisfactionStackContains(const NamedDecl *D, const llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID) const
Definition Sema.h:14776
ExprResult forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType)
Force an expression with unknown-type to an expression of the given type.
UnsignedOrNone getFullyPackExpandedSize(TemplateArgument Arg)
Given a template argument that contains an unexpanded parameter pack, but which has already been subs...
ASTContext::CXXRecordDeclRelocationInfo CheckCXX2CRelocatable(const clang::CXXRecordDecl *D)
LateTemplateParserCB * LateTemplateParser
Definition Sema.h:1324
void DiagnoseAmbiguousLookup(LookupResult &Result)
Produce a diagnostic describing the ambiguity that resulted from name lookup.
void ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *TagDecl, ArrayRef< Decl * > Fields, SourceLocation LBrac, SourceLocation RBrac, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList)
void CheckExplicitObjectLambda(Declarator &D)
bool LookupQualifiedName(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *LookupCtx, bool InUnqualifiedLookup=false)
Perform qualified name lookup into a given context.
void NoteDeletedInheritingConstructor(CXXConstructorDecl *CD)
QualType getCapturedDeclRefType(ValueDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc)
Given a variable, determine the type that a reference to that variable will have in the given scope.
ExprResult ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr)
void ModifyFnAttributesMSPragmaOptimize(FunctionDecl *FD)
Only called on function definitions; if there is a MSVC pragma optimize in scope, consider changing t...
void PopPragmaVisibility(bool IsNamespaceEnd, SourceLocation EndLoc)
PopPragmaVisibility - Pop the top element of the visibility stack; used for '#pragma GCC visibility' ...
ExprResult PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From, NestedNameSpecifier Qualifier, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, NamedDecl *Member)
Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
llvm::MapVector< FieldDecl *, DeleteLocs > DeleteExprs
Delete-expressions to be analyzed at the end of translation unit.
Definition Sema.h:8368
bool shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *OldDecl)
Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be put in the same redeclaration cha...
TentativeDefinitionsType TentativeDefinitions
All the tentative definitions encountered in the TU.
Definition Sema.h:3556
static bool getFormatStringInfo(const Decl *Function, unsigned FormatIdx, unsigned FirstArg, FormatStringInfo *FSI)
Given a function and its FormatAttr or FormatMatchesAttr info, attempts to populate the FormatStringI...
Expr * MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Expr *SubExpr)
MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups - If the current full-expression requires any cleanups,...
bool DeferDiags
Whether deferrable diagnostics should be deferred.
Definition Sema.h:10025
void checkInitializerLifetime(const InitializedEntity &Entity, Expr *Init)
Check that the lifetime of the initializer (and its subobjects) is sufficient for initializing the en...
QualType getLambdaConversionFunctionResultType(const FunctionProtoType *CallOpType, CallingConv CC)
Get the return type to use for a lambda's conversion function(s) to function pointer type,...
bool RebuildingImmediateInvocation
Whether the AST is currently being rebuilt to correct immediate invocations.
Definition Sema.h:8155
SemaSystemZ & SystemZ()
Definition Sema.h:1536
DarwinSDKInfo * getDarwinSDKInfoForAvailabilityChecking()
Definition Sema.cpp:123
bool isRedefinitionAllowedFor(const NamedDecl *D, bool &Visible)
Definition Sema.h:15465
const llvm::MapVector< FieldDecl *, DeleteLocs > & getMismatchingDeleteExpressions() const
Retrieves list of suspicious delete-expressions that will be checked at the end of translation unit.
Definition Sema.cpp:2895
void CheckCompletedCXXClass(Scope *S, CXXRecordDecl *Record)
Perform semantic checks on a class definition that has been completing, introducing implicitly-declar...
void DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext()
QualType BuiltinRemoveExtent(QualType BaseType, UTTKind UKind, SourceLocation Loc)
bool NeedToCaptureVariable(ValueDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc)
Checks if the variable must be captured.
SmallVector< ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord, 8 > ExprEvalContexts
A stack of expression evaluation contexts.
Definition Sema.h:8305
void PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC)
Set the current declaration context until it gets popped.
void warnOnCTypeHiddenInCPlusPlus(const NamedDecl *D)
bool CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(FunctionDecl *Old, FunctionDecl *New)
MemberPointerConversionResult
Definition Sema.h:10207
bool CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty, CastKind &Kind)
void makeMergedDefinitionVisible(NamedDecl *ND)
Make a merged definition of an existing hidden definition ND visible at the specified location.
void makeModuleVisible(Module *Mod, SourceLocation ImportLoc)
Definition Sema.h:9856
bool BuiltinConstantArgShiftedByteOrXXFF(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum, unsigned ArgBits)
BuiltinConstantArgShiftedByteOr0xFF - Check if argument ArgNum of TheCall is a constant expression re...
QualType getCompletedType(Expr *E)
Get the type of expression E, triggering instantiation to complete the type if necessary – that is,...
void mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old, AvailabilityMergeKind AMK=AvailabilityMergeKind::Redeclaration)
mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one.
StmtResult ActOnAttributedStmt(const ParsedAttributes &AttrList, Stmt *SubStmt)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:648
UuidAttr * mergeUuidAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, StringRef UuidAsWritten, MSGuidDecl *GuidDecl)
bool DiagnoseUninstantiableTemplate(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, NamedDecl *Instantiation, bool InstantiatedFromMember, const NamedDecl *Pattern, const NamedDecl *PatternDef, TemplateSpecializationKind TSK, bool Complain=true, bool *Unreachable=nullptr)
Determine whether we would be unable to instantiate this template (because it either has no definitio...
QualType BuiltinChangeCVRQualifiers(QualType BaseType, UTTKind UKind, SourceLocation Loc)
bool isDependentScopeSpecifier(const CXXScopeSpec &SS)
SourceManager & SourceMgr
Definition Sema.h:1286
DeclResult CheckVarTemplateId(VarTemplateDecl *Template, SourceLocation TemplateLoc, SourceLocation TemplateNameLoc, const TemplateArgumentListInfo &TemplateArgs, bool SetWrittenArgs)
Get the specialization of the given variable template corresponding to the specified argument list,...
TemplateNameIsRequiredTag
Definition Sema.h:11375
@ TemplateNameIsRequired
Definition Sema.h:11375
bool CheckDestructor(CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor)
CheckDestructor - Checks a fully-formed destructor definition for well-formedness,...
bool CheckAlignasTypeArgument(StringRef KWName, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceRange R)
ExprResult BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo)
Build an altivec or OpenCL literal.
NamedDecl * BuildUsingPackDecl(NamedDecl *InstantiatedFrom, ArrayRef< NamedDecl * > Expansions)
MemInitResult ActOnMemInitializer(Decl *ConstructorD, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase, ParsedType TemplateTypeTy, const DeclSpec &DS, SourceLocation IdLoc, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
Handle a C++ member initializer using parentheses syntax.
void SetDeclDeleted(Decl *dcl, SourceLocation DelLoc, StringLiteral *Message=nullptr)
ExprResult ActOnSizeofParameterPackExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, IdentifierInfo &Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Called when an expression computing the size of a parameter pack is parsed.
ExprResult UsualUnaryFPConversions(Expr *E)
UsualUnaryFPConversions - Promotes floating-point types according to the current language semantics.
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:783
bool isUnavailableAlignedAllocationFunction(const FunctionDecl &FD) const
Determine whether FD is an aligned allocation or deallocation function that is unavailable.
bool hasReachableExplicitSpecialization(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
Determine if there is a reachable declaration of D that is an explicit specialization declaration for...
Decl * BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS, RecordDecl *Record)
BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an Microsoft C anonymous structure.
bool isDeductionGuideName(Scope *S, const IdentifierInfo &Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, ParsedTemplateTy *Template=nullptr)
Determine whether a particular identifier might be the name in a C++1z deduction-guide declaration.
TypeSourceInfo * SubstAutoTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TypeWithAuto, QualType Replacement)
Substitute Replacement for auto in TypeWithAuto.
void ActOnPragmaPack(SourceLocation PragmaLoc, PragmaMsStackAction Action, StringRef SlotLabel, Expr *Alignment)
ActOnPragmaPack - Called on well formed #pragma pack(...).
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:438
static bool CanBeGetReturnTypeOnAllocFailure(const FunctionDecl *FD)
void ActOnStartDelayedCXXMethodDeclaration(Scope *S, Decl *Method)
ActOnStartDelayedCXXMethodDeclaration - We have completed parsing a top-level (non-nested) C++ class,...
LazyVector< CXXConstructorDecl *, ExternalSemaSource, &ExternalSemaSource::ReadDelegatingConstructors, 2, 2 > DelegatingCtorDeclsType
Definition Sema.h:6500
LabelDecl * GetOrCreateMSAsmLabel(StringRef ExternalLabelName, SourceLocation Location, bool AlwaysCreate)
bool DiagnoseDependentMemberLookup(const LookupResult &R)
Diagnose a lookup that found results in an enclosing class during error recovery.
DiagnosticsEngine & Diags
Definition Sema.h:1285
CXXMethodDecl * CreateLambdaCallOperator(SourceRange IntroducerRange, CXXRecordDecl *Class)
void DiagnoseUnterminatedPragmaAlignPack()
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:589
FullExprArg MakeFullDiscardedValueExpr(Expr *Arg)
Definition Sema.h:7775
OpenCLOptions & getOpenCLOptions()
Definition Sema.h:920
FPOptions CurFPFeatures
Definition Sema.h:1279
void ActOnStartSEHFinallyBlock()
TypeAwareAllocationMode ShouldUseTypeAwareOperatorNewOrDelete() const
CXXConstructorDecl * DeclareImplicitCopyConstructor(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl)
Declare the implicit copy constructor for the given class.
static bool CanBeGetReturnObject(const FunctionDecl *FD)
NamespaceDecl * getStdNamespace() const
void SetLateTemplateParser(LateTemplateParserCB *LTP, void *P)
Definition Sema.h:1327
QualType BuiltinRemovePointer(QualType BaseType, SourceLocation Loc)
llvm::SmallPtrSet< const CXXRecordDecl *, 8 > RecordDeclSetTy
Definition Sema.h:6491
ExprResult BuildEmptyCXXFoldExpr(SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, BinaryOperatorKind Operator)
void DeclareImplicitEqualityComparison(CXXRecordDecl *RD, FunctionDecl *Spaceship)
ExprResult BuildCXXThrow(SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *Ex, bool IsThrownVarInScope)
bool IsAtLeastAsConstrained(const NamedDecl *D1, MutableArrayRef< AssociatedConstraint > AC1, const NamedDecl *D2, MutableArrayRef< AssociatedConstraint > AC2, bool &Result)
Check whether the given declaration's associated constraints are at least as constrained than another...
bool AttachBaseSpecifiers(CXXRecordDecl *Class, MutableArrayRef< CXXBaseSpecifier * > Bases)
Performs the actual work of attaching the given base class specifiers to a C++ class.
void ActOnCXXExitDeclInitializer(Scope *S, Decl *Dcl)
ActOnCXXExitDeclInitializer - Invoked after we are finished parsing an initializer for the declaratio...
NamedDecl * ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous)
QualType BuildArrayType(QualType T, ArraySizeModifier ASM, Expr *ArraySize, unsigned Quals, SourceRange Brackets, DeclarationName Entity)
Build an array type.
ExprResult DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose=true)
DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
Definition SemaExpr.cpp:515
PragmaStack< StringLiteral * > DataSegStack
Definition Sema.h:2035
void deduceClosureReturnType(sema::CapturingScopeInfo &CSI)
Deduce a block or lambda's return type based on the return statements present in the body.
bool areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType srcType, QualType destType)
Are the two types lax-compatible vector types?
NamedDecl * ActOnNonTypeTemplateParameter(Scope *S, Declarator &D, unsigned Depth, unsigned Position, SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *DefaultArg)
ExprResult BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, bool ForFoldExpression=false)
ExprResult PerformCopyInitialization(const InitializedEntity &Entity, SourceLocation EqualLoc, ExprResult Init, bool TopLevelOfInitList=false, bool AllowExplicit=false)
static bool adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC)
Adjust the DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a function-local external declaration...
void diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateName Name, SourceLocation Loc)
Attr * CreateAnnotationAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, StringRef Annot, MutableArrayRef< Expr * > Args)
CreateAnnotationAttr - Creates an annotation Annot with Args arguments.
Definition Sema.cpp:2934
void CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D)
Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function parameters and non-type ...
ExprResult ActOnTypeTrait(TypeTrait Kind, SourceLocation KWLoc, ArrayRef< ParsedType > Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Parsed one of the type trait support pseudo-functions.
TemplateParamListContext
The context in which we are checking a template parameter list.
Definition Sema.h:11558
@ TPC_TemplateTemplateParameterPack
Definition Sema.h:11568
@ TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate
Definition Sema.h:11566
@ TPC_ClassTemplateMember
Definition Sema.h:11564
@ TPC_FunctionTemplate
Definition Sema.h:11563
@ TPC_FriendClassTemplate
Definition Sema.h:11565
@ TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition
Definition Sema.h:11567
void ActOnPragmaVisibility(const IdentifierInfo *VisType, SourceLocation PragmaLoc)
ActOnPragmaVisibility - Called on well formed #pragma GCC visibility... .
void ActOnAbortSEHFinallyBlock()
SpecialMemberOverloadResult LookupSpecialMember(CXXRecordDecl *D, CXXSpecialMemberKind SM, bool ConstArg, bool VolatileArg, bool RValueThis, bool ConstThis, bool VolatileThis)
NamedDecl * ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *D, LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration)
ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which declares a typedef-name,...
void ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D, ParsedAttributes &Attrs)
ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute - Invoked when we have finished parsing an attribute for which parsing is...
bool CheckQualifiedFunctionForTypeId(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc)
ExprResult ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, int64_t Val)
SemaAVR & AVR()
Definition Sema.h:1426
ExprResult BuildCXXDefaultInitExpr(SourceLocation Loc, FieldDecl *Field)
Decl * ActOnEmptyDeclaration(Scope *S, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList, SourceLocation SemiLoc)
Handle a C++11 empty-declaration and attribute-declaration.
friend class InitializationSequence
Definition Sema.h:1556
bool GloballyUniqueObjectMightBeAccidentallyDuplicated(const VarDecl *Dcl)
Certain globally-unique variables might be accidentally duplicated if built into multiple shared libr...
void DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E)
DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition - Given that an expression is being used as a boolean condition,...
SourceLocation OptimizeOffPragmaLocation
This represents the last location of a "#pragma clang optimize off" directive if such a directive has...
Definition Sema.h:2111
void checkSpecializationVisibility(SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *Spec)
We've found a use of a templated declaration that would trigger an implicit instantiation.
void DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *ND)
void handleDelayedAvailabilityCheck(sema::DelayedDiagnostic &DD, Decl *Ctx)
bool hasAcceptableDefaultArgument(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules, Sema::AcceptableKind Kind)
Determine if the template parameter D has a reachable default argument.
QualType BuildReadPipeType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc)
Build a Read-only Pipe type.
void PopDeclContext()
ExprResult VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, AllowFoldKind CanFold=AllowFoldKind::No)
Definition Sema.h:7734
void DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(const VarDecl *VDecl, const Expr *Init)
bool ActOnCXXEnterDeclaratorScope(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS)
ActOnCXXEnterDeclaratorScope - Called when a C++ scope specifier (global scope or nested-name-specifi...
TemplateArgumentLoc getIdentityTemplateArgumentLoc(NamedDecl *Param, SourceLocation Location)
Get a template argument mapping the given template parameter to itself, e.g.
bool CheckIfFunctionSpecializationIsImmediate(FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc)
ExprResult BuildLambdaExpr(SourceLocation StartLoc, SourceLocation EndLoc)
Complete a lambda-expression having processed and attached the lambda body.
void diagnoseIgnoredQualifiers(unsigned DiagID, unsigned Quals, SourceLocation FallbackLoc, SourceLocation ConstQualLoc=SourceLocation(), SourceLocation VolatileQualLoc=SourceLocation(), SourceLocation RestrictQualLoc=SourceLocation(), SourceLocation AtomicQualLoc=SourceLocation(), SourceLocation UnalignedQualLoc=SourceLocation())
AccessResult CheckMemberAccess(SourceLocation UseLoc, CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass, DeclAccessPair Found)
Checks access to a member.
void ActOnDeferStmtError(Scope *CurScope)
QualType CheckBitwiseOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
concepts::NestedRequirement * BuildNestedRequirement(Expr *E)
llvm::MapVector< NamedDecl *, SourceLocation > UndefinedButUsed
UndefinedInternals - all the used, undefined objects which require a definition in this translation u...
Definition Sema.h:6523
SmallVector< Module *, 16 > CodeSynthesisContextLookupModules
Extra modules inspected when performing a lookup during a template instantiation.
Definition Sema.h:13556
void PrintStats() const
Print out statistics about the semantic analysis.
Definition Sema.cpp:670
ExprResult ActOnStmtExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, SourceLocation RPLoc)
bool ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConversion=false, bool Complain=false, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining=SourceRange(), QualType DestTypeForComplaining=QualType(), unsigned DiagIDForComplaining=0)
QualType CheckConstructorDeclarator(Declarator &D, QualType R, StorageClass &SC)
CheckConstructorDeclarator - Called by ActOnDeclarator to check the well-formedness of the constructo...
ExprResult ConvertParamDefaultArgument(ParmVarDecl *Param, Expr *DefaultArg, SourceLocation EqualLoc)
void ProcessDeclAttributes(Scope *S, Decl *D, const Declarator &PD)
ProcessDeclAttributes - Given a declarator (PD) with attributes indicated in it, apply them to D.
static unsigned getPrintable(unsigned I)
Definition Sema.h:15006
void checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT)
Check to see if the given expression is a valid argument to a variadic function, issuing a diagnostic...
ExprResult ActOnCXXFoldExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr *LHS, tok::TokenKind Operator, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, Expr *RHS, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
Handle a C++1z fold-expression: ( expr op ... op expr ).
void CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, ParmVarDecl *Param, const Expr *ArgExpr)
CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static array parameter,...
LangOptions::PragmaMSPointersToMembersKind MSPointerToMemberRepresentationMethod
Controls member pointer representation format under the MS ABI.
Definition Sema.h:1798
QualType SubstAutoTypeDependent(QualType TypeWithAuto)
void FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S, bool ConsiderLinkage, bool AllowInlineNamespace)
Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope as determined by isDeclInScope.
void DeclApplyPragmaWeak(Scope *S, NamedDecl *ND, const WeakInfo &W)
DeclApplyPragmaWeak - A declaration (maybe definition) needs #pragma weak applied to it,...
QualType CheckSizelessVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
llvm::BumpPtrAllocator BumpAlloc
Definition Sema.h:1232
TemplateDeductionResult DeduceTemplateArguments(ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *Partial, ArrayRef< TemplateArgument > TemplateArgs, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info)
ExprResult ConvertMemberDefaultInitExpression(FieldDecl *FD, Expr *InitExpr, SourceLocation InitLoc)
QualType BuildWritePipeType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc)
Build a Write-only Pipe type.
void AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, Expr *Object, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that converts the given Object to a fun...
SourceRange getRangeForNextToken(SourceLocation Loc, bool IncludeMacros, bool IncludeComments, std::optional< tok::TokenKind > ExpectedToken=std::nullopt)
Calls Lexer::findNextToken() to find the next token, and if the locations of both ends of the token c...
Definition Sema.cpp:88
MemberExpr * BuildMemberExpr(Expr *Base, bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc, NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, ValueDecl *Member, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, bool HadMultipleCandidates, const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs=nullptr)
BuildForRangeKind
Definition Sema.h:11033
@ BFRK_Check
Determining whether a for-range statement could be built.
Definition Sema.h:11041
@ BFRK_Build
Initial building of a for-range statement.
Definition Sema.h:11035
@ BFRK_Rebuild
Instantiation or recovery rebuild of a for-range statement.
Definition Sema.h:11038
bool IsInvalidSMECallConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType)
SemaNVPTX & NVPTX()
Definition Sema.h:1481
void checkIncorrectVTablePointerAuthenticationAttribute(CXXRecordDecl &RD)
Check that VTable Pointer authentication is only being set on the first first instantiation of the vt...
StmtResult ActOnCXXCatchBlock(SourceLocation CatchLoc, Decl *ExDecl, Stmt *HandlerBlock)
ActOnCXXCatchBlock - Takes an exception declaration and a handler block and creates a proper catch ha...
void ActOnPragmaMSStrictGuardStackCheck(SourceLocation PragmaLocation, PragmaMsStackAction Action, bool Value)
ActOnPragmaMSStrictGuardStackCheck - Called on well formed #pragma strict_gs_check.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:874
void ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *dcl)
void checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init, SourceLocation Loc)
Emit diagnostics if the initializer or any of its explicit or implicitly-generated subexpressions req...
void ApplyAPINotesType(Decl *D, StringRef TypeString)
Apply the 'Type:' annotation to the specified declaration.
static Scope * getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC)
Finds the scope corresponding to the given decl context, if it happens to be an enclosing scope.
bool CheckFunctionTemplateConstraints(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, FunctionDecl *Decl, ArrayRef< TemplateArgument > TemplateArgs, ConstraintSatisfaction &Satisfaction)
TypedefDecl * ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo)
Subroutines of ActOnDeclarator().
QualType ActOnPackIndexingType(QualType Pattern, Expr *IndexExpr, SourceLocation Loc, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)
void checkLifetimeCaptureBy(FunctionDecl *FDecl, bool IsMemberFunction, const Expr *ThisArg, ArrayRef< const Expr * > Args)
void ActOnCaseStmtBody(Stmt *CaseStmt, Stmt *SubStmt)
ActOnCaseStmtBody - This installs a statement as the body of a case.
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:563
ExprResult ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope)
ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement literal was successfully compl...
void AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *dcl, Expr *init, bool DirectInit)
AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the declaration dcl.
QualType BuildTypeofExprType(Expr *E, TypeOfKind Kind)
bool isUsualDeallocationFunction(const CXXMethodDecl *FD)
PragmaSectionKind
Definition Sema.h:2055
@ PSK_ConstSeg
Definition Sema.h:2058
@ PSK_DataSeg
Definition Sema.h:2056
@ PSK_CodeSeg
Definition Sema.h:2059
@ PSK_BSSSeg
Definition Sema.h:2057
void CheckConceptRedefinition(ConceptDecl *NewDecl, LookupResult &Previous, bool &AddToScope)
void DiagnoseDeletedDefaultedFunction(FunctionDecl *FD)
Produce notes explaining why a defaulted function was defined as deleted.
ExprResult BuildArrayTypeTrait(ArrayTypeTrait ATT, SourceLocation KWLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo, Expr *DimExpr, SourceLocation RParen)
TypeResult ActOnTemplateIdType(Scope *S, ElaboratedTypeKeyword ElaboratedKeyword, SourceLocation ElaboratedKeywordLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, TemplateTy Template, const IdentifierInfo *TemplateII, SourceLocation TemplateIILoc, SourceLocation LAngleLoc, ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgs, SourceLocation RAngleLoc, bool IsCtorOrDtorName=false, bool IsClassName=false, ImplicitTypenameContext AllowImplicitTypename=ImplicitTypenameContext::No)
void runWithSufficientStackSpace(SourceLocation Loc, llvm::function_ref< void()> Fn)
Run some code with "sufficient" stack space.
Definition Sema.cpp:625
void MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E)
Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr.
bool CheckSpanLikeType(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, const QualType &Ty)
Check that the type is a plain record with one field being a pointer type and the other field being a...
ExprResult BuildCXXNamedCast(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind, TypeSourceInfo *Ty, Expr *E, SourceRange AngleBrackets, SourceRange Parens)
Definition SemaCast.cpp:337
bool DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy, SourceLocation Loc, QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action, bool *Complained=nullptr)
DiagnoseAssignmentResult - Emit a diagnostic, if required, for the assignment conversion type specifi...
bool CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(const CXXMethodDecl *New, const CXXMethodDecl *Old)
CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec - Checks whether the exception spec is a subset of base spec.
void ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagDecl, SourceLocation FinalLoc, bool IsFinalSpelledSealed, bool IsAbstract, SourceLocation TriviallyRelocatable, SourceLocation LBraceLoc)
ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations - Invoked when we have parsed a C++ record definition's base-specifie...
SmallVector< CXXRecordDecl *, 4 > DelayedDllExportClasses
Definition Sema.h:6267
Decl * ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth)
ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order to create a FieldDecl object...
bool BuiltinConstantArgPower2(CallExpr *TheCall, unsigned ArgNum)
BuiltinConstantArgPower2 - Check if argument ArgNum of TheCall is a constant expression representing ...
void MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func, bool MightBeOdrUse=true)
Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,...
bool SubstTemplateArgumentsInParameterMapping(ArrayRef< TemplateArgumentLoc > Args, SourceLocation BaseLoc, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, TemplateArgumentListInfo &Out, bool BuildPackExpansionTypes)
FormatMatchesAttr * mergeFormatMatchesAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, IdentifierInfo *Format, int FormatIdx, StringLiteral *FormatStr)
CodeAlignAttr * BuildCodeAlignAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *E)
ExprResult ActOnStmtExprResult(ExprResult E)
AvailabilityAttr * mergeAvailabilityAttr(NamedDecl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, IdentifierInfo *Platform, bool Implicit, VersionTuple Introduced, VersionTuple Deprecated, VersionTuple Obsoleted, bool IsUnavailable, StringRef Message, bool IsStrict, StringRef Replacement, AvailabilityMergeKind AMK, int Priority, IdentifierInfo *IIEnvironment)
void BuildVariableInstantiation(VarDecl *NewVar, VarDecl *OldVar, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, LateInstantiatedAttrVec *LateAttrs, DeclContext *Owner, LocalInstantiationScope *StartingScope, bool InstantiatingVarTemplate=false, VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *PrevVTSD=nullptr)
BuildVariableInstantiation - Used after a new variable has been created.
ExprResult ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input)
void mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *New, ObjCMethodDecl *Old)
bool CheckTemplateParameterList(TemplateParameterList *NewParams, TemplateParameterList *OldParams, TemplateParamListContext TPC, SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody=nullptr)
Checks the validity of a template parameter list, possibly considering the template parameter list fr...
void ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D)
bool CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(const CXXMethodDecl *New, const CXXMethodDecl *Old)
CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType - Checks whether the return types are covariant,...
std::tuple< MangleNumberingContext *, Decl * > getCurrentMangleNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC)
Compute the mangling number context for a lambda expression or block literal.
QualType BuildMatrixType(QualType T, Expr *NumRows, Expr *NumColumns, SourceLocation AttrLoc)
void DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE)
Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate that the user intended an assignment u...
bool isMoreSpecializedThanPrimary(ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *T, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info)
llvm::MapVector< IdentifierInfo *, llvm::SetVector< WeakInfo, llvm::SmallVector< WeakInfo, 1u >, llvm::SmallDenseSet< WeakInfo, 2u, WeakInfo::DenseMapInfoByAliasOnly > > > WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers
WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers - Identifiers contained in #pragma weak before declared.
Definition Sema.h:3531
SemaDiagnosticBuilder targetDiag(SourceLocation Loc, unsigned DiagID, const FunctionDecl *FD=nullptr)
Definition Sema.cpp:2104
ExprResult CreateRecoveryExpr(SourceLocation Begin, SourceLocation End, ArrayRef< Expr * > SubExprs, QualType T=QualType())
Attempts to produce a RecoveryExpr after some AST node cannot be created.
bool hasAcceptableDefinition(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl **Suggested, AcceptableKind Kind, bool OnlyNeedComplete=false)
UnsignedOrNone GetDecompositionElementCount(QualType DecompType, SourceLocation Loc)
PragmaClangSection PragmaClangBSSSection
Definition Sema.h:1811
Decl * ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D)
ExprResult ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope=nullptr)
DeclarationName VAListTagName
VAListTagName - The declaration name corresponding to __va_list_tag.
Definition Sema.h:1338
QualType CheckMatrixLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc)
ExprResult ActOnGCCAsmStmtString(Expr *Stm, bool ForAsmLabel)
AbstractDiagSelID
Definition Sema.h:6213
@ AbstractSynthesizedIvarType
Definition Sema.h:6220
@ AbstractVariableType
Definition Sema.h:6217
@ AbstractReturnType
Definition Sema.h:6215
@ AbstractNone
Definition Sema.h:6214
@ AbstractFieldType
Definition Sema.h:6218
@ AbstractArrayType
Definition Sema.h:6221
@ AbstractParamType
Definition Sema.h:6216
@ AbstractIvarType
Definition Sema.h:6219
StmtResult ActOnIfStmt(SourceLocation IfLoc, IfStatementKind StatementKind, SourceLocation LParenLoc, Stmt *InitStmt, ConditionResult Cond, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Stmt *ThenVal, SourceLocation ElseLoc, Stmt *ElseVal)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:950
MSPropertyDecl * HandleMSProperty(Scope *S, RecordDecl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart, Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth, InClassInitStyle InitStyle, AccessSpecifier AS, const ParsedAttr &MSPropertyAttr)
HandleMSProperty - Analyze a __delcspec(property) field of a C++ class.
bool InstantiateEnum(SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, EnumDecl *Instantiation, EnumDecl *Pattern, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, TemplateSpecializationKind TSK)
Instantiate the definition of an enum from a given pattern.
ExprResult BuildInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList, SourceLocation RBraceLoc)
ExprResult CheckVarOrConceptTemplateTemplateId(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Template, SourceLocation TemplateLoc, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs)
void ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope)
ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
void UpdateExceptionSpec(FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI)
ExprResult SubstCXXIdExpr(Expr *E, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
Substitute an expression as if it is a address-of-operand, which makes it act like a CXXIdExpression ...
bool IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) const
Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid conversion of ExtInfo/ExtProtoInf...
void ProcessAPINotes(Decl *D)
Map any API notes provided for this declaration to attributes on the declaration.
void CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Decl *D)
SemaSPIRV & SPIRV()
Definition Sema.h:1521
ParsedType getConstructorName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, bool EnteringContext)
ExprResult ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc, MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RLoc)
std::string getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(const TemplateParameterList *Params, const TemplateArgumentList &Args)
Produces a formatted string that describes the binding of template parameters to template arguments.
void HandleDelayedAccessCheck(sema::DelayedDiagnostic &DD, Decl *Ctx)
bool CheckRedeclarationInModule(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old)
A wrapper function for checking the semantic restrictions of a redeclaration within a module.
LazyDeclPtr StdAlignValT
The C++ "std::align_val_t" enum class, which is defined by the C++ standard library.
Definition Sema.h:8354
ExprResult ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc, bool IsAddressOfOperand)
Act on the result of classifying a name as an undeclared member of a dependent base class.
bool MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(const NamedDecl *D1, ArrayRef< AssociatedConstraint > AC1, const NamedDecl *D2, ArrayRef< AssociatedConstraint > AC2)
If D1 was not at least as constrained as D2, but would've been if a pair of atomic constraints involv...
ExprResult BuildAtomicExpr(SourceRange CallRange, SourceRange ExprRange, SourceLocation RParenLoc, MultiExprArg Args, AtomicExpr::AtomicOp Op, AtomicArgumentOrder ArgOrder=AtomicArgumentOrder::API)
Decl * ActOnFinishExportDecl(Scope *S, Decl *ExportDecl, SourceLocation RBraceLoc)
Complete the definition of an export declaration.
void finishLambdaExplicitCaptures(sema::LambdaScopeInfo *LSI)
Note that we have finished the explicit captures for the given lambda.
bool CheckTemplateArgumentList(TemplateDecl *Template, SourceLocation TemplateLoc, TemplateArgumentListInfo &TemplateArgs, const DefaultArguments &DefaultArgs, bool PartialTemplateArgs, CheckTemplateArgumentInfo &CTAI, bool UpdateArgsWithConversions=true, bool *ConstraintsNotSatisfied=nullptr)
Check that the given template arguments can be provided to the given template, converting the argumen...
QualType BuiltinChangeSignedness(QualType BaseType, UTTKind UKind, SourceLocation Loc)
void ActOnPragmaFPContract(SourceLocation Loc, LangOptions::FPModeKind FPC)
ActOnPragmaFPContract - Called on well formed #pragma {STDC,OPENCL} FP_CONTRACT and #pragma clang fp ...
void adjustMemberFunctionCC(QualType &T, bool HasThisPointer, bool IsCtorOrDtor, SourceLocation Loc)
Adjust the calling convention of a method to be the ABI default if it wasn't specified explicitly.
void ActOnPureSpecifier(Decl *D, SourceLocation PureSpecLoc)
void ActOnPragmaOptimize(bool On, SourceLocation PragmaLoc)
Called on well formed #pragma clang optimize.
ExprResult ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *ExecConfig=nullptr)
ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
ExprResult ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType, void *TyOrEx, SourceRange ArgRange)
ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle sizeof(type) and sizeof expr and the same for alignof and __al...
QualType PreferredConditionType(ConditionKind K) const
Definition Sema.h:7963
CUDALaunchBoundsAttr * CreateLaunchBoundsAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *MaxThreads, Expr *MinBlocks, Expr *MaxBlocks)
Create an CUDALaunchBoundsAttr attribute.
ForRangeStatus BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc, SourceLocation RangeLoc, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, LookupResult &MemberLookup, OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr)
Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement.
LiteralOperatorLookupResult
The possible outcomes of name lookup for a literal operator.
Definition Sema.h:9366
@ LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic
The lookup found no match but no diagnostic was issued.
Definition Sema.h:9370
@ LOLR_Raw
The lookup found a single 'raw' literal operator, which expects a string literal containing the spell...
Definition Sema.h:9376
@ LOLR_Error
The lookup resulted in an error.
Definition Sema.h:9368
@ LOLR_Cooked
The lookup found a single 'cooked' literal operator, which expects a normal literal to be built and p...
Definition Sema.h:9373
@ LOLR_StringTemplatePack
The lookup found an overload set of literal operator templates, which expect the character type and c...
Definition Sema.h:9384
@ LOLR_Template
The lookup found an overload set of literal operator templates, which expect the characters of the sp...
Definition Sema.h:9380
void ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo *WeakName, IdentifierInfo *AliasName, SourceLocation PragmaLoc, SourceLocation WeakNameLoc, SourceLocation AliasNameLoc)
ActOnPragmaWeakAlias - Called on well formed #pragma weak ident = ident.
sema::FunctionScopeInfo * getEnclosingFunction() const
Definition Sema.cpp:2528
const ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord & parentEvaluationContext() const
Definition Sema.h:6934
SemaLoongArch & LoongArch()
Definition Sema.h:1461
void ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope)
ActOnBlockArguments - This callback allows processing of block arguments.
QualType CheckRemainderOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign=false)
CheckConstexprKind
Definition Sema.h:6402
@ CheckValid
Identify whether this function satisfies the formal rules for constexpr functions in the current lanu...
Definition Sema.h:6407
@ Diagnose
Diagnose issues that are non-constant or that are extensions.
Definition Sema.h:6404
ExprResult InitializeExplicitObjectArgument(Sema &S, Expr *Obj, FunctionDecl *Fun)
std::pair< ValueDecl *, SourceLocation > PendingImplicitInstantiation
An entity for which implicit template instantiation is required.
Definition Sema.h:13951
void CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD)
sema::CompoundScopeInfo & getCurCompoundScope() const
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:432
DeclContext * FindInstantiatedContext(SourceLocation Loc, DeclContext *DC, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
Finds the instantiation of the given declaration context within the current instantiation.
sema::CapturedRegionScopeInfo * getCurCapturedRegion()
Retrieve the current captured region, if any.
Definition Sema.cpp:2887
OpaquePtr< TemplateName > TemplateTy
Definition Sema.h:1275
unsigned getTemplateDepth(Scope *S) const
Determine the number of levels of enclosing template parameters.
bool CanPerformCopyInitialization(const InitializedEntity &Entity, ExprResult Init)
ExprResult BuildExpressionFromDeclTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg, QualType ParamType, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *TemplateParam=nullptr)
Given a non-type template argument that refers to a declaration and the type of its corresponding non...
bool DiagnoseInvalidExplicitObjectParameterInLambda(CXXMethodDecl *Method, SourceLocation CallLoc)
Returns true if the explicit object parameter was invalid.
SkippedDefinitionContext ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TD)
Invoked when we enter a tag definition that we're skipping.
void diagnoseZeroToNullptrConversion(CastKind Kind, const Expr *E)
Warn when implicitly casting 0 to nullptr.
Definition Sema.cpp:708
bool CheckCXXThrowOperand(SourceLocation ThrowLoc, QualType ThrowTy, Expr *E)
CheckCXXThrowOperand - Validate the operand of a throw.
bool DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit, Expr *Init)
TemplateDeductionResult DeduceAutoType(TypeLoc AutoTypeLoc, Expr *Initializer, QualType &Result, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info, bool DependentDeduction=false, bool IgnoreConstraints=false, TemplateSpecCandidateSet *FailedTSC=nullptr)
Deduce the type for an auto type-specifier (C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p6)
void ActOnPragmaDump(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, IdentifierInfo *II)
Called on pragma clang __debug dump II.
bool LookupName(LookupResult &R, Scope *S, bool AllowBuiltinCreation=false, bool ForceNoCPlusPlus=false)
Perform unqualified name lookup starting from a given scope.
void ActOnPragmaFEnvAccess(SourceLocation Loc, bool IsEnabled)
ActOnPragmaFenvAccess - Called on well formed #pragma STDC FENV_ACCESS.
bool isIncompatibleTypedef(const TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New)
void checkEnumArithmeticConversions(Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, SourceLocation Loc, ArithConvKind ACK)
Check that the usual arithmetic conversions can be performed on this pair of expressions that might b...
bool SubstBaseSpecifiers(CXXRecordDecl *Instantiation, CXXRecordDecl *Pattern, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
Perform substitution on the base class specifiers of the given class template specialization.
void LoadExternalVTableUses()
Load any externally-stored vtable uses.
static QualType GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType Ty, TypeSourceInfo **TInfo=nullptr)
llvm::SmallPtrSet< const NamedDecl *, 4 > TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions
The function definitions which were renamed as part of typo-correction to match their respective decl...
Definition Sema.h:3512
void ActOnFinishOfCompoundStmt()
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:428
concepts::Requirement * ActOnNestedRequirement(Expr *Constraint)
void EmitDiagnostic(unsigned DiagID, const DiagnosticBuilder &DB)
Cause the built diagnostic to be emitted on the DiagosticsEngine.
Definition Sema.cpp:1679
QualType adjustCCAndNoReturn(QualType ArgFunctionType, QualType FunctionType, bool AdjustExceptionSpec=false)
Adjust the type ArgFunctionType to match the calling convention, noreturn, and optionally the excepti...
bool IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType)
Helper function to determine whether this is the (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to...
Decl * ActOnUsingDirective(Scope *CurScope, SourceLocation UsingLoc, SourceLocation NamespcLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation IdentLoc, IdentifierInfo *NamespcName, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList)
bool CheckExceptionSpecCompatibility(Expr *From, QualType ToType)
void AddSectionMSAllocText(FunctionDecl *FD)
Only called on function definitions; if there is a #pragma alloc_text that decides which code section...
void computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, sema::FunctionScopeInfo *Scope)
Given the set of return statements within a function body, compute the variables that are subject to ...
bool RequireCompleteExprType(Expr *E, unsigned DiagID, const Ts &...Args)
Definition Sema.h:15311
void AddAlignValueAttr(Decl *D, const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, Expr *E)
AddAlignValueAttr - Adds an align_value attribute to a particular declaration.
UnsignedOrNone getNumArgumentsInExpansionFromUnexpanded(llvm::ArrayRef< UnexpandedParameterPack > Unexpanded, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
void checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc, NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, unsigned NonTrivialKind)
Emit diagnostics if a non-trivial C union type or a struct that contains a non-trivial C union is use...
static ConditionResult ConditionError()
Definition Sema.h:7812
StmtResult ActOnCompoundStmt(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, ArrayRef< Stmt * > Elts, bool isStmtExpr)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:436
void NoteTemplateParameterLocation(const NamedDecl &Decl)
SemaWasm & Wasm()
Definition Sema.h:1541
ExprResult ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the provided arguments.
void HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, QualType FromType, QualType ToType)
HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing function types.
void ActOnStartTrailingRequiresClause(Scope *S, Declarator &D)
void FindHiddenVirtualMethods(CXXMethodDecl *MD, SmallVectorImpl< CXXMethodDecl * > &OverloadedMethods)
Check if a method overloads virtual methods in a base class without overriding any.
IdentifierResolver IdResolver
Definition Sema.h:3460
bool IsInvalidUnlessNestedName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, NestedNameSpecInfo &IdInfo, bool EnteringContext)
IsInvalidUnlessNestedName - This method is used for error recovery purposes to determine whether the ...
llvm::DenseSet< QualType > InstantiatedNonDependentTypes
Non-dependent types used in templates that have already been instantiated by some template instantiat...
Definition Sema.h:13552
ExprResult checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc, Expr *result, QualType &paramType)
Type-check an expression that's being passed to an __unknown_anytype parameter.
LifetimeCaptureByAttr * ParseLifetimeCaptureByAttr(const ParsedAttr &AL, StringRef ParamName)
bool IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val, bool AllowMask) const
IsValueInFlagEnum - Determine if a value is allowed as part of a flag enum.
bool ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn, FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, SourceLocation RParenLoc, bool ExecConfig=false)
ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of ...
ExprResult ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S, SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, SourceLocation TypeLoc, ParsedType ParsedArgTy, ArrayRef< OffsetOfComponent > Components, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
SemaPseudoObject & PseudoObject()
Definition Sema.h:1511
LabelDecl * LookupExistingLabel(IdentifierInfo *II, SourceLocation IdentLoc)
Perform a name lookup for a label with the specified name; this does not create a new label if the lo...
bool hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction() const
Determine whether any errors occurred within this function/method/ block.
Definition Sema.cpp:2489
StmtResult ActOnLabelStmt(SourceLocation IdentLoc, LabelDecl *TheDecl, SourceLocation ColonLoc, Stmt *SubStmt)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:588
ArrayRef< sema::FunctionScopeInfo * > getFunctionScopes() const
Definition Sema.h:11340
StmtResult ActOnCXXTryBlock(SourceLocation TryLoc, Stmt *TryBlock, ArrayRef< Stmt * > Handlers)
ActOnCXXTryBlock - Takes a try compound-statement and a number of handlers and creates a try statemen...
FullExprArg MakeFullExpr(Expr *Arg)
Definition Sema.h:7768
void PerformDependentDiagnostics(const DeclContext *Pattern, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs)
DeclContextLookupResult LookupConstructors(CXXRecordDecl *Class)
Look up the constructors for the given class.
void DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II, SourceLocation IILoc, Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS, ParsedType &SuggestedType, bool IsTemplateName=false)
Definition SemaDecl.cpp:718
void DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(ArrayRef< ParmVarDecl * > Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D)
Diagnose whether the size of parameters or return value of a function or obj-c method definition is p...
void checkTypeDeclType(DeclContext *LookupCtx, DiagCtorKind DCK, TypeDecl *TD, SourceLocation NameLoc)
Returns the TypeDeclType for the given type declaration, as ASTContext::getTypeDeclType would,...
Definition SemaDecl.cpp:147
void CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(FunctionTemplateDecl *TD)
void ActOnStartDelayedMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *Record)
FunctionTemplateDecl * getMoreSpecializedTemplate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FT1, FunctionTemplateDecl *FT2, SourceLocation Loc, TemplatePartialOrderingContext TPOC, unsigned NumCallArguments1, QualType RawObj1Ty={}, QualType RawObj2Ty={}, bool Reversed=false, bool PartialOverloading=false)
Returns the more specialized function template according to the rules of function template partial or...
llvm::SmallVector< std::pair< SourceLocation, const BlockDecl * >, 1 > ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs
List of SourceLocations where 'self' is implicitly retained inside a block.
Definition Sema.h:8313
OpaquePtr< DeclGroupRef > DeclGroupPtrTy
Definition Sema.h:1274
static int getPrintable(int I)
Definition Sema.h:15005
TypeResult ActOnTagTemplateIdType(TagUseKind TUK, TypeSpecifierType TagSpec, SourceLocation TagLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, TemplateTy TemplateD, SourceLocation TemplateLoc, SourceLocation LAngleLoc, ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsIn, SourceLocation RAngleLoc)
Parsed an elaborated-type-specifier that refers to a template-id, such as class T::template apply.
void ActOnPragmaMSSection(SourceLocation PragmaLocation, int SectionFlags, StringLiteral *SegmentName)
Called on well formed #pragma section().
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:885
bool hasReachableDeclaration(const NamedDecl *D, llvm::SmallVectorImpl< Module * > *Modules=nullptr)
Determine whether any declaration of an entity is reachable.
Definition Sema.h:9636
bool checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(CXXRecordDecl *RD, SourceRange Range, bool BestCase, MSInheritanceModel SemanticSpelling)
void MarkDeducedTemplateParameters(const FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, llvm::SmallBitVector &Deduced)
Definition Sema.h:12871
StmtResult ActOnDefaultStmt(SourceLocation DefaultLoc, SourceLocation ColonLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, Scope *CurScope)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:568
ExprResult ActOnCXXThis(SourceLocation Loc)
bool DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPacks(SourceLocation Loc, UnexpandedParameterPackContext UPPC, ArrayRef< UnexpandedParameterPack > Unexpanded)
Diagnose unexpanded parameter packs.
TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics
Describes the detailed kind of a template name. Used in diagnostics.
Definition Sema.h:3804
bool CheckAltivecInitFromScalar(SourceRange R, QualType VecTy, QualType SrcTy)
bool checkStringLiteralArgumentAttr(const AttributeCommonInfo &CI, const Expr *E, StringRef &Str, SourceLocation *ArgLocation=nullptr)
Check if the argument E is a ASCII string literal.
ExprResult HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E)
CXXConstructorDecl * findInheritingConstructor(SourceLocation Loc, CXXConstructorDecl *BaseCtor, ConstructorUsingShadowDecl *DerivedShadow)
Given a derived-class using shadow declaration for a constructor and the correspnding base class cons...
static const std::string & getPrintable(const std::string &S)
Definition Sema.h:15010
ExprResult ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList, SourceLocation RBraceLoc)
void warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D)
StmtResult ActOnCaseStmt(SourceLocation CaseLoc, ExprResult LHS, SourceLocation DotDotDotLoc, ExprResult RHS, SourceLocation ColonLoc)
Definition SemaStmt.cpp:532
TemplateArgumentLoc getTemplateArgumentPackExpansionPattern(TemplateArgumentLoc OrigLoc, SourceLocation &Ellipsis, UnsignedOrNone &NumExpansions) const
Returns the pattern of the pack expansion for a template argument.
TypeSourceInfo * CheckPackExpansion(TypeSourceInfo *Pattern, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, UnsignedOrNone NumExpansions)
Construct a pack expansion type from the pattern of the pack expansion.
bool isCheckingDefaultArgumentOrInitializer() const
Definition Sema.h:8181
bool CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped, QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed, const EnumDecl *Prev)
Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration.
SFINAETrap * CurrentSFINAEContext
Definition Sema.h:13567
SemaARM & ARM()
Definition Sema.h:1421
bool CheckExplicitlyDefaultedSpecialMember(CXXMethodDecl *MD, CXXSpecialMemberKind CSM, SourceLocation DefaultLoc)
bool isCurrentClassNameTypo(IdentifierInfo *&II, const CXXScopeSpec *SS)
Determine whether the identifier II is a typo for the name of the class type currently being defined.
llvm::DenseSet< InstantiatingSpecializationsKey > InstantiatingSpecializations
Specializations whose definitions are currently being instantiated.
Definition Sema.h:13548
void inferNullableClassAttribute(CXXRecordDecl *CRD)
Add _Nullable attributes for std:: types.
Definition SemaAttr.cpp:322
bool CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const LookupResult &R)
Decl * ActOnUsingDeclaration(Scope *CurScope, AccessSpecifier AS, SourceLocation UsingLoc, SourceLocation TypenameLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS, UnqualifiedId &Name, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, const ParsedAttributesView &AttrList)
void ActOnDelayedCXXMethodParameter(Scope *S, Decl *Param)
ActOnDelayedCXXMethodParameter - We've already started a delayed C++ method declaration.
static const char * getPrintable(const char *S)
Definition Sema.h:15008
bool CheckFunctionCall(FunctionDecl *FDecl, CallExpr *TheCall, const FunctionProtoType *Proto)
CheckFunctionCall - Check a direct function call for various correctness and safety properties not st...
void AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, SourceLocation OpLoc, ArrayRef< Expr * > Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO={})
Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are member functions.
ExprResult ActOnDecltypeExpression(Expr *E)
Process the expression contained within a decltype.
SmallVector< std::pair< Scope *, SourceLocation >, 2 > CurrentDefer
Stack of '_Defer' statements that are currently being parsed, as well as the locations of their '_Def...
Definition Sema.h:10943
bool isAbstractType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T)
bool CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param, Expr *Init=nullptr, bool SkipImmediateInvocations=true)
Instantiate or parse a C++ default argument expression as necessary.
ValueDecl * tryLookupUnambiguousFieldDecl(RecordDecl *ClassDecl, const IdentifierInfo *MemberOrBase)
ASTMutationListener * getASTMutationListener() const
Definition Sema.cpp:651
QualType BuildBlockPointerType(QualType T, SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity)
Build a block pointer type.
PragmaMsStackAction
Definition Sema.h:1817
@ PSK_Push_Set
Definition Sema.h:1823
@ PSK_Reset
Definition Sema.h:1818
@ PSK_Pop_Set
Definition Sema.h:1824
StmtResult FinishCXXForRangeStmt(Stmt *ForRange, Stmt *Body)
FinishCXXForRangeStmt - Attach the body to a C++0x for-range statement.
static CanThrowResult canCalleeThrow(Sema &S, const Expr *E, const Decl *D, SourceLocation Loc=SourceLocation())
Determine whether the callee of a particular function call can throw.
bool SetCtorInitializers(CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, bool AnyErrors, ArrayRef< CXXCtorInitializer * > Initializers={})
void CheckVirtualDtorCall(CXXDestructorDecl *dtor, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsDelete, bool CallCanBeVirtual, bool WarnOnNonAbstractTypes, SourceLocation DtorLoc)
void DiagnoseImmediateEscalatingReason(FunctionDecl *FD)
ExprResult ActOnFinishFullExpr(Expr *Expr, bool DiscardedValue)
Definition Sema.h:8645
CXXDestructorDecl * DeclareImplicitDestructor(CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl)
Declare the implicit destructor for the given class.
TypeSourceInfo * SubstFunctionDeclType(TypeSourceInfo *T, const MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs, SourceLocation Loc, DeclarationName Entity, CXXRecordDecl *ThisContext, Qualifiers ThisTypeQuals, bool EvaluateConstraints=true)
A form of SubstType intended specifically for instantiating the type of a FunctionDecl.
ExprResult CreateBuiltinMatrixSubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, Expr *RowIdx, Expr *ColumnIdx, SourceLocation RBLoc)
ExprResult ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *OverloadSet)
Act on the result of classifying a name as an overload set.
SFINAETrap * getSFINAEContext() const
Returns a pointer to the current SFINAE context, if any.
Definition Sema.h:13639
StmtResult ActOnGCCAsmStmt(SourceLocation AsmLoc, bool IsSimple, bool IsVolatile, unsigned NumOutputs, unsigned NumInputs, IdentifierInfo **Names, MultiExprArg Constraints, MultiExprArg Exprs, Expr *AsmString, MultiExprArg Clobbers, unsigned NumLabels, SourceLocation RParenLoc)
void createImplicitModuleImportForErrorRecovery(SourceLocation Loc, Module *Mod)
Create an implicit import of the given module at the given source location, for error recovery,...
void checkCall(NamedDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, const Expr *ThisArg, ArrayRef< const Expr * > Args, bool IsMemberFunction, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range, VariadicCallType CallType)
Handles the checks for format strings, non-POD arguments to vararg functions, NULL arguments passed t...
Encodes a location in the source.
bool isValid() const
Return true if this is a valid SourceLocation object.
This class handles loading and caching of source files into memory.
A trivial tuple used to represent a source range.
StandardConversionSequence - represents a standard conversion sequence (C++ 13.3.3....
Definition Overload.h:298
Stmt - This represents one statement.
Definition Stmt.h:85
SourceRange getSourceRange() const LLVM_READONLY
SourceLocation tokens are not useful in isolation - they are low level value objects created/interpre...
Definition Stmt.cpp:338
StringLiteral - This represents a string literal expression, e.g.
Definition Expr.h:1799
Represents the declaration of a struct/union/class/enum.
Definition Decl.h:3717
Exposes information about the current target.
Definition TargetInfo.h:226
A convenient class for passing around template argument information.
A template argument list.
Location wrapper for a TemplateArgument.
Represents a template argument.
TemplateArgument getPackExpansionPattern() const
When the template argument is a pack expansion, returns the pattern of the pack expansion.
unsigned pack_size() const
The number of template arguments in the given template argument pack.
ArrayRef< TemplateArgument > pack_elements() const
Iterator range referencing all of the elements of a template argument pack.
bool isPackExpansion() const
Determine whether this template argument is a pack expansion.
The base class of all kinds of template declarations (e.g., class, function, etc.).
This is a base class for callbacks that will be notified at every template instantiation.
Represents a C++ template name within the type system.
Stores a list of template parameters for a TemplateDecl and its derived classes.
TemplateSpecCandidateSet - A set of generalized overload candidates, used in template specializations...
TemplateTemplateParmDecl - Declares a template template parameter, e.g., "T" in.
Declaration of a template type parameter.
Token - This structure provides full information about a lexed token.
Definition Token.h:36
A declaration that models statements at global scope.
Definition Decl.h:4631
The top declaration context.
Definition Decl.h:105
Declaration of an alias template.
Models the abbreviated syntax to constrain a template type parameter: template <convertible_to<string...
Definition ASTConcept.h:227
Represents a declaration of a type.
Definition Decl.h:3513
Base wrapper for a particular "section" of type source info.
Definition TypeLoc.h:59
SourceRange getSourceRange() const LLVM_READONLY
Get the full source range.
Definition TypeLoc.h:154
A container of type source information.
Definition TypeBase.h:8264
The base class of the type hierarchy.
Definition TypeBase.h:1833
Represents the declaration of a typedef-name via the 'typedef' type specifier.
Definition Decl.h:3667
Base class for declarations which introduce a typedef-name.
Definition Decl.h:3562
Simple class containing the result of Sema::CorrectTypo.
Represents a C++ unqualified-id that has been parsed.
Definition DeclSpec.h:998
A reference to a name which we were able to look up during parsing but could not resolve to a specifi...
Definition ExprCXX.h:3390
Represents a C++ member access expression for which lookup produced a set of overloaded functions.
Definition ExprCXX.h:4126
A set of unresolved declarations.
The iterator over UnresolvedSets.
Represents a C++ using-declaration.
Definition DeclCXX.h:3587
Represents C++ using-directive.
Definition DeclCXX.h:3092
Represents a shadow declaration implicitly introduced into a scope by a (resolved) using-declaration ...
Definition DeclCXX.h:3395
Represent the declaration of a variable (in which case it is an lvalue) a function (in which case it ...
Definition Decl.h:712
Represents a variable declaration or definition.
Definition Decl.h:926
Declaration of a variable template.
Represents a variable template specialization, which refers to a variable template with a given set o...
Represents a GCC generic vector type.
Definition TypeBase.h:4176
Represents a C++11 virt-specifier-seq.
Definition DeclSpec.h:2754
Consumes visible declarations found when searching for all visible names within a given scope or cont...
Definition Lookup.h:838
Captures information about a #pragma weak directive.
Definition Weak.h:25
The API notes manager helps find API notes associated with declarations.
A requires-expression requirement which queries the validity and properties of an expression ('simple...
A requires-expression requirement which is satisfied when a general constraint expression is satisfie...
A static requirement that can be used in a requires-expression to check properties of types and expre...
A requires-expression requirement which queries the existence of a type name or type template special...
Retains information about a block that is currently being parsed.
Definition ScopeInfo.h:790
Retains information about a captured region.
Definition ScopeInfo.h:816
Contains information about the compound statement currently being parsed.
Definition ScopeInfo.h:67
A collection of diagnostics which were delayed.
A diagnostic message which has been conditionally emitted pending the complete parsing of the current...
Retains information about a function, method, or block that is currently being parsed.
Definition ScopeInfo.h:104
Provides information about an attempted template argument deduction, whose success or failure was des...
#define bool
Definition gpuintrin.h:32
#define UINT_MAX
Definition limits.h:64
Definition SPIR.cpp:47
Enums for the diagnostics of target, target_version and target_clones.
Definition Sema.h:841
const internal::VariadicAllOfMatcher< Decl > decl
Matches declarations.
const internal::VariadicDynCastAllOfMatcher< Stmt, Expr > expr
Matches expressions.
llvm::DenseMap< int, SourceRange > ParsedSubjectMatchRuleSet
void threadSafetyCleanup(BeforeSet *Cache)
TokenKind
Provides a simple uniform namespace for tokens from all C languages.
Definition TokenKinds.h:25
The JSON file list parser is used to communicate input to InstallAPI.
PragmaClangSectionAction
Definition Sema.h:475
TypeSpecifierType
Specifies the kind of type.
Definition Specifiers.h:55
ImplicitTypenameContext
Definition DeclSpec.h:1857
OverloadedOperatorKind
Enumeration specifying the different kinds of C++ overloaded operators.
OverloadKind
Definition Sema.h:810
@ NonFunction
This is not an overload because the lookup results contain a non-function.
Definition Sema.h:821
@ Match
This is not an overload because the signature exactly matches an existing declaration.
Definition Sema.h:817
@ Overload
This is a legitimate overload: the existing declarations are functions or function templates with dif...
Definition Sema.h:813
bool isa(CodeGen::Address addr)
Definition Address.h:330
OpaquePtr< TemplateName > ParsedTemplateTy
Definition Ownership.h:256
ArrayTypeTrait
Names for the array type traits.
Definition TypeTraits.h:42
@ CPlusPlus
MutableArrayRef< TemplateParameterList * > MultiTemplateParamsArg
Definition Ownership.h:263
VariadicCallType
Definition Sema.h:512
FunctionEffectMode
Used with attributes/effects with a boolean condition, e.g. nonblocking.
Definition Sema.h:458
CUDAFunctionTarget
Definition Cuda.h:61
CanThrowResult
Possible results from evaluation of a noexcept expression.
@ Specialization
We are substituting template parameters for template arguments in order to form a template specializa...
Definition Template.h:50
AllocationFunctionScope
The scope in which to find allocation functions.
Definition Sema.h:778
@ Both
Look for allocation functions in both the global scope and in the scope of the allocated class.
Definition Sema.h:786
PragmaMSCommentKind
Definition PragmaKinds.h:14
ConstexprSpecKind
Define the kind of constexpr specifier.
Definition Specifiers.h:35
ArrayRef< IdentifierLoc > ModuleIdPath
A sequence of identifier/location pairs used to describe a particular module or submodule,...
TryCaptureKind
Definition Sema.h:652
IfStatementKind
In an if statement, this denotes whether the statement is a constexpr or consteval if statement.
Definition Specifiers.h:39
ArithConvKind
Context in which we're performing a usual arithmetic conversion.
Definition Sema.h:660
@ BitwiseOp
A bitwise operation.
Definition Sema.h:664
@ Arithmetic
An arithmetic operation.
Definition Sema.h:662
@ Conditional
A conditional (?:) operator.
Definition Sema.h:668
@ CompAssign
A compound assignment expression.
Definition Sema.h:670
@ Comparison
A comparison.
Definition Sema.h:666
NullabilityKind
Describes the nullability of a particular type.
Definition Specifiers.h:348
InClassInitStyle
In-class initialization styles for non-static data members.
Definition Specifiers.h:271
@ Success
Annotation was successful.
Definition Parser.h:65
CXXConstructionKind
Definition ExprCXX.h:1540
ExprObjectKind
A further classification of the kind of object referenced by an l-value or x-value.
Definition Specifiers.h:149
PointerAuthDiscArgKind
Definition Sema.h:593
NonTagKind
Common ways to introduce type names without a tag for use in diagnostics.
Definition Sema.h:603
@ TemplateTemplateArgument
Definition Sema.h:612
OverloadCandidateParamOrder
The parameter ordering that will be used for the candidate.
Definition Overload.h:84
NonTrivialCUnionContext
Definition Sema.h:531
AvailabilityMergeKind
Describes the kind of merge to perform for availability attributes (including "deprecated",...
Definition Sema.h:627
@ Override
Merge availability attributes for an override, which requires an exact match or a weakening of constr...
Definition Sema.h:635
@ OptionalProtocolImplementation
Merge availability attributes for an implementation of an optional protocol requirement.
Definition Sema.h:641
@ Redeclaration
Merge availability attributes for a redeclaration, which requires an exact match.
Definition Sema.h:632
@ ProtocolImplementation
Merge availability attributes for an implementation of a protocol requirement.
Definition Sema.h:638
std::pair< llvm::PointerUnion< const TemplateTypeParmType *, NamedDecl *, const TemplateSpecializationType *, const SubstBuiltinTemplatePackType * >, SourceLocation > UnexpandedParameterPack
Definition Sema.h:237
@ Private
'private' clause, allowed on 'parallel', 'serial', 'loop', 'parallel loop', and 'serial loop' constru...
TypeOfKind
The kind of 'typeof' expression we're after.
Definition TypeBase.h:918
bool operator==(const CallGraphNode::CallRecord &LHS, const CallGraphNode::CallRecord &RHS)
Definition CallGraph.h:204
AccessSpecifier
A C++ access specifier (public, private, protected), plus the special value "none" which means differ...
Definition Specifiers.h:123
@ AS_none
Definition Specifiers.h:127
LazyOffsetPtr< Decl, GlobalDeclID, &ExternalASTSource::GetExternalDecl > LazyDeclPtr
A lazy pointer to a declaration.
SmallVector< Attr *, 4 > AttrVec
AttrVec - A vector of Attr, which is how they are stored on the AST.
ActionResult< Decl * > DeclResult
Definition Ownership.h:255
nullptr
This class represents a compute construct, representing a 'Kind' of ‘parallel’, 'serial',...
CapturedRegionKind
The different kinds of captured statement.
StorageClass
Storage classes.
Definition Specifiers.h:248
void inferNoReturnAttr(Sema &S, Decl *D)
Expr * Cond
};
llvm::MutableArrayRef< ImplicitConversionSequence > ConversionSequenceList
A list of implicit conversion sequences for the arguments of an OverloadCandidate.
Definition Overload.h:928
@ Dependent
Parse the block as a dependent block, which may be used in some template instantiations but not other...
Definition Parser.h:142
UnaryExprOrTypeTrait
Names for the "expression or type" traits.
Definition TypeTraits.h:51
bool isFunctionOrMethodOrBlockForAttrSubject(const Decl *D)
Return true if the given decl has function type (function or function-typed variable) or an Objective...
Definition Attr.h:40
OverloadCandidateRewriteKind
The kinds of rewrite we perform on overload candidates.
Definition Overload.h:89
MutableArrayRef< Expr * > MultiExprArg
Definition Ownership.h:259
LambdaCaptureInitKind
Definition DeclSpec.h:2798
@ CopyInit
[a = b], [a = {b}]
Definition DeclSpec.h:2800
@ Module
Module linkage, which indicates that the entity can be referred to from other translation units withi...
Definition Linkage.h:54
@ AANT_ArgumentIntegerConstant
PragmaOptionsAlignKind
Definition Sema.h:477
@ Result
The result type of a method or function.
Definition TypeBase.h:905
ActionResult< ParsedType > TypeResult
Definition Ownership.h:251
OffsetOfKind
Definition Sema.h:615
ArraySizeModifier
Capture whether this is a normal array (e.g.
Definition TypeBase.h:3720
CorrectTypoKind
Definition Sema.h:805
ActionResult< CXXCtorInitializer * > MemInitResult
Definition Ownership.h:253
const FunctionProtoType * T
bool isComputedNoexcept(ExceptionSpecificationType ESpecType)
bool isFunctionOrMethodVariadic(const Decl *D)
Definition Attr.h:112
@ Template
We are parsing a template declaration.
Definition Parser.h:81
ActionResult< CXXBaseSpecifier * > BaseResult
Definition Ownership.h:252
AssignConvertType
AssignConvertType - All of the 'assignment' semantic checks return this enum to indicate whether the ...
Definition Sema.h:688
@ IncompatiblePointer
IncompatiblePointer - The assignment is between two pointers types that are not compatible,...
Definition Sema.h:711
@ Incompatible
Incompatible - We reject this conversion outright, it is invalid to represent it in the AST.
Definition Sema.h:774
@ IntToPointer
IntToPointer - The assignment converts an int to a pointer, which we accept as an extension.
Definition Sema.h:703
@ IncompatibleVectors
IncompatibleVectors - The assignment is between two vector types that have the same size,...
Definition Sema.h:753
@ IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch
IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch - The assignment changes address spaces in nested point...
Definition Sema.h:743
@ IncompatibleObjCWeakRef
IncompatibleObjCWeakRef - Assigning a weak-unavailable object to an object with __weak qualifier.
Definition Sema.h:770
@ IntToBlockPointer
IntToBlockPointer - The assignment converts an int to a block pointer.
Definition Sema.h:757
@ CompatibleVoidPtrToNonVoidPtr
CompatibleVoidPtrToNonVoidPtr - The types are compatible in C because a void * can implicitly convert...
Definition Sema.h:695
@ IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers
IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers - The assignment discards qualifiers that we don't permit to be...
Definition Sema.h:737
@ CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers
CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers - The assignment discards c/v/r qualifiers, which we accept as an...
Definition Sema.h:732
@ IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId
IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId - The assignment is between a qualified id type and something else (that ...
Definition Sema.h:766
@ Compatible
Compatible - the types are compatible according to the standard.
Definition Sema.h:690
@ IncompatibleFunctionPointerStrict
IncompatibleFunctionPointerStrict - The assignment is between two function pointer types that are not...
Definition Sema.h:722
@ PointerToInt
PointerToInt - The assignment converts a pointer to an int, which we accept as an extension.
Definition Sema.h:699
@ FunctionVoidPointer
FunctionVoidPointer - The assignment is between a function pointer and void*, which the standard does...
Definition Sema.h:707
@ IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers
IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers - The assignment is between two nested pointer types,...
Definition Sema.h:749
@ IncompatibleFunctionPointer
IncompatibleFunctionPointer - The assignment is between two function pointers types that are not comp...
Definition Sema.h:716
@ IncompatiblePointerSign
IncompatiblePointerSign - The assignment is between two pointers types which point to integers which ...
Definition Sema.h:728
@ IncompatibleBlockPointer
IncompatibleBlockPointer - The assignment is between two block pointers types that are not compatible...
Definition Sema.h:761
TagUseKind
Definition Sema.h:450
MSVtorDispMode
In the Microsoft ABI, this controls the placement of virtual displacement members used to implement v...
Definition LangOptions.h:38
PragmaClangSectionKind
pragma clang section kind
Definition Sema.h:466
TagTypeKind
The kind of a tag type.
Definition TypeBase.h:5893
TUFragmentKind
Definition Sema.h:486
DeductionFailureInfo MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, TemplateDeductionResult TDK, sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info)
Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information to the form used in overload-can...
NameClassificationKind
Describes the result of the name lookup and resolution performed by Sema::ClassifyName().
Definition Sema.h:554
@ FunctionTemplate
The name was classified as a function template name.
Definition Sema.h:586
@ Keyword
The name has been typo-corrected to a keyword.
Definition Sema.h:561
@ DependentNonType
The name denotes a member of a dependent type that could not be resolved.
Definition Sema.h:575
@ UndeclaredTemplate
The name was classified as an ADL-only function template name.
Definition Sema.h:588
@ NonType
The name was classified as a specific non-type, non-template declaration.
Definition Sema.h:567
@ Unknown
This name is not a type or template in this context, but might be something else.
Definition Sema.h:557
@ Error
Classification failed; an error has been produced.
Definition Sema.h:559
@ Type
The name was classified as a type.
Definition Sema.h:563
@ TypeTemplate
The name was classified as a template whose specializations are types.
Definition Sema.h:582
@ Concept
The name was classified as a concept name.
Definition Sema.h:590
@ OverloadSet
The name was classified as an overload set, and an expression representing that overload set has been...
Definition Sema.h:580
@ UndeclaredNonType
The name was classified as an ADL-only function name.
Definition Sema.h:571
@ VarTemplate
The name was classified as a variable template name.
Definition Sema.h:584
LangAS
Defines the address space values used by the address space qualifier of QualType.
FormatStringType
Definition Sema.h:498
CastKind
CastKind - The kind of operation required for a conversion.
AllowFoldKind
Definition Sema.h:654
TranslationUnitKind
Describes the kind of translation unit being processed.
@ TU_Complete
The translation unit is a complete translation unit.
@ TU_Prefix
The translation unit is a prefix to a translation unit, and is not complete.
ComparisonCategoryType
An enumeration representing the different comparison categories types.
MutableArrayRef< ParsedTemplateArgument > ASTTemplateArgsPtr
Definition Ownership.h:261
VarArgKind
Definition Sema.h:675
PragmaMSStructKind
Definition PragmaKinds.h:23
AssignmentAction
Definition Sema.h:215
CXXSpecialMemberKind
Kinds of C++ special members.
Definition Sema.h:426
TemplateNameKind
Specifies the kind of template name that an identifier refers to.
@ TNK_Var_template
The name refers to a variable template whose specialization produces a variable.
@ TNK_Type_template
The name refers to a template whose specialization produces a type.
@ TNK_Function_template
The name refers to a function template or a set of overloaded functions that includes at least one fu...
@ TNK_Concept_template
The name refers to a concept.
@ TNK_Undeclared_template
Lookup for the name failed, but we're assuming it was a template name anyway.
BuiltinCountedByRefKind
Definition Sema.h:520
std::pair< SourceLocation, PartialDiagnostic > PartialDiagnosticAt
A partial diagnostic along with the source location where this diagnostic occurs.
bool hasImplicitObjectParameter(const Decl *D)
Definition Attr.h:126
LambdaCaptureDefault
The default, if any, capture method for a lambda expression.
Definition Lambda.h:22
PragmaFloatControlKind
Definition PragmaKinds.h:28
ExprValueKind
The categorization of expression values, currently following the C++11 scheme.
Definition Specifiers.h:132
@ VK_PRValue
A pr-value expression (in the C++11 taxonomy) produces a temporary value.
Definition Specifiers.h:135
SmallVector< CXXBaseSpecifier *, 4 > CXXCastPath
A simple array of base specifiers.
Definition ASTContext.h:149
TypeAwareAllocationMode
Definition ExprCXX.h:2251
IfExistsResult
Describes the result of an "if-exists" condition check.
Definition Sema.h:790
@ Exists
The symbol exists.
Definition Sema.h:792
@ DoesNotExist
The symbol does not exist.
Definition Sema.h:795
MSInheritanceModel
Assigned inheritance model for a class in the MS C++ ABI.
Definition Specifiers.h:410
bool hasFunctionProto(const Decl *D)
hasFunctionProto - Return true if the given decl has a argument information.
Definition Attr.h:55
llvm::PointerUnion< TemplateTypeParmDecl *, NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *, TemplateTemplateParmDecl * > TemplateParameter
Stores a template parameter of any kind.
unsigned getFunctionOrMethodNumParams(const Decl *D)
getFunctionOrMethodNumParams - Return number of function or method parameters.
Definition Attr.h:64
TPOC
The context in which partial ordering of function templates occurs.
Definition Template.h:302
TrivialABIHandling
Definition Sema.h:644
@ ConsiderTrivialABI
The triviality of a method affected by "trivial_abi".
Definition Sema.h:649
@ IgnoreTrivialABI
The triviality of a method unaffected by "trivial_abi".
Definition Sema.h:646
TemplateDeductionResult
Describes the result of template argument deduction.
Definition Sema.h:368
@ MiscellaneousDeductionFailure
Deduction failed; that's all we know.
Definition Sema.h:418
@ NonDependentConversionFailure
Checking non-dependent argument conversions failed.
Definition Sema.h:413
@ ConstraintsNotSatisfied
The deduced arguments did not satisfy the constraints associated with the template.
Definition Sema.h:416
@ Underqualified
Template argument deduction failed due to inconsistent cv-qualifiers on a template parameter type tha...
Definition Sema.h:389
@ InstantiationDepth
Template argument deduction exceeded the maximum template instantiation depth (which has already been...
Definition Sema.h:375
@ InvalidExplicitArguments
The explicitly-specified template arguments were not valid template arguments for the given template.
Definition Sema.h:411
@ CUDATargetMismatch
CUDA Target attributes do not match.
Definition Sema.h:420
@ TooFewArguments
When performing template argument deduction for a function template, there were too few call argument...
Definition Sema.h:408
@ Incomplete
Template argument deduction did not deduce a value for every template parameter.
Definition Sema.h:378
@ SubstitutionFailure
Substitution of the deduced template argument values resulted in an error.
Definition Sema.h:392
@ IncompletePack
Template argument deduction did not deduce a value for every expansion of an expanded template parame...
Definition Sema.h:381
@ DeducedMismatch
After substituting deduced template arguments, a dependent parameter type did not match the correspon...
Definition Sema.h:395
@ Inconsistent
Template argument deduction produced inconsistent deduced values for the given template parameter.
Definition Sema.h:384
@ TooManyArguments
When performing template argument deduction for a function template, there were too many call argumen...
Definition Sema.h:405
@ AlreadyDiagnosed
Some error which was already diagnosed.
Definition Sema.h:422
@ DeducedMismatchNested
After substituting deduced template arguments, an element of a dependent parameter type did not match...
Definition Sema.h:399
@ NonDeducedMismatch
A non-depnedent component of the parameter did not match the corresponding component of the argument.
Definition Sema.h:402
TemplateSpecializationKind
Describes the kind of template specialization that a particular template specialization declaration r...
Definition Specifiers.h:188
CallingConv
CallingConv - Specifies the calling convention that a function uses.
Definition Specifiers.h:278
U cast(CodeGen::Address addr)
Definition Address.h:327
SmallVector< Token, 4 > CachedTokens
A set of tokens that has been cached for later parsing.
Definition DeclSpec.h:1215
@ None
The alignment was not explicit in code.
Definition ASTContext.h:178
CCEKind
Contexts in which a converted constant expression is required.
Definition Sema.h:825
@ CaseValue
Expression in a case label.
Definition Sema.h:826
@ StaticAssertMessageData
Call to data() in a static assert message.
Definition Sema.h:836
@ Enumerator
Enumerator value with fixed underlying type.
Definition Sema.h:827
@ StaticAssertMessageSize
Call to size() in a static assert message.
Definition Sema.h:834
@ Noexcept
Condition in a noexcept(bool) specifier.
Definition Sema.h:833
@ ArrayBound
Array bound in array declarator or new-expression.
Definition Sema.h:831
@ TempArgStrict
As above, but applies strict template checking rules.
Definition Sema.h:829
@ ExplicitBool
Condition in an explicit(bool) specifier.
Definition Sema.h:832
OpaquePtr< QualType > ParsedType
An opaque type for threading parsed type information through the parser.
Definition Ownership.h:230
SourceLocIdentKind
Definition Expr.h:5004
ElaboratedTypeKeyword
The elaboration keyword that precedes a qualified type name or introduces an elaborated-type-specifie...
Definition TypeBase.h:5868
@ Class
The "class" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:5879
@ Enum
The "enum" keyword introduces the elaborated-type-specifier.
Definition TypeBase.h:5882
@ Typename
The "typename" keyword precedes the qualified type name, e.g., typename T::type.
Definition TypeBase.h:5886
ActionResult< Expr * > ExprResult
Definition Ownership.h:249
TypeTrait
Names for traits that operate specifically on types.
Definition TypeTraits.h:21
@ Parens
New-expression has a C++98 paren-delimited initializer.
Definition ExprCXX.h:2245
ExceptionSpecificationType
The various types of exception specifications that exist in C++11.
@ EST_None
no exception specification
@ EST_BasicNoexcept
noexcept
@ EST_NoexceptFalse
noexcept(expression), evals to 'false'
@ EST_Dynamic
throw(T1, T2)
PredefinedIdentKind
Definition Expr.h:1989
CheckedConversionKind
The kind of conversion being performed.
Definition Sema.h:437
@ Implicit
An implicit conversion.
Definition Sema.h:439
@ CStyleCast
A C-style cast.
Definition Sema.h:441
@ ForBuiltinOverloadedOp
A conversion for an operand of a builtin overloaded operator.
Definition Sema.h:447
@ OtherCast
A cast other than a C-style cast.
Definition Sema.h:445
@ FunctionalCast
A functional-style cast.
Definition Sema.h:443
ActionResult< Stmt * > StmtResult
Definition Ownership.h:250
NonOdrUseReason
The reason why a DeclRefExpr does not constitute an odr-use.
Definition Specifiers.h:173
unsigned int uint32_t
Diagnostic wrappers for TextAPI types for error reporting.
Definition Dominators.h:30
int const char * function
Definition c++config.h:31
#define false
Definition stdbool.h:26
#define true
Definition stdbool.h:25
The result of a constraint satisfaction check, containing the necessary information to diagnose an un...
Definition ASTConcept.h:91
DeclarationNameInfo - A collector data type for bundling together a DeclarationName and the correspon...
A structure used to record information about a failed template argument deduction,...
Describes whether we've seen any nullability information for the given file.
Definition Sema.h:241
SourceLocation PointerEndLoc
The end location for the first pointer declarator in the file.
Definition Sema.h:248
SourceLocation PointerLoc
The first pointer declarator (of any pointer kind) in the file that does not have a corresponding nul...
Definition Sema.h:244
bool SawTypeNullability
Whether we saw any type nullability annotations in the given file.
Definition Sema.h:254
uint8_t PointerKind
Which kind of pointer declarator we saw.
Definition Sema.h:251
A FunctionEffect plus a potential boolean expression determining whether the effect is declared (e....
Definition TypeBase.h:5006
Holds information about the various types of exception specification.
Definition TypeBase.h:5326
ExceptionSpecificationType Type
The kind of exception specification this is.
Definition TypeBase.h:5328
ArrayRef< QualType > Exceptions
Explicitly-specified list of exception types.
Definition TypeBase.h:5331
Expr * NoexceptExpr
Noexcept expression, if this is a computed noexcept specification.
Definition TypeBase.h:5334
Extra information about a function prototype.
Definition TypeBase.h:5354
Represents a complete lambda introducer.
Definition DeclSpec.h:2806
Contains a late templated function.
Definition Sema.h:15636
FPOptions FPO
Floating-point options in the point of definition.
Definition Sema.h:15641
Decl * D
The template function declaration to be late parsed.
Definition Sema.h:15639
A normalized constraint, as defined in C++ [temp.constr.normal], is either an atomic constraint,...
Definition SemaConcept.h:36
OverloadCandidate - A single candidate in an overload set (C++ 13.3).
Definition Overload.h:932
Describes how types, statements, expressions, and declarations should be printed.
SourceLocation CurrentPragmaLocation
Definition Sema.h:2030
bool SuppressUserConversions
Do not consider any user-defined conversions when constructing the initializing sequence.
Definition Sema.h:10494
bool OnlyInitializeNonUserDefinedConversions
Before constructing the initializing sequence, we check whether the parameter type and argument type ...
Definition Sema.h:10501
CheckNonDependentConversionsFlag(bool SuppressUserConversions, bool OnlyInitializeNonUserDefinedConversions)
Definition Sema.h:10503
bool StrictPackMatch
Is set to true when, in the context of TTP matching, a pack parameter matches non-pack arguments.
Definition Sema.h:11984
bool MatchingTTP
If true, assume these template arguments are the injected template arguments for a template template ...
Definition Sema.h:11980
CheckTemplateArgumentInfo(const CheckTemplateArgumentInfo &)=delete
CheckTemplateArgumentInfo(bool PartialOrdering=false, bool MatchingTTP=false)
Definition Sema.h:11961
bool PartialOrdering
The check is being performed in the context of partial ordering.
Definition Sema.h:11973
SmallVector< TemplateArgument, 4 > SugaredConverted
The checked, converted argument will be added to the end of these vectors.
Definition Sema.h:11970
SmallVector< TemplateArgument, 4 > CanonicalConverted
Definition Sema.h:11970
CheckTemplateArgumentInfo & operator=(const CheckTemplateArgumentInfo &)=delete
A context in which code is being synthesized (where a source location alone is not sufficient to iden...
Definition Sema.h:13076
SourceRange InstantiationRange
The source range that covers the construct that cause the instantiation, e.g., the template-id that c...
Definition Sema.h:13239
enum clang::Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::SynthesisKind Kind
bool InParameterMappingSubstitution
Whether we're substituting into the parameter mapping of a constraint.
Definition Sema.h:13196
const TemplateArgument * TemplateArgs
The list of template arguments we are substituting, if they are not part of the entity.
Definition Sema.h:13212
ArrayRef< TemplateArgument > template_arguments() const
Definition Sema.h:13231
NamedDecl * Template
The template (or partial specialization) in which we are performing the instantiation,...
Definition Sema.h:13207
SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation
The point of instantiation or synthesis within the source code.
Definition Sema.h:13199
unsigned NumCallArgs
The number of expressions in CallArgs.
Definition Sema.h:13225
bool InConstraintSubstitution
Whether we're substituting into constraints.
Definition Sema.h:13193
const Expr *const * CallArgs
The list of argument expressions in a synthesized call.
Definition Sema.h:13215
unsigned NumTemplateArgs
The number of template arguments in TemplateArgs.
Definition Sema.h:13222
SynthesisKind
The kind of template instantiation we are performing.
Definition Sema.h:13078
@ MarkingClassDllexported
We are marking a class as __dllexport.
Definition Sema.h:13170
@ DefaultTemplateArgumentInstantiation
We are instantiating a default argument for a template parameter.
Definition Sema.h:13088
@ ExplicitTemplateArgumentSubstitution
We are substituting explicit template arguments provided for a function template.
Definition Sema.h:13097
@ DefaultTemplateArgumentChecking
We are checking the validity of a default template argument that has been used when naming a template...
Definition Sema.h:13116
@ InitializingStructuredBinding
We are initializing a structured binding.
Definition Sema.h:13167
@ ExceptionSpecInstantiation
We are instantiating the exception specification for a function template which was deferred until it ...
Definition Sema.h:13124
@ NestedRequirementConstraintsCheck
We are checking the satisfaction of a nested requirement of a requires expression.
Definition Sema.h:13131
@ BuildingBuiltinDumpStructCall
We are building an implied call from __builtin_dump_struct.
Definition Sema.h:13174
@ DefiningSynthesizedFunction
We are defining a synthesized function (such as a defaulted special member).
Definition Sema.h:13142
@ Memoization
Added for Template instantiation observation.
Definition Sema.h:13180
@ LambdaExpressionSubstitution
We are substituting into a lambda expression.
Definition Sema.h:13107
@ TypeAliasTemplateInstantiation
We are instantiating a type alias template declaration.
Definition Sema.h:13186
@ BuildingDeductionGuides
We are building deduction guides for a class.
Definition Sema.h:13183
@ PartialOrderingTTP
We are performing partial ordering for template template parameters.
Definition Sema.h:13189
@ DeducedTemplateArgumentSubstitution
We are substituting template argument determined as part of template argument deduction for either a ...
Definition Sema.h:13104
@ PriorTemplateArgumentSubstitution
We are substituting prior template arguments into a new template parameter.
Definition Sema.h:13112
@ ExceptionSpecEvaluation
We are computing the exception specification for a defaulted special member function.
Definition Sema.h:13120
@ TemplateInstantiation
We are instantiating a template declaration.
Definition Sema.h:13081
@ DeclaringSpecialMember
We are declaring an implicit special member function.
Definition Sema.h:13134
@ DeclaringImplicitEqualityComparison
We are declaring an implicit 'operator==' for a defaulted 'operator<=>'.
Definition Sema.h:13138
@ DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation
We are instantiating a default argument for a function.
Definition Sema.h:13093
@ RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship
We are rewriting a comparison operator in terms of an operator<=>.
Definition Sema.h:13164
@ RequirementInstantiation
We are instantiating a requirement of a requires expression.
Definition Sema.h:13127
Decl * Entity
The entity that is being synthesized.
Definition Sema.h:13202
CXXSpecialMemberKind SpecialMember
The special member being declared or defined.
Definition Sema.h:13228
bool isInstantiationRecord() const
Determines whether this template is an actual instantiation that should be counted toward the maximum...
InitializationContext(SourceLocation Loc, ValueDecl *Decl, DeclContext *Context)
Definition Sema.h:6851
Data structure used to record current or nested expression evaluation contexts.
Definition Sema.h:6752
SmallVector< CXXBindTemporaryExpr *, 8 > DelayedDecltypeBinds
If we are processing a decltype type, a set of temporary binding expressions for which we have deferr...
Definition Sema.h:6785
llvm::SmallPtrSet< const Expr *, 8 > PossibleDerefs
Definition Sema.h:6787
bool InLifetimeExtendingContext
Whether we are currently in a context in which all temporaries must be lifetime-extended,...
Definition Sema.h:6838
Decl * ManglingContextDecl
The declaration that provides context for lambda expressions and block literals if the normal declara...
Definition Sema.h:6772
SmallVector< CallExpr *, 8 > DelayedDecltypeCalls
If we are processing a decltype type, a set of call expressions for which we have deferred checking t...
Definition Sema.h:6781
SmallVector< Expr *, 2 > VolatileAssignmentLHSs
Expressions appearing as the LHS of a volatile assignment in this context.
Definition Sema.h:6792
llvm::SmallPtrSet< DeclRefExpr *, 4 > ReferenceToConsteval
Set of DeclRefExprs referencing a consteval function when used in a context not already known to be i...
Definition Sema.h:6800
llvm::SmallVector< ImmediateInvocationCandidate, 4 > ImmediateInvocationCandidates
Set of candidates for starting an immediate invocation.
Definition Sema.h:6796
bool IsCaseExpr
Whether evaluating an expression for a switch case label.
Definition Sema.h:6841
SmallVector< MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, 8 > ForRangeLifetimeExtendTemps
P2718R0 - Lifetime extension in range-based for loops.
Definition Sema.h:6806
enum clang::Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext
SmallVector< LambdaExpr *, 2 > Lambdas
The lambdas that are present within this context, if it is indeed an unevaluated context.
Definition Sema.h:6767
ExpressionKind
Describes whether we are in an expression constext which we have to handle differently.
Definition Sema.h:6814
bool RebuildDefaultArgOrDefaultInit
Whether we should rebuild CXXDefaultArgExpr and CXXDefaultInitExpr.
Definition Sema.h:6844
SmallVector< MisalignedMember, 4 > MisalignedMembers
Small set of gathered accesses to potentially misaligned members due to the packed attribute.
Definition Sema.h:6810
CleanupInfo ParentCleanup
Whether the enclosing context needed a cleanup.
Definition Sema.h:6757
VarDecl * DeclForInitializer
Declaration for initializer if one is currently being parsed.
Definition Sema.h:6777
std::optional< InitializationContext > DelayedDefaultInitializationContext
Definition Sema.h:6861
ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(ExpressionEvaluationContext Context, unsigned NumCleanupObjects, CleanupInfo ParentCleanup, Decl *ManglingContextDecl, ExpressionKind ExprContext)
Definition Sema.h:6863
ExpressionEvaluationContext Context
The expression evaluation context.
Definition Sema.h:6754
unsigned NumCleanupObjects
The number of active cleanup objects when we entered this expression evaluation context.
Definition Sema.h:6761
FormatArgumentPassingKind ArgPassingKind
Definition Sema.h:2607
FunctionEffectDiffVector(const FunctionEffectsRef &Old, const FunctionEffectsRef &New)
Caller should short-circuit by checking for equality first.
std::optional< FunctionEffectWithCondition > Old
Definition Sema.h:15543
bool shouldDiagnoseConversion(QualType SrcType, const FunctionEffectsRef &SrcFX, QualType DstType, const FunctionEffectsRef &DstFX) const
Return true if adding or removing the effect as part of a type conversion should generate a diagnosti...
bool shouldDiagnoseRedeclaration(const FunctionDecl &OldFunction, const FunctionEffectsRef &OldFX, const FunctionDecl &NewFunction, const FunctionEffectsRef &NewFX) const
Return true if adding or removing the effect in a redeclaration should generate a diagnostic.
StringRef effectName() const
Definition Sema.h:15547
OverrideResult shouldDiagnoseMethodOverride(const CXXMethodDecl &OldMethod, const FunctionEffectsRef &OldFX, const CXXMethodDecl &NewMethod, const FunctionEffectsRef &NewFX) const
Return true if adding or removing the effect in a C++ virtual method override should generate a diagn...
OverrideResult
Describes the result of effects differing between a base class's virtual method and an overriding met...
Definition Sema.h:15555
std::optional< FunctionEffectWithCondition > New
Definition Sema.h:15545
FunctionEffect::Kind EffectKind
Definition Sema.h:15540
bool isInvalid() const
Determines whether we have exceeded the maximum recursive template instantiations.
Definition Sema.h:13415
InstantiatingTemplate(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation, Decl *Entity, SourceRange InstantiationRange=SourceRange())
Note that we are instantiating a class template, function template, variable template,...
void Clear()
Note that we have finished instantiating this template.
LocalInstantiationScope * Scope
Definition Sema.h:14078
LateInstantiatedAttribute(const Attr *A, LocalInstantiationScope *S, Decl *D)
Definition Sema.h:14081
bool isMoveEligible() const
Definition Sema.h:11101
bool isCopyElidable() const
Definition Sema.h:11102
const VarDecl * Candidate
Definition Sema.h:11096
IdentifierInfo * Identifier
The identifier preceding the '::'.
Definition Sema.h:3273
NestedNameSpecInfo(IdentifierInfo *II, SourceLocation IdLoc, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc, ParsedType ObjectType=ParsedType())
Creates info object for the most typical case.
Definition Sema.h:3282
SourceLocation IdentifierLoc
The location of the identifier.
Definition Sema.h:3276
SourceLocation CCLoc
The location of the '::'.
Definition Sema.h:3279
ParsedType ObjectType
The type of the object, if we're parsing nested-name-specifier in a member access expression.
Definition Sema.h:3270
NestedNameSpecInfo(IdentifierInfo *II, SourceLocation IdLoc, SourceLocation ColonColonLoc, QualType ObjectType)
Definition Sema.h:3288
SourceLocation LocStart
Definition Sema.h:7546
IdentifierInfo * IdentInfo
Definition Sema.h:7549
OriginalCallArg(QualType OriginalParamType, bool DecomposedParam, unsigned ArgIdx, QualType OriginalArgType)
Definition Sema.h:12603
This an attribute introduced by #pragma clang attribute.
Definition Sema.h:2086
SmallVector< attr::SubjectMatchRule, 4 > MatchRules
Definition Sema.h:2089
A push'd group of PragmaAttributeEntries.
Definition Sema.h:2094
SourceLocation Loc
The location of the push attribute.
Definition Sema.h:2096
SmallVector< PragmaAttributeEntry, 2 > Entries
Definition Sema.h:2099
const IdentifierInfo * Namespace
The namespace of this push group.
Definition Sema.h:2098
SourceLocation PragmaLocation
Definition Sema.h:1808
PragmaMsStackAction Action
Definition Sema.h:1828
Slot(llvm::StringRef StackSlotLabel, ValueType Value, SourceLocation PragmaLocation, SourceLocation PragmaPushLocation)
Definition Sema.h:1941
llvm::StringRef StackSlotLabel
Definition Sema.h:1937
SourceLocation PragmaLocation
Definition Sema.h:1939
SourceLocation PragmaPushLocation
Definition Sema.h:1940
ValueType CurrentValue
Definition Sema.h:2011
void SentinelAction(PragmaMsStackAction Action, StringRef Label)
Definition Sema.h:1997
bool hasValue() const
Definition Sema.h:2007
SmallVector< Slot, 2 > Stack
Definition Sema.h:2009
ValueType DefaultValue
Definition Sema.h:2010
SourceLocation CurrentPragmaLocation
Definition Sema.h:2012
PragmaStack(const ValueType &Default)
Definition Sema.h:2004
void Act(SourceLocation PragmaLocation, PragmaMsStackAction Action, llvm::StringRef StackSlotLabel, ValueType Value)
Definition Sema.h:1948
ProcessDeclAttributeOptions WithIgnoreTypeAttributes(bool Val)
Definition Sema.h:5063
ProcessDeclAttributeOptions WithIncludeCXX11Attributes(bool Val)
Definition Sema.h:5057
RecursiveInstGuard(Sema &S, Decl *D, Kind Kind)
Definition Sema.h:13051
ReferenceConversions
The conversions that would be performed on an lvalue of type T2 when binding a reference of type T1 t...
Definition Sema.h:10391
SFINAEContextBase(Sema &S, SFINAETrap *Cur)
Definition Sema.h:12416
Abstract class used to diagnose incomplete types.
Definition Sema.h:8246
virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T)=0
TypeTagData(QualType Type, bool LayoutCompatible, bool MustBeNull)
Definition Sema.h:2649
unsigned LayoutCompatible
If true, Type should be compared with other expression's types for layout-compatibility.
Definition Sema.h:2658
bool CheckSameAsPrevious
Definition Sema.h:354
NamedDecl * Previous
Definition Sema.h:355
SkipBodyInfo()=default
NamedDecl * New
Definition Sema.h:356
Information about a template-id annotation token.
Morty Proxy This is a proxified and sanitized view of the page, visit original site.